CONNING CORP
S-1/A, 1997-12-11
INVESTMENT ADVICE
Previous: OFFICE DEPOT INC, SC 13G/A, 1997-12-11
Next: EPITOPE INC/OR/, 8-K, 1997-12-11



<PAGE> 1
   
   AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON DECEMBER 11, 1997
    
                                                     REGISTRATION NO. 333-35993
===============================================================================

                      SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                            WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

                     ------------------------------------
   
                                AMENDMENT NO. 3
    
                                      TO
                                   FORM S-1
                            REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                          THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

                     ------------------------------------

                              CONNING CORPORATION
            (EXACT NAME OF REGISTRANT AS SPECIFIED IN ITS CHARTER)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
  <S>                                     <C>                                      <C>
              MISSOURI                                6282                               43-1719355
  (STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION OF         (PRIMARY STANDARD INDUSTRIAL                (I.R.S. EMPLOYER
          INCORPORATION OR                       CLASSIFICATION                    IDENTIFICATION NUMBER)
           ORGANIZATION)                          CODE NUMBER)
</TABLE>

                               700 MARKET STREET
                              ST. LOUIS, MO 63101
                                (314) 444-0498
  (ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE, OF
                   REGISTRANT'S PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES)

              ---------------------------------------------------

                             LEONARD M. RUBENSTEIN
                     CHAIRMAN AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
                              CONNING CORPORATION
                               700 MARKET STREET
                              ST. LOUIS, MO 63101
                                (314) 444-0498
(NAME, ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE,
                             OF AGENT FOR SERVICE)

              ---------------------------------------------------

                                  COPIES TO:

   JAMES L. NOUSS, JR., ESQ.                     GARY I. HOROWITZ, ESQ.
     R. RANDALL WANG, ESQ.                        ROBERT M. KANER, ESQ.
        BRYAN CAVE LLP                         SIMPSON THACHER & BARTLETT
211 NORTH BROADWAY, SUITE 3600                    425 LEXINGTON AVENUE
     ST. LOUIS, MO 63102                           NEW YORK, NY 10017
       (314) 259-2000                                (212) 455-2000
    FAX: (314) 259-2020                           FAX: (212) 455-2502


                   ----------------------------------------

    Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as
practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.

    If any of the securities registered on this form are to be offered on a
delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of
1933, other than securities offered only in connection with dividend or
interest reinvestment plans, check the following box. / /

    If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following
box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier
effective registration statement for the same offering. / /

    If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c)
under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. / /

    If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434,
please check the following box. / /

    THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR
DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT
SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(a) OF
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME
EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(a),
MAY DETERMINE.

===============================================================================

<PAGE> 2
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A
REGISTRATION STATEMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION. THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR MAY
OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT BECOMES
EFFECTIVE. THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR THE
SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE SECURITIES
IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION OR SALE WOULD BE UNLAWFUL PRIOR
TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY SUCH STATE.

   
                SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED DECEMBER 11, 1997
    

PROSPECTUS
         , 1997

                                [CONNING LOGO]

                               2,500,000 SHARES

                              CONNING CORPORATION

                                 COMMON STOCK

  All of the 2,500,000 shares of Common Stock offered hereby are being sold by
Conning Corporation (the "Company" or "Conning").

    After completion of the offering, General American Life Insurance Company
("General American") will beneficially own approximately 65% of the Company's
Common Stock (approximately 63% if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is
exercised in full). See "Risk Factors--Dependence on Principal Shareholder"
and "--Potential Conflicts of Interest."

    Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock. It is currently estimated that the initial public offering price will be
between $12.50 and $14.50 per share. See "Underwriting" for a discussion of
the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price.
The Company has received approval for the trading of its Common Stock on the
Nasdaq National Market under the symbol "CNNG," subject to official notice of
issuance.

    SEE "RISK FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE 9 FOR CERTAIN INFORMATION THAT
SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS.

THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES
 AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
 SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION
  PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRE-
          SENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                         PRICE            UNDERWRITING
                                                        TO THE            DISCOUNTS AND       PROCEEDS TO THE
                                                        PUBLIC           COMMISSIONS<F1>        COMPANY<F2>
<S>                                                     <C>                  <C>                 <C>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Share.......................................           $                    $                   $

Total <F2><F3>..................................        $                    $                   $
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<FN>

<F1> The Company has agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against certain
     liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
     amended (the "Securities Act"). See "Underwriting."

<F2> Before deducting offering expenses estimated at $1,375,000, payable by the
     Company.

<F3> The Company has granted to the Underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up
     to 375,000 additional shares of Common Stock on the same terms and
     conditions as set forth above solely to cover over-allotments, if any. If
     such option is exercised in full, the total Price to the Public,
     Underwriting Discounts and Commissions and Proceeds to the Company will be
     $                , $                and $               , respectively.
       ---------------    --------------       --------------
     See "Underwriting."
</TABLE>

    The shares of Common Stock are being offered by the several Underwriters,
subject to prior sale, when, as and if delivered to and accepted by them and
subject to various prior conditions, including their right to reject any order
in whole or in part. It is expected that delivery of the certificates for such
shares will be made against payment therefor in New York, New York on or about
                , 1997.

DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE                          A.G. EDWARDS & SONS, INC.
   SECURITIES CORPORATION


<PAGE> 3

[CONNING LOGO]



                     [REPRESENTATION OF FLOW CHART]


    CORE                      STRATEGIC                          PRODUCTS &
COMPETENCIES                  CRITERIA                            SERVICES


 INVESTMENT                                                        ASSET
 EXPERTISE                    RECURRING                          MANAGEMENT
                              REVENUE
  INSURANCE                                                      SPECIALIZED
  INDUSTRY             MARKET               ABILITY TO             ASSETS
 KNOWLEDGE & ----->  LEADERSHIP            DIFFERENTIATE ------>
 REPUTATION                                                      INVESTMENT
                                                                  ADVISORY
  CLIENT
  SERVICE                                                        INVESTMENT
  FOCUS                                                          ACCOUNTING
                                                                 & REPORTING
                             HIGH VALUE
                               ADDED                               PRIVATE
                                                                   EQUITY

                                                                 INSURANCE
                                                                 RESEARCH
                                                                 SERVICES


    Using its core competencies, Conning's business strategy is to apply one or
more of its strategic criteria to provide products and services to its clients.

    "Conning" and the related logo are service marks of the Company.

    CERTAIN PERSONS PARTICIPATING IN THIS OFFERING MAY ENGAGE IN TRANSACTIONS
THAT STABILIZE, MAINTAIN, OR OTHERWISE AFFECT THE PRICE OF THE COMMON STOCK.
SPECIFICALLY, THE UNDERWRITERS MAY OVERALLOT IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFERING,
AND MAY BID FOR, AND PURCHASE, SHARES OF THE COMMON STOCK IN THE OPEN MARKET.
IN ADDITION, CERTAIN UNDERWRITERS AND SELLING GROUP MEMBERS MAY ENGAGE IN
PASSIVE MARKET MAKING. FOR A DESCRIPTION OF THESE ACTIVITIES, SEE
"UNDERWRITING."

                                       2

<PAGE> 4
                              PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

    The following summary is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read
in conjunction with, the more detailed information and the Consolidated
Financial Statements, including the Notes thereto, appearing elsewhere in this
Prospectus. Unless otherwise indicated, all information in this Prospectus: (i)
reflects the conversion of all outstanding shares of Series A Convertible
Preferred Stock into an aggregate of 3,190,000 shares of Common Stock, the
conversion of all outstanding shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock
into an aggregate of 365,000 shares of Common Stock for additional
consideration to the Company of $1.67 per share, and the conversion of all
outstanding shares of Non-Voting Common Stock into an aggregate of 110,000
shares of Common Stock, upon or prior to the completion of this offering (the
"Capital Stock Conversions") and (ii) assumes that the over-allotment option
granted to the Underwriters by the Company will not be exercised.

    The Company is the successor to the business conducted by Conning, Inc. and
its operating subsidiary, Conning & Company (collectively, "Conning, Inc."),
and Conning Asset Management Company, formerly known as General American
Investment Management Company ("GAIMCO"), pursuant to a merger (the
"Strategic Merger") effected in August 1995. Prior to the Strategic Merger,
Conning, Inc. and GAIMCO were unrelated business entities. Conning, Inc. was an
85-year old Hartford, Connecticut based insurance specialty asset management
firm which provided asset management services and research for the insurance
industry. GAIMCO was a registered investment adviser which provided investment
advisory services primarily to its parent, General American Life Insurance
Company ("General American"), and its affiliates. The parties effected the
Strategic Merger in order to combine complementary businesses, each with
specialties in the insurance industry, to build a platform from which to
leverage additional growth. See "Certain Relationships and Related
Transactions--The Strategic Merger." Other than historical financial
statements and data, information herein concerning the Company regarding
periods prior to the date of the Strategic Merger, including without limitation
with respect to assets under management and private equity funds, includes the
Company and its predecessors unless the context indicates otherwise.

    The Company is a holding company that conducts its business through three
subsidiaries: (i) Conning, Inc. is a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company and
serves as an intermediate holding company; (ii) Conning & Company is a
wholly-owned subsidiary of Conning, Inc. and is a registered investment adviser
and broker-dealer; and (iii) Conning Asset Management Company is a wholly-owned
subsidiary of Conning & Company and is a registered investment adviser.
Throughout this Prospectus, the terms "Company" and "Conning" refer to
Conning Corporation and its subsidiaries. See "Glossary" for definitions of
certain terms used in this Prospectus.

                                  THE COMPANY

GENERAL

    Conning is a nationally recognized asset management company providing
services to the insurance industry and is also a leading provider of insurance
research. As of September 30, 1997, the Company had approximately $26.4 billion
of assets under discretionary management and, in total, provided services with
respect to approximately $73.6 billion of assets for insurance company clients.
The Company believes it is well positioned to take advantage of the continued
growth in insurance industry assets and the willingness of insurance companies
to consider utilizing external investment management expertise. During the
period from 1992 through 1996, assets under discretionary management of the
Company increased by an average of 24% per year, on a pro forma basis after
giving effect to the Strategic Merger and the inclusion of assets of General
American for all years. In 1996, its first full year of operations following
the Strategic Merger, the Company had revenues of approximately $53.7 million
and net earnings of approximately $6.2 million. During the nine months ended
September 30, 1997, the Company had revenues of approximately $46.9 million and
net earnings of approximately $6.4 million.

    The Company believes that it possesses competitive strengths in insurance
asset management which may support its prospects for growth:

    INSURANCE INDUSTRY FOCUS AND KNOWLEDGE. Based upon the Company's extensive
work with insurance companies, the Company believes that its focus on the
insurance industry allows it to provide substantially all of the services and
products that an insurance company seeks from an asset manager. By utilizing
its specialized knowledge of insurance company investment considerations, the
Company believes, based upon feedback from clients, that it offers

                                       3

<PAGE> 5
a more comprehensive set of asset management services than many of its
competitors, including asset allocation, asset and liability matching, cash
forecasts, tax modeling and investment accounting & reporting. The Company
offers expertise in asset classes that many insurance companies traditionally
utilize, including commercial mortgage loans, investment real estate and
private placements.

    NAME RECOGNITION WITHIN THE INSURANCE INDUSTRY. The Company believes that
the established reputation of Conning within the insurance industry provides
the Company with a marketing advantage. According to a 1996 survey by Eager &
Associates of 156 domestic, non-captive insurance companies and 110 groups of
insurance companies (representing 692 individual companies) each with assets
over $30 million (the "Eager Study"), the Company ranks among the top two
insurance asset management firms in terms of name recognition among survey
respondents. The Company's in-depth insurance industry research has been
targeted to senior executives in the insurance industry for more than 20 years,
and its Strategic Studies Series is subscribed to by 44 of the 50 largest U.S.
property-casualty insurance companies and 42 of the 50 largest U.S. life-health
insurance companies (based on 1996 premiums as reported by OneSource
Information Services, Inc. as provided to it by third parties).

    CLIENT SERVICE AND PERFORMANCE FOCUS. The Company attempts to differentiate
itself from competitors through its insurance-specific capabilities, investment
performance and frequent, responsive client communication. During the period
from 1992 through 1996, the Company retained an average of approximately 95% of
unaffiliated clients on an annual basis.

    EXPERIENCED MANAGEMENT WITH SIGNIFICANT STOCK OWNERSHIP. The Company
employs an experienced management team, the members of which have an average of
approximately 15 years of experience in the investment or insurance business.
In total, the employees of the Company will own in the aggregate approximately
29% of the Common Stock on a fully diluted basis after the offering (including
options to be granted upon the closing of this offering). See "Management"
and "Principal Shareholders."

COMPANY OPERATIONS

    The Company's business is asset management for insurance companies, which
is supplemented by its in-depth research focused on the insurance industry. The
Company's asset management services consist of three components: (i)
discretionary asset management services, (ii) investment advisory services and
(iii) investment accounting & reporting services. In connection with its
discretionary asset management services, the Company originates and services
commercial mortgages and manages investments in real estate assets. The Company
also sponsors and manages private equity funds investing in insurance and
insurance-related companies.

    ASSET MANAGEMENT. The Company's insurance asset management services are
designed to optimize investment returns for clients within the guidelines
imposed by insurance regulatory, accounting, tax and asset/liability management
considerations. As of September 30, 1997, the Company provided services with
respect to approximately $73.6 billion in assets, of which approximately (i)
$26.4 billion represented assets under discretionary management, (ii) $21.0
billion represented assets serviced under investment advisory agreements and
(iii) $26.2 billion represented assets receiving investment accounting &
reporting services on a stand-alone basis. As part of its discretionary asset
management services, as of September 30, 1997, the Company managed
approximately $2.6 billion of commercial mortgage loans and investment real
estate.

    The Company manages private equity funds which invest in insurance and
insurance-related companies. Since 1985, the Company has sponsored five private
equity funds, raising approximately $360 million in committed capital and
investing more than $193 million of these proceeds in 39 portfolio company
investments.

    INSURANCE RESEARCH. The Company believes that Conning & Company is one of
the leading insurance industry research firms in the United States. The Company
publishes in-depth insurance industry research covering major insurance
industry trends, products, markets and business segments. The Company also
publishes stock research on a broad group of publicly-traded insurance
companies for some of the largest United States institutional money managers as
well as pension funds, banks, mutual funds, and insurance companies. Conning &
Company also from time to time participates in the underwriting of public
offerings of equity securities for insurance and insurance-related companies.

                                       4

<PAGE> 6
    The Company's principal executive offices are currently located at 700
Market Street, St. Louis, Missouri 63101 (telephone number: (314) 444-0498) and
at CityPlace II, 185 Asylum Street, Hartford, Connecticut 06103 (telephone
number: (860) 527-1131).

DEVELOPING TRENDS IN THE INSURANCE INDUSTRY

    Certain key insurance industry trends that also affect the management of
insurance company assets are as follows:

    GROWING INSURANCE COMPANY ASSETS. Insurance company assets have grown over
several decades and during the period from 1986 to 1996 grew at an average rate
of approximately 9% per year, from approximately $1.3 trillion, to
approximately $3.1 trillion, according to a standard industry source.

    ACCEPTANCE OF OUTSOURCING. The Company believes that many insurance
companies are utilizing non-affiliated asset managers in order to respond to
competitive product requirements and the pressure to achieve higher returns on
investments while maintaining an acceptable level of risk. According to the
Eager Study, assets under management by external, non-affiliated managers
(which represented approximately 15% of industry assets in 1996) increased at a
rate of 17% per year from $300 billion in 1994 to $415 billion in 1996. Based
upon information provided by an industry source, insurance company assets
increased at a rate of approximately 9% per year, from $2.6 trillion in 1994 to
$3.1 trillion in 1996. The authors of the Eager Study concluded that externally
managed assets would continue to grow, but believed that the growth rate would
lose momentum over the next few years covered by the study.

STRATEGY

    The Company's primary operating strategy is to grow recurring, fee-based
asset management-related revenues, cash flow and profits through the following:

    LEVERAGE ESTABLISHED ASSET MANAGEMENT PLATFORM TO GENERATE GROWTH AND
PROFITABILITY. The Company believes that it has established a platform, made up
of core investment professionals, product expertise and systems, to support
future growth in fee-based asset management revenues. Opportunities for asset
management growth are expected to come from new and existing clients, strategic
acquisitions and alliances and through General American and its affiliates.

    GENERATE GROWTH FROM NEW AND EXISTING CLIENTS. The Company intends to take
advantage of the growth in insurance industry assets and a trend among
insurance companies to seek external investment management expertise. The
Company will pursue growth in assets under management from new clients by
increasing the Company's sales and marketing efforts and by leveraging the
Company's strong name recognition. Additionally, the Company will continue to
pursue growth in assets under management from existing clients by seeking to
increase its share of its clients' assets and from underlying growth in
existing assets.

    PURSUE STRATEGIC ACQUISITIONS AND ALLIANCES TO EXPAND MARKET PENETRATION.
The Company regularly evaluates strategic acquisitions, joint ventures and
marketing alliances as a means of increasing assets under management, expanding
the range of its product offerings and increasing its sales and marketing
capabilities.

    LEVERAGE STRATEGIC ALLIANCE WITH GROWING PARTNER. The Company's
relationship with General American, the Company's principal shareholder,
provides opportunities for distribution of the Company's products and services
to General American and its affiliates. The Company has benefited from the
internal growth and acquisition activity of General American and its
affiliates, with assets under management of General American and its affiliates
increasing at an average rate of approximately 14% per year, from approximately
$5.4 billion as of December 31, 1991 to approximately $10.6 billion as of
December 31, 1996. At September 30, 1997, such affiliated assets under
management totaled approximately $13.5 billion.

                                 RISK FACTORS

    No assurances can be given that the Company's objectives or strategies will
be achieved. Prospective investors should consider carefully the factors
discussed in detail elsewhere in this Prospectus under the captions
"Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements" and "Risk
Factors."

                                       5

<PAGE> 7

<TABLE>
                                 THE OFFERING
<CAPTION>

<S>                            <C>
Common Stock offered by the
  Company..................... 2,500,000 shares

Common Stock outstanding after
  the offering................ 12,875,000 shares<F1>

Dividend Policy............... The Company currently intends to pay quarterly cash dividends of
                               approximately $0.04 per share of Common Stock ($0.16 annually),
                               commencing in the first quarter of 1998. However, any dividends will
                               be (i) dependent upon the Company's earnings, capital requirements,
                               operating and financial condition and other relevant factors, (ii)
                               subject to declaration by the Company's Board of Directors, and (iii)
                               subject to certain regulatory constraints. See "Risk Fac-
                               tors--Regulation" and "Dividend Policy."

Use of Proceeds............... For general corporate purposes, including possible strategic acqui-
                               sitions or alliances. See "Use of Proceeds."

Nasdaq National Market
  symbol...................... "CNNG"

<FN>
- --------

<F1> Assumes no exercise of outstanding stock options. As of the date of this
     Prospectus, there are outstanding options to purchase 1,237,500 shares of
     Common Stock at a weighted average price of $5.65 per share. In addition,
     upon the closing of this offering the Company intends to grant options to
     purchase an additional estimated 1,294,987 shares of Common Stock at the
     initial public offering price. Does not include an aggregate of an
     estimated 905,013 shares of Common Stock reserved for future issuance
     under the Company's employee stock plans. See "Management--Employee Stock
     Plans" and Note 12 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial
     Statements.
</TABLE>

                                       6

<PAGE> 8
<TABLE>
                                          SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       YEARS ENDED        NINE MONTHS ENDED
                                              YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,<F1>           DECEMBER 31,<F2>       SEPTEMBER 30,
                                       ------------------------------------------  --------------------  --------------------
                                         1992       1993       1994       1995       1995       1996       1996       1997
                                                                                 PRO FORMA

INCOME STATEMENT DATA:                                       (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                     <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Revenues:

  Asset management and related
    fees...........................     $1,716     $2,446     $3,484    $24,050    $30,675    $40,456    $29,365    $36,018

  Research services................          0          0          0      4,090      9,480     12,148      9,582     10,278

  Other income.....................         51         36         57        663        996      1,062        792        629
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------

      Total revenues...............      1,767      2,482      3,541     28,803     41,151     53,666     39,739     46,925
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------

Operating income...................        832      1,341      2,112      6,292      7,389     11,792      9,093     10,972

  Interest expense.................          0          0          0        521      1,365        729        592        233
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------

Income before provision for income
  taxes............................        832      1,341      2,112      5,771      6,025     11,063      8,501     10,739

Provision for income taxes.........        311        507        827      2,359      2,739      4,851      3,762      4,317
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------

      Net income...................     $  521     $  834     $1,285    $ 3,412    $ 3,286    $ 6,212    $ 4,739    $ 6,422
                                        ======     ======     ======    =======    =======    =======    =======    =======

Preferred stock dividends..........          0          0          0        351        906        906        669        750
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------

Net earnings available to common
  shareholders.....................     $  521     $  834  $   1,285    $ 3,061    $ 2,380    $ 5,306    $ 4,070    $ 5,672
                                        ======     ======  =========    =======    =======    =======    =======    =======

      Pro forma net income per
        common share and common
        share equivalents <F3>.....                                                           $  0.57               $  0.58
                                                                                              =======               =======

<CAPTION>
                                                      AS OF DECEMBER 31,                    AS OF SEPTEMBER 30,
                                     -----------------------------------------------------  --------------------
                                         1992       1993       1994       1995       1996       1997       1997
                                                                                                            AS
                                                                                                         ADJUSTED
                                                                                                          <F4>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:                                                (IN THOUSANDS)

<S>                                     <C>        <C>        <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Total assets.......................     $1,395     $1,386     $1,683    $46,177    $50,020    $54,646    $85,255

Long-term debt.....................          0          0          0      9,000      2,000          0          0

Convertible preferred stock........          0          0          0     17,003     24,782     36,152          0

Total common shareholders'
  equity...........................        958        792      1,327      4,623      4,368         68     66,829

Number of common shares outstanding
  end of period....................        0.1        0.1        0.1      6,710      6,710      6,820     12,875

<CAPTION>
                                                              -----------------------------------------------------    AS OF
                                                                1992       1993       1994       1995       1996      9/30/97

OTHER OPERATING DATA:                                                          (IN BILLIONS, EXCEPT AS NOTED)
<S>                                                           <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Average assets under discretionary management<F5>:

  Unaffiliated..............................................  $     3.3  $     5.4  $     6.2  $     7.7  $     9.5  $    12.9

  General American & affiliates.............................        5.5        6.0        6.6        7.8        9.6       13.5
                                                              ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------

      Total.................................................        8.8       11.4       12.8       15.5       19.1       26.4

Average assets under advisory services......................        5.2       10.1       14.7       15.3       18.3       21.0

Average assets under accounting & reporting services........        0.0        1.3        2.6        4.8        9.2       26.2
                                                              ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------

      Total assets serviced.................................  $    14.0  $    22.8  $    30.1  $    35.6  $    46.6  $    73.6
                                                              =========  =========  =========  =========  =========  =========

<FN>
- ---------

<F1> The years 1992 to 1994 reflect the results of GAIMCO only. The year 1995
     reflects the results of the consolidated activity from August 1, 1995 to
     December 31, 1995 and the results of GAIMCO only from January 1, 1995 to
     July 31, 1995. See Note 1 to the Company's Consolidated Financial
     Statements.

<F2> Pro forma 1995 reflects the consolidated activity for the year assuming
     the Strategic Merger took place on January 1, 1995. The year 1996 reflects
     actual consolidated results. See Note 2 to the Company's Consolidated
     Financial Statements.

<F3> Pro forma earnings per share is computed by dividing net income by the
     weighted average number of shares of common stock and common stock
     equivalents considered outstanding during the period after giving effect
     to all dilutive common stock and common stock equivalents shares issued
     within twelve months of the public offering of the Company's common stock
     and to the Capital Stock Conversions.

<F4> Gives effect to the Capital Stock Conversions and the sale of 2,500,000
     shares of Common Stock offered hereby at an assumed initial public
     offering price of $13.50 per share and the receipt of the estimated net
     proceeds therefrom.

<F5> Since January 1, 1995, the assets of the general account of General
     American have been under contract with GAIMCO (now known as Conning Asset
     Management Company). General account assets prior to January 1, 1995 were
     managed by the investment division of General American, a predecessor of
     GAIMCO, and are included in assets under management for 1992, 1993 and
     1994. Data for 1995 and prior periods is presented on a pro forma basis to
     include both Conning and GAIMCO assets under management.
</TABLE>
                                       7

<PAGE> 9
                SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA (CONTINUED)

    The following financial information represents certain financial data of
Conning, Inc. and its subsidiaries for the years ended December 31, 1992, 1993
and 1994, and for the six months ended June 30, 1995:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  SIX
                                                                                                MONTHS
                                                                                                 ENDED
                                                                 YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,      JUNE 30,
                                                              -------------------------------  --------
CONNING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES                                  1992       1993       1994       1995
                                                                            (IN THOUSANDS)
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
<S>                                                             <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Revenues:

    Asset management and related fees.......................    $ 6,643    $ 8,107    $ 9,840    $ 5,662

    Research services.......................................      9,487     13,473      8,165      4,564

    Other income............................................        132      1,282        472        275
                                                                -------    -------     ------    -------

        Total revenues......................................     16,262     22,862     18,477     10,501
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------

Operating income............................................        582      4,441      2,751      2,092

    Interest expense........................................        111         85          0          0
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------

Income before provision for income taxes and cumulative
  effect of accounting change...............................        471      4,356      2,751      2,092

Provision for income taxes..................................         66        947      1,244        809
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------

Income before cumulative effect of accounting change........        405      3,409      1,507      1,283

Cumulative effect of accounting change......................          0        131          0          0
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------

        Net income..........................................    $   405    $ 3,540    $ 1,507    $ 1,283
                                                                =======    =======    =======    =======

Preferred stock dividends...................................         53        320        320        160
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------

Net earnings available to common shareholders...............    $   352    $ 3,220    $ 1,187    $ 1,123
                                                                =======    =======    =======    =======

<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  AS OF
                                                                     AS OF DECEMBER 31,         JUNE 30,
                                                               -------------------------------  --------
                                                                 1992       1993       1994       1995
                                                                            (IN THOUSANDS)
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
<S>                                                             <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Total assets................................................    $10,922    $11,274    $14,228    $16,003

Long-term debt..............................................          0          0          0          0

Redeemable preferred stock..................................      5,425          0          0          0

Cumulative preferred stock..................................          0      3,650      3,650      3,650

Total common shareholders' equity (deficit).................     (2,682)     2,552      4,186      5,426

Number of common shares outstanding end of period...........        446         93        106        108
</TABLE>

                                       8

<PAGE> 10
           CAUTIONARY STATEMENT REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

    Certain statements contained herein, including, without limitation, under
the captions "Prospectus Summary," "Risk Factors," "Business--General,"
"--Company Operations--Overview," "--Industry Background and Trends,"
"--Strategy" and "--Legal Proceedings" and "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," as well as
possible or assumed future results of operations of the Company, and other
statements contained herein or therein regarding matters that are not
historical facts, are or may constitute forward-looking statements, including,
without limitation, statements relating to the Company's financial position,
plans to increase revenues, competitive strengths, business objectives or
strategies, insurance industry trends and expectations regarding General
American's assets or activities. Because such statements are subject to risks
and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those expressed or
implied by such forward-looking statements. Factors that could cause actual
results to differ materially (the "Cautionary Statements") include, but are
not limited to, those discussed under "Risk Factors." All subsequent written
and oral forward-looking statements attributable to the Company or persons
acting on its behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety by the
Cautionary Statements. Investors are cautioned not to place undue reliance on
such statements, which speak only as of the date hereof. The Company undertakes
no obligation to release publicly any revisions to these forward-looking
statements after the completion of this offering to reflect events or
circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of
unanticipated events.

                                 RISK FACTORS

    In addition to the other information in this Prospectus, the following risk
factors should be considered carefully by prospective investors in evaluating
the Company before purchasing the Common Stock offered hereby.

RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH INSURANCE INDUSTRY FOCUS

    Because the Company focuses on providing asset management services to the
insurance industry, its business may be materially adversely affected by events
impacting the insurance industry. In particular, the insurance industry has
been experiencing consolidation as companies merge or are acquired. In the
event such consolidation activity continues and the Company's current or
prospective clients are acquired, their assets may subsequently be managed by
the combined company's internal staff or by another external manager. In such
event, the Company's business, financial condition, results of operations and
business prospects could be materially adversely affected. Further, as a
greater percentage of insurance company assets have shifted to external
management, additional opportunities to capture externally managed assets may
be limited. See "Business--Industry Background and Trends--Developing Trends
in the Insurance Industry." In addition, changes affecting the insurance
industry, including any changes in federal or state laws or regulations
relating thereto, including, without limitation, any change adversely affecting
insurance products or insurance company investments, may have a materially
adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition, results of
operations and business prospects.

DEPENDENCE ON PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDER

    The Company's business, financial condition, results of operations and
business prospects are significantly dependent on its relationship with its
principal shareholder, General American, an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of
General American Mutual Holding Company. See "Principal Shareholders." As of
September 30, 1997, General American and its affiliates accounted for
approximately $13.5 billion of the approximately $26.4 billion in assets which
the Company had under discretionary management. The advisory agreements between
General American or one of its affiliates and the Company are subject to
termination upon 30 to 90 days' notice without penalty; General American is a
co-licensee with the Company to the Company's investment accounting & reporting
software. There can be no assurance that General American and its affiliates
will maintain or not seek to renegotiate their existing investment advisory
relationships with the Company in the future, and the renegotiation of such
relationships could have, and the termination of such relationships would have,
a materially adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition,
results of operations and business prospects. Additionally, General American
presently leases to the Company all of the Company's office space in St. Louis
and provides to the Company certain administrative services. There can be no
assurance that such arrangements will continue or that the Company would be
able to

                                       9

<PAGE> 11
procure replacement office space or services on similar or otherwise favorable
terms. See "Business--Asset Management," "Business--Facilities," "Certain
Relationships and Related Transactions" and Note 11 of Notes to the Company's
Consolidated Financial Statements.

POTENTIAL CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

    General American will beneficially own approximately 65% of the Common
Stock after the consummation of the offering (approximately 63% if the
Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in full). The Company's Board
of Directors consists of five directors, three of whom are officers of the
Company or General American, and two of whom are not otherwise affiliated with
the Company or General American (the "Independent Directors"). After the
offering, General American will have the power to elect the Board of Directors
and to approve certain actions requiring shareholder approval, including
adopting amendments to the Company's articles of incorporation, and to control
certain other actions requiring shareholder approval, including mergers or
sales of substantially all of the assets of the Company or its subsidiaries.
For financial reporting purposes, General American will include its share of
the Company's net income or loss in its consolidated financial statements. The
Company's Board of Directors, including members who also are affiliated with
General American, may consider not only the short-term and long-term impact of
operating decisions on the Company but also the impact of such decisions on
General American. See "--Certain Other Anti-Takeover Provisions,"
"Management" and "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions."

    The Company is a party to investment advisory, administrative services, and
other agreements with General American and certain of its affiliates. Certain
officers of the Company were also officers of General American when such
agreements were entered into. Although the Company believes that the terms of
such agreements are at least as favorable to the Company as those it could
negotiate with unrelated parties, these agreements may be modified or
renegotiated in the future and additional agreements or transactions may be
entered into between the Company, on the one hand, and General American or its
affiliates, on the other hand. Conflicts of interest could arise between
General American and its affiliates with respect to any of the foregoing, or
any future agreements or arrangements between them. See "Certain Relationships
and Related Transactions."

    Executive officers, directors and employees of the Company from time to
time receive a profit interest in, and in the future may invest in, investment
funds in which the Company, or an affiliate of the Company, is a sponsor or an
investor or for which the Company performs asset management services, publishes
research or acts as a market-maker. In addition, the Company may in the future
organize businesses in which employees of the Company acquire minority
interests. There is a risk that, as a result of any such profit or investment
interest, a director, officer or employee may take actions which could conflict
with the best interests of the Company. See "Certain Relationships and Related
Transactions."

DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL

   
    The Company's future performance depends to a significant degree upon the
continued contributions of its officers and key management personnel listed in
the tables under the caption "Management--Directors, Executive Officers and
Certain Other Significant Officers." The Company is party to three-year
employment agreements, entered into in connection with the Strategic Merger
in August, 1995, with all of the then shareholders and option holders,
which agreements are terminable at any time by written notice, subject to
certain conditions. The employment agreements may not be specifically
enforceable against the employees as it is not possible to compel employees to
work for the Company, and there can be no assurance that the non-competition
covenants in such agreements are enforceable. Further, the Company does not
have employment agreements with its senior management members who were hired
after August 1995. See "Management--Directors, Executive Officers and Certain
Other Significant Officers" and "Management--Employment Agreements and Other
Compensation Arrangements." In addition, the Company's business is dependent
on the highly skilled, and often highly specialized, individuals it employs.
Retention of asset management, investment advisory, private equity, research,
sales and trading, and administrative professionals is particularly important
to the Company's business, financial condition, results of operations and
business prospects. There can be no assurance that losses of key personnel
will not occur in the future, which could materially and adversely affect the
and adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition, results of
operations and business prospects.
    
                                      10

<PAGE> 12
    The Company expects further growth in the number of its personnel.
Competition for employees with the qualifications desired by the Company is
intense, especially with respect to asset management and research professionals
with expertise in the insurance industry, and the Company expects that
continuing competition will cause its compensation costs to continue to
increase. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to recruit a
sufficient number of new employees with the desired qualifications in a timely
manner. The failure to recruit new employees could materially and adversely
affect the Company's business, financial condition, results of operations and
business prospects.

SIGNIFICANT INDUSTRY COMPETITION

    All of the Company's businesses are conducted in highly competitive
markets. The Company competes with a large number of other asset management
firms, as well as broker-dealers, insurance companies, commercial banks and
others in the business. The Company's asset management business competes for
assets under discretionary management with a large number of other specialty
and diversified investment advisory firms and divisions, including internal
investment divisions of insurance companies. The intensity of competition could
increase if the rate of growth in insurance company assets managed externally
were to decline. See "Business--Industry Background and Trends--Developing
Trends in the Insurance Industry." The asset management industry is
characterized by relatively low cost of entry, and new entities may be formed
which may compete with the Company. The Company's focus on the insurance
industry makes it particularly subject to direct competition from firms or
divisions that specialize in providing services to the insurance sector.
Additionally, other insurance companies may determine to spin out their
investment management divisions, which might then become competitors. The
Company's asset management, real estate, private equity and investment
accounting & reporting services are also subject to intense competition, and
are characterized by limited capital requirements and low barriers to entry.
There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to compete successfully
against current and future competitors or that competitive pressures faced by
the Company will not materially and adversely affect the Company's business,
financial condition, results of operations and business prospects.

    Many of the Company's current and potential competitors are larger and have
access to greater resources and a number of the Company's current competitors
ranked more highly in the Eager Study than the Company with respect to their
perceived ability to generate good performance, all of which could be used to
compete effectively against the Company. Such competition could have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition, results of
operations and business prospects, as well as its ability to attract and retain
highly skilled individuals as employees. See "Business--Competition."

RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH ACQUISITIONS

    As part of its business strategy, the Company intends to consider
acquisitions of similar or complementary businesses. No assurance can be given
that the Company will be successful in identifying attractive acquisition
candidates or completing acquisitions on favorable terms. In addition, any
future acquisitions will be accompanied by the risks commonly associated with
acquisitions. These risks include potential exposure to unknown liabilities of
acquired companies or to acquisition costs and expenses, the difficulty and
expense of integrating the operations and personnel of the acquired companies,
the potential disruption to the business of the combined company and potential
diversion of management's time and attention, the impairment of relationships
with and the possible loss of key employees and clients as a result of the
changes in management, the incurrence of amortization expenses if an
acquisition is accounted for as a purchase and dilution to the shareholders of
the combined company if the acquisition is made for stock of the combined
company. There can be no assurance that products, technologies or businesses of
acquired companies will be effectively assimilated into the business or product
offerings of the combined company or will have a positive effect on the
combined company's revenues or earnings. Further, the combined company may
incur significant expense to complete acquisitions and to support the acquired
products and businesses. Any such acquisitions may be funded with cash, debt or
equity, which could have the effect of diluting or otherwise adversely
affecting the holdings or the rights of existing shareholders of the Company,
including investors acquiring Common Stock in this offering.

                                      11

<PAGE> 13
CHANGES IN ECONOMIC OR MARKET CONDITIONS AFFECTING FEE LEVELS

    Changes in economic and market conditions may adversely affect the
profitability and performance of and demand for the Company's services. A
significant portion of the Company's revenue is derived from asset management
fees, which are generally based on the market value of assets under management.
Consequently, significant fluctuations in the values of securities (e.g., as
the result of substantial changes in the equity and fixed income markets
resulting from changes in interest rates, inflation rates or other economic
factors) may affect materially the amount of assets under management and thus
the Company's revenues and profitability. Due to the Company's focus on
insurance companies, which tend to invest more predominantly in
interest-sensitive securities, the Company's assets under management are
particularly sensitive to interest rate volatility. In addition to the
potential reduction in market value of assets under management, adverse market
conditions could also cause the Company's clients to reduce the amount of new
funds contributed to accounts under management, withdraw funds or reduce the
allocation of assets to particular types of investments, all of which could
reduce the Company's revenues.

    The amount of assets under management is also affected by fluctuations in
the investment patterns of the Company's clients. Because the Company's clients
are predominantly in the insurance business, regulatory changes (such as
changes in insurance company investment regulations or adverse tax law changes)
could negatively impact the Company's revenues. See "--Risks Associated with
Insurance Industry Focus."

    The Company's mortgage origination and mortgage and real estate servicing
business is dependent on local economic conditions. Although the Company has
mortgage activity in approximately 25 states, significant declines in the local
economies in a number of such states could reduce the availability of, and
increase competition for, high quality mortgages and real estate developments.
Economic and market conditions may also result in a decline in client demand
for mortgages.

    The Company from time to time serves as an underwriter of publicly offered
securities. Underwriting revenues, as well as brokerage commissions, are highly
volatile, depending on a variety of factors, including market conditions and
transaction activity; accordingly, no assurance can be given as to the amount
of such revenues, if any, that may arise in future periods. See "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and
"Business--Asset Management."

REGULATION

  INTRODUCTION

    The securities industry and the business of the Company are subject to
extensive regulation by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC" or
the "Commission"), state securities regulators and other governmental
regulatory authorities. The business of the Company also is regulated by the
National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. (the "NASD"). Conning &
Company and Conning Asset Management Company, both subsidiaries of the Company,
are registered as investment advisers with the SEC. As registered investment
advisers, each is subject to the requirements of the Investment Advisers Act of
1940, as amended (the "Advisers Act"), and the SEC's regulations thereunder.
Conning Asset Management Company acts as an investment adviser to certain
registered investment companies, and therefore is also subject to regulation
under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the "Investment Company
Act"). Conning & Company is registered as a broker-dealer under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), and various state
broker-dealer registration laws. Conning Asset Management Company is a
fiduciary under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended
("ERISA"), and regulations thereunder with respect to the investments of its
discretionary asset management clients which are employee benefit plans subject
to ERISA and with respect to the investments of portfolios managed by the
Company that contain assets of plans subject to ERISA. In addition, the
Company's mortgage origination activities are subject to the licensing
requirements of certain states. See "Regulation."

  GENERAL RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH REGULATION

    Due to the extensive regulation to which the Company is subject, the
Company may be restricted in its activities, and the Company's management may
be required to devote substantial time and effort to regulatory compliance
issues. Furthermore, Conning & Company is exposed to liability under federal
and state securities laws and court decisions, including decisions with respect
to underwriters' liability and limitations on indemnification of underwriters

                                      12

<PAGE> 14
by issuers. See "Business--Legal Proceedings." Violations of federal or state
laws or regulations or rules of industry self-regulatory organizations
("SROs"), such as the NASD, including without limitation with respect to
fiduciary duties, could subject the Company, its subsidiaries and/or its
employees to disciplinary proceedings or civil or criminal liability, including
revocation of licenses, censures, fines or temporary suspension or permanent
bar from the conduct of their business. Any such proceeding or liability could
have a material adverse effect upon the Company's business, financial
condition, results of operations and business prospects. See "Regulation."

  RISK OF PENALTIES DUE TO NONCOMPLIANCE

    Compliance with many of the regulations applicable to the Company involves
a number of risks, particularly because applicable regulations in a number of
areas, such as those governing affiliated transactions involving clients, may
be subject to varying interpretation. Regulators make periodic examinations and
review annual, monthly and other reports on the Company's operations and
financial condition. In the event of noncompliance by the Company with any
applicable law or regulation, governmental regulators and SROs may institute
administrative or judicial proceedings that may result in censure, fine, civil
penalties (including treble damages in the case of insider trading violations),
criminal penalties, the issuance of cease-and-desist orders, the deregistration
or suspension of the non-compliant broker-dealer or investment adviser, the
suspension or disqualification of the broker-dealer's or investment adviser's
officers or employees, the removal of the Company from its role as fiduciary
with respect to the investment of assets subject to ERISA, and other adverse
consequences. The Company has not experienced any such penalties to date. Such
violations or noncompliance could also subject the Company and/or its employees
to civil actions by private parties. In connection with the Company's private
equity activities, Conning & Company, its affiliates and the private equity
funds which they manage are relying on exemptions from registration under the
Investment Company Act, the Securities Act and state securities laws. Failure
to meet the requirements of any such exemptions could have a material adverse
effect on the Company's business, financial condition, results of operations
and business prospects and the manner in which the Company, its affiliates and
the private equity funds they manage carry out their investment activities and
on the compensation received by Conning & Company and its affiliates from the
private equity funds. See "Regulation."

  RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH CHANGING REGULATORY ENVIRONMENT

    The regulatory environment in which the Company operates is subject to
change. The Company may be adversely affected as a result of new or revised
legislation or regulations imposed by the SEC, other governmental regulatory
authorities or SROs. The Company also may be adversely affected by changes in
the interpretation or enforcement of existing laws and rules by these
governmental authorities and SROs. See "Regulation."

  RISK OF CHANGES IN OTHER BUSINESS REGULATIONS

    The Company's businesses may be materially affected not only by securities
regulations but also by regulations of general application. For example, the
volume of the Company's asset management revenue in a given time period could
be affected by, among other things, existing and proposed tax legislation and
other governmental regulations and policies (including, without limitation, the
interest rate policies of the Federal Reserve Board) and changes in the
interpretation or enforcement of existing laws and rules that affect the
business and financial communities. The level of business and financing
activity in the insurance industry can be affected not only by such legislation
or regulations of general applicability, but also by industry-specific
legislation or regulations. See "Regulation."

  POTENTIAL LIMITS ON OPERATIONS AND DIVIDENDS DUE TO NET CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS

    As a registered broker-dealer and member of the NASD, Conning & Company is
subject to the net capital rules of the SEC, various states and the NASD. These
rules specify minimum net capital requirements for registered broker-dealers
and NASD members, are designed to assure that broker-dealers maintain adequate
regulatory capital in relation to their liabilities and the size of their
customer business, and have the effect of requiring that a substantial portion
of a broker-dealer's assets be kept in cash or highly liquid investments. Such
net capital requirements could have a materially adverse effect on the
Company's ability to distribute any declared dividends to its shareholders. The
Company is a holding company, the principal assets of which consist of the
common stock of Conning, Inc. Conning, Inc. owns all of the common stock of
Conning & Company. The primary source of funds for the Company to make dividend
distributions, if any, will be dividends paid to the Company by Conning, Inc.
Conning, Inc.'s principal source

                                      13

<PAGE> 15
of funds is dividends received from Conning & Company, which may be restricted
in its distribution of any such dividends by such net capital rules. See
"Regulation--Net Capital Requirements."

TERMINATION PROVISIONS OF INVESTMENT ADVISORY AGREEMENTS

    A large portion of the Company's revenues are derived from investment
advisory agreements with insurance companies, particularly General American and
its affiliates, and institutional clients, which agreements are generally
terminable upon 30 to 90 days' notice without penalty. The termination of any
of these agreements representing a material portion of assets under management
could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial
condition, results of operations and business prospects. See "Regulation."

CONSEQUENCES OF A CHANGE OF CONTROL ON INVESTMENT ADVISORY AGREEMENTS;
LIMITATIONS ON VOTING RIGHTS

    Under the Advisers Act, investment advisory agreements are voidable upon
assignment unless the client consents to such assignment. Under the Investment
Company Act, investment advisory agreements terminate upon assignment. Under
both Acts, an investment advisory agreement is deemed to have been assigned
when there is a direct or indirect transfer of the agreement, including a
direct assignment or a transfer of a "controlling block" of the firm's voting
securities or, under certain circumstances, upon the transfer of a
"controlling block" of the voting securities of its parent corporation. Under
Section 15(f) of the Investment Company Act, during the two-year period after a
change of control of an investment adviser of a registered investment company,
there may not be imposed an "unfair burden" on such company as a result of a
change in control. Section 15(f) could be interpreted to restrict increases in
investment advisory fees during such two-year period and, accordingly, may
discourage potential purchasers from acquiring any interest in the Company that
might constitute a change of control under the Investment Company Act. See
"Regulation."

   
    Following the completion of the offering, sales of Common Stock by General
American or other shareholders of the Company or issuances of Common Stock by
the Company, among other things, could result in a deemed assignment of the
Company's investment advisory agreements under the Advisers Act and the
Investment Company Act. Any assignment of the Company's investment advisory
agreements would require, as to any registered investment company client, the
prior approval by a majority of its shareholders, and as to the Company's other
clients, the prior consent of such clients. There can be no assurance that the
Company's clients would consent to the assignment of investment advisory
agreements or approve new investment advisory agreements with the Company in
such an event. The Company's Restated Articles of Incorporation (the
"Articles") provide that no person or group deemed to be a beneficial owner
(as defined therein) of the Common Stock may vote more than 20% of the total
number of shares of Common Stock outstanding. This provision of the Articles
does not apply to General American Mutual Holding Company, General American,
General American Holding Company or their subsidiaries or affiliates, direct or
indirect subsidiaries of the Company and certain employee plans established or
to be established by the Company. The Company's Board of Directors may approve
the exemption of other persons or groups from the provisions described above.
While this voting limitation is in place to reduce the likelihood, under certain
circumstances, of inadvertent terminations of the Company's advisory agreements
as a result of "assignments" of such contracts, there can be no guarantees that
this voting limitation will prevent such a termination from occurring. In
addition, such limitation could be deemed to have an anti-takeover effect and to
make changes in management more difficult. See "Regulation" and "Certain Charter
and Bylaw Provisions--Limitations on Voting of Shares in Certain Circumstances."
    

CERTAIN OTHER ANTI-TAKEOVER PROVISIONS

    In addition to the provision in the Articles described in the preceding
paragraph, certain other provisions of Missouri law, the Articles and the
Company's Bylaws (the "Bylaws") could have the effect of making it more
difficult for a third party to acquire, or of discouraging a third party from
attempting to acquire, control of the Company, including, without limitation,
the business combination provisions of the Missouri General and Business
Corporation Law. Such provisions of Missouri law include, among others: (i)
Missouri's "business combination" statute which imposes restrictions and
conditions on certain transactions with an "interested shareholder"
(generally a shareholder owning more than 20% of the corporation's voting
stock) for five years following the date on which such shareholder became an
interested shareholder; and (ii) Missouri's "take-over bid disclosure"
statute which provides that prior to making a tender offer for certain Missouri
corporations the offeror must file certain disclosure materials. The

                                      14

<PAGE> 16
Company's Articles and Bylaws, among other things, (i) contain certain
limitations on the voting power of certain shareholders, (ii) provide for a
classified Board of Directors, (iii) limit the right of shareholders to remove
directors or change the size of the Board of Directors, to fill vacancies on the
Board of Directors, to act by written consent and to call a special meeting of
shareholders, (iv) require a higher percentage of shareholders than would
otherwise be required to amend, alter, change or repeal certain provisions of
the Articles and Bylaws, and (v) provide that the Bylaws may be amended only by
the majority vote of the Board of Directors. See "Certain Charter and Bylaw
Provisions." Such provisions could also limit or depress the price that certain
investors might be willing to pay in the future for shares of the Common Stock.
The Company is also authorized to issue preferred stock with rights senior to,
and that may adversely affect, the Common Stock, without the necessity of
shareholder approval and with such rights, preferences and privileges as the
Company's Board of Directors may determine. The Company, however, has no present
plans to issue any shares of preferred stock. See "Principal Shareholders" and
"Description of Capital Stock."

NO PRIOR PUBLIC MARKET FOR COMMON STOCK

    Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock, and there can be no assurance that an active public market will develop
or be sustained after this offering or that investors will be able to sell the
Common Stock should they desire to do so. The initial public offering price
will be determined by negotiations between the Company and the Underwriters and
may bear no relationship to the price at which the Common Stock will trade upon
completion of this offering. See "Underwriting" for a discussion of the
factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price.

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE; POSSIBLE ADVERSE EFFECT ON FUTURE MARKET
PRICES

   
    Following the completion of the offering, sales of substantial numbers of
additional shares of Common Stock in the public market, or the perception that
such sales could occur, could adversely affect the market price of the Common
Stock and make it more difficult for the Company to raise funds through future
equity offerings. General American will beneficially own approximately 65% of
the Common Stock after the consummation of the offering (approximately 63% if
the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in full) and a sale of
such shares could adversely affect the market price of the Common Stock. The
Company's directors and executive officers and other shareholders holding all
of the 10,375,000 shares outstanding on the date hereof have entered into
lock-up agreements under which they have agreed, other than with the consent of
Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation, not to sell such shares
for a period of 180 days following the completion of the offering. The Company
believes that, following the lock-up period, up to 1,472,288 shares held by
existing shareholders could be eligible for sale without restriction and up to
8,902,712 "affiliate" shares held by executive officers, directors and other
affiliates could be eligible for sale, subject to certain volume and other
limitations of Rule 144; all such shares, however, may be subject to additional
holding periods under Rule 144 based on, among other things, particular
interpretative considerations, facts and circumstances relating to such
shareholders. Following effectiveness of the registration statement covering
the shares offered hereby, the Company will register on Form S-8 under the
Securities Act an aggregate of 3,437,500 shares of Common Stock issuable under
employee stock plans, which registrations are expected to become effective upon
filing. There are options to purchase 1,237,500 shares of Common Stock
outstanding on the date hereof, 400,000 of which are currently exercisable, an
additional 600,000 of which will be exercisable upon completion of the offering
and the remaining 237,500 of which will become exercisable over a five-year
vesting period commencing November 22, 1997. Upon the closing of this offering,
certain incentive stock options will be recharacterized as other than incentive
stock options; the Company intends to compensate for such recharacterization by
granting new non-qualified stock options to purchase an estimated aggregate
329,987 shares to holders of such recharacterized options upon the closing of
this offering, which options are exercisable immediately upon the closing of
this offering. See "Management--Employee Stock Plans." In addition, upon the
closing of this offering, the Company intends to grant options to purchase an
additional 965,000 shares of Common Stock, which options will become
exercisable over a five-year vesting period commencing on the first anniversary
of the closing of this offering. Upon the first anniversary of the date hereof,
General American and the other shareholders of the Company have certain rights
to require the Company to register 8,780,005 of their 10,375,000 shares of
Common Stock for sale under the Securities Act. See "Management--Employee Stock
Plans," "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions," "Description of
Capital Stock" and "Shares Eligible for Future Sale."
    

                                      15

<PAGE> 17
POSSIBLE VOLATILITY OF STOCK PRICE

    The market price of the shares of Common Stock could be subject to wide
fluctuations in response to factors such as actual or anticipated variations in
the Company's operating results, changes in financial estimates by securities
analysts, conditions and trends in the asset management or insurance
industries, adoption of new accounting standards affecting the investment
advisory or insurance industries, general market conditions and other factors.
Further, the stock market in general has experienced extreme price and volume
fluctuations that often have been unrelated or disproportionate to the
operating performance of such companies. These market fluctuations, as well as
general economic, political and market conditions, may adversely affect the
market price of the Common Stock. In the past, following periods of volatility
in the market price of a company's securities, securities class action
litigation has often been instituted against such company. Such litigation, if
instituted, could result in substantial costs and a diversion of management
attention and resources, which would have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition, results of operations and business
prospects.

DILUTION

    Purchasers of the Common Stock offered hereby will experience immediate
estimated dilution of approximately $10.00 per share in the net tangible book
value of their shares from the assumed initial public offering price. To the
extent outstanding options to purchase Common Stock are exercised, there will
be further dilution. See "Dilution."

DISCRETIONARY USE OF PROCEEDS

    Although the Company has not yet identified specific uses for the net
proceeds to be received by it from this offering, such proceeds are expected to
be used for general corporate purposes, including possible acquisitions of
related businesses or investments in strategic or joint venture relationships.
The Company has no present understandings, agreements or commitments with
respect to any such acquisitions or investments, and no assurance can be given
that any such acquisition or investment will take place. Pending application to
such purposes, the net proceeds will be invested in short-term, investment
grade, interest-bearing securities. The Company's management will have
discretion over the use and investment of such net proceeds. Accordingly, there
can be no assurance regarding the utilization or timing of the utilization of
the remaining net proceeds of this offering. See "Use of Proceeds."

RISK OF SYSTEMS FAILURE; DEPENDENCE ON VENDORS

    The Company's business is highly dependent on communications and
information systems and certain third-party vendors for securities pricing
information and updates on certain software. The Company's investment
accounting & reporting services depend on the timeliness and accuracy of
reports furnished by the Company to its customers. Although the Company
believes it has adequate procedures in place to ensure the timeliness and
accuracy of the Company's services, any delays or inaccuracies in such
information may give rise to potential claims against the Company and could
materially adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition,
results of operations and business prospects. Further, there can be no
assurance that the Company will not suffer a systems failure or interruption,
whether caused by an earthquake, fire, other natural disaster, power or
telecommunications failure, act of God, act of war or otherwise, or that the
Company's back-up procedures and capabilities in the event of any such failure
or interruption will be adequate. Significant portions of the Company's
business are dependent on the Company's ability to protect its computer
equipment and the information stored in its data processing centers against
damage that may be caused by fire, power loss, telecommunications failures,
unauthorized access and other events. The Company's data processing centers are
located in Hartford, Connecticut and St. Louis, Missouri. Software and related
data files are expected to be backed-up regularly and stored off-site. The
Company has contracted with an outside service to provide disaster recovery
services. There can be no assurance that these measures are sufficient to
eliminate the risk of extended interruption in the Company's operations.
Further, there can be no assurance that the Company will continue to be able to
obtain timely and accurate securities pricing information from third-party
vendors on an ongoing basis, which is vital to the Company's ability to provide
investment accounting & reporting services because it enables the Company to
value its clients' portfolios. Any delays or inaccuracies in securities pricing
information could give rise to claims against the Company, which could have a
material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition, results
of operations and business prospects.

                                      16

<PAGE> 18
    Under a software license agreement with SS&C Technologies, Inc. ("SS&C"),
effective as of January 27, 1996 (the "License Agreement"), the Company has a
perpetual non-exclusive license to use, maintain and modify its investment
accounting & reporting software, including both CAMRA(TM) and FILMS(TM), in
both source code and object code (the "Software"). SS&C Technologies, Inc.
represents that it is the owner of the trademarks CAMRA(TM) and FILMS(TM). The
License Agreement permits the Software to be used by the Company for
accounting, reporting and similar purposes in the asset management business and
for outsourcing to customers in the insurance industry and by General American
and its subsidiaries in certain circumstances. The Company is obligated to make
annual payments under the License Agreement until the year 2000. Additional
license fees may be due as a result of an increase of assets under management
or advisement only if the assets under management or advisement increase as the
result of certain business combinations involving the Company. SS&C may
terminate the License Agreement in the event of, among other things, a breach
by the Company which is not cured after written notice, certain bankruptcy,
insolvency or similar events affecting the Company or certain other
transactions such as the acquisition of a controlling interest in the Company
by, or the entering into of certain transactions between the Company and, an
entity that competes with SS&C. While the Company has contracted to receive
certain updates to its software, there can be no assurance that it will obtain
updated software in a timely manner. Any failure or interruption of the
Company's systems or a failure to receive timely and accurate securities
pricing information or updates to software could have a material adverse effect
on the Company's business, financial condition, results of operations and
business prospects. See "Business--Asset Management--Investment Accounting &
Reporting."

YEAR 2000 COMPLIANCE

    As the year 2000 approaches, a critical business issue has emerged
regarding how existing application software programs and operating systems can
accommodate this date value. In brief, many existing application software
products in the marketplace were designed to only accommodate a two digit date
position which represents the year (e.g., '95 is stored on the system and
represents the year 1995). As a result, the year 1999 (i.e., '99) could be the
maximum date value these systems will be able to accurately process. Management
is in the process of working with its software vendors to assure that the
Company is prepared for the year 2000. Based on information currently
available, management does not anticipate that the Company will incur
significant operating expenses or be required to invest heavily in computer
system improvements to be year 2000 compliant, however the Company is still in
the preliminary stages of analyzing its systems and requirements. To the extent
the Company's systems are not fully year 2000 compliant, there can be no
assurance that potential systems interruptions or the cost necessary to update
software would not have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition, results of operations and business prospects.

                                USE OF PROCEEDS

    The net proceeds to the Company from the sale of the 2,500,000 shares of
Common Stock offered by the Company hereby are estimated to be approximately
$30.0 million, assuming an initial public offering price of $13.50 per share
and after deducting the underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated
offering expenses payable by the Company.

    The principal purposes of this offering are to increase the Company's
equity capital and to create a public market for the Common Stock, which will
facilitate the Company's future access to the public equity markets and enhance
the ability of the Company to use its Common Stock as consideration for
acquisitions and as a means of attracting and retaining key employees.

    The net proceeds of this offering will be used for general corporate
purposes. The Company's business strategy contemplates that it will seek to
complement internal growth with strategic investments and acquisitions.
Accordingly, a portion of the net proceeds may also be used for acquiring
related businesses or investing in strategic or joint venture relationships.
The Company has no present understandings, agreements or commitments with
respect to any such acquisition or investment, and no assurance can be given
that any such acquisition or investment will take place. Pending application to
the uses described above, the Company intends to invest the net proceeds of
this offering in short-term, investment-grade, interest-bearing securities.

                                      17

<PAGE> 19
                                DIVIDEND POLICY

    The Company initially intends to establish a policy after this offering of
declaring quarterly dividends, commencing in the first quarter of 1998, at the
rate of approximately $0.04 per share ($0.16 annually) on the Common Stock. The
declaration and payment of dividends to holders of Common Stock will be at the
discretion of the Company's Board of Directors and will depend upon the
Company's capital requirements and operating and financial condition, as well
as the legal and regulatory restrictions from net capital rules of various
regulatory bodies applicable to Conning & Company and such other factors as the
Board of Directors may deem relevant. See "Regulation."

                                CAPITALIZATION

    The following table sets forth the long-term borrowings and capitalization
of the Company at September 30, 1997 on a historical basis, and as adjusted to
give effect to the Capital Stock Conversions and the sale by the Company of
2,500,000 shares of Common Stock in the offering (assuming the Underwriters'
over-allotment option is not exercised) at an assumed initial public offering
price of $13.50 per share, less the underwriting discounts, commissions and
estimated offering expenses and the application of the estimated net proceeds
therefrom. See "Use of Proceeds". This table should be read in conjunction
with the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements and the Notes thereto
included elsewhere in this Prospectus.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                             AS OF SEPTEMBER 30, 1997
                                                                                            --------------------------
                                                                                               ACTUAL     AS ADJUSTED
                                                                                              (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                                                           <C>            <C>
Long-term debt............................................................................    $   -0-        $   -0-

Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, $.01 par value, $5.33 liquidation value: 3,190,000
  shares authorized, issued and outstanding; no as adjusted shares issued and
  outstanding<F1>.........................................................................    $32,894            -0-

Series B Convertible Preferred Stock, $.01 par value, $5.33 liquidation value: 600,000
  shares authorized, 365,000 shares issued and outstanding; no as adjusted shares issued
  and outstanding<F1>.....................................................................      3,257            -0-

Non-Voting Common Stock, $.01 par value: 20,000,000 shares authorized; 110,000 shares
  issued and outstanding; no as adjusted shares issued and outstanding<F1>................          1            -0-

Common Stock, $.01 par value: 50,000,000 shares authorized; 6,710,000 shares issued and
  outstanding; 12,875,000 as adjusted shares issued and outstanding<F1><F2>...............         67            129

Additional paid-in capital................................................................        -0-         66,700

Retained earnings.........................................................................        -0-            -0-
                                                                                              -------        -------

        Total common shareholders' equity.................................................         68         66,829
                                                                                              -------        -------

            Total capitalization..........................................................    $36,219        $66,829
                                                                                              =======        =======

<FN>
- --------

<F1> Gives effect to changes in the Company's capitalization effected in June
     1997, including the increase in the numbers of authorized shares of Common
     Stock and authorized but undesignated shares of preferred stock. Upon the
     completion of this offering, the Company intends to file an amendment to
     its Articles to eliminate the Series A and Series B Convertible Preferred
     Stock and the Non-Voting Common Stock. See "Description of Capital
     Stock."

<F2> Assumes no exercise of outstanding stock options. As of the date of this
     Prospectus, there are outstanding options to purchase 1,237,500 shares of
     Common Stock at a weighted average exercise price of $5.65 per share. In
     addition, upon the closing of this offering, the Company intends to grant
     options to purchase an additional estimated 1,294,987 shares of Common
     Stock at the initial public offering price. An additional estimated
     905,013 shares are currently reserved for future grants under the
     Company's employee benefit plans. See "Management--Employee Stock Plans"
     and Note 12 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements.
</TABLE>

                                      18

<PAGE> 20
                                   DILUTION

    The adjusted net tangible book value of the Company as of September 30,
1997 was approximately $14.5 million, or $1.39 per share of Common Stock.
Adjusted net tangible book value per share is equal to the Company's total
tangible assets less total liabilities, divided by the number of shares of
Common Stock outstanding, after giving effect to the Capital Stock Conversions.
After giving effect to the sale by the Company of 2,500,000 shares of Common
Stock offered hereby at an assumed initial public offering price of $13.50 per
share and the application of the estimated net proceeds therefrom (see "Use of
Proceeds"), the pro forma adjusted net tangible book value of the Company at
September 30, 1997 would have been approximately $45 million, or $3.50 per
share. This represents an immediate increase in adjusted net tangible book
value of $2.11 per share to existing shareholders and an immediate dilution of
$10.00 per share to new investors purchasing shares in the offering. The
following table illustrates this per share dilution:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                                               <C>        <C>
Assumed initial public offering price per share<F1>.............................             $13.50

    Adjusted net tangible book value per share as of September 30, 1997.........  $1.39

    Increase in adjusted net tangible book value per share attributable to new
     investors..................................................................   2.11

Pro forma adjusted net tangible book value per share after the offering.........               3.50
                                                                                             ------

Dilution in adjusted net tangible book value per share to new investors<F2>.....             $10.00
                                                                                             ======

<FN>
- --------

<F1> Before deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and
     estimated expenses of the offering payable by the Company.

<F2> The above computation assumes no exercise of outstanding stock options. As
     of the date of this Prospectus, there are outstanding options to purchase
     1,237,500 shares of Common Stock at a weighted average exercise price of
     $5.65 per share which would result in total dilution in adjusted net
     tangible book value per share to new investors of $9.81 if all such
     options were exercised. In addition, upon the closing of this offering,
     the Company intends to grant options to purchase an additional estimated
     1,294,987 shares of Common Stock at the assumed initial public offering
     price. To the extent these options are exercised total dilution in
     adjusted net tangible book value per share to new investors would be
     $8.99. An additional estimated 905,013 shares are currently reserved for
     future grants under the Company's employee benefit plans. See "Manage-
     ment--Employee Stock Plans" and Note 12 of Notes to the Company's
     Consolidated Financial Statements.
</TABLE>

    The following table summarizes on a pro forma basis, at September 30, 1997,
the difference between existing shareholders and new investors with respect to
the number of shares of Common Stock purchased from the Company (assuming no
exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option), the approximate total
consideration paid, and the average price per share paid, by existing holders
of Common Stock and by the investors purchasing shares of Common Stock in this
offering before deduction of underwriting discounts and commissions and
estimated offering expenses and assuming an initial public offering price of
$13.50 per share.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  SHARES PURCHASED         TOTAL CONSIDERATION<F1>
                                             ------------------------    -------------------------    AVERAGE PRICE
                                               NUMBER         PERCENT       AMOUNT         PERCENT     PER SHARE
<S>                                          <C>              <C>        <C>               <C>           <C>
Existing shareholders...................     10,375,000        81.0%     $32,726,818        49.2%        $ 3.15

New investors...........................      2,500,000        19.0%      33,750,000        50.8%        $13.50
                                             ----------       -----      -----------       -----
    Total<F1><F2>.......................     12,875,000       100.0%     $66,476,818       100.0%

<FN>
- --------

<F1> A portion of the total consideration with respect to existing shareholders
     other than General American is calculated based on values established in
     connection with the Strategic Merger, and in the case of General American
     reflects book value of assets contributed pursuant to the Strategic Merger
     plus subsequent purchases.

<F2> The above computation assumes no exercise of outstanding stock options.
</TABLE>

                                      19

<PAGE> 21
                                   BUSINESS

GENERAL

    Conning is a nationally recognized asset management company providing
services to the insurance industry, and is also a leading provider of insurance
research. As of September 30, 1997, the Company had approximately $26.4 billion
of assets under discretionary management and, in total, provided services with
respect to approximately $73.6 billion of assets for insurance company clients.
The Company believes it is well positioned to take advantage of the continued
growth in insurance industry assets and the willingness of insurance companies
to consider utilizing external investment management expertise. The Company
believes that many insurance companies are responding to increasing
competitive, financial and regulatory pressures by engaging outside asset
managers for (i) sophisticated asset management, (ii) access to specialized
asset classes supported by a comprehensive analytical methodology, and (iii)
comprehensive investment accounting & reporting services. During the period
from 1992 through 1996, assets under discretionary management of the Company
increased by an average of 24% per year, on a pro forma basis after giving
effect to the Strategic Merger and the inclusion of assets of General American
for all years. In 1996, its first full year of operations following the
Strategic Merger, the Company had revenues of approximately $53.7 million and
net earnings of approximately $6.2 million. During the nine months ended
September 30, 1997, the Company had revenues of approximately $46.9 million and
net earnings of approximately $6.4 million.

    The Company was formed pursuant to the Strategic Merger in 1995 and is the
successor to the businesses formerly conducted independently by Conning, Inc.
and GAIMCO. The parties effected the Strategic Merger in order to combine
complementary businesses, each with specialties in the insurance industry, to
build a platform from which to leverage additional growth. See "Certain
Relationships and Related Transactions--The Strategic Merger." Since January
1, 1995, the assets of the general account of General American have been under
contract with Conning Asset Management Company (formerly, GAIMCO). Prior to
such time, the assets of the general account were managed by the investment
division of General American, a predecessor of GAIMCO.

    The Company believes that it possesses competitive strengths in insurance
asset management which may support its prospects for growth:

    INSURANCE INDUSTRY FOCUS AND KNOWLEDGE. Based upon the Company's extensive
work with insurance companies, the Company believes that its focus on the
insurance industry allows it to provide substantially all of the services and
products that an insurance company seeks from an asset manager. By utilizing
its specialized knowledge of insurance company investment considerations, the
Company believes, based upon feedback from clients, that it offers a more
comprehensive set of asset management services than many of its competitors,
including asset allocation, asset and liability matching, cash forecasts, tax
modeling and investment accounting & reporting. The Company offers expertise in
asset classes that many insurance companies traditionally utilize, including
commercial mortgage loans, investment real estate and private placements.

    NAME RECOGNITION WITHIN THE INSURANCE INDUSTRY. The Company believes that
the established reputation of Conning within the insurance industry provides
the Company with a marketing advantage. According to the Eager Study, the
Company ranks among the top two insurance asset management firms in terms of
name recognition among domestic, non-captive insurance companies with assets
over $30 million which responded to the survey. The Company's in-depth
insurance industry research has been targeted to senior executives in the
insurance industry for more than 20 years, and its Strategic Studies Series is
subscribed to by 44 of the 50 largest U.S. property-casualty insurance
companies and 42 of the 50 largest U.S. life-health insurance companies (based
on 1996 premiums as reported by OneSource Information Services, Inc. as
provided to it by third parties).

    CLIENT SERVICE AND PERFORMANCE FOCUS. The Company attempts to differentiate
itself from competitors through its insurance-specific capabilities, investment
performance and frequent, responsive client communication. During the period
from 1992 through 1996, the Company retained an average of approximately 95% of
unaffiliated clients on an annual basis.

    * Capabilities--The Company utilizes a team approach to managing each
      client's portfolios, combining the talents of investment, insurance,
      actuarial, tax and accounting specialists. The Company utilizes a set of
      insurance-related research products, including property/casualty and
      life/health profitability models, a loss ratio and loss reserve analysis
      service and a tax optimization model.

                                      20

<PAGE> 22
    * Performance--The Company tailors its asset management services to the
      specific needs and objectives of each client's investment portfolio and
      seeks to achieve favorable results based upon risk and return parameters
      established for each client's portfolio. The Company ranked below a
      number of competitors in the Eager Study with respect to its perceived
      ability to generate good performance, which was also cited by survey
      respondents as the most common criteria in the selection of investment
      manager candidates. However, the Company believes that other criteria on
      which the Company did rank highly, including knowledge and experience
      with insurance industry issues and the provision of services beyond
      investment management, are also important in the selection of investment
      managers, particularly in light of regulatory constraints applicable to
      insurance companies. See "Risk Factors--Risks Associated with Insurance
      Industry Focus," and "Risk Factors--Significant Industry Competition."
      The Company's insurance asset management services are designed to
      optimize investment returns for clients within the constraints imposed by
      insurance regulatory, accounting, tax and asset/liability management
      considerations.

    * Responsiveness--The Company communicates frequently with its clients to
      pursue the clients' investment objectives in light of changing business
      and market conditions. The Company believes such responsiveness is
      critical to strong client relationships and client satisfaction. The
      Company believes that its comprehensive investment accounting & reporting
      services are integral to client communications.

    EXPERIENCED MANAGEMENT WITH SIGNIFICANT STOCK OWNERSHIP. The Company
employs an experienced management team, the members of which have an average of
approximately 15 years of experience in the investment or insurance business.
In total, the employees of the Company will own in the aggregate approximately
29% of the Common Stock on a fully diluted basis after the offering (including
options to be granted upon the closing of this offering). See "Management"
and "Principal Shareholders."

COMPANY OPERATIONS--OVERVIEW

    The Company's business is asset management for insurance companies, which
is supplemented by its in-depth research focused on the insurance industry. The
Company's asset management services consist of three components: (i)
discretionary asset management services, (ii) investment advisory services and
(iii) investment accounting & reporting services. In connection with its
discretionary asset management services, the Company originates and services
commercial mortgages and manages investments in real estate assets. The Company
also sponsors and manages private equity funds investing in insurance and
insurance-related companies.

    ASSET MANAGEMENT. The Company's insurance asset management services are
designed to optimize investment returns for clients within the guidelines
imposed by insurance regulatory, accounting, tax and asset/liability management
considerations. As of September 30, 1997, the Company provided services with
respect to approximately $73.6 billion in assets, of which approximately (i)
$26.4 billion represented assets under discretionary management, (ii) $21.0
billion represented assets serviced under investment advisory agreements and
(iii) $26.2 billion represented assets receiving investment accounting &
reporting services on a stand-alone basis. As part of its discretionary asset
management services, as of September 30, 1997, the Company managed
approximately $2.6 billion of commercial mortgage loans and investment real
estate.

    The Company manages private equity funds which invest in insurance and
insurance-related companies. Since 1985, the Company has sponsored five private
equity funds, raising approximately $360 million in committed capital. The
private equity funds have invested more than $193 million of these proceeds in
39 companies which constitute the investment portfolios of these funds. In most
cases, these invested proceeds serve to provide a portion of additional
equity-based financing or to partially capitalize a new company.

    INSURANCE RESEARCH. The Company believes that Conning & Company is one of
the leading insurance industry investment research firms in the United States.
The Company publishes in-depth insurance industry research covering major
insurance industry trends, products, markets and business segments. The Company
also publishes stock research on a broad group of publicly-traded insurance
companies for some of the largest United States institutional money managers as
well as pension funds, banks, mutual funds, and insurance companies. Conning &
Company also from time to time participates in the underwriting of public
offerings of equity securities for insurance and insurance-related companies.

                                      21

<PAGE> 23
INDUSTRY BACKGROUND AND TRENDS

    Due to the unique financial characteristics and the regulatory environment
governing the various segments of the insurance industry, effective management
of insurance company assets requires specialized industry knowledge. In
addition to an in-depth understanding of an insurance company's business and
products, the Company believes that insurance companies expect that their
assets should be carefully tailored to meet the company's specific regulatory
and tax requirements and profitability objectives, and that the asset manager
should manage investment risk to reflect the underlying income and cash flow
characteristics of the insurance products which the investments support.

  INSURANCE INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

    Dynamics of Insurance. The insurance industry reduces the risk of
significant financial loss for individuals, families and businesses resulting
from the loss of life or ability to lead a productive life or from a property
or casualty-related loss. The dynamics of the insurance industry are
significantly influenced on a broad level by changes in economic or market
conditions, regulations, and natural disasters and by individual factors such
as personal health and longevity, accidents and personal misfortune.

    Unique Financial Characteristics. Insurance companies must carefully
monitor cash flow patterns with respect to premium collections and claims
payments in order to ensure that invested assets are adequate to cover the
payment of potential future claims. Cash flow patterns vary depending on the
type of insurance (i.e., life/health and property/casualty). For example, life
insurance policies typically have either an up-front premium or steady premiums
collected over the life of the policy, and claims are typically paid in a lump
sum or a stream of payments many years after the policy's inception. Many life
insurance products combine a tax-efficient savings component with the insurance
component. Health insurance premiums, on the other hand, are generally
collected in a steady stream and closely match the projected stream of medical
claims payments. Property insurance premiums are typically collected over the
life of the policy and claims are typically paid within the life of the policy
or shortly after the policy term expires. Casualty insurance premiums are
typically paid over the life of the policy and if claims are made, usually
after litigation, typically many years after the policy period.

    Regulatory Environment. Insurance companies are heavily regulated by state
laws and regulatory agencies, which require, among other things, that insurance
companies comply with risk-based capital requirements. Additionally, insurance
company portfolios are constrained in the asset classes and allocations they
can hold and are typically heavily weighted toward fixed income securities of
investment grade or higher. Property/casualty companies typically hold limited
amounts of real estate investments, while life insurance companies invest more
heavily in real estate. Further, insurance companies must submit to state
regulators statutory financial statements which conform to regulatory
requirements.

    The Company believes that its understanding of the dynamics of the
insurance industry, the unique financial characteristics of different insurance
products, and the insurance industry's regulatory environment enables it to
provide comprehensive asset management services to insurance companies.

                                      22

<PAGE> 24
  DEVELOPING TRENDS IN THE INSURANCE INDUSTRY

    Certain key insurance industry trends that also affect the management of
insurance company assets are as follows:

    Growing Insurance Company Assets. Insurance company assets have grown over
several decades and during the period from 1986 to 1996 grew at an average rate
of approximately 9% per year, from approximately $1.3 trillion to approximately
$3.1 trillion, according to a standard industry source, as shown in the
following table:
                           INSURANCE COMPANY ASSETS
                               (IN MILLIONS)

                                  [GRAPH]

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
     1986               1987              1988               1989               1990               1991
- --------------     --------------     --------------     --------------     --------------     --------------
<C>                <C>                <C>                <C>                <C>                <C>
$1,305,366         $1,460,109         $1,634,187         $1,811,072         $1,947,021         $2,105,350

<CAPTION>
     1992               1993              1994               1995               1996
- --------------     --------------     --------------     --------------     --------------
<C>                <C>                <C>                <C>                <C>
$2,259,960         $2,474,023         $2,629,529         $2,891,085         $3,105,321
</TABLE>

    Continuing Trend Towards Increased Savings. As the "baby-boom" generation
continues to age, the Company believes that the demographics of the population
of the United States should favor wealth accumulation. Thus, the Company
anticipates that the growth of asset accumulation products (e.g., annuities)
will outpace the growth of mortality based products (e.g., term life
insurance). The Company believes this trend will cause insurance companies to
focus increasingly on the importance of investment management to support
competition in investment-oriented products.

    Acceptance of Outsourcing. The Company believes that many insurance
companies are utilizing non-affiliated asset managers in order to respond to
competitive product requirements and the pressure to achieve higher returns on
investments while maintaining an acceptable level of risk. According to the
Eager Study, assets under management by external, non-affiliated managers
(which represented approximately 15% of industry assets in 1996) increased at a
rate of 17% per year from $300 billion in 1994 to $415 billion in 1996. Based
upon information provided by an industry source, insurance company assets
increased at a rate of approximately 9% per year, from $2.6 trillion in 1994 to
$3.1 trillion in 1996. The authors of the Eager Study concluded that externally
managed assets would continue to grow, but believed that the growth rate would
lose momentum over the next few years covered by the study. The Eager Study
indicated that the percentage of insurance companies using one or more
non-affiliated external managers increased 6% from 1992 to 1994, but did not
increase from 1994 to 1996. In addition, the study reported that the median
(typical) company indicated that it had about reached the maximum percentage of
assets expected to be managed externally.

    The Company believes that outsourcing can provide insurance companies the
opportunity to access the specialized expertise, scale and technology needed to
manage assets more effectively. The Company also believes outsourcing has
become an accepted business approach in the insurance industry.

    The Company believes many insurance companies and other financial service
providers, including banks and investment managers, will be driven by increased
competition, regulatory considerations and increased capital needs to divest
themselves of non-core businesses and to seek to acquire, merge with or
otherwise strategically align themselves with complementary businesses in order
to achieve economies of scale. The Eager Study indicated that merger and
consolidation activity had appeared to offset some growth activity among
investment management firms and may have created economies favoring internal
asset management by insurance companies. However, the Company also believes
that such merger or consolidation activity in the insurance industry may also
create additional outsourcing opportunities as the remaining companies seek
ways to achieve increased efficiencies.

    See "Risk Factors--Risks Associated with Insurance Industry Focus" and
"Risk Factors--Significant Industry Competition."

                                      23

<PAGE> 25
STRATEGY

    The Company's growth is built on a foundation of recurring, fee-based
revenues. Fee-based revenues represented approximately 80% of the Company's
total revenues both in 1996 and for the first nine months of 1997. The
Company's primary operating strategy is to grow recurring, fee-based asset
management related revenues through the following strategies:

  LEVERAGE ESTABLISHED ASSET MANAGEMENT PLATFORM TO GENERATE GROWTH AND
PROFITABILITY

    The Company believes that it has established a platform, made up of core
investment professionals, product expertise and systems, to support future
growth in fee-based asset management revenues. Opportunities for asset
management growth are expected to come from new and existing clients, strategic
acquisitions and alliances and through General American and its affiliates.

  GENERATE GROWTH FROM NEW AND EXISTING CLIENTS

    The Company intends to take advantage of the growth in insurance industry
assets and a trend among insurance companies to seek external investment
management expertise. The Company will pursue growth in assets under management
from new clients by increasing the Company's sales and marketing efforts and by
leveraging the Company's strong name recognition. Additionally, the Company
will continue to pursue growth in assets under management from existing clients
by seeking to increase its share of its clients' assets and from underlying
growth in existing assets.

  PURSUE STRATEGIC ACQUISITIONS AND ALLIANCES TO EXPAND MARKET PENETRATION

    The Company regularly evaluates strategic acquisitions, joint ventures and
marketing alliances as a means of increasing assets under management, expanding
the range of its product offerings and increasing its sales and marketing
capabilities.

  LEVERAGE STRATEGIC ALLIANCE WITH GROWING PARTNER

    The Company's relationship with General American, the Company's principal
shareholder, provides opportunities for distribution of the Company's products
and services to General American and its affiliates. The Company has benefited
from the internal growth and acquisition activity of General American and its
affiliates, with assets under management of General American and its affiliates
increasing at an average rate of approximately 14% per year, from approximately
$5.4 billion as of December 31, 1991 to approximately $10.6 billion as of
December 31, 1996. At September 30, 1997, such affiliated assets under
management totaled approximately $13.5 billion.

    No assurance can be given that the Company's objectives or strategies will
be achieved. See "Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements"
and "Risk Factors."

ASSET MANAGEMENT

    The Company's business is asset management for insurance companies, which
is supplemented by its in-depth research focused on the insurance industry. The
Company's asset management services consist of three components: (i)
discretionary asset management services, (ii) investment advisory services and
(iii) investment accounting & reporting services. In connection with its
discretionary asset management services, the Company originates and services
commercial mortgages and manages investments in real estate assets. The Company
also sponsors and manages private equity funds investing in insurance and
insurance-related companies.

                                      24

<PAGE> 26
    As of September 30, 1997, the Company provided services with respect to
approximately $73.6 billion in assets, of which approximately (i) $26.4 billion
represented assets under discretionary management, (ii) $21.0 billion
represented assets serviced under investment advisory agreements and (iii)
$26.2 billion represented assets receiving investment accounting & reporting
services on a stand-alone basis. This array of services allows the Company to
provide a fully integrated product offering, with some clients utilizing all of
the asset management services the Company offers, and others utilizing only
selected services. Assets serviced by the Company have increased at a compound
annual rate of approximately 35% from December 31, 1991 to December 31, 1996,
as shown in the following table:

<TABLE>
                      ASSETS SERVICED BY THE COMPANY<F1>

                                 (IN BILLIONS)
<CAPTION>
                                                                            AVERAGE ASSETS
                                                       AS OF   ------------------------------------------    AS OF   AS OF
                                                     12/31/91  1992     1993     1994     1995     1996    12/31/96 9/30/97
<S>                                                  <C>       <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>
Assets under discretionary
  management

    Unaffiliated..................................   $ 1.7     $ 3.3    $ 5.4    $ 6.2    $ 7.7    $ 9.5   $10.1    $12.9

    Affiliated....................................     5.4       5.5      6.0      6.6      7.8      9.6    10.6     13.5
                                                     -----     -----    -----    -----    -----    -----   -----    -----
        Total.....................................     7.1       8.8     11.4     12.8     15.5     19.1    20.7     26.4

Investment advisory...............................     4.9       5.2     10.1     14.7     15.3     18.3    20.8     21.0

Investment accounting & reporting.................      --        --      1.3      2.6      4.8      9.2    11.7     26.2
                                                     -----     -----    -----    -----    -----    -----   -----    -----
            Total.................................   $12.0     $14.0    $22.8    $30.1    $35.6    $46.6   $53.2    $73.6
                                                     =====     =====    =====    =====    =====    =====   =====    =====

<FN>
- --------

<F1> Since January 1, 1995, the assets of the general account of General
     American have been under contract with GAIMCO (now known as Conning Asset
     Management Company). General account assets prior to January 1, 1995 were
     managed by the investment division of General American, a predecessor of
     GAIMCO, and are included in assets under management for years prior to
     1995. Data for 1995 and prior periods are presented on a pro forma basis
     to include both Conning and GAIMCO assets under management.
</TABLE>

    Discretionary Asset Management & Investment Advisory Services. The
Company's assets under discretionary management have increased at a compounded
annualized rate of approximately 24% from December 31, 1991 through December
31, 1996, with assets of General American-related (affiliated) accounts
increasing approximately 14% and assets of other clients (unaffiliated)
increasing approximately 44% over the period. The Company's insurance asset
management services are designed to optimize investment returns for clients
within the constraints imposed by insurance regulatory, accounting, tax and
asset/liability management considerations. The Company utilizes a team-based,
client-oriented approach, drawing upon a variety of insurance specialists,
including researchers, actuaries and investment, financial and tax
professionals, with specific industry expertise, investment class knowledge,
insurance product knowledge, risk analysis, portfolio management and client
relationship skills. The Company supports a variety of asset classes, as shown
in the following table:

<TABLE>
                     ASSETS UNDER DISCRETIONARY MANAGEMENT
                                 (IN BILLIONS)
<CAPTION>
                                                     AS OF
                  ASSET CLASSES               SEPTEMBER 30, 1997

<S>                                                  <C>
Corporate bonds...................................   $ 7.5

Asset-backed securities...........................     5.8

Mortgage loans....................................     2.4

Municipal bonds...................................     2.6

Government bonds..................................     2.0

Private placements................................     2.2

Indexed equity....................................     1.4

Short-term obligations............................     1.0

Equity............................................     1.3

Real estate.......................................     0.2
                                                     -----

        Total.....................................   $26.4
                                                     =====
</TABLE>

                                      25

<PAGE> 27
    The Company works with each client individually to conduct an in-depth
analysis of its insurance operations and investment objectives. This broad
strategic approach is designed to address each client's core needs to model
asset and liability durations and manage risk and maximize returns. In
particular, the Company analyzes the client's strategic objectives, operational
forecasts, business needs, cash flows, regulatory and rating agency concerns,
and accounting and tax issues. The Company utilizes a "top down" investment
methodology, beginning with an analysis of macro-economic and capital market
conditions. Additionally, the Company considers the client's current portfolio
characteristics, management's risk tolerance, investment guidelines,
performance benchmarks and desired asset allocation. The Company undertakes
quantitative analyses, including (i) asset/liability analyses, (ii) analyses of
cash flows, interest rate risk and surplus adequacy, (iii) peer group
comparisons and (iv) asset allocation modeling. The Company also utilizes its
insurance related research products, including property/casualty and
life/health profitability models, a loss ratio and loss reserve analysis
service, and a tax optimization model.

    The Company assists its clients in the development of new insurance
products by advising them as to investment strategies required to meet the
profitability goals set for such products. The Company is integral to the
product management, administration and distribution of one of General
American's stable value insurance products.

    The Company also serves as the investment adviser to several registered
investment companies and unit investment trusts sponsored by General American.
Investment advisory agreements with registered investment companies and unit
investment trusts may be terminated at any time by the entity upon specified
notice, terminate automatically in the event of their assignment, and are
subject to annual renewal by the board of the entity.

    The Company also provides stand-alone investment advisory services to
clients who are seeking only business analysis and asset allocation or
diversification advice. Such advice typically includes a review of the
portfolio from the standpoint of liability structure, capital adequacy, return
on equity, asset allocation, regulatory and rating agency implications, and
income and cash flow requirements. As of September 30, 1997, the Company had
approximately $21.0 billion in assets under investment advisory contracts on a
stand-alone basis.

    The Company's asset management accounts are each managed pursuant to a
written investment management agreement with the client. Such agreements are
terminable upon relatively short notice (typically 30-90 days) by either party.
In providing discretionary asset management services, the Company generally is
compensated on the basis of fees calculated as a percentage of assets under
management. Fees generally are billed and are payable quarterly and typically
are calculated on the asset value of an account at the beginning or end of a
quarter. The fee schedules typically provide lower incremental fees above
certain levels of managed assets. The Company's investment advisory accounts
are managed pursuant to a written agreement for a specified term, generally one
to three years, pursuant to which the Company generally receives a fixed
periodic fee.

                                      26

<PAGE> 28
    Mortgage Origination and Service of Real Estate. The Company has developed
expertise in the origination and servicing of commercial mortgage loans and the
management of real estate, asset classes which are frequently utilized by life
insurance companies. As of September 30, 1997, the Company managed
approximately $2.4 billion in commercial mortgage loans and approximately $200
million in investment real estate. The Company has originated more than $2.2
billion of mortgage loans for its clients since January 1, 1994, most of which
were on behalf of General American and its affiliates. In addition, the Company
is developing opportunities for placements for other insurance company clients
and pension funds. The following chart shows the growth of the amount of new
mortgage loans that the Company has originated during the period from 1992
through 1996.

                          NEW MORTGAGE LOAN FUNDINGS
                                 (IN MILLIONS)

                                    [GRAPH]

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
  1992       1993       1994       1995       1996
  ----       ----       ----       ----       ----
<S>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
 $89.3      $139.1     $361.5     $529.0     $819.7
</TABLE>

    During the first nine months of 1997, the Company originated approximately
$520 million of new mortgage loans. The Company believes it has the capacity,
under favorable market conditions, to generate approximately $900 million in
commercial mortgage loans annually.

   
    The Company has traditionally focused on originating commercial mortgage
loans generally ranging in size from $2 million to $15 million, with varying
maturities of five to twenty years, secured by office, industrial, retail or
multi-family properties. The Company also provides development, advisory and
management services with respect to real estate investment properties. The
Company originates, actively monitors and manages its commercial mortgage loan
and real estate portfolios through its St. Louis home office location and
eleven field offices located in Arizona, California (2), Colorado (2), Florida,
Georgia, Illinois, Missouri, Texas and Washington, D.C. The Company performs a
full array of mortgage loan origination and portfolio management services
including lease analysis, property valuation, economic and financial reviews,
tenant analysis and oversight of default and bankruptcy proceedings. All
properties are inspected each year and evaluated periodically based on internal
quality ratings for purposes of loan loss reserve and internal management.

    The Company also provides ongoing servicing, generally as part of an
integrated mortgage loan origination program and in several cases on a
stand-alone basis. As of September 30, 1997, the Company provided mortgage loan
servicing for approximately $2.8 billion of mortgage loans, primarily for
General American and its affiliates. Of this amount, approximately $0.4 billion
was serviced on a stand-alone basis. The Company is rated as an acceptable
master servicer and an average special servicer for purposes of servicing
securitized loan portfolios by Fitch Investors Service, L.P. and has received an
average ranking as a commercial loan servicer by Standard & Poor's.
The Company also provides a wide range of mortgage loan and real estate
accounting services, including reconciliation reports, mortgage loan and real
estate reporting for regulatory agencies, management and outside clients, and
tax analysis and support. See "--Investment Accounting & Reporting." The Company
established a relationship with an investment banking firm to originate mortgage
loans. In 1995 the Company originated loans in the amount of approximately $172
million for a securitized offering by such investment banking firm, and the
Company retained the master servicing of the entire loan portfolio totaling
approximately $278 million. During the first quarter of 1997, the Company
originated approximately $200 million of mortgage loans for such firm.
Additionally, the Company is expanding

                                      27

<PAGE> 29
efforts to market its mortgage loan origination and servicing and accounting
capabilities to other life insurance companies.
    

    The Company generally receives a fee associated with loan origination,
which is usually approximately 1% of the loan balance. The Company also
receives ongoing servicing fees and management fees with respect to mortgage
loans in portfolios managed by the Company.

    Private Placement Investing. The Company believes it has considerable
expertise in evaluating private placement securities. As of September 30, 1997,
the Company managed approximately $2.2 billion in private placement securities,
most of which were purchased on behalf of General American and its affiliates.
Private placement securities are acquired pursuant to negotiated transactions
between investors and issuers pursuant to exemptions from registration with the
SEC. While less liquid than public securities, private placements often contain
investment characteristics favorable to investors such as more stringent
financial covenants, prepayment protection, collateral or higher yields than
similar public securities. The Company purchases both fixed and floating rate,
U.S. dollar denominated private securities on behalf of its client accounts,
primarily of investment grade quality and primarily according to a "buy and
hold" strategy. Such an investment in a private placement is generally between
$5 million and $15 million.

    The Company conducts in-depth reviews of each private placement security's
credit, structure, terms and proposed pricing prior to making a commitment to
purchase a private placement on behalf of a client. The Company considers
credit analysis to be critical to its success in private placement investing
and such credit analysis consists of an evaluation of all aspects of a
borrowing, including analysis of financial statements and ratios, cash flow,
industry and competitive position, operating trends and any collateral securing
the loan.

    Investment Accounting & Reporting. As of September 30, 1997, the Company's
investment accounting & reporting services provided stand-alone investment
accounting for approximately $26.2 billion in assets. All $73.6 billion in
assets serviced by the Company are supported by the Company's investment
accounting & reporting system. The Company's investment accounting & reporting
services include management and regulatory reporting on invested assets,
operating income and capital gains and losses. These services have been
designed to address the needs of clients for timely and accurate reporting for
management purposes, as well as the increased information required in filings
with state and federal regulatory authorities regarding assets and liabilities
as well as risk-based capital allocations, including Schedules B and D of the
standard insurance industry annual statutory financial report.

    The Company's accounting & reporting system utilizes the Complete Asset
Management, Reporting and Accounting software system (known as CAMRA(TM)) and
the Fully Integrated Loan Management Information Software System (known as
FILMS(TM)) under a software license agreement with SS&C Technologies, Inc.
("SS&C"), effective as of January 27, 1996 (the "License Agreement"). SS&C
represents that it is the owner of the trademarks CAMRA(TM) and FILMS(TM). In
connection with insurance investment accounting, the Company obtains pertinent
client information through frequent and ongoing contact with the client,
portfolio manager, brokers and custodians, in addition to standard industry
sources. The Company utilizes detailed portfolio information as the foundation
for asset allocation and portfolio management as well as to support its
clients' operational and information needs. By utilizing CAMRA(TM), the Company
is able to provide a number of services, such as: (i) portfolio management and
market analyses, including a comprehensive securities database supporting
on-line daily, monthly, quarterly and on-demand calculation of a range of
information, including book and market value, yields, duration, average life
and various user-selected scenarios; (ii) comprehensive accounting and
reporting capabilities, including four accounting bases--GAAP, statutory,
management and tax--exporting data directly to spreadsheets, word processors and
databases for ease of delivery and presentation; (iii) multi-currency
processing, calculating transaction and translation values in accordance with
applicable accounting and insurance industry rules; and (iv) regulatory
compliance, providing performance measurement calculations. The
Company utilizes FILMS(TM) to enable its mortgage professionals to process,
analyze and report on a comprehensive basis information regarding their loan
portfolios. CAMRA(TM) and FILMS(TM) allow for detailed and timely reporting to
the Company's clients, providing them with valuable management tools. Such
reporting is an integral component of the Company's focus on client service.

    Under the License Agreement, the Company has a perpetual non-exclusive
license to use, maintain and modify its investment accounting & reporting
software, including both CAMRA(TM) and FILMS(TM), in both source code and
object code (the "Software"). The License Agreement permits the Software to
be used by the Company and General American and its subsidiaries for
accounting, reporting and similar purposes in the asset management
business and for outsourcing to customers in the insurance industry. See "Risk
Factors--Risk of Systems Failure; Dependence on Vendors."

                                      28

<PAGE> 30

    Investment accounting & reporting services are typically provided in
conjunction with insurance asset management services and are therefore subject
to the terms of an overall management agreement. See "--Discretionary Asset
Management & Investment Advisory Services." In a number of cases, however,
clients have retained the Company to provide such services on a stand-alone
basis. In those cases, the services are subject to the terms of a separate
agreement and the Company is generally compensated on the basis of fees
calculated as a percentage of assets serviced.

    Private Equity Funds. The Company believes it is a leader in facilitating
the provision of private equity capital to the insurance and insurance-related
industries. Since 1985, the Company has organized five funds that have raised
approximately $360 million in committed capital. The private equity funds have
invested more than $193 million of these proceeds in 39 companies which
constitute the investment portfolios of these funds. In most cases, these
invested proceeds serve to provide a portion of additional equity-based
financing or to partially capitalize a new company. The Company or a subsidiary
acts as the general partner of the funds and maintains a 1% general partner
capital interest. The Company may also invest as a limited partner in future
funds it may organize. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations" and "Certain Relationships and Related
Transactions."

    Management believes that limited partners invest in the Company's private
equity funds to obtain the opportunity for potential private equity returns on
investments in insurance or insurance-related enterprises. Investors also
receive exposure to new business strategies and entrepreneurial developments in
the insurance industry. More than 70 limited partners have invested in the
Company's private equity funds since 1985, including financial companies,
banks, pension funds and some of the largest insurance companies in the world.
A number of limited partners have invested in multiple private equity funds
over time.

    The following table shows the average private equity committed capital over
the past five years.

<TABLE>
                       PRIVATE EQUITY COMMITTED CAPITAL
                                 (IN MILLIONS)
<CAPTION>
                                  AVERAGE COMMITTED CAPITAL
                       -----------------------------------------------    AS OF
                        1992      1993      1994      1995      1996     9/30/97

<S>                     <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>
Fund I..............    $ 50.5    $ 42.4    $ 28.4    $ 18.9    $  7.7    $  -0-

Fund II.............      67.7      67.7      67.7      67.7      67.7      67.7

Fund III............        --      21.8      50.1      56.6      56.6      56.6

Fund IV.............        --        --        --      18.7      38.9      40.4

Fund V..............        --        --        --        --        --     146.5
                        ------    ------    ------    ------    ------    ------
        Total.......    $118.2    $131.9    $146.2    $161.9    $170.9    $311.2
                        ======    ======    ======    ======    ======    ======
</TABLE>

    These funds have invested in a wide range of insurance, healthcare and
insurance service company segments, including specialty property-casualty,
life, health, managed care, agency, software, and service companies. The
portfolio companies have been in various stages of development, including
start-ups, expansion rounds, buy-outs and recapitalizations.

    The Company seeks to develop a working relationship with senior management
of the portfolio companies to jointly maximize shareholder value. An employee
of the Company generally serves as a representative on the board of directors
of the portfolio companies. By providing guidance through board of director
participation, the Company seeks to assist senior management in developing
business strategies, raising capital in the public and private markets and
acquiring new or complementary businesses. Investors in the funds have become
co-investors, joint venture partners, reinsurers or customers to over half of
the funds' portfolio companies.

    Subject to the ability to raise capital, the Company currently plans to
maintain several funds at any point in time, reflecting the approximate ten
year life cycle of the funds. The objective of the funds is to liquidate their
investments through public offerings, sale of the portfolio company or the
fund's investment, redemption or otherwise. Since inception, approximately 15
portfolio companies have emerged as public entities. The Company receives
annual management fees from the private equity funds of approximately 2% of
committed funds and a specified interest in the cumulative net profit. Certain
of the Company's professionals share in the Company's share of any profit
participation. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--
Participation in Private Equity Funds."

                                      29
<PAGE> 31
INSURANCE RESEARCH

    Name recognition associated with the Company's insurance research business
is an integral component of the marketing strategy for the Company's insurance
asset management services. The Company believes that Conning & Company is
viewed as one of the leading insurance industry investment research firms in
the United States. The Company publishes in-depth insurance industry research
covering major insurance industry trends, products, markets and business
segments. The Company also publishes stock research on a broad group of
publicly-traded insurance companies for some of the largest United States
institutional money managers as well as pension funds, banks, mutual funds, and
insurance companies. The Company's in-depth insurance industry research has
been targeted to senior executives in the insurance industry for more than 20
years, and its Strategic Studies Series is subscribed to by 44 of the 50
largest U.S. property-casualty insurance companies and 42 of the 50 largest
U.S. life-health insurance companies (based on 1996 premiums as reported by
OneSource Information Services, Inc. as provided to it by third parties).
During 1996 and the first nine months of 1997, the Company published the
following studies:

  LIFE/HEALTH/ASSET ACCUMULATION

    The High Net Worth Market for Financial Services--Leveraging Customer
      Specialization to Achieve Sustainable Competitive Advantage
    The Pension/Retirement Assets Business--Sleeping With the Enemy
    The Rise of Multiple Life Distribution Channels--Covering All Bases
    Individual Annuities--Rising Tide Will Not Lift All Carriers
    Social Security Reform--Private Market Opportunities?

  FINANCIAL

    Alternative Markets--Evolving to a New Layer
    Lloyd's of London--A New World of Capital. Is the Genie Out of the Bottle?
    Mergers & Acquisitions and Public Equity Offerings--Sink, Swim Fast or be
      Swallowed
    Technology I--Electronic Commerce and the Internet
    Banking--New Opportunities for Banks in Insurance
    Mergers & Acquisitions and Public Equity Offerings--Mid-Year 1997 Review
    Insurance and Technology--Leveraging the Drivers of Competitive Advantage

  HEALTHCARE

    Medicare and Medicaid--The Private Sector Steps to the Plate
    Reinvesting Individual Disability Income Insurance--The Long Road Back
    The Health Care Marketplace--The Move Toward Managed Care Accelerates
    From Medical Malpractice to Managed Care Liability--Fifty Ways to Meet the
      Future

  PROPERTY/CASUALTY

    The Property-Casualty Underwriting Cycle--Lifting the Veil of Abnormal
      Losses
    Insurance Fraud--The Quiet Catastrophe
    Property-Casualty Expenses--Building Muscles While Losing Fat
    Personal Auto Insurance--Winning Strategies for the Year 2000
    The Independent P/C Agent--The Squeeze Is Still On
    Strategic Customer Specialization--The Patchwork Quilt of Minority Owned
      Businesses
    Strategic Customer Segmentation--Women Business Owners--Doing It Their Way

  REINSURANCE

    Outlook for the Reinsurance Industry--A New Definition of Quality
    Life and Health Reinsurance--Pockets of Opportunity
    A Portrait of Reinsurance--Back to the Basics and Beyond

    In addition, the Company from time to time participates in the underwriting
of public offerings of equity securities for insurance and insurance-related
companies. Since 1993, the Company has participated in syndicates for
approximately 120 insurance-related underwritings for both initial and
follow-on public offerings. Payment for the

                                      30

<PAGE> 32
Company's research services is primarily in the form of commissions derived
from securities transactions effected by the Company and, to a lesser extent,
subscription fees for research publications. In addition, the research services
revenues received by the Company reflect underwriting fees with participation
in public offerings of insurance and insurance-related companies.

ACCOUNTING, ADMINISTRATION AND OPERATIONS

    The Company's accounting, administration and operations personnel are
responsible for financial controls, internal and external financial reporting,
compliance with regulatory and legal requirements, office and personnel
services, the Company's management information and telecommunications systems,
and the processing of the Company's securities transactions. General American
provides certain of these functions pursuant to an Administrative Services
Agreement. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--Transactions
with General American." The Company contracts with outside services for
securities pricing information in connection with its asset management and
investment accounting & reporting services. See "Risk Factors--Risk of Systems
Failure; Dependence on Vendors."

COMPETITION

    All of the Company's businesses are conducted in highly competitive
markets. The Company competes with a large number of other asset management
firms as well as broker-dealers, insurance companies, commercial banks and
others in the business. Conning Asset Management Company competes for assets
under discretionary management with a large number of specialty and diversified
investment advisory firms and divisions, including internal investment
divisions of insurance companies, many of which are larger and have access to
greater resources than the Company. The intensity of competition could increase
if the rate of growth in insurance company assets managed externally were to
decline. See "Business--Industry Background and Trends--Developing Trends in
the Insurance Industry." The asset management industry is characterized by
relatively low cost of entry, and new investment advisory entities may be
formed which may compete with the Company. The Company's focus on the insurance
industry makes it particularly subject to direct competition from firms or
divisions which specialize in providing services to the insurance industry.
Additionally, other insurance companies may determine to spin out their
investment management divisions, which might then become significant
competitors. The Company believes that the most important factors affecting
competition for investment management clients are the knowledge and reputations
of investment managers, customer service, performance records and pricing
policies.

    The Company's mortgage origination and servicing business faces competition
from local and national mortgage brokerage firms, other direct institutional
lenders and services, lending programs from investment banking firms and other
financial institutions, many of whom are larger and have access to greater
resources than the Company. The Company believes that the most important
factors affecting competition for the origination of commercial mortgage loans
are price, loan quality and service. For most customers, the Company's
investment accounting & reporting services face competition from certain other
asset management firms as well as software companies, including SS&C. The
Company believes the most important factors affecting competition for
investment accounting & reporting services are the quality and performance of
the Company's software and service, and to a lesser extent price. The Company's
private equity business faces competition for raising capital and making equity
investments from securities firms, venture capitalists, commercial banks,
investment banks and insurance companies, many of whom are larger and have
access to greater resources than the Company. The Company believes that the
most important factors affecting competition for the sponsorship and management
of such funds are performance records and the reputations and expertise of
sponsors. The Company's insurance research business faces competition from
traditional securities firms and investment banks in providing research on
publicly-traded insurance industry related companies and research on the
insurance industry. The Company believes that the most important factors
affecting competition are the quality and number of the insurance research
professionals, the breadth of coverage and the number of topics covered.

    There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to compete
successfully against current and future competitors or that competitive
pressures faced by the Company will not materially and adversely affect the
Company's business, financial condition, results of operations and business
prospects. See "Risk Factors--Significant Industry Competition."

                                      31

<PAGE> 33
FACILITIES

    The Company's headquarters and certain of its executive offices are located
in an approximately 25,000 square foot office space located at 700 Market
Street, St. Louis, Missouri 63101 pursuant to a lease from General American.
The Company anticipates leasing up to an additional 10,000 square feet at this
location during 1997 on substantially the same terms and conditions. See
"Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--Transactions with General
American." The Company also maintains executive offices in a 49,500 square
foot office space located at 185 Asylum Street, Hartford, Connecticut pursuant
to a lease expiring in 2005 with annual base rental expense of approximately
$1.0 million until 1999 and a base rental expense of approximately $1.2 million
from 1999 until 2004, subject to increases for taxes, insurance and operating
expenses. The Company also leases from third parties, or subleases from General
American, each of eleven other office sites for its various mortgage loan and
real estate offices located in Arizona, California (2), Colorado (2), Florida,
Georgia, Illinois, Missouri, Texas and Washington, D.C.

    The Company's principal offices in St. Louis and all but one of the remote
office spaces described above are rented pursuant to written leases and a
sublease between the Company and General American. See "Certain Relationships
and Related Transactions--Transactions with General American." The terms of
such leases and the sublease (collectively, the "Leases"), were designed to
approximate the cost to General American of owning or leasing such spaces. The
Company believes that the prices and other terms under the Leases are at least
as favorable as those prices and terms being offered generally in the same
marketplaces by unrelated parties for comparable spaces.

    The Company believes its facilities have been generally well maintained,
are in good operating condition, and, upon lease of the additional space
described above, will be adequate for its current requirements.

EMPLOYEES

    As of September 30, 1997, the Company employed approximately 275 employees.
None of the Company's employees is subject to a collective bargaining
agreement. The Company believes that its relations with its employees are good.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

    On November 14, 1994, the Insurance Commissioner of the Commonwealth of
Pennsylvania, in its capacity as statutory liquidator of Rockwood Insurance
Company ("Rockwood"), initiated an action in the Commonwealth Court of
Pennsylvania against Conning & Company and certain of the officers of Conning &
Company styled Maleski v. Conning & Company, et al., No. 94-7507 (subsequently
amended to Linda S. Kaiser v. Conning). The action arises out of the
Commissioner's previous retention of Conning & Company as placement agent for
the sale of one of Rockwood's subsidiaries. The complaint alleges breach of
fiduciary duty, breach of contract, professional negligence, bad faith and
conspiracy, and seeks compensatory damages for approximately $6.5 million and
unspecified punitive damages, costs and interest. Conning & Company is
defending the action vigorously and the Company believes that Conning & Company
has meritorious defenses to all claims. Although the matter is subject to
uncertainty, as it remains in the preliminary stages and discovery has not been
completed, the Company believes that the probable outcome should not have a
material adverse effect upon the Company.

    On July 8, 1997, a consolidated amended class-action complaint was filed
against SS&C Technologies, Inc. ("SS&C") in the United States District Court,
District of Connecticut, styled Marc A. Feiner, M.D., et al. v. SS&C
Technologies, Inc., et al. (Civil Action No. 397CV00656(JBA) consolidated with
Civil Action No. 397CV01077). The complaint names SS&C, the directors of SS&C
at the time of SS&C's initial public offering (including John B. Clinton, an
officer of the Company), and lead underwriters Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated
and Hambrecht & Quist as defendants. The complaint alleges, among other things,
there were material misstatements in the prospectus used by SS&C in an initial
public offering in May 1996 and seeks, among other things, rescission and/or
money damages, equitable relief and costs and expenses. Conning & Company, a
subsidiary of the Company, was a participant of the underwriting syndicate in
connection with SS&C's initial public offering, and thus may share, to the
extent of its participation in the initial public offering, in any potential
liability of the lead underwriters. General American and Fund I were selling
shareholders in SS&C's initial public offering, and the lead underwriters have
demanded of the selling shareholders indemnity against any losses, claims,
damages or liabilities arising out of the action and reimbursement for legal or
other expenses incurred in connection with investigating or defending the
action. Although the matter is subject to uncertainty as, among other things,
the action is in the preliminary stages, the Company believes that the probable
outcome of the pending action should not have a material adverse effect upon
the Company.

                                      32

<PAGE> 34
                     SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

    The selected consolidated financial data presented below should be read in
conjunction with the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements and the Notes
thereto included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The income statement and balance
sheet data for, and as of the end of, each of the years in the three-year
period ended December 31, 1996 are derived from the financial statements of the
Company, which financial statements have been audited by KPMG Peat Marwick LLP,
independent certified public accountants. The consolidated financial statements
for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1996, and the
report thereon, are included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected
financial data of the Company presented below for the years ended December 31,
1992 and 1993 and as of December 31, 1992, 1993 and 1994 are derived from
audited financial statements not included in this Prospectus. The selected
consolidated financial data for the nine months ended September 30, 1997 and
the nine months ended September 30, 1996 have been derived from the unaudited
consolidated financial statements of the Company, which have been prepared on
the same basis as the audited consolidated financial statements of the Company
and, in the opinion of management, reflect all normal recurring adjustments
necessary for a fair presentation of the financial position and results of
operations as of the end of and for such periods. The information set forth
below should be read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and Analysis
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," the Company's Consolidated
Financial Statements and the Notes thereto included elsewhere in this
Prospectus. Also set forth below is certain operating and financial
information.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     YEARS ENDED        NINE MONTHS ENDED
                                            YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,<F1>           DECEMBER 31,<F2>       SEPTEMBER 30,
                                         ------------------------------------      ----------------     -----------------
                                         1992       1993       1994      1995      1995        1996       1996       1997
                                                                                 PRO FORMA
                                                             (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                  <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:

Revenues:

    Asset management and related
      fees.........................     $1,716     $2,446     $3,484    $24,050    $30,675    $40,456    $29,365    $36,018

    Research services..............          0          0          0      4,090      9,480     12,148      9,582     10,278

    Other income...................         51         36         57        663        996      1,062        792        629
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------
        Total revenues.............      1,767      2,482      3,541     28,803     41,151     53,666     39,739     46,925
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------
Expenses:

    Employee compensation and
      benefits.....................          0          0          0     12,027     18,336     26,002     18,522     23,559

    Amortization of goodwill and
      other........................          0          0          0      1,289      2,911      2,721      2,062      1,953

    All other expenses.............        935      1,141      1,429      9,195     12,515     13,151     10,062     10,441
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------
        Total expenses.............        935      1,141      1,429     22,511     33,762     41,874     30,646     35,953
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------
Operating income...................        832      1,341      2,112      6,292      7,389     11,792      9,093     10,972

    Interest expense...............          0          0          0        521      1,365        729        592        233
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------
Income before provision for income
  taxes............................        832      1,341      2,112      5,771      6,025     11,063      8,501     10,739

Provision for income taxes.........        311        507        827      2,359      2,739      4,851      3,762      4,317
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------
        Net income.................     $  521     $  834     $1,285    $ 3,412    $ 3,286    $ 6,212    $ 4,739    $ 6,422
                                        ======     ======     ======    =======    =======    =======    =======    =======
Preferred stock dividends..........          0          0          0        351        906        906        669        750
                                        ------     ------     ------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------
Net earnings available to common
  shareholder......................     $  521     $  834     $1,285    $ 3,061    $ 2,380    $ 5,306    $ 4,070    $ 5,672
                                        ======     ======     ======    =======    =======    =======    =======    =======
    Pro forma net income per common
      share and common share
      equivalents<F3>..............                                                           $  0.57               $  0.58
                                                                                              =======               =======

<FN>
- --------
Footnotes on next page.

</TABLE>
                                      33

<PAGE> 35

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      AS OF DECEMBER 31,                      AS OF SEPTEMBER 30,
                                        --------------------------------------------------    -------------------
                                         1992       1993       1994       1995       1996       1997       1997
                                                                                                            AS
                                                                                                       ADJUSTED<F4>
                                                                   (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                    <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Total assets.......................     $1,395     $1,386     $1,683    $46,177    $50,020    $54,646    $85,255
Long-term debt.....................          0          0          0      9,000      2,000          0          0
Total liabilities..................        437        594        356     24,552     20,870     18,426     18,426
Convertible preferred stock........          0          0          0     17,003     24,782     36,152          0
Total common shareholder's
  equity...........................        958        792      1,327      4,623      4,368         68     66,829
Number of common shares outstanding
  end of period....................        0.1        0.1        0.1      6,710      6,710      6,820     12,875
</TABLE>
    Set forth below is certain operating and financial information.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        ------------------------------------------------      AS OF
                                                        1992       1993       1994       1995       1996     9/30/97
                                                                     (IN BILLIONS, EXCEPT AS NOTED)
<S>                                                 <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
OTHER OPERATING DATA:

Average assets under discretionary management<F5>:

    Unaffiliated..................................     $  3.3     $  5.4     $  6.2     $  7.7     $  9.5    $  12.9

    General American & affiliates.................        5.5        6.0        6.6        7.8        9.6       13.5
                                                       ------     ------     ------     ------     ------    -------
        Total.....................................        8.8       11.4       12.8       15.5       19.1       26.4

Average assets under advisory services............        5.2       10.1       14.7       15.3       18.3       21.0

Average assets under accounting & reporting
  services........................................        0.0        1.3        2.6        4.8        9.2       26.2
                                                       ------     ------     ------     ------     ------    -------
        Total assets serviced.....................     $ 14.0     $ 22.8     $ 30.1     $ 35.6     $ 46.6    $  73.6
                                                       ======     ======     ======     ======     ======    =======
<FN>
- --------
<F1> The years 1992 to 1994 reflect the results of GAIMCO only. The year 1995
     reflects the results of the consolidated activity, from August 1, 1995 to
     December 31, 1995 and the results of GAIMCO only from January 1, 1995 to
     July 31, 1995. See Note 1 to the Company's Consolidated Financial
     Statements.

<F2> Pro forma 1995 reflects the consolidated activity for the year assuming
     the Strategic Merger took place on January 1, 1995. The year 1996 reflects
     actual consolidated results. See Note 2 to the Company's Consolidated
     Financial Statements.

<F3> Pro forma earnings per share is computed by dividing net income by the
     weighted average number of shares of common stock and common stock
     equivalents considered outstanding during the period after giving effect
     to all dilutive common stock and common stock equivalents shares issued
     within twelve months of the public offering of the Company's common stock
     and to the Capital Stock Conversions.

<F4> Gives effect to the Capital Stock Conversions and the sale of 2,500,000
     shares of Common Stock offered hereby at an assumed initial public
     offering price of $13.50 per share and the receipt of the estimated net
     proceeds therefrom.

<F5> Since January 1, 1995, the assets of the general account of General
     American have been under contract with GAIMCO (now known as Conning Asset
     Management Company). General account assets prior to January 1, 1995 were
     managed by the investment division of General American, a predecessor or
     GAIMCO, and are included in assets under management for 1992, 1993 and
     1994. Data for 1995 and prior periods is presented on a pro forma basis to
     include both Conning and GAIMCO assets under management.
</TABLE>
                                      34

<PAGE> 36
    The following financial information represents financial data of Conning,
Inc. and its subsidiaries for the years ended December 31, 1992, 1993 and 1994,
and for the six months ended June 30, 1995 and should be read in conjunction
with Conning, Inc.'s Consolidated Financial Statements and the Notes thereto
included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The income statement and balance sheet
data for, and as of the end of, the year ended December 31, 1994 are derived
from the financial statements of Conning, Inc. and its subsidiaries, which
financial statements have been audited by Price Waterhouse LLP, independent
certified public accountants. The income statement and balance sheet data for,
and as of the end of, the six month period ended June 30, 1995 are derived from
the financial statements for the six month period ended June 30, 1995, which
financial statements have been audited by KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, certified
public accountants. The consolidated financial statements for the year ended
December 31, 1994 and the report thereon, and the financial statements for the
six month period ended June 30, 1995 are included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
The selected financial data presented below for the years ended December 31,
1992 and 1993 and as of December 31, 1992 and 1993 are derived from audited
financial statements not included in this Prospectus.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  SIX
                                                                                                 MONTHS
                                                                                                 ENDED
                                                                  YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,      JUNE 30,
                                                                 --------------------------     --------
CONNING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES                                   1992       1993       1994       1995
                                                                             (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                            <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:

Revenues:

    Asset management and related fees.......................    $ 6,643    $ 8,107    $ 9,840    $ 5,662

    Research services.......................................      9,487     13,473      8,165      4,564

    Other income............................................        132      1,282        472        275
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
        Total revenues......................................     16,262     22,862     18,477     10,501
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
Expenses:

    Employee compensation and benefits......................      9,382     10,616     10,196      5,322

    Amortization of goodwill and other......................          0          0          0          0

    All other expenses......................................      6,298      7,805      5,530      3,087
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
        Total expenses......................................     15,680     18,421     15,726      8,409
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
Operating income............................................        582      4,441      2,751      2,092

    Interest expense........................................        111         85          0          0
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
Income before provision for income taxes and cumulative
  effect of accounting change...............................        471      4,356      2,751      2,092

Provision for income taxes..................................         66        947      1,244        809
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
Income before cumulative effect of accounting change........        405      3,409      1,507      1,283

Cumulative effect of accounting change......................          0        131          0          0
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
        Net income..........................................    $   405    $ 3,540    $ 1,507    $ 1,283
                                                                =======    =======    =======    =======
Preferred stock dividends...................................         53        320        320        160
                                                                -------    -------    -------    -------
Net earnings available to common shareholders...............    $   352    $ 3,220    $ 1,187    $ 1,123
                                                                =======    =======    =======    =======

<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  AS OF
                                                                    AS OF DECEMBER 31,           JUNE 30,
                                                                  --------------------------     --------
                                                                  1992       1993       1994       1995
                                                                              (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                            <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:

Total assets................................................    $10,922    $11,274    $14,228    $16,003

Long-term debt..............................................          0          0          0          0

Total liabilities...........................................      8,179      5,071      6,392      6,927

Redeemable preferred stock..................................      5,425          0          0          0

Cumulative preferred stock..................................          0      3,650      3,650      3,650

Total common shareholders' equity (deficit).................     (2,682)     2,552      4,186      5,426

Number of common shares outstanding end of period...........        446         93        106        108
</TABLE>

                                      35

<PAGE> 37
                    MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
                 FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

OVERVIEW

    The Company's revenues consist of asset management and related fees,
research service fees and other income.

    The Company's asset management and related revenues derive from three
sources: asset management fees, private equity fund management fees and fees
related to the Company's mortgage and real estate activities. Asset management
fees primarily reflect fees for discretionary asset management services
provided to insurance company clients, including General American and its
affiliates. Asset management fees are generally a function of the overall fee
rate charged to each account and the level of assets under management. A
portion of revenues are generated when the Company provides investment advisory
services as well as when the Company provides investment accounting and
reporting services on a stand-alone basis. Assets under management are affected
by the addition of new client accounts or client contributions to existing
accounts, withdrawals of assets from or terminations of client accounts and
investment performance, which may depend on general market conditions.

    The Company's private equity fund management fees represent annual
management fees based on a percentage of committed capital and a participation
in specified net gains of the funds. The Company's commercial mortgage fees
primarily reflect fees associated with loan originations, which usually
approximate 1% of the loan balance, as well as fees associated with ongoing
servicing and management fees with respect to loans in portfolios managed by
the Company. In addition to loans for General American and its affiliates, the
Company has originated mortgage loans in a securitized offering for an
investment banking firm.

    Payment for the Company's research services is primarily in the form of
commissions derived from securities transactions effected by the Company and,
to a lesser extent, subscription fees for research publications. A negotiated
commission is received on each listed equity transaction, and total commission
revenues depend on the value that clients place on the research services the
Company provides. In addition, the research services revenues received by the
Company reflect underwriting fees with participation in public offerings of
insurance and insurance-related companies.

EFFECTS OF THE STRATEGIC MERGER

    The Company was formed on August 11, 1995 as a holding company to effect
the Strategic Merger. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions"
and Note 1 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements. Upon
consummation of the Strategic Merger, General American owned 100% of the
outstanding Common Stock. If all of the outstanding shares of convertible
preferred stock were converted as of the date of the Strategic Merger, General
American would have owned approximately 65% of the outstanding Common Stock,
without giving effect to outstanding stock options. Under generally accepted
accounting principles, the GAIMCO contribution was recorded at historical book
value as a combination of entities under common control. The Conning & Company
contribution was recorded utilizing the purchase accounting method. The
historical financial statements include the operations and financial position
of GAIMCO through July 31, 1995, and consolidated operations thereafter and
consolidated financial position at December 31, 1995 and December 31, 1996. The
excess of purchase price over the fair value of net assets acquired resulted in
goodwill of $20.3 million.

    As a result of the required accounting presentation and the inherent
difficulties of analyzing the historical financial statements for periods prior
to 1996 and comparing them to the 1996 results, also included is financial
information on a pro forma basis as if the Strategic Merger occurred on January
1, 1995. The following discussion begins with a comparison of the historical
financial statements and follows with a discussion of results based on the pro
forma financial information which is found in Note 2 of Notes to the Company's
Consolidated Financial Statements. See also "Selected Consolidated Financial
Data."

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

  HISTORICAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

    Statement of Income for the nine months ended September 30, 1997 compared
to the nine months ended September 30, 1996

    Total revenues increased 18% from $39.7 million for the first nine months
of 1996 to $46.9 million for the first nine months of 1997, primarily as the
result of the addition of new clients and growth in assets of existing clients.

                                      36

<PAGE> 38
Assets under discretionary management increased from approximately $19.9
billion at September 30, 1996 to approximately $26.4 billion at September 30,
1997. Asset management and related fees increased 23% from $29.4 million for
the nine month period ended September 30, 1996 to $36.0 million for the nine
months ended September 30, 1997. Fees for research services increased slightly
from $9.6 million for the first nine months of 1996 to $10.3 million for the
first nine months of 1997. Conning & Company was a co-manager of four public
offerings which produced revenues of $2.0 million in 1996 and $1.1 million in
1997. Excluding the effect of revenues from these transactions, fees for
research services would have increased 21% from the first nine months of 1996
to the first nine months of 1997. Underwriting revenues are highly volatile,
depending on a variety of factors, including market conditions and transaction
activity; accordingly, no assurance can be given as to the amount of such
revenues, if any, that may arise in future periods. Other income decreased by
approximately $0.2 million from $0.8 million for the first nine months of 1996
to $0.6 million for the first nine months of 1997, primarily due to the $0.3
million non-recurring realized gain from the sale of securities that occurred
in the first quarter of 1996.

    Total expense increased 17% from $30.6 million for the first nine months of
1996 to $36.0 million for the first nine months of 1997, primarily due to
increased employee compensation and benefits. Employee compensation and
benefits increased 27% from $18.5 million for the first nine months ended
September 30, 1996 to $23.6 million for the nine months ended September 30,
1997, primarily due to additional staffing to keep pace with increased revenue
activity and additional incentive compensation accruals as a result of the
increased operating income. The Company's incentive compensation practice is
based on the level of and growth in the Company's operating profits.

    Interest expense decreased significantly from $0.6 million for the nine
months ended September 30, 1996 to $0.2 million for the nine months ended
September 30, 1997 due to the continuing reduction of principal on long term
debt payable to affiliates, of which the final payment of principal and
interest was made in February, 1997.

    Provision for income taxes increased 15% from $3.8 million for the first
nine months of 1996 to $4.3 million for the first nine months of 1997 as a
direct result of the increase in income before provision for income taxes.
However, the effective federal and state income tax rates decreased from 44.3%
for the nine month period ended September 30, 1996 to 40.2% for the nine month
period ended September 30, 1997 due to the Company being able to recognize
state net operating loss carryforwards in 1997.

    As a result of all of the above, net income increased 36% from $4.7 million
for the first nine months of 1996 to $6.4 million for the first nine months of
1997.

    Statement of Income for 1996 compared to 1995

    All consolidated revenue and expense categories are greater in 1996 than
1995 because each consolidated revenue and expense category includes the full
year's results of Conning & Company in 1996 and only five months of Conning &
Company results in 1995. The effective federal and state tax rate increased
from 40.9% in 1995 to 43.8% in 1996. The higher state tax rate from Conning &
Company's operations is included for the full year in 1996 and for only five
months in 1995.

    Goodwill arising from the Strategic Merger in the amount of $20.3 million
is being amortized on a straight-line basis over 20 years. This resulted in
amortization expense of $0.4 million in 1995 and $1.0 million in 1996.

    Statement of Income for 1995 compared to 1994

    All revenue and expense categories increased substantially from 1994 to
1995 principally due to the following: (i) 1995 includes the results of Conning
& Company for the five months ended December 31, 1995 and there are no Conning
& Company results included in 1994; and (ii) the contract to manage the general
account assets of General American by GAIMCO was entered into effective January
1, 1995. The effective federal and state income tax rate increased from 39.2%
in 1994 to 40.9% in 1995 due to the inclusion of goodwill in 1995 and the
higher state tax rate applied to Conning & Company's results for the five
months ended December 31, 1995.

  PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION

    Statement of Income for 1996 compared to Pro Forma 1995

    Asset Management and Related Fees. Asset management and related fees
increased 32% from $30.7 million in 1995 to $40.5 million in 1996 primarily due
to the addition of new clients and growth in assets of existing clients, and to

                                      37

<PAGE> 39
a lesser extent as a result of a resurgence in the real estate market and
growth in mortgage assets from new and existing clients. Assets under
management increased 18% from $17.6 billion at December 31, 1995 to $20.7
billion at December 31, 1996, 6% because of additions of new clients and 12%
because of growth of assets of existing clients. Private equity fund management
and related fees increased 21% from $3.9 million in 1995 to $4.7 million in
1996 due primarily to the March 1996 completion of Fund IV with committed
capital of $40 million. See "Business--Private Equity Funds."

    Research Fees. Research services revenues increased 28% from $9.5 million
in 1995 to $12.1 million in 1996 due primarily to the increased capital markets
activity in the insurance industry and the increase in core research revenues
in 1996. Conning is often a member of underwriting syndicates of insurance
company offerings and twice during 1996 acted as co-manager of a secondary
offering. In the aggregate, the Company generated revenues from underwriting
activities of $4.0 million in 1996, as compared to $1.2 million in 1995.
Underwriting revenues are highly volatile, depending on a variety of factors,
including market conditions and transaction activity; accordingly, no assurance
can be given as to the amount of such revenues, if any, that may arise in
future periods.

    Other Income. Other income remained virtually unchanged at $1.1 million,
primarily reflecting miscellaneous non-recurring revenues.

    Expenses. Employee compensation and benefits increased 42% from $18.3
million in 1995 to $26.0 million in 1996 primarily due to the higher incentive
compensation as a result of the large increase in operating results from 1995
to 1996, as well as additions to staff during 1996. The Company's incentive
compensation practice is based on the level of and growth in the Company's
operating profits. Other operating expenses increased 5% from $12.5 million in
1995 to $13.2 million in 1996, reflecting additional ancillary costs from
increased hiring and increased marketing expenses. Goodwill of $20.3 million
resulting from the Strategic Merger is being amortized on a straight-line basis
over 20 years. Amortization of goodwill and other charges totaling $2.9 million
in 1995 and $2.7 million in 1996 are noncash expenses and do not affect cash
available for other operating or capital needs.

    Interest Expense. Interest expense decreased 47% from $1.4 million in 1995
to $0.7 million in 1996 due primarily to prepayments of debt during 1996. Debt
outstanding was $9.0 million and $2.0 million at December 31, 1995 and 1996,
respectively. Such debt arose from the Strategic Merger and was payable to
General American. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions."

    Income Taxes. The provision for income taxes increased $2.1 million from
$2.7 million in 1995 to $4.8 million in 1996 due to the increase in pre-tax
earnings of the Company.

    Net Income. As a result of all of the above, net income increased $2.9
million from $3.3 million in 1995 to $6.2 million in 1996.

    Statement of Income for 1995 compared to 1994

    The investment management contract between GAIMCO and General American
relating to the General American--General Account assets of $5.2 billion was
entered into effective January 1, 1995. As such, the Company believes
comparisons between 1995 and 1994, even on a pro forma basis after giving
effect to the Strategic Merger, are not useful.

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

    For purposes of this discussion, see Note 1 of Notes to the Company's
Consolidated Financial Statements for the principal operating entities that are
included as part of the Company.

    The Company's business is not capital intensive. Working capital
requirements for the Company have historically been provided almost exclusively
by operating cash flow. It is expected that such cash flows will continue to
serve as the principal source of working capital for the Company for the near
future.

    At September 30, 1997, the Company's capital structure included 6,710,000
shares of Common Stock, 110,000 shares of Non-Voting Common Stock, 3,190,000
shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock and 365,000 shares of Series B
Convertible Preferred Stock. The Series A Convertible Stock is entitled to
quarterly dividends, equal to the 90 day United States Treasury Bill rate as in
effect from time to time. Such dividends amounted to approximately $669,900 for
the period commencing on January 1, 1997 and ending on September 30, 1997. The
Series B Convertible

                                      38

<PAGE> 40
Preferred Stock which was issued commencing in November 1996 is entitled to
quarterly dividends of 5% per annum, or $80,600 in the aggregate, through
September 30, 1997. Upon the completion of this offering, it is anticipated
that all of the Non-Voting Common Stock and Series A and Series B Convertible
Preferred Stock will have been converted to Common Stock and the Company will
no longer have any preferred stock outstanding.

    Conning & Company is subject to the net capital requirements imposed on
registered broker-dealers by the Exchange Act. See "Regulation." At December
31, 1996, Conning & Company had net capital (as defined by the Exchange Act) of
approximately $2.4 million, which was approximately $1.8 million in excess of
the regulatory minimum, and at September 30, 1997, Conning & Company had net
capital of approximately $6.2 million, which was approximately $5.7 million in
excess of the regulatory minimum. Conning & Company has in place a revolving
subordinated loan facility with a commercial bank for $2.0 million that, when
utilized, qualifies as capital for purposes of the Exchange Act's net capital
rules. The agreement expires on December 31, 1997 and management believes that
such line will be renewed at the end of its current term. Any amounts drawn
under such facility would bear interest based on a fixed rate at the then
prevailing rate plus a specified amount per annum.

    As of September 30, 1997, the Company had no outstanding long-term debt.
The Company had total outstanding long-term debt at December 31, 1996 in the
principal amount of $2.0 million. Such debt arose from the Strategic Merger and
was payable to General American in the initial principal amount of $13.0
million bearing interest at an annual rate of 7.0%. See "Certain Relationships
and Related Transactions." The remaining debt was paid in full in February
1997.

    The Company or a subsidiary acts as the general partner of certain private
equity funds and maintains a 1% general partner capital interest in such funds.
The Company may also invest as a limited partner in future funds it may
organize. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions." Interests in
such private equity funds are generally illiquid.

    The $30.0 million in estimated net proceeds of this offering will be used
for general corporate purposes. The Company's business strategy contemplates
that it will seek to complement internal growth with strategic investments and
acquisitions. Accordingly, a portion of the net proceeds may also be used for
acquiring related businesses or investing in strategic or joint venture
relationships. The Company has no present understandings, agreements or
commitments with respect to any such acquisition, and no assurance can be given
that any such acquisition will take place. Pending application to the uses
described above, the Company intends to invest the net proceeds of this
offering in short-term, investment-grade, interest-bearing securities.

NEW ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENT

    In February 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued SFAS No.
128, "Earnings Per Share." SFAS No. 128 specifies new standards designed to
improve the earnings per share ("EPS") information provided in financial
statements by simplifying the existing computational guidelines, reviewing the
disclosure requirements and increasing the comparability of EPS data on an
international basis. Some of the changes made to simplify the EPS computations
include: (a) eliminating the presentation of primary EPS and replacing it with
basic EPS, with the principal difference being that common stock equivalents
are not considered in computing basic EPS, (b) eliminating the modified
treasury stock method and the three percent materiality provision and (c)
revising the contingent share provisions and the supplemental EPS data
requirements. SFAS No. 128 also makes a number of changes to existing
disclosure requirements. SFAS No. 128 is effective for financial statements
issued for periods ending after December 15, 1997, including interim periods.
The Company has not yet determined impact of the implementation of SFAS No.
128.

IMPACT OF INFLATION

    The Company does not believe that inflation has had a significant impact on
the Company's consolidated operations.

                                      39

<PAGE> 41
                                  REGULATION

    The Company's business and the investment management industry in general
are subject to extensive regulation in the United States at both the federal
and state level, as well as by SROs. A number of federal regulatory agencies
are charged with safeguarding the integrity of the securities and other
financial markets and with protecting the interests of customers participating
in those markets. The SEC is the federal agency that is primarily responsible
for the regulation of investment advisers and broker-dealers doing business in
the United States, and the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
promulgates regulations applicable to securities credit transactions involving
broker-dealers and certain other United States institutions. Investment
advisers and broker-dealers are subject to registration and regulation by state
securities regulators in those states in which they conduct business. Industry
SROs, each of which has authority over the firms that are its members, include
the NASD and national securities exchanges.

    Conning & Company and Conning Asset Management Company are registered as
investment advisers with the SEC. As investment advisers, each is subject to
the requirements of the Advisers Act and the SEC's regulations thereunder.
They, and their employees engaged in advisory services, are also subject to
certain state securities laws and regulations, and to state laws regarding
fiduciaries. Federal and state regulations provide, among other things,
limitations on the ability of investment advisers to charge performance-based
or non-refundable fees to clients, record-keeping and reporting requirements,
disclosure requirements, limitations on principal transactions between an
adviser or its affiliates and advisory clients, requirements as to fees paid to
solicitors, restrictions on commission and fee arrangements with
broker-dealers, and advertising restrictions, as well as general anti-fraud
prohibitions. The state securities law requirements applicable to employees of
investment advisers include certain qualification requirements as to advisory
employees. In addition, Conning Asset Management Company, as investment adviser
to two mutual funds registered under the Investment Company Act, is subject to
requirements under the Investment Company Act and the SEC's regulations
thereunder. The Company's mortgage origination and servicing activities are
subject to the licensing requirements of certain states. Such requirements
include, among other things, record-keeping and reporting requirements,
procedures for handling funds, and requirements that certain employees obtain
and maintain appropriate licenses.

    In connection with the Company's private equity activities, Conning &
Company, its affiliates and the private equity funds which they manage are
relying on exemptions from registration under the Investment Company Act, the
Securities Act and state securities laws. Failure to meet the requirements of
any such exemptions could have a material adverse effect on the Company, its
affiliates and the private equity funds they manage, including, without
limitation, with respect to the manner in which they carry out their investment
activities and on the compensation received by Conning & Company and its
affiliates from the private equity funds.

    Conning & Company is registered as a broker-dealer with the SEC and in
Connecticut, New York and Texas, and is a member of, and subject to regulation
by, the NASD.

    As a result of federal and state broker-dealer registration and SRO
memberships, Conning & Company is subject to overlapping schemes of regulation
which cover many aspects of its securities business. Such regulations cover
matters including capital requirements, the use and safekeeping of customers'
funds and securities, record keeping and reporting requirements, supervisory
and organizational procedures intended to assure compliance with securities
laws and to prevent the improper trading on material nonpublic information,
employee-related matters, including qualification and licensing of supervisory
and sales personnel, limitations on extensions of credit in securities
transactions, clearance and settlement procedures, requirements for the
registration, underwriting, sale and distribution of securities and rules of
the SROs designed to promote high standards of commercial honor and just and
equitable principles of trade. A particular focus of the applicable regulations
concerns the relationship between broker-dealers and their customers. As a
result, many aspects of the broker-dealer customer relationship are subject to
regulation, including in some instances "suitability" determinations as to
certain customer transactions, limitations in the amounts that may be charged
to customers, timing of proprietary trading in relation to customers' trades
and disclosures to customers.

    Conning Asset Management Company is a fiduciary under ERISA and the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), and regulations
thereunder with respect to the investments of its discretionary asset
management clients which are employee benefit plans subject to ERISA and with
respect to the investments of portfolios managed by the Company that contain
assets of plans subject to ERISA. ERISA and the Code impose

                                      40

<PAGE> 42
certain duties on persons who are fiduciaries of a plan and prohibit certain
transactions involving the assets of a plan and its fiduciaries or other
interested parties. Under ERISA and the Code, any person who exercises any
authority or control over the management or disposition of the assets of a plan
is generally considered to be a fiduciary of the plan. Under ERISA or the Code,
in situations where the Company and its affiliates are providing investment
management or other services to a plan, (i) the Company's actions would be
governed by prudence and other fiduciary responsibility standards and (ii)
certain transactions in which the Company might seek to engage could constitute
"prohibited transactions." If a prohibited transaction occurs for which no
exemption is available, the Company and any other party in interest that has
engaged in the prohibited transaction could be required, among other things,
(i) to restore to the plan any profit realized on the transaction, (ii) to
reimburse the plan for any losses suffered as a result of the transaction,
(iii) to pay an excise tax equal to 15% of the amount involved in the
prohibited transaction for each year the transaction continues and (iv) unless
the transaction is corrected within statutorily required periods, to pay an
additional tax equal to 100% of the amount involved in the transaction. Plan
fiduciaries who participate in transactions with the Company could, under
certain circumstances, be liable for prohibited transactions or other
violations as a result of an investment or as co-fiduciaries for actions taken
by or on behalf of the plan by the Company.

    Compliance with many of the regulations applicable to the Company involves
a number of risks, particularly because applicable regulations in a number of
areas, such as those governing affiliated transactions involving clients, may
be subject to varying interpretation. Regulators make periodic examinations and
review annual, monthly and other reports on the Company's operations and
financial condition. In the event of a violation of or non-compliance with any
applicable law or regulation, governmental regulators and SROs may institute
administrative or judicial proceedings that may result in censure, fine, civil
penalties (including treble damages in the case of insider trading violations),
criminal penalties, the issuance of cease-and-desist orders, the deregistration
or suspension of the non-compliant broker-dealer or investment adviser, the
suspension or disqualification of the broker-dealer's or investment adviser's
officers or employees, the removal of the Company from its role as a fiduciary
with respect to the investments of assets subject to ERISA and other adverse
consequences. The Company has not experienced any such penalties to date. Such
violations or non-compliance could also subject the Company, and/or its
employees to civil actions by private persons. As an underwriter from time to
time, Conning & Company is exposed to liability under federal and state
securities laws and court decisions, including decisions with respect to
underwriters' liability and limitations on indemnification of underwriters by
issuers. For example, a firm that acts as an underwriter may be held liable for
material misstatements or omissions of fact in a prospectus used in connection
with the securities being offered or for statements made by its securities
analysts or other personnel. Any governmental, SRO or private proceeding
alleging violation of or non-compliance with laws or regulations could have a
material adverse effect upon the Company's business, financial condition,
results of operations and business prospects.

    The regulatory environment in which the Company operates is subject to
change. The Company may be adversely affected as a result of new or revised
legislation or regulations imposed by the SEC, other United States, state or
foreign governmental regulatory authorities or SROs. The Company also may be
adversely affected by changes in the interpretation or enforcement of existing
laws and rules by these governmental authorities and SROs. The Company's
businesses may be materially affected not only by securities regulations but
also by regulations of general application. For example, the volume of the
Company's principal investment advisory businesses in a given time period could
be affected by, among other things, existing and proposed tax legislation and
other governmental regulations and policies (including the interest rate
policies of the Federal Reserve Board) and changes in the interpretation or
enforcement of existing laws and rules that affect the business and financial
communities. The level of business and financing activity in the insurance
industry can be affected not only by such legislation or regulations of general
applicability, but also by industry-specific legislation or regulations.

   
    Under the Advisers Act, every investment advisory agreement with its
clients must expressly provide that it may not be assigned by the investment
adviser without the consent of the client. Under the Investment Company Act,
every investment adviser's agreement with a registered investment company must
provide for the agreement's automatic termination on the event of its
assignment. Under both Acts, an investment advisory agreement is deemed to have
been assigned when there is a direct or indirect transfer of the agreement,
including a direct assignment or a transfer of a "controlling block" of the
firm's voting securities or, under certain circumstances, upon the transfer of
a "controlling block" of the voting securities of its parent corporation. A
transaction is not, however, an assignment

                                      41

<PAGE> 43
under the Advisers Act or the Investment Company Act if it does not result in a
change of actual control or management of the investment adviser. Any
assignment of the Company's investment advisory agreements would require, as to
any registered investment company client, the prior approval by a majority of
its shareholders, and as to the Company's other clients, the prior consent of
such clients to such assignments. Following completion of the offering, sales
by General American or other shareholders or issuances of Common Stock by the
Company, among other things, could result in a deemed assignment of the
Company's investment advisory agreements under such statutes. The Company's
Articles provide that no person or group deemed to be a beneficial owner (as
defined therein) of the Common Stock may vote more than 20% of the total number
of shares of Common Stock outstanding. These provisions of the Articles do not
apply to General American Mutual Holding Company, General American, General
American Holding Company or their subsidiaries or affiliates, direct or indirect
subsidiaries of the Company and certain employee plans established or to be
established by the Company. The Company's Board of Directors may approve the
exemption of other persons or groups from the provisions described above. While
this voting limitation is in place to reduce the likelihood, under certain
circumstances, of inadvertent terminations of the Company's advisory agreements
as a result of "assignments" of the Company's investment advisory contracts,
there can be no guarantees that this limitation will prevent such a termination
from occurring. In addition, such limitation could be deemed to have an
anti-takeover effect and to make changes in management more difficult. See "Risk
Factors--Regulation," "Risk Factors--Termination Provisions of Investment
Advisory Agreements," "Risk Factors--Consequences of a Change of Control on
Investment Advisory Agreements; Limitations on Voting Rights," "Description of
Capital Stock--Common Stock" and "Certain Charter and Bylaw Provisions--
Limitations on Voting of Shares in Certain Circumstances."
    

    The officers, directors and employees of the Company's investment
management subsidiaries may from time to time own securities which are also
owned by one or more of their clients. Each subsidiary has internal policies
with respect to individual investments and requires reporting of securities
transactions and restricts certain transactions so as to reduce the possibility
of conflicts of interest.

NET CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS

    As a broker-dealer registered with the SEC and various states and a member
firm of the NASD, Conning & Company is subject to the capital requirements of
the SEC, the states, and the NASD. These capital requirements specify minimum
levels of capital, computed in accordance with regulatory requirements ("net
capital"), that such firm is required to maintain and also limit the amount of
leverage that such firm is able to obtain in its respective business. A failure
of a broker-dealer to maintain its minimum required capital would require it to
cease executing customer transactions until it returned to capital compliance,
and could cause it to lose its membership on an exchange, or in an SRO, to lose
its registration with the SEC or a state, or require its liquidation. Further,
the decline in a broker-dealer's net capital below certain "early warning
levels," even though above minimum capital requirements, could cause material
adverse consequences to the broker-dealer. For example, the SEC's capital
regulations prohibit payment of dividends, redemption of stock and the
prepayment of subordinated indebtedness if a broker-dealer's net capital
thereafter would be less than 5% of aggregate debit items. These regulations
also prohibit principal payments in respect of subordinated indebtedness if a
broker-dealer's net capital thereafter would be less than 5% of aggregate debit
items.

    Compliance with regulatory capital requirements could limit the operations
of Conning & Company or Conning Asset Management Company that require the
intensive use of capital, such as underwriting and trading activities, and
financing of customer account balances, and also could restrict the Company's
ability to withdraw capital from Conning & Company and Conning Asset Management
Company, which in turn could limit its ability to pay dividends, repay debt and
redeem or purchase shares of its outstanding capital stock.

    At September 30, 1997, Conning & Company was required to maintain minimum
net capital, in accordance with SEC rules, of approximately $525,000 and had
total net capital of approximately $6.2 million, or approximately $5.7 million
in excess of the amount required.

                                      42

<PAGE> 44
                                  MANAGEMENT

DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CERTAIN OTHER SIGNIFICANT OFFICERS

    Directors and Executive Officers

    The directors and executive officers of the Company are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        NAME                                 AGE                          POSITION
<S>                                       <C>         <C>
Leonard M. Rubenstein...................      51      Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
Maurice W. Slayton......................      59      President and Director
John A. Fibiger.........................      65      Director
Richard A. Liddy........................      62      Director
John C. Shaw............................      63      Director
Mark E. Hansen..........................      48      Executive Vice President
Fred M. Schpero.........................      44      Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
</TABLE>

    Following is certain additional information concerning each director and
executive officer of the Company. Each such individual has served in his
present capacity of his principal occupation for the last five years, unless
otherwise indicated.

    LEONARD M. RUBENSTEIN, C.F.A., is in the Office of the Chairman and has
been Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the Company since 1995 and also
serves as Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and Chief Investment Officer of
Conning Asset Management Company. Mr. Rubenstein has 25 years of investment
experience. Prior to his position with Conning, Mr. Rubenstein spent 23 years
in the investment operations of General American, where he held various
positions, including Executive Vice President of Investments. Mr. Rubenstein is
a director of a number of General American subsidiaries, none of which is
registered with the Commission except Reinsurance Group of America,
Incorporated. From 1984 to 1991, he served as Vice President of General
American. He is a past president of the St. Louis Society of Financial
Analysts. Mr. Rubenstein and the Company entered into an Employment Agreement
in August 1995. See "--Employment Agreements and Other Compensation
Arrangements."

    MAURICE W. SLAYTON is in the Office of the Chairman and has been the
President of the Company since 1995 and also serves as President and Chief
Executive Officer of Conning & Company. Mr. Slayton joined Conning in 1973.
Prior thereto, he had 12 years of experience with Hartford Steam Boiler
Inspection and Insurance Company and National Life of Vermont in a number of
insurance and investment positions. He is currently a director of several
insurance related entities, none of which is registered with the Commission
except PennCorp Financial Group, Inc. Mr. Slayton is a member and past
president of The Hartford Society of Financial Analysts. Mr. Slayton and the
Company entered into an Employment Agreement in August 1995. See "--Employment
Agreements and Other Compensation Arrangements."

    JOHN A. FIBIGER has been a director of the Company since June 1997. Until
April 1997, he was Chairman of the Board of Transamerica Occidental Life
Insurance Company as well as a director of four of its wholly owned life
insurance subsidiaries. He remains a director of two of such
subsidiaries--Transamerica Life Company of Canada and Transamerica Life Company
of New York. Mr. Fibiger joined Transamerica Life Companies as chief financial
officer in 1991. He was named president of Transamerica Occidental Life
Insurance Company, one of the seven Transamerica Life Companies, in December
1994. A 38-year veteran of the life insurance industry, Mr. Fibiger was vice
chairman, president and chief operating officer of New England Mutual Life
Insurance Company in Boston. Prior to that, he held positions with Bankers Life
Nebraska (now Ameritas) and Lincoln National Life. A past board member of the
Society of Actuaries, Mr. Fibiger was the first chairman of the Interim
Actuarial Standards Board and served as president of the American Academy of
Actuaries. He is a past member of the Council of the International Actuarial
Association.

    RICHARD A. LIDDY has been a director of the Company since November 1996. He
is President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of General
American Life Insurance Company, and President and Chairman of GenAmerica
Corporation and General American Mutual Holding Company. From 1982 through 1988
he was Senior

                                      43

<PAGE> 45
Vice President and Executive Vice President of Continental Corporation, and
President, Financial Services Group of Continental Insurance Company. He is
also Chairman of the Board of General American Capital Company and The Walnut
Street Funds, Inc., each a registered investment company, Chairman of Paragon
Life Insurance Company, Chairman of Reinsurance Group of America, Incorporated,
Chairman of Security Equity Life Insurance Company, Chairman of Security Mutual
Life Insurance Company of New York and a director of Brown Group, Inc., Ralston
Purina Company and Union Electric Company.

    JOHN C. SHAW has been a director of the Company since June 1997. He is the
founding partner of the Shaw Group LLC, a management consulting firm
specializing in transformation management. From 1994 to 1997, he served in the
Office of Chairman of Well Point Health Network, Inc., a large, publicly-traded
managed healthcare company. From 1966 to 1994, he was a partner of Deloitte &
Touche, most recently serving as Vice Chairman. Previously he has served as
national director for Strategic Planning, Partner-In-Charge of the New York
office and a member of the Board of Directors and Board of Governors for Touche
Ross. Mr. Shaw has taught at Stanford Business School and the Wharton School,
lectured at several national seminars and authored several books and articles
on modern business techniques.

    MARK E. HANSEN, C.F.A., has been the Executive Vice President of the
Company since 1995, Executive Vice President of Conning & Company since 1993
and Executive Vice President of Conning Asset Management Company since August
1996. Mr. Hansen also served as a director of the Company from August 1995
until March 1997. Mr. Hansen has over 25 years of investment experience, having
joined Conning in 1984 from the Bank of Boston-Connecticut. Mr. Hansen and the
Company entered into an Employment Agreement in August 1995. See "--Employment
Agreements and Other Compensation Arrangements."

    FRED M. SCHPERO, C.P.A., has been a Senior Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer of the Company since January 1997. Prior to that time, Mr.
Schpero was Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Conning & Company
from 1985 through 1996 and at Conning Asset Management Company from August 1996
through December 1996. Prior to joining Conning, he was 2nd Vice
President--Finance with Security Connecticut Life Insurance Company and a
senior accountant at the public accounting firm of Coopers & Lybrand LLP. Mr.
Schpero and the Company entered into an Employment Agreement in August 1995.
See "--Employment Agreements and Other Compensation Arrangements."

    Classified Board of Directors

    All of the current directors were elected pursuant to action of the
Company's shareholders in June 1997 and have been divided into three classes
with terms expiring, respectively, at the annual meetings of shareholders in
1998 (Mr. Fibiger), 1999 (Messrs. Liddy and Shaw) and 2000 (Messrs. Rubenstein
and Slayton). Commencing with the next annual meeting of shareholders in 1998,
directors then standing for election will be elected for three-year terms, with
one class of directors being elected at each annual meeting of shareholders
thereafter. See "Certain Charter and Bylaw Provisions." Officers are elected
annually and serve at the discretion of the Board of Directors, subject to the
terms of applicable employment agreements. See "--Employment Agreements and
Other Compensation Arrangements."

    Committees

    The Board of Directors has an Audit Committee comprised of Messrs. Fibiger,
Liddy and Shaw, a Compensation Committee comprised of Messrs. Rubenstein and
Slayton and an Executive Compensation Committee comprised of Messrs. Fibiger
and Shaw.

                                      44

<PAGE> 46
    Certain Other Significant Officers

    Certain other significant officers of the Company or its subsidiaries who
are not directors or executive officers (the "Other Significant Officers")
are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
         NAME                      AGE            POSITION                           DIVISION
<S>                             <C>         <C>                             <C>
Thomas A. Byrne...............      40      Senior Vice President           Research
Stephan L. Christiansen.......      48      Senior Vice President           Private Equity
John B. Clinton...............      42      Senior Vice President           Private Equity
Paul S. Goulekas..............      42      Senior Vice President           Research
Charles P. Kapp...............      38      Senior Vice President           Mortgage Loans and Real Estate
Glen D. Keller................      45      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
Douglas R. Koester............      43      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
Donald L. McDonald............      35      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
Michael D. McLellan...........      41      Senior Vice President           Mortgage Loans and Real Estate
Steven F. Piaker..............      35      Senior Vice President           Private Equity
Stephen R. Pivacek............      54      Senior Vice President           Research
Gordon G. Pratt...............      35      Senior Vice President           Private Equity
Gary K. Ransom................      45      Senior Vice President           Research
David N. Reid.................      36      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
Thomas D. Sargent.............      39      Senior Vice President           Research
William C. Shenton............      43      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
Christopher J. Swift..........      37      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
J. Terri Tanaka...............      35      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
John W. Zimmerman.............      35      Senior Vice President           Asset Management
</TABLE>

    Following is certain information concerning the Other Significant Officers.
Each such individual has served in his or her present capacity or his or her
principal occupation for the last five years, unless otherwise indicated.

    THOMAS A. BYRNE has been a Senior Vice President of the Company since 1993
and has been with the Company since 1984. Before joining the Company, Mr. Byrne
had prior experience at Travelers Insurance Companies.

    STEPHAN L. CHRISTIANSEN, F.C.A.S., M.A.A.A., has been a Senior Vice
President of the Company since 1989. Prior to joining the Company in 1986, Mr.
Christiansen had 16 years of insurance industry experience with Colonial Penn
Insurance and Insurance Company of North America.

    JOHN B. CLINTON, C.P.C.U., C.P.A., has been a Senior Vice President of the
Company since 1992. Mr. Clinton's previous experience has been with KCP Holding
Company and its subsidiary, National American Insurance Company of California,
where he was CFO and Director. Prior to this, he was a Vice President of Dillon
Read & Co., Inc. and a founding partner of Concord Partners, a private equity
fund. He previously worked for New Court Securities and KPMG Peat Marwick LLP.

    PAUL S. GOULEKAS has been a Senior Vice President of the Company since
1994. Mr. Goulekas joined the firm after 12 years experience at Aetna Life &
Casualty, most recently as operations controller/treasurer of Aetna Health
Plans, and prior to that worked as an economist at The Hartford Insurance
Group.

    CHARLES P. KAPP joined the Company as Senior Vice President in July 1997.
For seven years prior to joining the Company, Mr. Kapp held various positions
with Mark Twain Bancshares in Chicago, Illinois, most recently as Senior Vice
President in the area of institutional bond sales.

    GLEN D. KELLER, F. S. A., has been a Senior Vice President at the Company
since 1996. Mr. Keller has over 20 years of experience in the life insurance
industry. Prior to joining the Company, he managed the Canadian Pension and
Annuity business for Metropolitan Life. Prior to that, he was the investment
actuary for National Life of Vermont.

                                      45

<PAGE> 47
    DOUGLAS R. KOESTER, C.F.A., is Senior Vice President and has been with the
Company since 1986. Prior to his current position, Mr. Koester spent 14 years
with GAIMCO and in the investment operations division of General American. He
served as a director of the Company from August 1995 until April 1997 and has
been an executive officer of Conning Asset Management Company and its
predecessor GAIMCO from 1988 to present.

    DONALD L. MCDONALD has been a Senior Vice President at the Company since
1993. Mr. McDonald joined the Company in 1992 from Daiwa Securities of America
and his prior investment experience includes Roosevelt & Cross and Salomon
Brothers.

    MICHAEL D. MCLELLAN is a Senior Vice President and has been with the
Company since 1995. Mr. McLellan served as a director of the Company from
August 1995 until April 1997. Prior to his position with the Company, Mr.
McLellan spent 13 years with GAIMCO and General American where he held various
positions including Vice President of Mortgage Loans and Real Estate. Mr.
McLellan is an M.A.I. candidate (Member Appraisal Institute).

    STEVEN F. PIAKER, C.F.A., has been a Senior Vice President for the Company
since January 1997. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Piaker was a Senior Vice
President of Conseco, Inc., where he worked on the company's acquisitions and
private equity-linked investments. His previous experience was with G.E.
Capital as Vice President of the Corporate Finance Group.

    STEPHEN R. PIVACEK has been a Senior Vice President of the Company since
1993. Mr. Pivacek joined the Company in 1986 from Aetna Life & Casualty where
he was employed as a Director in the trading department.

    GORDON G. PRATT has been a Senior Vice President of the Company since 1994.
Prior to joining the Company in 1992 he was Vice President and Product Manager
in the Insurance M&A and Insurance Leveraged Acquisitions areas of The Chase
Manhattan Bank, N.A. Prior to that, he was with the Consulting Division of The
First National Bank of Chicago.

    GARY K. RANSOM, F.C.A.S., M.A.A.A., has been a Senior Vice President since
1989. Prior to joining the Company in 1979, Mr. Ransom worked at Travelers
Insurance Companies in various actuarial positions.

    DAVID N. REID has been a Senior Vice President of the Company since 1996.
Mr. Reid has over 13 years of investment accounting, operations, reporting and
systems experience. Prior to joining the Company in 1991, Mr. Reid spent four
years with SS&C Technologies, Inc. (formerly known as Securities Software &
Consulting, Inc.) where he directed the development and marketing of LAN based
investment management and accounting system, and five years with The Hartford
Insurance Group.

    THOMAS D. SARGENT, C.F.A., has been a Senior Vice President of the Company
since 1993. Prior to joining the Company in 1986, Mr. Sargent was in the
commercial lending area at Connecticut Bank & Trust Company. He also completed
an internship with Willis Faber, a London-based insurance broker.

    WILLIAM C. SHENTON has been a Senior Vice President of the Company since
1993. Prior to joining the Company in 1990, he held numerous management
positions with Control Data, including domestic and international assignments
concentrating on the financial services industry, most recently involving the
international insurance investment community.

    CHRISTOPHER J. SWIFT, C.P.A., has been a Senior Vice President of the
Company since October 1997. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Swift was a
financial services partner of the St. Louis office of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP
specializing in the insurance and mutual fund industries and also served as the
market leader of the insurance practice for the St. Louis office.

    J. TERRI TANAKA, C.F.A., has been a Senior Vice President of the Company
since 1995. Ms. Tanaka also served as a director of the Company from August
1995 until April 1997. Prior to her current position, Ms. Tanaka spent eight
years with GAIMCO and in the investment operations division of General
American. She has been an executive officer of Conning Asset Management Company
and its predecessor GAIMCO from 1995 to present.

    JOHN W. ZIMMERMAN, C.F.A., joined the Company as a Senior Vice President in
April 1997. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Zimmerman worked for NationsBank
Private Investments (formerly Boatmen's Trust Company), where he held various
positions since 1987, most recently as Vice President, Manager of Fundamental
Research.

                                      46

<PAGE> 48
DIRECTORS' COMPENSATION

    The Board pays each director who is not employed by the Company or General
American a $10,000 annual retainer and a $1,000 fee for each Board meeting
attended, plus expenses, and may also award stock options to directors. Upon
the closing of this offering, the Company intends to grant options to purchase
5,000 shares to each of Messrs. Fibiger and Shaw. Officers of the Company do
not receive any additional compensation for serving the Company as members of
the Board of Directors or any of its Committees. Messrs. McLellan and Koester
and Ms. Tanaka, who served as directors until June 1997, and Mr. Liddy have
also received stock options and purchased shares of Series B Convertible
Preferred Stock of the Company as described in "Certain Relationships and
Related Transactions."

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

    Compensation Summary. The following table sets forth the compensation paid
to the Chief Executive Officer and the three other executive officers of the
Company.

<TABLE>
                          SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE
                            ANNUAL COMPENSATION<F1>

<CAPTION>
                                                                                        LONG-TERM
                                                                                    COMPENSATION<F4>
                                                                                   ------------------
                                                                                       SECURITIES
            NAME AND                       FISCAL                                  UNDERLYING OPTIONS       ALL OTHER
       PRINCIPAL POSITION                   YEAR       SALARY<F2>    BONUS<F3>         (#SHS)<F5>       COMPENSATION<F6>
<S>                                        <C>        <C>          <C>             <C>                  <C>
Leonard M. Rubenstein...................    1996        $270,000   $325,000<F7>          20,000             $32,913
  Chairman and Chief
    Executive Officer
Maurice W. Slayton......................    1996        $260,000   $325,000                  --             $12,300
  President and Director
Mark E. Hansen..........................    1996        $235,000   $275,000                  --             $12,300
  Executive Vice President
Fred M. Schpero.........................    1996        $120,000   $120,000              10,000             $11,604
  Senior Vice President and
    Chief Financial Officer

<FN>
- --------
<F1> Perquisites and other personal benefits are not included, as they do not
     exceed the lesser of $50,000 and 10% of total of salary and bonus for any
     named executive officer.

<F2> Includes amounts deferred at the election of the officer under the General
     American Life Insurance Company Executive Deferred Savings Plan (a defined
     contribution plan), with respect to Mr. Rubenstein, and the Conning &
     Company Profit Sharing and 401(k) Savings Plan, with respect to Messrs.
     Slayton, Hansen and Schpero.

<F3> Bonuses are for services performed during 1996.

<F4> Does not include award of or distributions with respect to participation
     interests in private investment funds sponsored by the Company. See
     "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--Participation in Private
     Equity Funds."

<F5> See "Option Grants in Last Fiscal Year."

<F6> For Mr. Rubenstein, amount represents contributions by the Company to the
     General American Executive Deferred Savings Plan and Augmented Progress
     Sharing Plan (defined contribution plans). For Messrs. Slayton, Hansen and
     Schpero, amounts represent contributions by the Company to the Conning &
     Company Profit Sharing and 401(k) Savings Plan.

<F7> Mr. Rubenstein continues to accrue certain pension and post-retirement
     health benefits under General American benefit plans. See
     "Management--Employee Agreements and Other Compensation Arrangements."
     Although the cost of such benefits for 1996 was deducted from Mr.
     Rubenstein's bonus, such cost has not been deducted from the bonus shown
     above. The actual bonus paid to Mr. Rubenstein for 1996 was $292,100.
</TABLE>

                                      47

<PAGE> 49
     Stock Option Awards. The following tables show information regarding
awards of stock options in 1996 and the number and value of unexercised options
held by the named executive officers at the end of fiscal 1996. The value of
unexercised options is based on a value of $13.50 per share for the Company's
Common Stock, which is the assumed initial public offering price. No stock
options were exercised by the named executive officers in fiscal 1996.

<TABLE>
                       OPTION GRANTS IN LAST FISCAL YEAR

<CAPTION>
                                                                                             POTENTIAL REALIZABLE
                                  NUMBER OF     % OF TOTAL                                      VALUE AT ASSUMED
                                   SHARES         OPTIONS                                    ANNUAL RATES OF STOCK
                                 UNDERLYING     GRANTED TO                                   PRICE APPRECIATION FOR
                                   OPTIONS       EMPLOYEES     EXERCISE OR                      OPTION TERM<F3>
                                   GRANTED          IN         BASE PRICE    EXPIRATION   ----------------------------
         NAME                      (#)<F1>      FISCAL YEAR      ($/SH)       DATE<F2>       5% ($)         10% ($)
<S>                              <C>           <C>            <C>            <C>         <C>             <C>
Leonard M. Rubenstein.........      20,000          8.70%         $7.00      11/21/06       $88,000         $223,200
Maurice W. Slayton............          --            --             --            --            --               --
Mark E. Hansen................          --            --             --            --            --               --
Fred M. Schpero...............      10,000          4.35%         $7.00      11/21/06       $44,000         $111,600

<FN>
- --------
<F1> Options granted in 1996 are exercisable with respect to 20% of the option
     shares on the first anniversary of the grant date and with respect to an
     additional 20% on each of the four succeeding anniversary dates. Options
     are intended to qualify as incentive stock options under the Internal
     Revenue Code. Each option is forfeitable if not exercised within a
     specified time after the holder's death, disability or termination for any
     reason. See "Management--Employee Stock Plans."

<F2> The options have terms of 10 years, subject to earlier termination in
     certain events related to termination of employment.

<F3> Amounts represent the potential realizable value of each grant of options
     at the time of grant, assuming that the price of the underlying shares
     appreciates in value from the date of grant to the end of the term, at
     annualized rates of 5% and 10%, respectively.
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
             AGGREGATED OPTIONS AND FISCAL YEAR-END OPTION VALUES

<CAPTION>
                                   NUMBER OF SECURITIES         VALUE OF UNEXERCISED
                                  UNDERLYING UNEXERCISED        IN-THE-MONEY OPTIONS
                                OPTIONS AT FISCAL YEAR-END     AT FISCAL YEAR-END<F1>
                                --------------------------   --------------------------
             NAME               EXERCISABLE  UNEXERCISABLE   EXERCISABLE  UNEXERCISABLE
<S>                             <C>          <C>             <C>          <C>
Leonard M. Rubenstein.........      24,000   116,000<F2>       $196,080      $914,320
Maurice M. Slayton............      24,000    96,000<F3>       $196,080      $784,320
Mark E. Hansen................      24,000    96,000<F3>       $196,080      $784,320
Fred M. Schpero...............       2,000    18,000<F4>       $ 16,340      $130,360

<FN>
- --------
<F1> Represents the estimated fair value of the shares of Common Stock subject
     to outstanding options, based on the assumed initial offering price of
     $13.50 per share, less the aggregate exercise price of the options.

<F2> Includes options to purchase 28,000 shares that became exercisable after
     December 31, 1996 and options to purchase 72,000 shares that will become
     exercisable upon closing of the offering.

<F3> All such options will become exercisable upon closing of the offering.

<F4> Includes options to purchase 4,000 shares that became exercisable after
     December 31, 1996 and options to purchase 6,000 shares that will become
     exercisable upon closing of the offering.
</TABLE>

     All options have been issued as incentive stock options under the Internal
Revenue Code; the Company intends to compensate the individual for the
additional federal income taxes that accrue to such optionholder in excess of
then applicable federal income tax on capital gain transactions as a result of
the recharacterization as other than incentive stock options. In such an event,
the Company would be entitled to a tax deduction for any compensation
recognized by the option holder. Upon the closing of this offering, a total of
471,587 incentive stock options will have been so recharacterized. The Company
intends to compensate for such recharacterization by granting new non-qualified
options to all holders of such recharacterized options upon the closing of this
offering. The Company also intends to grant options to purchase an additional
965,000 shares of Common Stock upon closing of this offering. See "--Employee
Stock Plans."

                                      48

<PAGE> 50
EMPLOYEE STOCK PLANS

   
    The Board of Directors and shareholders of the Company approved the 1997
Flexible Stock Plan in December 1997 (the "1997 Plan"). The 1997 Plan
provides for the award of benefits (collectively, "Benefits") of various
types, including stock options, stock appreciation rights ("SARs"),
restricted stock, performance shares, cash awards and other stock-based awards.
Set forth below is a description of the principal features of the 1997 Plan.
This description is subject to and qualified in its entirety by the full text
of the 1997 Plan, which is filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of
which this Prospectus is a part.
    

    The Company has adopted the 1997 Plan to attract, retain, motivate, and
reward officers, employees and other individuals, to encourage ownership of
Common Stock by officers, employees and directors, and to promote and further
the best interests of the Company. The number of shares of Common Stock which
may be issued in connection with Benefits is 2,200,000 shares.

   
    The 1997 Plan will be administered with respect to executive officers by
the Executive Compensation Committee of the Board, with respect to non-employee
directors by the full Board, and with respect to all other participants by
the Compensation Committee of the Board. The Board may amend the 1997 Plan at
any time, provided that the Board may not amend the 1997 Plan without
shareholder approval if such amendment would (i) cause options that are intended
to qualify as incentive stock options to fail to qualify as such, (ii) cause the
Plan to fail to meet the requirements of Rule 16b-3 under the Exchange Act, or
(iii) violate applicable law. The 1997 Plan has no fixed termination date and
will continue in effect until terminated by the Board.

    Under the 1997 Plan, the appropriate Committee may grant Benefits at such
times, in such amounts, and to such recipients as such Committee may
determine. Benefits may be awarded only to officers, employees and directors of
the Company and its subsidiaries, employees and owners of non-affiliated
entities and entities with which the Company or its subsidiaries have business
relationships, and persons providing services to the Company or a subsidiary.
    

    Incentive stock options and non-qualified stock options may be granted
under the 1997 Plan. In the case of non-qualified stock options, the option
price shall be no less than the fair market value of the shares of Common Stock
on the date the option is granted, and, in the case of incentive stock options,
the price will be determined by the Committee but shall be not less than the
fair market value of the shares of Common Stock on the date the option is
granted. The other terms of options will be determined by the Compensation
Committee, the Executive Compensation Committee or the Board, as applicable.

   
    The 1997 Plan also permits the award of SARs, restricted stock, performance
shares, cash awards and other stock-based awards, including performance-based
compensation subject to certain requirements. The maximum number of shares
subject to options and SARs which may be granted to a participant in any year is
500,000. The 1997 Plan also provides for the award of other Benefits valued in
whole or in part by reference to, or otherwise based on, the Common Stock.

    In the event of a Change in Control, as defined below, the Compensation
Committee, the Executive Compensation Committee or the Board, as applicable,
may provide such protection as it deems necessary to maintain a participant's
rights; including (without in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing
or requiring any specific protection) to: (i) provide for the acceleration of
the exercise or realization of any Benefit; (ii) provide for the purchase of a
Benefit upon the participant's request for an amount in cash equal to the
amount which could have been attained upon the exercise or realization of the
Benefit had it been currently exercisable or payable; (iii) make such
adjustment to the outstanding Benefits as it deems appropriate; and/or (iv)
cause the outstanding Benefits to be assumed, or new Benefits substituted
therefor, by the surviving corporation. "Change in Control" means: (i) the
acquisition after the adoption of the 1997 Plan, without the approval of the
Board, by any person or group (as that term is used in Section 13(d) and
14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act), other than the Company and certain related
entities, of beneficial ownership (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange
Act) of more than 20% of the combined voting power in the election of directors
of the then outstanding shares of the Company's voting securities; (ii) the
liquidation or dissolution of the Company following a sale or other disposition
of all or substantially all of its assets; (iii) a merger or consolidation
involving the Company as a result of which persons who were shareholders of the
Company immediately prior to the effective date of the merger or consolidation
shall have beneficial ownership of less than 50% of the combined voting power in
the election of directors of the surviving corporation following the effective
date of such merger or consolidation; or (iv) a change in the majority of the
members of the Board (other than as a result of death or disability) during any
period of two years or less unless the election or nomination for

                                      49

<PAGE> 51
election of such members was approved by at least two-thirds of (x) the then
remaining members of the Board who were members at the beginning of such period
plus (y) the then remaining members whose election or nomination for election
was approved by at least two-thirds of the members of the Board who were members
at the start of such period.

    Awards under the 1997 Plan may be granted in tandem. However, no Benefit may
be granted in tandem with an incentive stock option except an SAR. Upon the
exercise of any option or in the case of any other Benefit that requires a
payment to the Company, payment may be made either (i) in cash, or (ii) with the
consent of the Compensation Committee, Executive Compensation Committee or
Board, as applicable, (a) by the surrender of all or part of a Benefit, (b)
by the tender to the Company of shares of Common Stock having an aggregate fair
market value equal to the amount due the Company, (c) in other property, rights
or credits deemed acceptable by such Committee or (d) by any combination of the
foregoing. At the time any Benefit is distributed under the Plan, the Company
may withhold, in cash or in shares of Common Stock, from such distribution any
amount necessary to satisfy income withholding requirements applicable to
such distribution.
    

    The Compensation Committee, Executive Compensation Committee or Board, as
applicable, may impose restrictions upon the transferability of any Benefit.

   
    The Board has approved two other plans, the 1996 Flexible Stock Plan in
November 1996 (the "1996 Plan") and the 1995 Flexible Stock Plan in August 1995
(the "1995 Plan"), that are substantially similar to the 1997 Plan, except that
the definition of "Change of Control" under the 1995 Plan and the 1996 Plan
means: (i) the acquisition, without the approval of the Board, by any person or
entity, other than the Company or certain related entities, of more than 20% of
the outstanding shares of the Company's voting common stock through a tender
offer, exchange offer or otherwise; (ii) the liquidation or dissolution of the
Company following a sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of its
assets; (iii) a merger or consolidation involving the Company which results in
the Company not being the surviving parent corporation; or (iv) any time during
any two-year period in which individuals who constituted the Board at the start
of such period (or whose election was approved by at least two-thirds of the
then members of the Board who were members at the start of the two-year period)
do not constitute at least 50% of the Board for any reason. The Board authorized
the award of 2,100,000 shares for each Plan and options for a total of 1,237,500
shares have been granted. As a result of the approval of the 1997 Plan, the
Company has determined not to award any additional benefits pursuant to the 1995
Plan or the 1996 Plan.
    

    Upon the closing of this offering, the Company intends to grant options to
purchase a total of 965,000 shares at the initial public offering price to
certain Company employees and directors, including options to purchase 25,000
shares to Mr. Schpero and 5,000 shares each to Messrs. Fibiger and Shaw. All of
such options are subject to the same terms. Each award will become exercisable
in varying percentages of the shares it covers over five years, beginning on
the first anniversary of the closing of this offering. In addition, upon the
closing of this offering, the Company intends to grant options to certain
employees of the Company in order to compensate such persons for certain tax
liabilities resulting from the recharacterization of their existing incentive
stock options as other than incentive stock options. See "--Executive
Compensation--Stock Option Awards." All of such non-qualified options will
have an exercise price equal to the initial public offering price and will be
100% vested upon the closing of the offering. Options to purchase an estimated
total of 329,987 shares would be granted, including options to purchase
approximately 61,388, 57,712 and 57,712 shares to Messrs. Rubenstein, Slayton
and Hansen, respectively. The actual number of shares subject to the options is
subject to increase or decrease, depending on the actual initial public
offering price. All of the options to be granted upon closing of the offering
may only be exercised if the individual is an employee, officer or director of
the Company at the time of exercise, subject to certain exceptions in the case
of death, disability, retirement or a Change of Control.

EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS AND OTHER COMPENSATION ARRANGEMENTS

   
    The Company is party to employment agreements, entered into in connection
with the Strategic Merger in August, 1995 (the "Employment Agreements"), with
all of its then executive officers and certain other employees, each with a term
of three years ending August 11, 1998. Under each Employment Agreement, the
employee (the "Employee") receives an annual base salary, in the case of Messrs.
Rubenstein, Slayton, Hansen and Schpero, of $257,500, $250,000, $225,000 and
$115,000, respectively, subject to increases pursuant to periodic salary reviews
consistent with the Company's corporate policies. In addition, each Employee is
eligible, in the sole discretion of the Board of Directors, to participate as a
limited partner in Conning Investment Partners LP III or in the Company's
Venture Carried Interests Allocation Plan and the Company's Bonus Plan, as
modified to reflect the Strategic Merger.
    

                                      50

<PAGE> 52
    The Employee's employment may be terminated without cause: (i) at any time
upon the mutual written agreement of the parties; (ii) immediately upon the
Employee's death or total disability; or (iii) upon not less than 30 days'
advance written notice by either party. The Employee's employment may be
terminated by the Company upon written notice to the Employee at any time for
any of the following reasons, each of which shall constitute "termination for
cause": (i) any material breach of the agreement by the Employee which is not
cured within 20 days after written notice by the Company; (ii) the Employee's
fraud, embezzlement, dishonesty or unlawful acts in connection with the
business of the Company or its affiliates; (iii) the Employee's conviction for
any felony; or (iv) the Employee's substantial and continuing willful failure
to perform, or grossly negligent performance of, the duties of the Employee's
position.

    Upon termination of employment, the Company has no obligation to the
Employee except for compensation due the Employee under the agreement through
the termination date; provided that, in the event of a termination by the
Company other than for cause (as defined above) (excluding terminations by
agreement or on account of death or disability), the Company is required to pay
the Employee an amount equal to 150% of the annual base salary for each year
(or portion thereof, pro rated) for the balance of the term of the agreement
and provide all insurance, welfare, sick leave and other benefits described in
the agreement through the balance of the term.

    Upon execution of the applicable Employment Agreement, Messrs. Slayton,
Hansen and Schpero were paid a signing bonus in cash (the "Signing Bonus"),
subject to the forfeiture described below, equal to $195,000, $95,000 and
$35,000, respectively. Certain other employees also received signing bonuses.
See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--The Strategic Merger."
Upon termination of the agreement for cause (as defined above) or because such
employee has resigned, the employee is required to repay the specified
percentage of the Signing Bonus indicated in parentheses, depending upon the
year in which such termination occurs: Year 1 (100%), Year 2 (66.6%), and Year
3 (33.3%).

    Each Employee is prohibited from disclosing, directly or indirectly, to any
other firm or person any of the Company's or its affiliates' confidential
information, including customer lists, trade secrets, and know-how relating to
its or their businesses. Additionally, each Employee has agreed that until
August, 1998, regardless of whether the Employee remains employed by the
Company and regardless of whether the Employee's termination, if any, is with
or without cause, neither the Employee nor any entity controlling, controlled
by or under common control with the Employee will (i) engage in, or have any
direct or indirect interest in any other person, firm, corporation, or other
entity engaged in any business activities competitive with the business
activities of the Company and the subsidiaries it controls, or (ii) become an
employee, director, adviser, consultant, independent contractor, or agent of
any such person, firm, corporation, or other entity, except with the Company's
prior written consent.

    Mr. Slayton's Employment Agreement provides that for the term of the
Agreement Mr. Slayton will be employed as President of the Company and have
responsibility for (i) marketing for the Company, (ii) managing the Company's
Hartford office, (iii) participating in identifying and negotiating
acquisitions, and (iv) participating in the development and execution of any
initial public offering of the Common Stock. Pursuant to an Amended and
Restated Shareholders' Agreement among the Company and its shareholders and
optionholders and General American, as amended (the "Shareholders
Agreement"), the Company has agreed to place Mr. Slayton on the Board of
Directors until the earlier of August 11, 2000 or the consummation of an
initial public offering of the Common Stock. See "Certain Relationships and
Related Transactions--The Strategic Merger."

   
    The Company does not have a defined benefit plan. Mr. Rubenstein, as a
result of his 25 years of service with General American, is eligible to
continue to participate in the General American Life Insurance Company Pension
Plan and Trust, a qualified defined benefit plan, and the General American
Augmented Plan, a non-qualified defined benefit plan as well as General
American's post-retirement medical plan (collectively, the "GA Retirement
Plans"). Retirement benefits under the GA Retirement Plans are based on a
participant's final average compensation and credited years of service. Mr.
Rubenstein's final average compensation has been predetermined and represents
his estimated final average salary and bonus as if he were to remain an officer
of General American from December 31, 1995 (the date on which his benefits
under the qualified plan were frozen) through his retirement at age 65. Mr.
Rubenstein will receive credit for years of service under the GA Retirement
Plans while serving as Chief Executive Officer of the Company and has agreed to
pay for the cost of the additional retirement benefits, which has been
determined to be approximately 10% of Mr. Rubenstein's assumed annual General
American salary and bonus in any year. The amount of any bonus paid to Mr.
Rubenstein by the Company will be reduced by this cost. Such amount

                                      51

<PAGE> 53
was approximately $32,900 in 1996. Based on Mr. Rubenstein's predetermined final
average compensation, the annual pension benefit payable to Mr. Rubenstein upon
his retirement from the Company at age 65 would be $367,000.
    

COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION

    The members of the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors
currently are Messrs. Rubenstein and Slayton. See "Certain Relationships and
Related Transactions" for a description of certain transactions involving
Messrs. Rubenstein and Slayton. Prior to October 1997, the Compensation
Committee of the Board was responsible for making all compensation decisions.
In October 1997, the Company established an Executive Compensation Committee
comprised of Messrs. Fibiger and Shaw. The Executive Compensation Committee is
responsible for making all stock-based compensation decisions regarding the
Company's executive officers. Neither Mr. Fibiger nor Mr. Shaw is a current or
former officer or employee of the Company or any of its affiliates.

INDEMNIFICATION

    As permitted by The General and Business Corporation Law of Missouri (the
"GBCL"), the Articles provide (i) that the Company is required to indemnify
its directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by Missouri law,
(ii) the Company is permitted to indemnify employees or agents as set forth in
the GBCL, (iii) to the fullest extent permitted by the GBCL, the Company is
required to advance expenses, as incurred, to its directors and officers in
connection with a legal proceeding (subject to certain exceptions), (iv) the
rights conferred in the GBCL are not exclusive, and (v) the Company is
authorized to enter into indemnification agreements with its directors,
officers, employees and agents without further approval of the shareholders.

    Directors or officers of the Company who are directors or officers of
General American may also be entitled to indemnification under the provisions
of General American's Articles of Incorporation, which provide indemnification
to them since they serve, at General American's request, as directors or
officers of the Company. Such individuals are also covered by General
American's director's and officer's liability insurance policy.

    General American Mutual Holding Company maintains a policy of insurance
under which the directors and officers of the Company are insured, subject to
the limits of the policy, against certain losses, as defined in the policy,
arising from claims made against such directors and officers by reason of any
wrongful acts, as defined in the policy, in their respective capacities as
directors or officers of the Company.

                CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

THE STRATEGIC MERGER

    The Company was formed in August 1995 as a holding company for all of the
operations of the Company following the Strategic Merger. The parties effected
the Strategic Merger in order to combine complementary businesses, each with
specialties in the insurance industry, to build a platform from which to
leverage additional growth. The Strategic Merger was effected in August 1995
when (i) General American Holding Company contributed to the Company all of the
issued and outstanding common stock of GAIMCO (now known as Conning Asset
Management Company), a registered investment adviser which provided investment
advisory services to General American and its affiliates (including General
American Capital Company's family of mutual funds), endowment funds, corporate
non-qualified assets, and pension/profit sharing funds of other entities in
exchange for 6,710,000 shares of Company Common Stock; and (ii) each of the
shareholders of Conning, Inc., other than three non-employee directors and two
institutional shareholders (the "Non-Contributing Shareholders"), contributed
all of the common stock then owned by such shareholders to the Company and each
holder of options to acquire Conning, Inc. common stock canceled all of such
options in exchange for $4,505,000 in cash and 3,190,000 shares of the
Company's Series A Convertible Preferred Stock having a value at the date of
issuance of $17,002,700, with Messrs. Slayton, Hansen and Schpero receiving
cash payments of $898,708, $438,661, and $40,164, respectively, and 636,376,
310,616, and 28,441 shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock,
respectively; and the Other Significant Officers, as a group, and officers of
the Company who are not Executive Officers or Other Significant Officers (the
"Other Officers"), as a group, receiving cash payments of $2,736,122 and
$391,345, respectively, and 1,937,455 and 277,112 shares of Series A
Convertible Preferred Stock, respectively. By agreement among the former
shareholders of Conning, Inc., the shares

                                      52

<PAGE> 54
of Conning, Inc. owned by the Non-Contributing Shareholders were acquired in
exchange for cash payments in the aggregate of $7,495,000. See Note 1 of Notes
to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements.

    In connection with the Strategic Merger, the Company, General American and
its other shareholders and option holders entered into the Shareholders
Agreement, which restricts the transfer of shares of the Company by any
shareholder (other than General American), except pursuant to a right of first
refusal in favor of General American with respect to shares acquired in
connection with the Strategic Merger or pursuant to a right of first refusal in
favor of the Company in the case of shares acquired subsequent to the Strategic
Merger (and with respect to all shares, in favor of the other shareholders if
General American or the Company does not purchase such shares). The
Shareholders Agreement further provides for the rights of shareholders to
require General American, or in some cases the Company, to purchase their
shares in certain situations including death, disability and termination of
employment with the Company and, in certain other situations, provides General
American, or in some cases the Company, with the right to purchase such shares.
The Shareholders Agreement also provides that, until August 1998, (i) the
Company will maintain the general approach and methodology regarding cash
compensation and private equity carried interest allocations, (ii) the Company
will have a Board of Directors comprised of no more than seven members, at least
two of whom will be members of management (including Mr. Slayton or his
successor), (iii) the Company will have a Compensation Committee of the Board of
which the President will be a member, (iv) Mr. Slayton will serve as President
of the Company and Conning Asset Management Company and as President and CEO of
Conning, Inc. and Conning & Company and Mr. Rubenstein will serve as Chairman
and CEO of the Company and Conning Asset Management Company, and (v) Mr.
Slayton will serve as a senior member of management of the Company with certain
specified responsibilities. Upon consummation of this offering, the
Shareholders Agreement will terminate, except for certain provisions requiring
the Company to maintain certain compensation approaches as described in clause
(i) of the preceding sentence.

    The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock pays a quarterly dividend equal to
the 90 day United States Treasury Bill rate as in effect from time to time.
Pursuant to the terms of the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, upon the
consummation of the sale of the Common Stock offered hereby, the Series A
Convertible Preferred Stock will convert automatically on a one-for-one basis
into shares of Common Stock. Pursuant to the Shareholders Agreement, in June
1997 General American exercised a right in connection with the amendment and
restatement of such agreement (the "call right"), to purchase 1,594,995
shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, representing approximately 50%
of the outstanding Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, for the negotiated per
share price of $11.25, with Messrs. Slayton, Hansen and Schpero receiving cash
payments of $3,579,615, $1,747,215, and $159,975, respectively; and Other
Significant Officers, as a group, and Other Officers, as a group, receiving
cash payments of $10,898,156 and $1,558,733, respectively. Prior to the
amendment and restatement of the Shareholders Agreement in June, 1997, General
American had the right to purchase up to 50% of the Series A Convertible
Preferred Stock only upon the occurrence of an initial public offering of the
Company's Common Stock. See "Principal Shareholders."

    Each Employee who entered into an employment agreement in connection with
the Strategic Merger received a signing bonus that is subject to forfeiture in
the event that such Employee's employment is terminated under certain
circumstances during the first three years after the Strategic Merger. As of
the date hereof, of the $195,000, $95,000 and $35,000 of signing bonus paid to
Messrs. Slayton, Hansen and Schpero, respectively, $65,000, $31,667 and $11,667
are subject to forfeiture; of the $465,000 and $80,000 of signing bonuses paid
to the Other Significant Officers and Other Officers, respectively, $155,000
and $26,667 are subject to forfeiture, which forfeiture obligations expire on
August 11, 1998. See "Management--Employment Agreements and Other Compensation
Arrangements."

   
    In connection with the Strategic Merger certain employees of the Company
entered into option cancellation agreements and received payments from the
Company, which, based upon an understanding among the selling shareholders, are
subject to forfeiture in the event that any such employee's employment is
terminated under certain circumstances during the first three years after the
Strategic Merger. As of the date hereof, of the $1,176,196, $804,491 and
$55,237 of the payments paid in connection with the option cancellation
agreements to Messrs. Slayton, Hansen and Schpero, respectively, $265,961,
$129,829 and $11,887 are subject to forfeiture; of the $4,353,082 and $605,119
of payments to the Other Significant Officers and Other Officers, respectively,
$809,803 and $115,853 are subject to forfeiture, which forfeiture obligations
expire on August 11, 1998.
    

    In connection with the Strategic Merger, the parties agreed to indemnify
each other for breaches of representations and warranties, certain tax matters
and certain litigation matters. Most of these indemnification obligations

                                      53

<PAGE> 55
expired by their own terms on February 11, 1997. The indemnification
obligations of the former shareholders and optionholders of Conning, Inc. that
survived beyond that date have been released, which benefited all of the former
shareholders and optionholders of Conning, Inc., including Messrs. Slayton,
Hansen and Schpero. General American's and the Company's obligations to
indemnify the former shareholders and optionholders of Conning, Inc. remains in
force with respect to certain potential tax liabilities of the Company and
certain potential tax liabilities of the former shareholders and optionholders.

    Also in connection with the Strategic Merger, the Company granted certain
employees of the Company options ("1995 Options") to purchase in the
aggregate 1,000,000 shares of the Company's Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
("Non-Voting Common Stock") at a price of $5.33 per share, with Messrs.
Rubenstein, Slayton, Hansen, and Schpero receiving options to purchase 120,000,
120,000, 120,000, and 10,000 shares, respectively; with the Other Significant
Officers and Other Officers receiving options to purchase 460,000 and 170,000
shares, respectively, which includes Messrs. Koester and McLellan and Ms.
Tanaka each receiving options to purchase 70,000 shares. These options vest
annually in equal portions over the five years between August 11, 1995 and
August 11, 2000, but upon the consummation of this offering all of these
options will become fully vested. Also upon the consummation of this offering,
the Company's Non-Voting Common Stock will convert automatically on a
one-for-one basis into shares of Common Stock. Thus, the 1995 Options will
become exercisable for shares of Common Stock at a price of $5.33 per share.
All 1995 Options were issued as Incentive Stock Options.

    In connection with the Strategic Merger, General American loaned the
Company $13,000,000 on an unsecured basis bearing interest at the rate of 7%
per annum, payable as follows: (a) commencing January 1, 1996, semi-annual
interest payments until September 1, 2002, (b) on September 1, 2003 and
September 1, 2004, principal payments of $4,333,333, together with all interest
accrued through such dates, and (c) on September 1, 2005, the final payment of
principal in the amount of $4,333,334, together with all interest accrued
through such date. As of December 31, 1996, the outstanding principal balance
on this loan was $2,000,000 and this remaining principal was paid in February
1997. Also in connection with the Strategic Merger, General American made a
$2,500,000 short term loan to the Company on an unsecured basis bearing
interest at 6.75% per annum. This loan was due August 31, 1996 and was fully
paid by June, 1996.

   
    The Company intends to declare prior to the closing of this offering, and
to pay, dividends on the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock and the Series B
Convertible Preferred Stock approximating the amounts that would have been
payable on the next dividend payment date, pro rated through the date of closing
of this offering, in the aggregate amount of approximately $213,000, of which
General American will receive approximately $96,000 and no director or
executive officer of the Company will receive in excess of $25,000.

RECENT EMPLOYEE OFFERINGS
    

    Commencing in November 1996, in conjunction with an employee incentive
program, the Company has sold shares of its Series B Convertible Preferred
Stock to certain employees of the Company at a price of $5.33 per share. To
date, 475,000 shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock have been sold in
connection with such program, with Messrs. Rubenstein, Liddy and Schpero
acquiring 40,000, 50,000 and 20,000 shares, respectively; with Other
Significant Officers and Other Officers acquiring 175,000 and 175,000 shares,
respectively (which includes Messrs. Koester and McLellan and Ms. Tanaka each
acquiring 20,000 shares). The Series B Convertible Preferred Stock is
convertible upon demand on a one-for-one basis into shares of Non-Voting Common
Stock at a conversion price of $1.67 per share, subject to anti-dilution
adjustments, and pays a quarterly dividend of 5% per annum. As noted above,
upon the consummation of this offering, the Company's Non-Voting Common Stock
will convert automatically on a one-for-one basis into shares of Common Stock.
Thus, shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock effectively will become
convertible into shares of Common Stock upon payment of the conversion price of
$1.67 per share (i.e., for a total purchase price of $7.00 per share). Pursuant
to the Shareholders Agreement, as amended and restated, subject to the
consummation of this offering, the Company has the right to redeem the Series B
Convertible Preferred Stock for the price of $5.33 per share plus accrued
dividends.

   
    In connection with the Company's private offering of Series B Convertible
Preferred Stock to certain employees and directors of the Company in 1996 and
January 1997, General American holds unsecured recourse demand notes from
certain shareholders totaling $2,265,250, including $213,200 due from Mr.
Rubenstein and $106,600 due from Mr. Schpero, respectively, and $932,750
from the Other Significant Officers, as a group including $106,600 each from

                                      54

<PAGE> 56
Mr. Koester, Mr. McLellan and Ms. Tanaka, and $932,750 from the Other Officers,
as a group, respectively. Interest on such notes accrues at 6% per annum and is
payable semi-annually beginning in July, 1997. Principal payments on such notes
are due annually beginning January, 1998 in the amount of 25% of the gross bonus
earned by the obligor in the immediately preceding year. General American has
issued or will issue loans to certain shareholders to finance the conversion of
Series B Convertible Preferred Stock on terms similar to those described above
and in the aggregate amount of $642,950, including $66,800 for Mr. Rubenstein,
$33,400 for Mr. Schpero, $292,250 for the Other Significant Officers (including
$33,400 for each of Mr. Koester, Mr. McLellan and Ms. Tanaka) and $292,250 for
the Other Officers.
    

    Also commencing in November 1996, the Company has granted certain of its
employees options ("1996 Options") to purchase in the aggregate 237,500
shares of the Company's Non-Voting Common Stock for the price of $7.00 per
share. See "Management--Executive Compensation." The Company granted options
to Messrs. Rubenstein, Liddy and Schpero to purchase 20,000, 25,000 and 10,000
shares, respectively; options to purchase 87,500 shares to the Other
Significant Officers, as a group (including 10,000 shares each to Mr. McLellan,
Mr. Koester and Ms. Tanaka); and options to purchase 87,500 shares to the Other
Officers, as a group. These options vest annually in equal portions over the
five-year period commencing on the date of grant. The consummation of the sale
of Common Stock offered hereby will not affect the vesting of the 1996 Options.
As noted above, upon the consummation of this offering, the Company's Non-Voting
Common Stock will convert automatically on a one-for-one basis into shares of
Common Stock. Thus, the 1996 Options effectively will become exercisable for
shares of Common Stock at a price of $7.00 per share.

   
    The Underwriters have reserved approximately 125,000 shares of the Common
Stock for sale, at the initial public offering price, to directors, officers and
employees of the Company and its affiliates, directors of General American and
family members of the foregoing, in order to permit such persons to purchase
such shares of Common Stock in the offering.  See "Underwriting."
    

TRANSACTIONS WITH GENERAL AMERICAN

    General American, an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of General American
Mutual Holding Company, currently is the principal shareholder of the Company.
After completion of the offering, General American will beneficially own
approximately 65% of the Company's outstanding Common Stock (approximately 63%
if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in full). General
American is a Missouri state life insurance company which began operations as a
stock company in 1933, was converted to a mutual company in a process that
ended in 1946 and became a stock company in 1997 in connection with the
formation of its mutual holding company parent. General American is principally
engaged in issuing individual and group life and health insurance policies and
annuity contracts. The principal offices of General American are located at 700
Market Street, St. Louis, Missouri 63101. See "Risk Factors--Dependence on
Principal Shareholder," "--Potential Conflicts of Interest," "--Termination
Provisions of Investment Advisory Agreements," "--Consequences of a Change of
Control on Investment Advisory Agreements; Limitations on Voting Rights" and
"--Certain Other Anti-Takeover Provisions," "Management," and "Principal
Shareholders."

    The Company, through its subsidiary Conning Asset Management Company, acts
as the investment adviser for the general and separate accounts of General
American and certain of its affiliates, including the General American Capital
Company funds, COVA Corporation and its subsidiaries ("COVA"), Reinsurance
Group of America, Incorporated and certain of its subsidiaries ("RGA"),
Paragon Life Insurance Company, General Life Insurance Company, General Life
Insurance Company of America, Security Equity Life Insurance Company and the
General American Life Insurance Company Pension Plan Trust. The Company also
acts as the investment adviser for Security Mutual Life Insurance Company of
New York, which has entered into a strategic alliance with General American.
Such advisory agreements are generally terminable upon 30 to 90 days' notice
without penalty. The Company is generally compensated on the basis of fees
calculated at a percentage of the market value of the assets under management.
The fees are billed and are payable quarterly in arrears. Investment management
fees from these affiliated entities for the years ended December 31, 1995 and
1996 amounted to $12,573,489 and $14,300,367, respectively. Effective January
1, 1995, General American and Conning Asset Management Company entered into an
investment advisory agreement pursuant to which the Company would manage all of
the general account assets of

                                      55

<PAGE> 57
General American. As of December 31, 1994, such assets totaled approximately
$5.2 billion. While investment management contracts were not in place during
1994 for General American's general account and COVA, investment management fees
earned from the other affiliated entities for the year ended December 31, 1994
totaled $2,618,635. See Note 11 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial
Statements.

    After the 180-day period during which General American has agreed not to
offer for sale, sell, or otherwise dispose of, directly or indirectly, any
shares of Common Stock without the prior written consent of Donaldson, Lufkin &
Jenrette Securities Corporation (see "Underwriting"), it is possible that
General American will, from time to time depending on future conditions,
further reduce or increase its beneficial ownership of the Common Stock.
Additionally, the Company has granted General American certain rights with
respect to the registration of shares of Common Stock that will be owned by
General American upon completion of the offering. See "Shares Eligible for
Future Sale."

   
    Pursuant to an Administrative Services Agreement, General American provides
the Company with certain management and administrative services at the
Company's request. Such services include legal, employee benefit, payroll,
personnel, facilities and information services. As consideration for these
services, the Company pays General American a monthly fee based on General
American's cost, computed in accordance with General American's current cost
accounting system. The Company paid to General American $871,221, $12,308,103
and $14,611,221 for administrative services rendered for the years ended
December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively, of which a substantial portion
reflects reimbursement of salaries and employee-related costs. Until January 1,
1997, certain employees of the historical operations of GAIMCO who were
employees of General American and costs associated with such employees were
allocated and charged to the Company pursuant to such Agreement. The
Administrative Services Agreement is terminable by General American on 180
days' written notice and by the Company on 90 days' written notice. General
American, however, has agreed not to terminate the Agreement prior to July 19,
1998. See Note 11 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements.
    

    Effective July 31, 1996, Conning Asset Management Company entered into an
agreement with General American for the lease of approximately 25,000 square
feet of office space located at 700 Market Street, St. Louis, Missouri. Such
lease has a five-year term, is terminable by the Company upon 30 days' notice
and calls for annual lease payments of approximately $600,000. The Company
anticipates leasing up to an additional 10,000 square feet at this location
during 1997 on substantially the same terms and conditions. The Company also
subleases from General American, pursuant to a written sublease, five of its
eleven office sites for its various mortgage loan and real estate offices. The
five offices are located in California, Florida, Georgia, Illinois and Texas.
The sublease terminates with respect to a particular location immediately prior
to termination of the applicable lease. The underlying leases have terms of
varying lengths ranging from month-to-month to a fixed term ending in 2000.
Either party may terminate the sublease with respect to one or more locations
on 90 days' written notice. The Company's total annual base rent for 1997 under
the sublease totals approximately $124,000. The terms of all of the foregoing
leases and the sublease (collectively, the "Leases") were designed to
approximate the cost to General American of owning or leasing such spaces. The
Company made rental payments to General American of approximately $300,000,
$624,000 and $613,000 in 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively. The Company
believes that the prices and other terms under the Leases are at least as
favorable as those prices and terms being offered generally in the same
marketplaces by unrelated parties for comparable spaces. See Note 11 of Notes
to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements.

    The Company and General American Mutual Holding Company have entered into a
Tax Allocation and Tax Sharing Agreement dated as of June 12, 1997 (the "Tax
Agreement"). The Tax Agreement provides, among other things, that the tax
liability of the General American Mutual Holding Company federal consolidated
tax return group (the "General American Tax Group") during the period that
the Company is a member of such group (i.e., from June 12, 1997 to the closing
of this offering) will be allocated among the members of the group in
proportion to their separately calculated tax liabilities. The Tax Agreement
also provides that any savings resulting from the tax benefits of a particular
member will be paid to that member, rather than accruing to the benefit of the
other members, and requires, among other things, that certain payments be made
between the Company and General American Mutual Holding Company in the event
there is a change in the pre-offering tax liabilities of the Company. In
addition, under the Tax Agreement, General American Mutual Holding Company will
indemnify the Company against any tax liabilities of the General American Tax
Group that are not attributable to the Company, and the Company will indemnify
General American Mutual Holding Company against any tax liabilities of the
Company. From August 11, 1995 (the date of the Strategic Merger) to June 12,
1997, the Company was not a member of the General American Tax Group but was a
party to a Tax Sharing Agreement with General American providing for
indemnification rights and tax sharing liabilities in a manner similar to the
current Tax Agreement for the period during which Conning

                                      56

<PAGE> 58
Asset Management Company was a member of such group. The tax liabilities of the
members of the General American Tax Group prior to the Strategic Merger, which
included Conning Asset Management Company, are allocated under a Tax Allocation
Agreement dated as of October 30, 1992, in a manner similar to the Tax
Agreement.

    Mr. Liddy is also an executive officer and director of General American and
certain of its affiliates. His son has been employed by the Company since 1995.
Mr. Rubenstein is also a director of certain of General American's affiliates.
See "Management--Directors, Executive Officers and Certain Significant
Officers."

    The Company's mortgage origination activities have been historically
operated pursuant to informal agreements through General American. Since
January 1, 1995, the Company has generally received a fee associated with loan
originations of approximately 1% of the loan balance. The Company also receives
ongoing servicing fees and management fees with respect to mortgage loans in
portfolios managed by the Company. Such loans have been originated primarily for
General American and its affiliates. Total fees received from General American
and its affiliates for loan originations, servicing and management fees during
1994, 1995 and 1996 were approximately $0, $7,424,000, and $11,830,000,
respectively. See "Business--Asset Management--Mortgage Origination and Service
of Real Estate" for information regarding the amounts of mortgage loan
originations.

    The existing and proposed agreements between the Company, on the one hand,
and General American and its affiliates, on the other hand, may be modified or
renegotiated in the future and additional transactions or agreements may be
entered into between the Company and General American and its affiliates. See
"Risk Factors--Potential Conflicts of Interest."

   
    See "--Recent Employee Offerings" for a description of the Company's
directed share program.
    

PARTICIPATION IN PRIVATE EQUITY FUNDS

   
    The Company, directly or indirectly through intermediary partnerships, is
the general partner of the following private equity funds with a 1% general
partner capital interest: Conning Insurance Capital Limited Partnership II and
Conning Insurance Capital International Partners II (together, "Fund II"),
Conning Insurance Capital Limited Partnership III and Conning Insurance Capital
International Partners III (together, "Fund III"), Conning Connecticut
Insurance Fund, L.P. ("Fund IV") and Conning Insurance Capital Limited
Partnership V ("Fund V"). At September 30, 1997, the Company's commitment to
fund future required capital contributions was approximately $2.1 million. The
Company had established similar relationships with respect to Conning Insurance
Capital Limited Partnership and Conning Insurance Capital International
Partners (together, "Fund I"), which terminated pursuant to their terms on
December 31, 1995. Collectively, Fund I, Fund II, Fund III, Fund IV and Fund V
are referred to as the "Funds". Each Fund has a term of eight to ten years,
subject to certain extensions for liquidation purposes. Fund I commenced
December, 1985, Fund II commenced December, 1988, Fund III commenced December,
1993, Fund IV commenced December, 1995 and Fund V commenced August, 1997. The
Company and its predecessors received investment management fees from the
Funds, in the aggregate, of approximately $3.2 million, $3.2 million, $4.0
million and $3.3 million for 1994, 1995, 1996 and the first nine months of
1997, respectively. The Company through its subsidiary has committed to Conning
Connecticut Investors, L.L.C., a limited liability company of which the Company
is the general partner and managing member, up to approximately $4,040,000 for
purposes of capitalizing the general partner. The amount is payable only in the
event of insolvency on the part of the Conning Connecticut Investors, L.L.C.
See Note 15 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements.

    The Company is also entitled to a carried interest, or performance fee, in
each Fund representing up to approximately 20% of specified gains of the Fund,
as determined in accordance with the applicable partnership or limited
liability company agreement. Certain officers and directors of the Company and
its subsidiaries receive participation percentages annually over a five-year
period, in a portion of the Company's carried interest, which participations
are subject to a climbing vesting schedule varying by Fund, generally over a
period of up to seven years from the date of receipt of the participation
percentage. At the end of the five year period, the Company's percentage of the
carried interest ranges from 25% to 40% of the original amount, depending on
the Fund. At September 30, 1997, the percentage interests in the general partner
of Fund V held by Messrs. Rubenstein, Slayton, Hansen and Schpero were 0.55%,
1.35%, 0.375% and 0.25%, respectively; and ranged from 0.0% to 1.65% for each of
the Other Significant Officers; and ranged from 0.0% to 1.1% for each of the
Other Officers; the percentage interests in the general partner of Fund IV held
by Messrs. Rubenstein, Slayton, Hansen and Schpero were 0.50%, 2.80%, 1.40% and
0.45%, respectively; the percentage interests held by Messrs. Koester and
McLellan and Ms. Tanaka were 0.15% each; and ranged from 0.15% to 3.40% for each
of the Other Significant Officers; and ranged from 0.10% to 2.06% for each of
the Other Officers; the percentage interests in the general partner of Fund III
held by Messrs.

                                      57

<PAGE> 59
Rubenstein, Slayton, Hansen and Schpero were 0.50%, 6.07%, 3.19% and 0.57%,
respectively, the percentage interests held by Messrs. Koester and McLellan and
Ms. Tanaka were 0.15% each, and ranged from 0.15% to 6.86% for each of the Other
Significant Officers and ranged from 0.10% to 4.17% for each of the Other
Officers; and the percentage interests in the general partners of Funds I and II
held by Messrs. Slayton, Hansen and Schpero were 8.54%, 5.86% and 0.84%,
respectively, and the percentage interests held by each of the Other Significant
Officers ranged from 1.47% to 6.75%; and the percentage interests held by each
of the Other Officers ranged from 0.13% to 2.80%. Participation percentages are
complete for Funds I and II; Fund III has approximately one year remaining for
completion of the determination of participation percentages; Fund IV has
approximately three years remaining for completion of the determination of
participation percentages; and Fund V has approximately four years remaining for
completion of the determination of participation percentages. With the exception
of Fund I, none of the Funds has generated a carried interest as of September
30, 1997 and the value, if any, of such participations cannot be readily
determined. Distributions to date of the carried interest from Fund I were made
during 1996 and 1997 to Messrs. Slayton, Hansen and Schpero in the amounts of
$678,669, $466,025 and $67,092, respectively, and ranged from $117,252 to
$536,496 for each of the Other Significant Officers and ranged from $3,975 to
$222,659 for each of the Other Officers.
    

    General American and its affiliates other than the Company have committed
or invested a total of $30.0 million in four of the Funds. A subsidiary of
Transamerica Occidental Life Insurance Company ("Transamerica"), of which Mr.
Fibiger was Chairman of the Board, has invested a total of $4.0 million in two
of the Funds. General American and its affiliates may participate in the
distributions from the private equity funds on a pro rata basis with other
limited partners in the private equity funds. General American and certain of
its affiliates, which may include the Company, may invest in new private equity
funds in the future as limited partners.

                            PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

    The following table sets forth certain information regarding the beneficial
ownership of the Common Stock as of November 20, 1997, giving effect to the
Capital Stock Conversions and the vesting of certain options upon the closing
of the offering and as adjusted to reflect the sale of shares offered hereby,
for (i) each person known to the Company to own beneficially 5% or more of the
outstanding shares of Common Stock, (ii) the Company's directors and named
executive officers, and (iii) all the Company's directors and executive
officers as a group. Except as otherwise noted in the footnotes to this table,
the named beneficial owner has sole voting and investment power. As of November
20, 1997, there were 43 shareholders of record.

   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               PERCENTAGE OF SHARES
                                                                                   BENEFICIALLY
                                                                  NUMBER OF       OWNED<F1><F2>
                                                                   SHARES      --------------------
                                                                 BENEFICIALLY  BEFORE         AFTER
                  NAME OF BENEFICIAL OWNER                        OWNED<F1>    OFFERING    OFFERING
                  ------------------------                        ---------    --------    --------
<S>                                                               <C>            <C>       <C>
General American Life Insurance Company<F3>.................      8,304,995       80.0%     64.5%
Leonard M. Rubenstein<F4>...................................        225,388        2.1       1.7
Maurice W. Slayton<F5>......................................        495,900        4.7       3.8
Mark E. Hansen<F5>..........................................        333,020        3.2       2.6
Fred M. Schpero<F6>.........................................         46,221        <F*>      <F*>
John A. Fibiger.............................................            --         --        --
Richard A. Liddy<F7>........................................         55,000        <F*>      <F*>
John C. Shaw................................................            --         --        --
All Directors and Executive Officers as a group
  (7 persons)<F8>...........................................      1,155,529       10.6       8.6
Other Significant Officers as a group (19 persons)<F9>......      1,764,682       16.0      13.1
Other Officers as a group (36 persons)<F10>.................        510,781        4.8       3.9

<FN>
- --------
<F*> Less than 1%

 <F1> Except for shares owned by General American, which represent 6,710,000
      shares of Common Stock and 1,594,995 shares of Series A Convertible
      Preferred Stock, all shares owned prior to the offering represent shares
      of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, shares of Series B Convertible
      Preferred Stock, shares of Non-Voting Common Stock and shares of
      Non-Voting Common Stock subject to outstanding stock options that are

                                      58

<PAGE> 60
      exercisable within 60 days, including the vesting of certain options upon
      the closing of the offering. All shares, other than shares of Common
      Stock, are currently non-voting. The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock
      and Non-Voting Common Stock will automatically convert into an equal
      number of shares of Common Stock upon completion of the offering and the
      holders of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock have agreed to convert
      such shares into an equal number of shares of Common Stock for additional
      consideration of $1.67 per share, upon completion of the offering. See
      "Description of Capital Stock."

 <F2> Assumes no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option. Shares
      owned before and after the offering include the following options to
      purchase Common Stock: (i) outstanding options which are currently
      exercisable or are exercisable within 60 days of the date hereof; (ii)
      outstanding options which will become exercisable upon the closing of
      this offering; and (iii) options the Company intends to grant upon the
      closing of this offering which will be immediately exercisable. The number
      of immediately exercisable options to be granted at closing has been
      estimated; the number of options actually granted will depend upon the
      actual initial public offering price. See "Management--Employee Stock
      Plans."

 <F3> Represents shares owned by General American Holding Company, a wholly-owned
      subsidiary of General American. The address of General American is 700
      Market Street, St. Louis, Missouri 63101. General American is a
      wholly-owned subsidiary of GenAmerica Corporation, which is a
      wholly-owned subsidiary of General American Mutual Holding Company.

 <F4> Includes 52,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to currently
      exercisable options, 72,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to
      options that will become exercisable upon the closing of the offering and
      an estimated 61,388 shares subject to exercisable options that will be
      granted upon the closing of the offering.

 <F5> Includes 48,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to currently
      exercisable options, 72,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to
      options that will become exercisable upon the closing of the offering and
      an estimated 57,712 shares subject to exercisable options that will be
      granted upon the closing of the offering.

 <F6> Includes 6,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to currently
      exercisable options and 6,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to
      options that will become exercisable upon the closing of the offering.

 <F7> Includes 5,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to currently
      exercisable options. Mr. Liddy, a director of the Company, is also
      Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of General American. Mr. Liddy
      disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares owned by General American.

 <F8> Includes 159,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to currently
      exercisable options, 222,000 shares which may be acquired pursuant to
      options that will become exercisable upon the closing of the offering and
      an estimated 176,812 shares subject to exercisable options that will be
      granted upon the closing of the offering.

 <F9> Consists of the 19 persons listed under the caption
      "Management--Directors, Executive Officers and Certain Other Significant
      Officers--Certain Other Significant Officers." Includes 201,500 shares
      which may be acquired pursuant to currently exercisable options, 276,000
      shares which may be acquired pursuant to options that will become
      exercisable upon the closing of the offering and an estimated 143,452
      shares subject to exercisable options that will be granted upon the
      closing of the offering.

<F10> Consists of 36 officers who are neither Executive Officers nor Other
      Significant Officers. Includes 85,500 shares which may be acquired
      pursuant to currently exercisable options, 102,000 shares which may be
      acquired pursuant to options that will become exercisable upon the
      closing of the offering and an estimated 9,723 shares subject to
      exercisable options that will be granted upon the closing of the
      offering.
</TABLE>
    

                                      59

<PAGE> 61
                        SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

    Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock of the Company. Future sales of substantial amounts of Common Stock in
the public market, or the perception that such sales could occur, could
adversely affect market prices prevailing from time to time and the ability of
the Company to raise equity capital in the future.

RESTRICTION ON SALES

    Upon completion of this offering and assuming no exercise of outstanding
options, the Company will have outstanding 12,875,000 shares of Common Stock
(13,250,000 shares if the Underwriters' over allotment option is exercised in
full). Of these shares, the 2,500,000 shares sold in the offering will be
immediately eligible for resale in the public market without restriction under
the Securities Act, except for any shares purchased by an "Affiliate" (as
that term is defined under the Securities Act) of the Company, which shares
will be subject to the resale limitations of Rule 144 under the Securities Act.
The remaining 10,375,000 shares outstanding following this offering (the
"Previously Issued Shares") were issued by the Company in private
transactions not involving a public offering and are thus treated as
"restricted securities" within the meaning of Rule 144 under the Securities
Act. Subject to the Lock-up Agreements described below, the Previously Issued
Shares may be sold in the public market only if registered or pursuant to an
exemption from registration such as those afforded by Rules 144, 144A, 701 and
Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933.

   
    The holders of the Previously Issued Shares of Common Stock have entered
into agreements with the Company ("Lock-up Agreements") pursuant to which
they have agreed that, during the 180-day period after the date of this
prospectus, they will not, except with the prior consent of Donaldson, Lufkin &
Jenrette Securities Corporation or in certain limited circumstances, offer,
sell, contract to sell or grant an option to purchase any of such Previously
Issued Shares. In addition, the Company has agreed that during such period it
will not, without the prior consent of Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities
Corporation or in certain limited circumstances, offer, sell, contract to sell
or grant an option to purchase any shares of Common Stock. See
"Underwriting." The Company believes that, following the lock-up period, up
to 1,472,288 shares held by existing shareholders could be eligible for sale
without restriction and up to 8,902,712 "affiliate" shares held by executive
officers, directors, and other affiliates could be eligible for sale, subject
to certain volume and other limitations of Rule 144 as described below; all
such shares, however, may be subject to additional holding periods under Rule
144 based on, among other things, particular interpretative considerations,
facts and circumstances relating to such shareholders. Outstanding options to
purchase 1,000,000 shares of Common Stock will be exercisable upon completion
of the offering. Upon the closing of this offering, certain incentive stock
options will be recharacterized as other than incentive stock options; the
Company intends to compensate for such recharacterization by granting new
non-qualified stock options to purchase an estimated aggregate 329,987 shares
to holders of such recharacterized options upon the closing of this offering,
which options are exercisable immediately upon the closing of this offering. See
"Management--Employee Stock Plans." In addition, upon the closing of this
offering, the Company intends to grant options to purchase an additional
965,000 shares of Common Stock, which options will become exercisable over
a five-year vesting period commencing on the first anniversary of the closing
of this offering. Upon the first anniversary of the date hereof, General
American and the holders of shares issuable upon the Capital Stock Conversions
have the right to require the Company in certain circumstances to register
their shares of Common Stock for sale under the Securities Act. See
"--Registration Rights" below and "Certain Relationships and Related
Transactions."
    

    In general, under Rule 144 as currently in effect, beginning 90 days after
the date of this Prospectus, an Affiliate of the Company or other person (or
persons whose shares are aggregated) who has beneficially owned Previously
Issued Shares for at least one year will be entitled to sell in any three-month
period a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of (i) 1% of the
then outstanding shares of the Company's Common Stock (approximately 132,500
shares immediately after the offering, if the Underwriters' over-allotment
option is exercised in full) or (ii) the average weekly trading volume of the
Company's Common Stock on the Nasdaq National Market during the four calendar
weeks immediately preceding the date on which notice of the sale is filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission. Sales pursuant to Rule 144 are subject
to certain requirements relating to manner of sale, notice and availability of
current public information about the Company. A person (or persons whose shares
are aggregated) who is not deemed to have been an Affiliate of the Company at
any time during the 90 days immediately preceding the sale and who has
beneficially owned Restricted Shares for at least two years is entitled to sell
such shares pursuant to Rule 144(k) without regard to the limitations described
above.

                                      60

<PAGE> 62
    Previously Issued Shares may also be resold (1) to a person whom the seller
reasonably believes is a qualified institutional buyer within the meaning of
Rule 144A under the Securities Act purchasing for its own account or for the
account of a qualified institutional buyer in a transaction meeting the
requirements of Rule 144A and (2) in an off-shore transaction complying with
Rules 903 or 904 of Regulation S under the Securities Act.

    An employee of the Company who purchased shares or was awarded options to
purchase shares pursuant to a written compensatory plan or contract meeting the
requirements of Rule 701 under the Securities Act is entitled to rely on the
resale provisions of Rule 701 under the Securities Act which permits Affiliates
and non-Affiliates to sell their Rule 701 shares without having to comply with
the holding period restrictions of Rule 144, in each case commencing 90 days
after the date of this Prospectus. In addition, non-Affiliates may sell Rule 701
shares without complying with the public information, volume and notice
provisions of Rule 144.

   
    Following the effectiveness of the registration statement covering the
shares of Common Stock offered hereby, the Company will register under the
Securities Act the shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under the
Company's employee stock plans covering 3,437,500 shares. The Company expects
that these registrations will automatically become effective upon filing.
Accordingly, shares registered under such registration statements and acquired
pursuant to such Plans will be available for sale in the open market upon the
expiration of the public sale restrictions described below (see
"Underwriting"), subject to Rule 144 volume limitations applicable to
Affiliates.
    

REGISTRATION RIGHTS

    The Company has granted certain rights with respect to the registration of
6,710,000 of the 8,304,995 shares of Common Stock that will be owned by General
American upon completion of the offering (the "Registrable Securities").
Subject to certain limitations, General American and permitted assignees have
the right at any time after the first anniversary of the date hereof to require
the Company to register the sale of such shares under the Securities Act (a
"demand registration"). The number of demand registrations is limited to two.
A demand registration must be requested by holders of Registrable Securities
representing at least 10% of the outstanding Common Stock and must include at
least 10% of such Registrable Securities. The Company is not required to effect
more than one demand registration in any twelve-month period. The holders of
Registrable Securities are also entitled to include such shares in a registered
offering of securities by the Company for its own account or the account of any
other security holder (a "piggy-back registration"), subject to certain
conditions and restrictions. A piggy-back registration is counted as one of the
demand registrations if the holder sold at least 80% of the Registrable
Securities it requested be registered. In addition to the demand and piggy-back
registration rights described above after the first anniversary of the date
hereof, the holders of Registrable Securities representing at least 10% of the
outstanding Common Stock may require the Company to file up to two registration
statements relating to such Registrable Securities on Form S-3 under the
Securities Act when such form is available to the Company. A demand
registration on Form S-3 will count as a Form S-3 registration. A registration
on Form S-3 must relate to the offering of securities, including the
Registrable Securities, at an aggregate price to the public of at least
$5,000,000. The Company is not required to effect more than one such
registration on Form S-3 (including any demand registrations registered on Form
S-3) in any twelve-month period. The registration expenses of holders of
Registrable Securities (other than underwriting discounts and commissions) will
be paid by the Company. The registration rights expire for any Holder owning
Registrable Securities representing less than 1% of the outstanding Common
Stock on the date such Holder is able to dispose of all of its shares in any
90-day period pursuant to Rule 144, and, in any event, on the date such
Holder's Registrable Securities can be sold pursuant to Rule 144(k) under the
Securities Act. The registration rights are not assignable by General American
other than to General American Holding Company, a direct or indirect subsidiary
of General American or General American Holding Company, a parent of General
American or General American Holding Company, or a direct or indirect
subsidiary of such parent entity.

    The Company has granted the holders of the 2,070,005 shares of Common Stock
issued upon the Capital Stock Conversions the right to require the Company to
file a registration statement on Form S-3 on or about the first anniversary of
the date hereof covering the resale of such shares, provided that such Form S-3
is available to the Company; provided further, that (i) the Company would be
under no obligation to maintain the effectiveness of such registration
statement for more than twelve months and (ii) the holders of such stock enter
into a registration rights agreement at that time containing such limitations
and conditions as the Company deems appropriate.

                                      61

<PAGE> 63
                         DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

AUTHORIZED CAPITAL STOCK

    Under the Company's Restated Articles of Incorporation (previously defined
as the "Articles"), the Company's authorized capital stock consists of
50,000,000 shares of Common Stock, par value $.01 per share, 20,000,000 shares
of Non-Voting Common Stock, par value $.01 per share and 23,790,000 shares of
preferred stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Preferred Stock"). The
Company will have outstanding, immediately prior to the issuance and sale of
shares of Common Stock pursuant to the offering 10,375,000 shares of Common
Stock, after giving effect to the Capital Stock Conversions. Upon the closing
of this offering, assuming no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment
option and no exercise of outstanding stock options, the Company will have
outstanding 12,875,000 shares of Common Stock and no shares of Preferred Stock.
Upon the closing of this offering, the Company intends to file an amendment to
its Articles to eliminate the Non-Voting Common Stock and to reduce the number
of authorized shares of Preferred Stock to 20,000,000.

COMMON STOCK

    All of the outstanding shares of Common Stock are, and the shares offered
hereby will be, fully paid and nonassessable. Each holder of Common Stock is
entitled to one vote for each share held of record on all matters presented to
a vote of shareholders, including the election of directors, except that, as
provided in the Articles, no person or group other than General American,
certain affiliates of General American, certain savings, profit sharing, stock
bonus and employee stock ownership plans established by the Company or certain
subsidiaries of the Company and other persons approved in advance by the Board
of Directors of the Company, shall have the right to vote more than 20% of the
combined voting power of the Company's Voting Stock (as defined in the
Articles). See "Certain Charter and Bylaw Provisions--Limitations on Voting of
Shares in Certain Circumstances" for a more detailed description of this 20%
voting limitation. Accordingly, assuming such 20% voting restriction does not
apply, holders of a majority of the shares of Common Stock entitled to vote in
any election of directors may elect all of the directors standing for election.
Subject to the prior rights of the holders of any shares of Preferred Stock
which subsequently may be issued and outstanding, the holders of Common Stock
are entitled to receive dividends as and when declared by the Board of
Directors out of funds legally available therefor, and, in the event of
liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the Company, to share ratably in all
assets remaining after payment of liabilities. Holders of Common Stock do not
have cumulative voting rights in the election of directors or preemptive rights
to purchase or subscribe for any stock or other securities and there are no
conversion rights or redemption or sinking fund provisions with respect to such
stock. Additional shares of authorized Common Stock may be issued without
shareholder approval.

    As of September 30, 1997, there were outstanding 110,000 shares of
Non-Voting Common Stock. Such shares of Non-Voting Common Stock have no voting
or dividend rights. Upon the closing of this offering, all issued and
outstanding shares of Non-Voting Common Stock will be converted into an
aggregate of 110,000 shares of Common Stock.

PREFERRED STOCK

    As of September 30, 1997, there were outstanding 3,190,000 shares of Series
A Convertible Preferred Stock and 365,000 shares of Series B Convertible
Preferred Stock. Upon or prior to the closing of this offering, all issued and
outstanding shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock will be converted
into an aggregate of 3,190,000 shares of Common Stock, and all outstanding
shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock will be converted into an
aggregate of 365,000 shares of Common Stock for additional consideration to the
Company of $1.67 per share. Upon the closing of this offering, the Company
intends to file an amendment to its Articles to eliminate the series
designations of the Series A and B Convertible Preferred Stock.

    Following the closing of this offering, the Board will have the authority
to issue up to an aggregate of 20,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock from time
to time in one or more series without shareholder approval. The Board of
Directors has the authority to prescribe for each series of Preferred Stock it
establishes the number of shares in that series, the dividend rate, and the
voting rights, conversion privileges, redemption and liquidation rights, if
any, and any other rights, preferences and limitations of the particular
series. Depending upon the rights of such Preferred Stock, the issuance of
Preferred Stock could have an adverse effect on the holders of Common Stock by
delaying or preventing a change of control of the Company, making removal of
the present management of the Company more

                                      62

<PAGE> 64
difficult, or resulting in restrictions upon the payment of dividends and other
distributions to the holders of Common Stock. The Company has no present plans
to issue any Preferred Stock.

CERTAIN EFFECTS OF AUTHORIZED BUT UNISSUED STOCK

    Upon the completion of this offering, there will be 34,592,513 shares of
Common Stock and 20,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock available for future
issuance without shareholder approval, taking into consideration the 1,237,500
shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance upon exercise of currently
outstanding options and an estimated 1,294,987 shares of Common Stock reserved
for issuance upon exercise of options to be granted upon the closing of this
offering. These additional shares may be issued for a variety of proper
corporate purposes, including raising additional capital, corporate
acquisitions, and implementing employee benefit plans. Except as contemplated
by the Company's existing and other possible employee benefit or stock purchase
plans, the Company does not currently have any plans to issue additional shares
of Common Stock or Preferred Stock. See "Management--Employee Stock Plans."

    One of the effects of the existence of unissued and unreserved Common Stock
and Preferred Stock may be to enable the Board of Directors to issue shares to
persons friendly to current management, which could render more difficult or
discourage an attempt to obtain control of the Company by means of a merger,
tender offer, proxy contest, or otherwise, and thereby protect the continuity
of the Company's management and possibly deprive the shareholders of
opportunities to sell their shares of Common Stock at prices higher than the
prevailing market prices. Such additional shares also could be used to dilute
the stock ownership of persons seeking to obtain control of the Company. See
also "Certain Charter and Bylaw Provisions."

TRANSFER AGENT

    The transfer agent and registrar for the Common Stock is ChaseMellon
Shareholder Services, L.L.C., Overpeck, New Jersey.

                     CERTAIN CHARTER AND BYLAW PROVISIONS

    The Company's Articles and Bylaws, among other things, (i) contain certain
limitations on the voting power of certain shareholders, (ii) provide for a
classified Board of Directors, (iii) limit the right of shareholders to remove
directors or change the size of the Board of Directors, to fill vacancies on
the Board of Directors, to act by written consent and to call a special meeting
of shareholders, and (iv) require a higher percentage of shareholders than
would otherwise be required to amend, alter, change, or repeal the provisions
of the Articles and Bylaws discussed in this section, as well as those
described above under "Management--Indemnification." The Articles also
provide that the Bylaws may be amended only by the majority vote of the Board
of Directors; thus shareholders will not be able to amend the Bylaws without
first amending the Articles. These provisions, which are summarized below, may
have the effect of discouraging certain types of transactions that involve an
actual or threatened change of control of the Company. Reference is made to the
full text of the Articles and Bylaws, which are included as exhibits to the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part. The following
summary is qualified in its entirety by such reference.

LIMITATIONS ON VOTING OF SHARES IN CERTAIN CIRCUMSTANCES

   
    In order to limit the likelihood under certain circumstances of a deemed
assignment, under the Advisers Act or the Investment Company Act, of the
investment advisory contracts that the Company's subsidiaries have with their
clients (see "Regulation"), the Articles include provisions limiting the
voting power of shares of Common Stock in certain circumstances. The Investment
Company Act and the Advisers Act define the term "assignment" to include any
"direct or indirect transfer" of "a controlling block of the voting
securities" of the issuer's outstanding voting securities. The Investment
Company Act presumes that any person holding 25% of the voting stock of the
Company "controls" the Company. The Articles provide that a person or
"group" (which includes affiliates and associates of a person, as defined in
the Articles) that owns (as defined in the Articles) more than 20% of the
voting shares of the Company's issued and outstanding capital stock ("Voting
Stock") shall have the right to vote not more than 20% of the outstanding
shares of Voting Stock entitled to vote. The remaining shares of Voting Stock
owned by such person or group ("Excludable Shares") shall have no voting
rights and shall not be counted for quorum or shareholder

                                      63

<PAGE> 65
approval purposes. These provisions do not apply to General American Mutual
Holding Company, General American, General American Holding Company or their
subsidiaries or affiliates, direct or indirect subsidiaries of the Company
and certain employee plans established or to be established by the Company. The
Company's Board of Directors may approve the exemption of other persons or
groups from the provisions described above. The foregoing limitation is intended
to have the effect of decreasing the chance of any assignment occurring for
purposes of the Advisers Act and the Investment Company Act, including in
connection with future issuances or sales of Common Stock. However, no
assurances can be given that such an "assignment" will not occur under these or
other circumstances. The Company has the right to inquire of any owner of Voting
Stock, or person who purports to exercise voting rights with respect to such
stock, and the owner will have the obligation to provide such information to the
Company as the Company may reasonably request, as to the number of shares owned,
whether such shares are owned by any other person and the identity of such
person, whether affiliates or associates of such person own any shares, whether
such person is a member of a "group" owning such shares or whether such person,
or any of such person's affiliates or associates, has any agreement, arrangement
or understanding with any other person with respect to the Voting Stock.
    

    The limitation on voting may be viewed as having the effect of making more
difficult or of discouraging, absent the support of General American, a proxy
contest, a merger or other combination involving the Company, a tender offer,
an open-market purchase program or other purchase of Common Stock that could
give shareholders an opportunity to realize a premium over the then-prevailing
market price for their shares. However, given the authority that General
American will exercise over the affairs of the Company following the completion
of the offering in any event, the Company does not consider the likely effect
of this limitation to be significant.

SIZE OF BOARD, ELECTION OF DIRECTORS, CLASSIFIED BOARD, REMOVAL OF DIRECTORS
AND FILLING VACANCIES

    The Articles provide that the number of directors to constitute the board
of directors initially shall be five and thereafter the number of directors
shall be fixed from time to time as provided in the Bylaws. The Bylaws provide
for a Board of Directors of five directors, but in no event less than three,
and permit the Board of Directors to change the number of directors with a
majority vote. The Articles further provide that the Bylaws may be amended only
by majority vote of the Board of Directors.

    In order for a shareholder to nominate a candidate for director, the Bylaws
require that timely notice be given to the Company in advance of the meeting.
Ordinarily, such notice must be given not less than 60 days nor more than 90
days before the first anniversary of the preceding year's annual meeting, or
not less than 60 days nor more than 90 days before May 12, 1998, in the case of
the next annual meeting; provided, however, that if the date of the annual
meeting is advanced by more than 30 days or delayed by more than 60 days from
such anniversary date, then the shareholder must give such notice not earlier
than 90 days nor later than 60 days prior to such meeting or 10 days after
notice of the meeting is mailed or other public disclosure of the meeting is
made. In certain cases, notice may be delivered later if the number of
directors to be elected is increased. The shareholder filing the notice of
nomination must describe various matters regarding the nominee, including,
without limitation, such information as name, address, occupation, and shares
held. The Articles do not permit cumulative voting in the election of
directors, and the Bylaws provide that the majority of the votes cast in the
election of directors shall elect those directors. Accordingly, the holders of
a majority of the then outstanding shares of voting stock can elect all the
directors then being elected at that meeting of shareholders.

    The Articles and Bylaws provide that the Board shall be divided into three
classes, with the classes to be as nearly equal in number as possible, and that
one class shall be elected each year and serve for a three-year term.

    Missouri law provides that, unless a corporation's articles of
incorporation provide otherwise, the holders of a majority of the corporation's
voting stock may remove any director from office. The Articles provide that,
except as described below, a director may be removed by shareholders only "for
cause" and with the approval of the holders of 85% of the Company's voting
stock.

    Missouri law further provides that, unless a corporation's articles of
incorporation or bylaws provide otherwise, all vacancies on a corporation's
board of directors, including any vacancies resulting from an increase in the
number of directors, may be filled by the vote of a majority of the remaining
directors even if that number is less than a quorum. The Articles provide that,
subject to the rights, if any, of the holders of any class of preferred stock
then

                                      64

<PAGE> 66
outstanding and except as described below, vacancies may be filled only by the
vote of a majority of the remaining directors.

    The classification of directors, the inability to vote shares cumulatively,
the advance notice requirements for nominations, and the provisions in the
Articles that limit the ability of shareholders to increase the size of the
Board or to remove directors and that permit the remaining directors to fill
any vacancies on the Board will have the effect of making it more difficult for
shareholders to change the composition of the Board. As a result, at least two
annual meetings of shareholders may be required for the shareholders to change
a majority of the directors, whether or not a change in the Board would be
beneficial to the Company and its shareholders and whether or not a majority of
the Company's shareholders believes that such change would be desirable.

LIMITATIONS ON SHAREHOLDER ACTION BY WRITTEN CONSENT; LIMITATIONS ON CALLING
SHAREHOLDER MEETINGS

    As required by Missouri law, the Bylaws provide that any action by written
consent of shareholders in lieu of a meeting must be unanimous. Under the
Bylaws, except as described below, shareholders are not permitted to call
special meetings of shareholders or to require the Board to call a special
meeting of shareholders and a special meeting of shareholders may be called
only by a majority of the entire Board of Directors, the Chairman of the Board,
or the President. In order for a shareholder to bring a proposal before a
shareholder meeting, the Bylaws require that timely notice be given to the
Company in advance of the meeting. Ordinarily, such notice must be given not
less than 60 days nor more than 90 days before the first anniversary of the
preceding year's annual meeting, or not less than 60 days nor more than 90 days
before May 12, 1998 in the case of the next annual meeting; provided, however,
that if the date of the annual meeting is advanced by more than 30 days or
delayed by more than 60 days from such anniversary date, then the shareholder
must give such notice not earlier than 90 days nor later than 60 days prior to
such meeting or 10 days after notice of the meeting is mailed or other public
disclosure of the meeting is made. Such notice must include a description of
the proposal, the reasons therefor, and other specified matters. The Board may
reject any such proposals that are not made in accordance with these procedures
or that are not a proper subject for shareholder action in accordance with the
provisions of applicable law.

    The provision of the Bylaws requiring unanimity for shareholder action by
written consent gives all the shareholders of the Company entitled to vote on a
proposed action the opportunity to participate in such action and will prevent
the holders of a majority of the voting power of the Company from using the
written consent procedure to take shareholder action. Moreover, a shareholder
cannot force a shareholder consideration of a proposal over the opposition of
the Board of Directors by calling a special meeting of shareholders or forcing
consideration of such a proposal.

    These provisions are designed in part to make it more difficult and
time-consuming to obtain majority control of the Board of Directors of the
Company or otherwise to bring a matter before the shareholders without the
Board's consent, and thus to reduce the vulnerability of the Company to an
unsolicited takeover proposal. These provisions are designed to enable the
Company to develop its business in a manner which will foster its long-term
growth, with the threat of a takeover not deemed by the Board to be in the best
interests of the Company and its shareholders and the potential disruption
entailed by such a threat reduced to the extent practicable. On the other hand,
these provisions may have an adverse effect on the ability of shareholders to
influence the governance of the Company and the possibility of shareholders
receiving a premium above the prevailing market price for their securities from
a potential acquiror who is unfriendly to management.

CERTAIN MISSOURI STATUTORY PROVISIONS

    The GBCL has a control share acquisition statute. A "control share
acquisition" is defined as the acquisition, directly or indirectly, of either
ownership or the power to direct the exercise of voting power with respect to
"control shares," which are defined as shares which, when added to all other
shares of the issuing corporation owned by the acquiring person, would entitle
such person to exercise certain degrees of voting power with respect to stock
of the issuing corporation. Under the Missouri control share acquisition
statute (which is only applicable to certain corporations that have 100 or more
shareholders), shareholders who acquire enough shares to give them (1)
one-fifth or more to less than one-third, (2) one-third or more to less than a
majority, or (3) a majority or more of the outstanding stock of the Company
will not be able to vote those excess shares unless certain disclosure
requirements are satisfied and the retention of voting rights by the acquiror
is approved by at least a majority of shares entitled to

                                      65

<PAGE> 67
vote and a majority of all non-interested shares entitled to vote. A
corporation's articles of incorporation or bylaws may provide that a corporation
will not be subject to Missouri's control share acquisition statute. The
Articles contain a provision exempting the Company from Missouri's control share
acquisition statute.

    The GBCL restricts a "business combination" (defined to include generally
a merger or consolidation, a sale, exchange or other dispositions of 10% or
more of the aggregate market value of all assets or stock of the corporation,
or certain other transactions which have the effect of disproportionately
increasing the share ownership) with an "interested shareholder" (defined
generally as the beneficial owner or at least 20% of the corporation's voting
stock) for five years following the stock acquisition date (i.e., the date the
person became an interested shareholder), unless the board of directors approves
the business combination or the purchase of stock by the interested shareholder
before the stock acquisition date. Business combinations with an interested
shareholder are permitted only if (i) the board of directors approved the
business combination or acquisition of the stock prior to the stock acquisition
date, (ii) the business combination is approved by a majority of the
outstanding voting stock not beneficially owned by the interested shareholder
no earlier than five years after the stock acquisition date, or (iii) the
consideration to be received by shareholders meets certain requirements of the
statute with respect to form and amount. The Articles contain a provision
electing to subject the Company to the business combination statute of the
GBCL; such provision has the effect, among other things, of rendering the
statute inapplicable to transactions with "interested shareholders," such as
General American, that acquired their status prior to the effective date of
such provision. The Articles further provide that General American and its
affiliates are expressly deemed not to constitute "interested shareholders."

    Missouri law contains certain requirements concerning disclosures which
must be made in connection with "take-over bids." Take-over bids are defined
as the acquisition of or offer to acquire any equity security of a domestic
target company, if after acquisition thereof the offeror would, directly or
indirectly, be a beneficial owner of more than five percent of any class of the
issued and outstanding equity securities of such target company. A take-over
bid does not include an offer to acquire such equity security solely in
exchange for other securities, or the acquisition of such equity security
pursuant to such offer, for the sole account of the offeror, in good faith and
not to avoid Missouri's statutory regulation of take-over bids, and not
involving any public offering within the meaning of the Securities Act. Unless
the offeror, prior to making a take-over bid, files with the Commissioner of
Securities and delivers to the target company certain materials, including
copies of all offering information, certain information regarding the offeror,
the source of funds financing the offer, the number of shares to be acquired
and whether the offeror intends to sell the assets of the company, the offeror
will be subject to civil monetary and criminal penalties.

                                      66

<PAGE> 68
                                 UNDERWRITING

    Subject to certain terms and conditions contained in the Underwriting
Agreement, the syndicate of Underwriters named below, for whom Donaldson,
Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation and A.G. Edwards & Sons, Inc. are
acting as representatives (the "Representatives"), have severally agreed to
purchase from the Company an aggregate of 2,500,000 shares of Common Stock. The
number of shares of Common Stock that each Underwriter has agreed to purchase
is set forth opposite its name below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   UNDERWRITERS                                       NUMBER OF SHARES

<S>                                                                                  <C>
Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation................................
A.G. Edwards & Sons, Inc...........................................................


                                                                                          ----------
    Total..........................................................................        2,500,000
                                                                                          ==========
</TABLE>

    The Underwriting Agreement provides that the obligations of the several
Underwriters to purchase shares of Common Stock are subject to the approval of
certain legal matters by counsel and to certain other conditions. If any of the
shares of Common Stock are purchased by the Underwriters pursuant to the
Underwriting Agreement, all such shares of Common Stock (other than the shares
of Common Stock covered by the over-allotment option described below) must be
so purchased.

    Prior to the offering, there has been no established trading market for the
Common Stock. The initial price to the public for the Common Stock offered
hereby will be determined by negotiation between the Company and the
Representatives. The factors to be considered in determining the initial price
to the public include the history of and the prospects for the industry in
which the Company competes, the ability of the Company's management, the past
and present operations of the Company, the historical results of operations of
the Company, the prospects for future earnings of the Company, the present
state of the Company's development, the general condition of the securities
markets at the time of the offering and the recent market prices of and the
demand for publicly traded common stock of generally comparable companies.

    The Company has agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against certain
liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or to contribute
to payments that the Underwriters may be required to make in respect thereof.

    The Company has been advised by the Representatives that the Underwriters
propose to offer the Common Stock to the public initially at the price set
forth on the cover page of this Prospectus and to certain dealers (who may
include the Underwriters) at such price less a concession not to exceed
$---------- per share. The Underwriters may allow, and such dealers may reallow,
discounts not in excess of $---------- per share to any other Underwriter and
certain other dealers.

   
    The Underwriters have reserved approximately 125,000 shares of the Common
Stock for sale, at the initial public offering price, to directors, officers
and employees of the Company, and its affiliates, directors of General American
and family members of the foregoing, in order to permit such persons to purchase
such shares of Common Stock in the offering. Each purchaser of such reserved
shares will agree to certain transfer restrictions with respect to such shares
for a period of five months following the closing of this offering. The number
of shares of Common Stock available for sale to the general public will be
reduced to the extent such persons purchase such reserved shares of Common
Stock. Any reserved shares of the Common Stock not so purchased will be offered
by the Underwriters to the general public on the same basis as the shares of the
Common Stock offered pursuant to the offering.
    

    The Company has granted to the Underwriters an option to purchase up to
375,000 additional shares of Common Stock, at the initial public offering price
less underwriting discounts and commissions, solely to cover over-allotments.
Such option may be exercised at any time until 30 days after the effective date
of the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is part. To the extent
that the Underwriters exercise such option each of the Underwriters will be
committed, subject to certain conditions, to purchase a number of option shares
proportionate to such Underwriter's initial commitment as indicated in the
preceding table.
   
    All shareholders of the Company have agreed that they will not directly or
indirectly offer, sell, contract to sell, or otherwise dispose of or transfer
any shares of Common Stock of the Company owned by them without the prior

                                      67

<PAGE> 69
written consent of Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation, for a
period of 180 days after the date of this Prospectus except in certain
non-public transactions in which the acquiror or acquirors of such shares
agree(s) to such restrictions. In addition, the Company has agreed that for a
period of 180 days after the date of this Prospectus it will not, without the
prior written consent of Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation,
offer, sell, contract to sell, grant any option to purchase or otherwise dispose
of any shares of Common Stock or any securities convertible into or exercisable
or exchangeable for such Common Stock or in any other manner transfer all or a
portion of the economic consequences associated with such Common Stock, except
for (i) shares of Common Stock offered hereby, (ii) shares of Common Stock
issued pursuant to the exercise of options outstanding on the date of this
Prospectus, (iii) options or other stock-based awards granted or shares of
Common Stock after the date of this Prospectus pursuant to the Company's
employee stock plans and other plans and (iv) shares or options issued in
acquisitions in which the acquiror or acquirors of such shares agree(s) to such
restrictions. See "Shares Eligible for Future Sale."
    

    In connection with the offering, the Underwriters may engage in
transactions that stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the price of the
Common Stock. Specifically, the Underwriters may overallot the offering,
creating a syndicate short position. In addition, the Underwriters may bid for,
and purchase, shares of Common Stock in the open market to cover syndicate
shorts or to stabilize the price of the Common Stock. Finally, the underwriting
syndicate may reclaim selling concessions allowed for distributing the Common
Stock in the offering, if the syndicate repurchases previously distributed
Common Stock in syndicate covering transactions, in stabilization transactions
or otherwise. Any of these activities may stabilize or maintain the market
price of the Common Stock above independent market levels. The Underwriters are
not required to engage in these activities, and may end any of these activities
at any time.

    The Underwriters and dealers may engage in passive market making
transactions in the Common Stock in accordance with Rule 103 of Regulation M
promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commission. In general, a passive
market maker may not bid for, or purchase, the Common Stock at a price that
exceeds the highest independent bid. In addition, the net daily purchases made
by any passive market maker generally may not exceed 30% of its average daily
trading volume in the Common Stock during a specified two month prior period,
or 200 shares, whichever is greater. A passive market maker must identify
passive market making bids as such on the Nasdaq electronic inter-dealer
reporting system. Passive market making may stabilize or maintain the market
price of the Common Stock above independent market levels. Underwriters and
dealers are not required to engage in passive market making and may end passive
market making activities at any time.

    The Representatives have informed the Company that the Underwriters do not
intend to confirm sales of shares of Common Stock offered hereby to accounts
over which they exercise discretionary authority.

                                      68

<PAGE> 70
                                 LEGAL MATTERS

   
    The validity of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby has been passed
upon for the Company by Bryan Cave LLP, St. Louis, Missouri. Certain legal
matters will be passed upon for the Company by Matthew P. McCauley, Esq.,
Secretary and General Counsel of the Company and Vice President and Associate
General Counsel of General American Life Insurance Company, and for the
Underwriters by Simpson Thacher & Bartlett (a partnership which includes
professional corporations), New York, New York. The Honorable John C. Danforth,
a partner of Bryan Cave LLP, is a director of General American Life Insurance
Company, GenAmerica Corporation and General American Mutual Holding Company, and
may purchase shares in the Company's directed share program. Bryan Cave LLP from
time to time serves as legal counsel to General American and certain of its
affiliates.
    

                                    EXPERTS
    The consolidated financial statements and schedule of the Company as of
December 31, 1995 and 1996, and for each of the years in the three-year period
ended December 31, 1996, and the consolidated financial statements of Conning,
Inc. and subsidiaries as of, and for the six month period ended, June 30, 1995,
have been included herein and in the Registration Statement in reliance upon
the report of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, independent certified public accountants,
appearing elsewhere herein, and upon the authority of said firm as experts in
accounting and auditing.

    The Consolidated Financial Statements and related schedules of Conning, Inc.
and subsidiaries for the year ended December 31, 1994, appearing in this
Prospectus and elsewhere in the Registration Statement have been included
herein and elsewhere in the Registration Statement have been audited by Price
Waterhouse LLP, independent certified public accountants, as stated in their
report appearing herein.

                            ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

    The Company has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission,
Washington, D.C. (the "Commission"), a Registration Statement (the
"Registration Statement") on Form S-1 under the Securities Act, with respect
to the Common Stock offered hereby. This Prospectus, which constitutes part of
the Registration Statement, omits certain of the information contained in the
Registration Statement and the exhibits and schedules thereto on file with the
Commission pursuant to the Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission
thereunder. The Registration Statement, including exhibits and schedules
thereto, may be inspected at the principal offices of the Commission at 450
Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, and at its regional offices at
Citicorp Center, 500 W. Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661,
and at Seven World Trade Center, Suite 1300, New York, New York 10048, and
copies may be obtained at the prescribed rates from the Public Reference
Section of the Commission at its principal office in Washington, D.C. The
Commission maintains an Internet Web site (http://www.sec.gov.) that contains
such documents filed electronically by the Company with the Commission through
its Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval System (EDGAR) filing
system. Statements contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any
contract, agreement or other document referred to herein are not necessarily
complete and in each instance reference is made to the copy of such contract,
agreement or other document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement,
each such statement being qualified in all respects by such reference.

                                      69
<PAGE> 71
<TABLE>
                                  INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                            PAGE

<S>                                                                                                         <C>
UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1996 and September 30, 1997 (unaudited)..............        F-2

Consolidated Statements of Income for the nine month periods ended September 30, 1996 and 1997
  (unaudited).......................................................................................        F-3

Consolidated Statements of Common Shareholders' Equity for the nine month period ended
  September 30, 1997 (unaudited)....................................................................        F-4

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the nine month periods ended September 30, 1996 and 1997
  (unaudited).......................................................................................        F-5

Notes to Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements................................................        F-6

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Independent Auditors' Report........................................................................        F-7

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1995 and 1996........................................        F-8

Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996..............        F-9

Consolidated Statements of Common Shareholder's Equity for the years ended December 31, 1994,
  1995 and 1996.....................................................................................       F-10

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996..........       F-11

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements..........................................................       F-12

SCHEDULE I--FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF CONNING CORPORATION (PARENT COMPANY ONLY)<F*>

Condensed Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1995 and 1996...........................................       F-24

Condensed Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996.......................       F-25

Condensed Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996...................       F-26

Notes to Condensed Financial Statements.............................................................       F-27

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

Independent Auditors' Report........................................................................       F-28

Consolidated Balance Sheet as of June 30, 1995......................................................       F-29

Consolidated Statement of Income for the six month period ended June 30, 1995.......................       F-30

Consolidated Statement of Common Shareholders' Equity for the six month period ended June 30, 1995..       F-31

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows for the six month period ended June 30, 1995...................       F-32

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements..........................................................       F-33

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

Report of Independent Accountants...................................................................       F-39

Consolidated Statement of Financial Condition as of December 31, 1994...............................       F-40

Consolidated Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 1994...........................       F-41

Consolidated Statement of Shareholders' Equity for the year ended December 31, 1994.................       F-42

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows for the year ended December 31, 1994...........................       F-43

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements..........................................................       F-44

<FN>
- --------

<F*>The 1994 Parent Company only Financial Statements are not required as 25%
    of the net assets of the Company were not in restricted subsidiaries.
</TABLE>
                                      F-1

<PAGE> 72
<TABLE>
                               CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                                   CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                                           (UNAUDITED)
<CAPTION>
                                                                                DECEMBER 31,   SEPTEMBER 30,
                                                                                    1996            1997
                                                                                -----------    ------------
<S>                                                                             <C>             <C>
                                  ASSETS
Current assets:
    Cash and cash equivalents..............................................     $ 9,816,568     $ 8,536,722
    Short-term investments.................................................       7,901,637      10,729,558
    Accounts receivable, net...............................................       5,297,660       8,533,730
    Marketable equity securities...........................................          45,625              --
    Income taxes receivable................................................          11,447       1,854,305
    Prepaid expenses and other current assets..............................         162,622         323,710
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total current assets...........................................      23,235,559      29,978,025
Non-marketable investments at value........................................       1,756,931       1,919,650
Equipment and leasehold improvements, at cost, less accumulated
  depreciation and amortization of $562,812 and $1,281,545.................         815,112         996,426
Deferred income taxes......................................................       1,572,859       1,320,657
Goodwill...................................................................      18,825,870      18,066,085
Other assets...............................................................       3,813,608       2,365,278
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total assets...................................................     $50,019,939     $54,646,121
                                                                                ===========     ===========
                   LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
Current liabilities:
    Compensation payable...................................................     $ 8,422,199     $ 7,067,465
    Deferred revenue.......................................................       1,533,290       1,504,213
    Due to affiliates......................................................       1,473,811         626,059
    Accounts payable and other accrued expenses............................       2,707,872       5,022,968
    Preferred dividends payable............................................         235,815         247,618
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total current liabilities......................................      14,372,987      14,468,323
Accrued rent liability.....................................................       3,643,996       3,438,008
Long term debt payable to affiliate........................................       2,000,000              --
Other payables.............................................................         853,521         520,000
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total liabilities..............................................      20,870,504      18,426,331
                                                                                -----------     -----------
Series A convertible preferred stock, $.01 par value, $5.33 liquidation
  value: 3,190,000 shares authorized, issued and outstanding...............      22,330,004      32,894,185
Series B convertible preferred stock, $.01 par value, $5.33 liquidation
  value: 600,000 shares authorized, 460,000 and 365,000 shares issued and
  outstanding..............................................................       2,451,800       3,257,405
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total convertible preferred stock..............................      24,781,804      36,151,590
                                                                                -----------     -----------
Non-Voting Common Stock, $.01 par value: 20,000,000 shares authorized;
  110,000 shares issued and outstanding....................................              --           1,100
Common stock, $.01 par value: 20,000,000 and 50,000,000 shares authorized;
  6,710,000 shares issued and outstanding..................................          67,100          67,100
Additional paid in capital.................................................       2,944,647              --
Retained earnings..........................................................       1,355,884              --
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total common shareholders' equity..............................       4,367,631          68,200
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total liabilities and shareholders' equity.....................     $50,019,939     $54,646,121
                                                                                ===========     ===========

    See accompanying notes to unaudited consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                      F-2

<PAGE> 73
<TABLE>
                           CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                             CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
               FOR THE NINE MONTH PERIODS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1996 AND 1997

                                        (UNAUDITED)
<CAPTION>
                                                                          1996            1997
<S>                                                                   <C>             <C>
Revenues:
    Asset management and related fees............................     $29,365,205     $36,018,354
    Research services............................................       9,582,015      10,277,378
    Other income.................................................         791,767         629,142
                                                                      -----------     -----------
            Total revenues.......................................      39,738,987      46,924,874
                                                                      -----------     -----------

Expenses:
    Employee compensation and benefits...........................      18,522,125      23,558,926
    Occupancy and equipment costs................................       1,816,693       2,509,470
    Marketing and production costs...............................       3,985,613       3,998,660
    Professional services........................................       1,160,578       1,154,438
    Amortization of goodwill and other...........................       2,061,870       1,953,119
    Other operating costs........................................       3,099,181       2,778,749
                                                                      -----------     -----------
            Total expenses.......................................      30,646,060      35,953,362
                                                                      -----------     -----------
    Operating income.............................................       9,092,927      10,971,512
    Interest expense.............................................         591,605         232,760
                                                                      -----------     -----------
    Income before provision for income taxes.....................       8,501,322      10,738,752
    Provision for income taxes...................................       3,762,192       4,316,334
                                                                      -----------     -----------
    Net income...................................................     $ 4,739,130     $ 6,422,418
                                                                      ===========     ===========
    Preferred stock dividends....................................         669,080         750,500
                                                                      -----------     -----------
    Net earnings available to common shareholder.................     $ 4,070,050     $ 5,671,918
                                                                      ===========     ===========
    Pro forma weighted average common shares and equivalents
      outstanding................................................              --      11,094,110
    Pro forma earnings per common share and common share
      equivalents................................................                     $      0.58

    See accompanying notes to unaudited consolidated financial statements.

</TABLE>
                                      F-3

<PAGE> 74
<TABLE>
                                       CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                              CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMMON SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                  FOR NINE MONTH PERIOD ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997
                                                    (UNAUDITED)
<CAPTION>
                                                        NON-
                                                       VOTING                ADDITIONAL                      TOTAL COMMON
                                                       COMMON     COMMON      PAID IN        RETAINED        SHAREHOLDERS'
                                                       STOCK       STOCK      CAPITAL        EARNINGS           EQUITY

<S>                                                    <C>       <C>       <C>              <C>              <C>
Balance, December 31, 1996........................     $         $67,100   $ 2,944,647      $ 1,355,884      $  4,367,631

Conversion of 110,000 shares of Series B preferred
  stock...........................................      1,100                  768,900                            770,000

Tax benefit--employee compensation (Note 2).......                           1,134,785                          1,134,785

Accretion on preferred stock......................                          (4,848,332)      (7,027,802)      (11,876,134)

Net income........................................                                            6,422,418         6,422,418

Dividends on preferred stock......................                                             (750,500)         (750,500)
                                                       ------    -------   -----------      -----------      ------------

Balance, September 30, 1997.......................     $1,100    $67,100   $        --      $        --      $     68,200
                                                       ======    =======   ===========      ===========      ============

    See accompanying notes to unaudited consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                      F-4

<PAGE> 75
<TABLE>
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
         FOR THE NINE MONTH PERIODS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1996 AND 1997
                                  (UNAUDITED)

<CAPTION>
                                                                        1996          1997

<S>                                                                <C>            <C>
Operating activities:

    Net income...................................................  $  4,739,130   $  6,422,418

    Adjustment for items not affecting cash:

        Depreciation and amortization............................       545,897        674,186

        Amortization of goodwill and other.......................     2,061,869      1,953,115

        Deferred income tax provision............................    (2,400,596)     1,386,987

        Net unrealized appreciation on non-marketable
          securities.............................................        33,118             --

        Net sales of marketable securities.......................        10,375         45,625

        Accretion of discounts on short-term investments.........      (114,869)      (177,764)

        Changes in:

            Accounts receivables.................................     4,397,775     (3,236,070)

            Prepaid expenses and other assets....................     1,672,223       (161,088)

            Accounts payables and other accrued expenses.........      (603,173)     2,113,379

            Income taxes receivable..............................       496,069     (1,842,858)

            Due to affiliates....................................       231,168       (847,752)

            Deferred revenue.....................................       918,018        (29,077)

            Accrued rent liability...............................      (200,611)      (205,988)

            Compensation payable.................................      (948,312)    (1,354,734)
                                                                   ------------   ------------
                Net cash provided by operating activities........    10,838,081      4,740,379
                                                                   ------------   ------------

Investing activities:

    Sale of marketable securities................................     1,160,000             --

    Purchases of non-marketable securities.......................       (44,949)      (162,719)

    Proceeds from non-marketable partnership investments.........       384,450             --

    Purchases of equipment and other assets, net.................    (1,285,944)      (720,500)

    Purchases of short-term investments..........................   (23,383,662)   (54,545,324)

    Maturities of short-term investments.........................    19,600,000     51,895,168
                                                                   ------------   ------------
                Net cash used in investing activities............    (3,570,105)    (3,533,375)
                                                                   ------------   ------------

Financing activities:

    Repayments on long term debt.................................    (5,000,000)    (2,000,000)

    Repayments on short term debt................................      (500,000)            --

    Other payments...............................................            --             --

    Issuance of Series B preferred stock.........................            --         79,950

    Conversion of Series B preferred stock.......................            --        183,700

    Dividends on preferred stock.................................      (669,080)      (750,500)
                                                                   ------------   ------------
                Net cash used in financing activities............    (6,169,080)    (2,486,850)
                                                                   ------------   ------------

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents........................     1,098,896     (1,279,848)

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year.....................     5,995,260      9,816,568
                                                                   ------------   ------------
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period.........................  $  7,094,156   $  8,536,722
                                                                   ============   ============

    See accompanying notes to unaudited consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                      F-5

<PAGE> 76
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

             NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1--BASIS OF PRESENTATION

    The accompanying unaudited consolidated financial statements should be read
in conjunction with the financial statements and notes for the year ended
December 31, 1996. In the opinion of management, the financial information
reflects all adjustments which are necessary for a fair presentation of
financial position, results of operations and cash flows for the interim
periods. The results of operations for interim periods are not necessarily
indicative of the results to be expected for the entire year.

NOTE 2--PREFERRED STOCK AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY

    In January, 1997, the Company issued an additional 15,000 shares of Series
B Preferred Stock at $5.33 per share.

    In April, 1997, certain shareholders converted 110,000 shares of Series B
Preferred Stock to Non-Voting Common Stock. The resulting transaction increased
additional paid in capital by $768,900 and increased common equity by $1,100.

    In June, 1997, General American, pursuant to a call right, purchased
1,594,995 shares of the Company's Series A Preferred Stock from existing
shareholders for $11.25 per share. In connection with such purchase, certain
restrictions were eliminated on the Series A Preferred Stock which generated an
additional tax benefit to the Company of $1,134,785 recorded directly to
additional paid in capital.

    In June, 1997, the authorized number of shares of Series A Voting Common
Stock increased from 20,000,000 to 50,000,000. The authorized number of shares
of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock remains at 20,000,000.

    The carrying value of the Convertible Preferred Stock is at original issue
price plus accretion relating to any increase in the redemption value of the
stock during the period. During the nine months ended September 30, 1996 and
September 30, 1997, such accretion was $0 and $11,876,134, respectively.

                                      F-6

<PAGE> 77
                         INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT

The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Conning Corporation:

    We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Conning
Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the related
consolidated statements of income, common shareholder's equity, and cash flows
for the three-year period ended December 31, 1996. In connection with our
audits of the consolidated financial statements, we have audited the
accompanying financial statement schedule. These consolidated financial
statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the
Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our
audits.

    We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of
material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence
supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial
statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.

    In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above
present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Conning
Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, and the results
of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the
three-year period ended December 31, 1996, in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles. Also in our opinion, the related financial
statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated
financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material
respects, the information set forth herein.

                                           /s/  KPMG Peat Marwick LLP

St. Louis, Missouri
March 21, 1997, except as to note 21
which is as of September 19, 1997

                                      F-7

<PAGE> 78
<TABLE>
                                 CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
                                      CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

<CAPTION>
                                                                                      DECEMBER 31,
                                                                             ------------------------------
                                                                                    1995            1996
<S>                                                                             <C>             <C>
                                  ASSETS
Current assets:
    Cash and cash equivalents..............................................     $ 5,995,260     $ 9,816,568
    Short-term investments.................................................       3,598,594       7,901,637
    Accounts receivable, net (note 11).....................................       6,382,572       5,297,660
    Marketable equity securities...........................................       1,241,250          45,625
    Income taxes receivable................................................         507,498          11,447
    Prepaid expenses and other current assets..............................         133,955         162,622
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total current assets...........................................      17,859,129      23,235,559
Non-marketable investments at value........................................       1,775,613       1,756,931
Equipment and leasehold improvements, at cost, less accumulated
  depreciation and amortization of $170,600 and $562,812...................         964,132         815,112
Deferred income taxes......................................................       1,606,469       1,572,859
Goodwill...................................................................      19,838,917      18,825,870
Other assets...............................................................       4,133,194       3,813,608
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total assets...................................................     $46,177,454     $50,019,939
                                                                                ===========     ===========
                   LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY
Current liabilities:
    Short term debt........................................................     $   500,000     $        --
    Compensation payable...................................................       3,729,971       8,422,199
    Deferred revenue.......................................................       2,401,527       1,533,290
    Due to affiliates......................................................         836,233       1,473,811
    Accounts payable and other accrued expenses............................       3,541,019       2,707,872
    Preferred dividends payable............................................         223,300         235,815
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total current liabilities......................................      11,232,050      14,372,987
Accrued rent liability.....................................................       3,914,196       3,643,996
Long term debt payable to affiliates.......................................       9,000,000       2,000,000
Other payables.............................................................         405,789         853,521
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total liabilities..............................................      24,552,035      20,870,504
                                                                                -----------     -----------
Series A convertible preferred stock, $.01 par value, $5.33 liquidation
  value: 3,190,000 shares authorized, issued and outstanding...............      17,002,704      22,330,004
Series B convertible preferred stock, $.01 par value, $5.33 liquidation
  value: 600,000 shares authorized, 460,000 issued and outstanding.........              --       2,451,800
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total convertible preferred stock..............................      17,002,704      24,781,804
                                                                                -----------     -----------
Common stock, $.01 par value: 20,000,000 shares authorized; 6,710,000
  shares issued and outstanding............................................          67,100          67,100
Additional paid in capital.................................................       2,944,647       2,944,647
Retained earnings..........................................................       1,376,668       1,355,884
Unrealized appreciation on investments, net of deferred income taxes.......         234,300              --
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total common shareholder's equity..............................       4,622,715       4,367,631
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total liabilities and shareholder's equity.....................     $46,177,454     $50,019,939
                                                                                ===========     ===========

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                      F-8

<PAGE> 79
<TABLE>
                                 CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                                   CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                         FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994, 1995 AND 1996
<CAPTION>
                                                                         1994            1995            1996
<S>                                                                   <C>            <C>             <C>
Revenues:
    Asset management and related fees (note 11)..................     $3,484,115     $24,049,683     $40,456,343
    Research services............................................             --       4,089,571      12,148,164
    Other income.................................................         57,277         663,767       1,061,855
                                                                      ----------     -----------     -----------
            Total revenues.......................................      3,541,392      28,803,021      53,666,362
                                                                      ----------     -----------     -----------

Expenses:
    Employee compensation and benefits...........................             --      12,027,224      26,001,771
    Occupancy and equipment costs................................             --       1,498,641       2,584,544
    Marketing and production costs...............................             --       2,393,281       5,281,667
    Professional services........................................        323,248       3,555,052       1,537,220
    Amortization of goodwill and other...........................             --       1,288,911       2,720,969
    Other operating expenses.....................................      1,106,147       1,748,349       3,747,838
                                                                      ----------     -----------     -----------
            Total expenses.......................................      1,429,395      22,511,458      41,874,009
                                                                      ----------     -----------     -----------
    Operating income.............................................      2,111,997       6,291,563      11,792,353
    Interest expense.............................................             --         520,523         729,088
                                                                      ----------     -----------     -----------
    Income before provision for income taxes.....................      2,111,997       5,771,040      11,063,265
    Provision for income taxes...................................        827,165       2,358,889       4,851,034
                                                                      ----------     -----------     -----------
    Net income...................................................     $1,284,832     $ 3,412,151     $ 6,212,231
                                                                      ==========     ===========     ===========
    Preferred stock dividends....................................             --         350,900         905,715
                                                                      ----------     -----------     -----------
    Net earnings available to common shareholder.................     $1,284,832     $ 3,061,251     $ 5,306,516
                                                                      ==========     ===========     ===========
    Pro forma weighted average common shares and
      equivalents outstanding....................................                                     10,871,936
    Pro forma earnings per common share and common share
      equivalents................................................                                    $      0.57

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                      F-9

<PAGE> 80
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
            CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMMON SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY
             FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994, 1995 AND 1996

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                 UNREALIZED
                                                                                                 APPRECIA-
                                                                                                    TION
                                                                                                 (DEPRECIA-
                                                                  ADDITIONAL                       TION) ON        TOTAL COMMON
                                                       COMMON      PAID IN        RETAINED       INVESTMENTS,     SHAREHOLDER'S
                                                       STOCK       CAPITAL        EARNINGS           NET              EQUITY

<S>                                                   <C>        <C>             <C>              <C>               <C>
Balance, December 31, 1993........................    $    --    $   55,000      $   737,332      $       --        $  792,332

Net income........................................                                 1,284,832                         1,284,832

Dividend on common stock..........................                                  (750,000)                         (750,000)
                                                      -------    ----------      -----------      ----------        ----------

Balance, December 31, 1994........................         --        55,000        1,272,164              --         1,327,164

Issuance of 6,710,000 shares of common stock for
  contribution of GAIMCO..........................     67,100     2,889,647       (2,956,747)                               --

Change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation)
  of investment, net of deferred income taxes.....                                                   234,300           234,300

Net income........................................                                 3,412,151                         3,412,151

Dividends on preferred stock......................                                  (350,900)                         (350,900)
                                                      -------    ----------      -----------      ----------       -----------

Balance, December 31, 1995........................     67,100     2,944,647        1,376,668         234,300         4,622,715

Change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation)
  of investment, net of deferred income taxes.....                                                  (234,300)         (234,300)

Accretion on Series A preferred stock.............                                (5,327,300)                       (5,327,300)

Net income........................................                                 6,212,231                         6,212,231

Dividends on preferred stock......................                                  (905,715)                         (905,715)
                                                      -------    ----------      -----------      ----------       -----------

Balance, December 31, 1996........................    $67,100    $2,944,647      $ 1,355,884      $       --       $ 4,367,631
                                                      =======    ==========      ===========      ==========       ===========

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-10

<PAGE> 81
<TABLE>
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
             FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994, 1995 AND 1996

<CAPTION>
                                                                      1994         1995         1996

<S>                                                                <C>         <C>          <C>
Operating activities:

    Net income...................................................  $1,284,832  $ 3,412,151  $ 6,212,231

    Adjustment for items not affecting cash:

        Depreciation and amortization............................          --      170,600      817,422

        Amortization of goodwill and other.......................          --    1,288,911    2,720,969

        Allowance for doubtful accounts..........................          --       50,000      (97,750)

        Deferred income tax provision............................          --   (1,053,875)  (1,457,941)

        Net unrealized appreciation on non-marketable
          securities.............................................          --     (191,426)    (125,654)

        Net sales of securities held for market making...........          --       34,537       35,625

        Gain on sale of marketable securities....................          --           --     (400,000)

        Accretion of discounts on short-term investments.........          --      (70,161)    (235,711)

        Changes in:

            Accounts receivable..................................    (214,040)   3,000,376    1,182,662

            Prepaid expenses and other assets....................      24,117    2,194,688    1,569,898

            Accounts payable and other accrued expenses..........          --    1,065,845     (833,147)

            Income taxes receivable..............................    (326,669)     734,930      496,051

            Due to affiliates....................................      60,135   (3,180,835)     637,578

            Deferred revenue.....................................          --    2,093,952     (868,237)

            Accrued rent liability...............................          --     (104,867)    (270,200)

            Compensation payable.................................          --   (2,839,348)   4,692,228
                                                                   ----------  -----------  -----------
                 Net cash provided by operating activities.......     828,375    6,605,478   14,076,024
                                                                   ----------  -----------  -----------

Investing activities:

    Sale of marketable securities................................          --           --    1,160,000

    Purchases of non-marketable securities.......................          --     (242,415)    (273,233)

    Proceeds from non-marketable partnership investments.........          --           --      417,568

    Purchases of equipment and other assets, net.................          --      (44,439)  (1,238,050)

    Purchases of short-term investments..........................          --   (7,769,655) (46,567,333)

    Maturities of short-term investments.........................          --    6,900,000   42,500,000

    Contribution of GAIMCO cash..................................          --    5,077,492           --

    Acquisition of Conning, net of cash acquired.................          --  (12,207,581)          --
                                                                   ----------  -----------  -----------
                 Net cash used in investing activities...........          --   (8,286,598)  (4,001,048)
                                                                   ----------  -----------  -----------

Financing activities:

    Borrowings on long term debt.................................          --   13,000,000           --

    Repayments on long term debt.................................          --   (4,000,000)  (7,000,000)

    Repayments on short term debt................................          --   (2,000,000)    (500,000)

    Other payments...............................................          --     (163,220)    (312,268)

    Issuance of Series B preferred stock.........................          --           --    2,451,800

    Dividends on common stock....................................    (750,000)          --           --

    Dividends on preferred stock.................................          --     (127,600)    (893,200)
                                                                   ----------  -----------  -----------
                 Net cash provided by (used in) financing
                   activities....................................    (750,000)   6,709,180   (6,253,668)
                                                                   ----------  -----------  -----------
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents........................      78,375    5,028,060    3,821,308

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year.....................     888,825      967,200    5,995,260
                                                                   ----------  -----------  -----------
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year...........................  $  967,200  $ 5,995,260  $ 9,816,568
                                                                   ==========  ===========  ===========

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:

Cash paid for:

    Interest.....................................................          --  $   391,921  $   446,531

    Income taxes.................................................  $1,153,834  $ 1,761,076  $ 4,546,603

Supplemental disclosure of non-cash information:

    Preferred stock issued in Conning acquisition................          --  $17,002,704           --

    Common stock issued in GAIMCO contribution...................          --   $3,011,747           --

    Accretion on Series A preferred stock........................          --           --   $5,327,300

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-11

<PAGE> 82
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1--ORGANIZATION

    Conning Corporation (the "Company"), formed in 1995 as a Missouri
corporation, is a holding company organized to hold the operating subsidiaries
in the Conning group, Conning Asset Management Company ("CAM", formerly known
as General American Investment Management Company, "GAIMCO") and Conning &
Company ("C&C"). The Company provides asset management and research services
focused upon the insurance industry. Both CAM and C&C are registered investment
advisers with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") under the
Investment Advisers Act of 1940.

    All the outstanding voting common stock of the Company is held by a
wholly-owned holding company subsidiary of General American Life Insurance
Company (together "General American"). If all of the outstanding convertible
preferred stock (see Note 9) was converted on December 31, 1996, General
American would own approximately 65% of the resulting outstanding common stock.

    On August 11, 1995, the shareholders of the holding company of C&C
contributed all of their common stock to Conning Corporation in a Section 351
merger transaction (the "Strategic Merger") in exchange for cash and
convertible preferred stock of the Company. General American contributed all of
the outstanding common stock of GAIMCO as part of the Strategic Merger in
exchange for common shares of the Company. The GAIMCO contribution was recorded
at historical book value. The Conning portion of the Strategic Merger was
accounted for using the purchase method. The purchase price consisting of cash
of $12.0 million and $17.0 million of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock was
allocated to assets acquired based on their estimated fair values. The excess
of purchase price over the fair value of net assets acquired resulted in $20.3
million of goodwill which is being amortized on a straight line basis over 20
years.

    The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of
Conning Corporation, Conning Inc. (the holding company parent of C&C), Conning
& Company and Conning Asset Management Company. The historical financial
statement includes the operations and financial position of GAIMCO through July
31, 1995, and consolidated operations thereafter, and consolidated financial
position as of December 31, 1995 and 1996.

                                     F-12

<PAGE> 83
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 2--PRO FORMA RESULTS (UNAUDITED)

    The table below contains unaudited pro forma summary financial information
for the year ended December 31, 1995, and for comparative purposes, summary
financial information condensed from the audited financial statements for the
year ended December 31, 1996. The pro forma 1995 information was derived from
the historical financial statements for Conning Corporation, GAIMCO and Conning
Inc. and gives effect to (i) the Strategic Merger, (ii) the issuance of $13.0
million of debt by the Company at an interest rate of 7% per annum for the
purpose of providing the $12.0 million cash portion of purchase price and
payments of $1.0 million representing employment bonuses to certain employees,
(iii) the issuance of $17.0 million of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock and
(iv) the short term borrowing of $2.5 million from General American at an
interest rate of 6.75% per annum by Conning Inc. effective prior to, and in
anticipation of, the Strategic Merger for the purpose of redeeming and retiring
the 8% cumulative senior preferred stock. The pro forma information has been
prepared assuming these transactions and arrangements were effected on January
1, 1995.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 DECEMBER 31,    DECEMBER 31,
                                                                     1995            1996
                                                                 -----------     -----------
                                                                  PRO FORMA
                                                                 (UNAUDITED)        ACTUAL
<S>                                                              <C>             <C>
Revenues:
    Asset management and related fees.......................     $30,674,994     $40,456,343
    Research services.......................................       9,480,364      12,148,164
    Other income............................................         995,605       1,061,855
                                                                 -----------     -----------
            Total revenues..................................      41,150,963      53,666,362
                                                                 -----------     -----------
Expenses:
    Employee compensation and benefits......................      18,336,044      26,001,771
    Amortization of goodwill and other......................       2,911,384       2,720,969
    Other operating expenses................................      12,514,187      13,151,269
                                                                 -----------     -----------
    Operating income........................................       7,389,348      11,792,353
    Interest expense........................................       1,364,547         729,088
                                                                 -----------     -----------
    Income before provision for income taxes................       6,024,801      11,063,265
    Provision for income taxes..............................       2,738,954       4,851,034
                                                                 -----------     -----------
    Net income..............................................     $ 3,285,847     $ 6,212,231
                                                                 ===========     ===========
    Preferred stock dividends...............................         905,715         905,715
                                                                 -----------     -----------
    Net earnings available to common shareholder............     $ 2,380,132     $ 5,306,516
                                                                 ===========     ===========
    Pro forma earnings per common share and common share
      equivalents...........................................     $      0.30     $      0.57
</TABLE>

    Pro forma earnings per share is computed by dividing net income by the
weighted average number of shares of common stock and common stock equivalents
considered outstanding during the period after giving effect to all dilutive
common stock and common stock equivalent shares issued within twelve months of
the public offering of the Company's common stock. For the purpose of this
calculation, outstanding shares of Series A and Series B Convertible Preferred
Stock are considered common stock equivalent shares.

                                     F-13

<PAGE> 84
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

    The table below contains unaudited pro forma summary financial information
for the year ended December 31, 1994 and was derived from the historical
financial statements for Conning Corporation, GAIMCO and Conning Inc. and gives
effect to (i) the Strategic Merger, (ii) the issuance of $13.0 million of debt
by the Company at an interest rate of 7% per annum for the purpose of providing
the $12.0 million cash portion of purchase price and payments of $1.0 million
representing employment bonuses to certain employees, (iii) the issuance of
$17.0 million of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock and (iv) the short term
borrowing of $2.5 million from General American at an interest rate of 6.75%
per annum by Conning Inc. effective prior to, and in anticipation of the
Strategic Merger for the purpose of redeeming and retiring the 8% cumulative
senior preferred stock. The pro forma information has been prepared assuming
these transactions and arrangements were effected on January 1, 1994.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       DECEMBER 31,
                                                           1994
                                                       -----------
                                                        PRO FORMA
                                                       (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                    <C>
Revenues..........................................     $22,016,698
                                                       -----------
Expenses:
    Operating expenses............................      16,689,461
    Amortization of goodwill and other............       2,911,384
                                                       -----------
    Operating income..............................       2,415,853
    Interest expense..............................       1,395,528
                                                       -----------
    Income before provision for income taxes......       1,020,325
    Provision for income taxes....................         919,014
                                                       -----------
    Net income....................................     $   101,311
                                                       ===========
    Preferred stock dividends.....................         905,715
                                                       -----------
    Net loss attributable to common
      shareholders................................     $  (804,404)
                                                       ===========
</TABLE>

    The pro forma information presented in the previous two tables is not
necessarily indicative of the results that would have been obtained had the
transactions and arrangements taken effect on the assumed date, nor is the
information intended to be a projection for any future period.

NOTE 3--SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

    The accompanying consolidated financial statements of the Company have been
prepared in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. For
accounting purposes the Strategic Merger was effective at the close of business
July 31, 1995. The contribution of GAIMCO to the Company as a result of the
Strategic Merger is treated as a combination of entities under common control,
using historical cost basis accounting.

    Principles of Consolidation--The consolidated financial statements include
the accounts of the Company and its subsidiaries after elimination of
intercompany balances and transactions.

    Revenue Recognition--Asset management fees are determined based on
contractual provisions and are earned at varying percentages of the assets
under management. Such fees are accrued into income in the period in which the
service is provided. Research fees, primarily in the form of commissions
derived from securities transactions effected by the Company and, to a lesser
extent, subscription fees for research publications, are recorded in income
when services are provided or earned. Mortgage loan fee income, included in
Asset Management and Related Fees, is earned through the origination of
mortgage loans for General American, its affiliates and outside parties. The
fees earned are based on agreements with the borrowers and is recognized at the
closing of the mortgage commitment.

                                     F-14

<PAGE> 85
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

Deferred mortgage loan origination fees represent moneys received for loan
commitments that will be earned upon loan funding and are included in deferred
revenue on the consolidated balance sheet.

    Cash and Cash Equivalents--Cash and cash equivalents represent cash and
highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less. The
Company had funds on deposit with General American amounting to $5,386,747 and
$6,449,642 at December 31, 1995 and 1996, which were readily convertible to
cash and earns interest at the short-term money market rates. For purposes of
the financial statements, such funds are considered cash equivalents.

    Short-Term Investments--Short-term investments are comprised of U.S.
Government Securities and investment grade commercial paper having a maturity
of one year or less and are carried at amortized cost, which approximates fair
value.

    Investments--Marketable equity securities classified as trading securities
are presented at fair value with corresponding unrealized gains or losses
included in current period income. Marketable equity securities classified as
available-for-sale are presented at fair value with corresponding unrealized
gains or losses included as a separate component of shareholder's equity, net
of deferred income taxes. Non-marketable investments in various private equity
funds are held by the Company's broker-dealer subsidiary in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles for broker-dealers. Such investments
are recorded using the equity method basis of accounting (including unrealized
gains and losses). The changes in fair values are included in the consolidated
statements of income.

    Equipment and Leasehold Improvements--Equipment is stated at cost, less
accumulated depreciation provided on an accelerated method over periods not
exceeding eight years. Leasehold improvements are stated at cost less,
accumulated amortization provided on a straight-line basis over the term of the
lease.

    Income Taxes--Income tax expense is based on income reported in the
financial statements. Deferred federal and state income taxes are provided
based on an asset and liability approach which requires the recognition of
deferred income tax assets and liabilities for the expected future tax
consequences of temporary differences between the financial statement carrying
amounts and the tax basis of assets and liabilities. The Company files
consolidated federal income tax returns with its subsidiaries.

    Goodwill--Goodwill arising from the Strategic Merger is being amortized on
a straight-line basis over a period of 20 years. Accumulated amortization was
$422,105 and $1,435,152 as of December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
Goodwill is periodically reviewed to determine recoverability based on the
discounted operating cash flows of the underlying business. At December 31,
1995 and 1996, no impairment was indicated.

    Other Assets--Included in other assets are costs associated with the
purchase of a software license agreement (the "License Agreement") effective
as of January 27, 1996. The total cost of the license is being amortized over
the life of the License Agreement. As of December 31, 1996, $1,388,332 remains
to be amortized over the four remaining years of the License Agreement. Total
amortization of $311,667 is included in the consolidated statements of income
for the year ended December 31, 1996. Also included in other assets is the
unamortized cost of compensation relating to the Strategic Merger that is being
amortized over a three year period ending August 11, 1998. Amortization of
$866,806 and $1,707,918 is included in the consolidated statements of income
for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively. The unamortized
amount of $4,133,194 and $2,425,276 is included in other assets as of December
31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.

    Compensation Payable--Compensation payable represents amounts payable to
employees as a result of the Company's incentive compensation programs during
the normal course of operations. Amounts are accrued in the period earned.

    Accrued Rent Liability--The Company has recorded as a liability the present
value of the difference between a market rate lease and the contract rate in
the lease for the Company's office space in Hartford, Connecticut as part of
the fair value adjustments relating to the Strategic Merger. This difference is
being amortized as a reduction of rent expense over the remaining lease period.

                                     F-15

<PAGE> 86
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

    Preferred Stock--The carrying value of the convertible preferred stock is
at original issue price plus accretion relating to any increase in the
redemption value of the stock during the period. During 1995 and 1996, such
accretion was $0 and $5,327,300, respectively.

    Other Income--Other income is comprised of investment income and other
miscellaneous revenues.

    Non-cash employee compensation--The Company uses the intrinsic value method
to account for stock option plans as prescribed by the Accounting Principles
Board Opinion No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees" ("APB
25"). Under this method, compensation expense is recognized for awards of
options to purchase shares of stock to employees under compensatory plans only
if the fair market value of the stock at the option grant date (or other
measurement date, if later) is greater than the amount the employee must pay to
acquire the stock. In October 1995, the Financial Accounting Standards Board
issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123, "Accounting for
Stock-Based Compensation" ("FAS 123"). FAS 123 permits companies to adopt a
new fair value based method to account for stock option plans or to continue
using the intrinsic value method. The Company intends to continue using the
intrinsic value method and provides the pro forma disclosures in Note 12, as
required by FAS 123.

    Use of estimates--Management of the Company has made a number of estimates
and assumptions relating to the reporting of assets and liabilities in the
preparation of the financial statements. Actual results could differ from these
estimates.

    Reclassifications--Certain amounts have been reclassified in prior years to
conform to 1996 presentation.

NOTE 4--ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE

    Accounts receivable include primarily amounts due for management fees,
selling concessions due from underwriters and amounts due from other business
activities of the Company. At December 31, 1995 and 1996, an allowance for
doubtful accounts of $262,750 and $165,000 was applied as a reduction of
accounts receivable, respectively. The change in the allowance in the current
period was the result of management's assessment of the collectibility of the
underlying receivables.

NOTE 5--INVESTMENTS

    At December 31, 1995 and 1996, the estimated fair value of marketable and
non-marketable investments were as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          1995           1996
<S>                                                    <C>            <C>
Marketable equity securities--trading (cost
  $83,600 and $46,250)............................     $   81,250     $   45,625
Marketable equity securities--Available-for-sale
  (cost $760,000).................................      1,160,000             --
                                                       ----------     ----------
    Total marketable securities...................     $1,241,250     $   45,625
                                                       ==========     ==========
Non-marketable equity securities (cost $5,000)....     $    9,250     $   10,945
Non-marketable partnership investments (cost
  $1,554,524 and $1,448,968)......................      1,766,363      1,745,986
                                                       ----------     ----------
    Total non-marketable investments..............     $1,775,613     $1,756,931
                                                       ==========     ==========
</TABLE>

    The Company is a 1% general partner in various private equity funds. The
value of the non-marketable partnership investments is accounted for using the
equity method and updated periodically based upon changes in fair values and
recorded in the consolidated statements of income. Additionally, the Company
had no derivative investments during 1995 and 1996.

                                     F-16

<PAGE> 87
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 6--EQUIPMENT AND LEASEHOLD IMPROVEMENTS

    At December 31, 1995 and 1996, equipment and leasehold improvements
comprised the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           1995          1996
<S>                                                    <C>            <C>
Office equipment..................................     $  436,519     $  641,421
Computer equipment................................        442,685        468,950
Leasehold improvements............................        255,528        267,553
                                                       ----------     ----------
                                                        1,134,732      1,377,924
Less accumulated depreciation and amortization....        170,600        562,812
                                                       ----------     ----------
                                                       $  964,132     $  815,112
                                                       ==========     ==========
</TABLE>

    Depreciation expense of $0, $170,600 and $447,070 on the above is included
in the consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 1994,
1995 and 1996, respectively. The Company owned no equipment or leasehold
improvements during 1994.

    The Company occupies premises and rents certain office equipment under
leases that are accounted for as operating leases and that have expiration
dates through 2005. At December 31, 1996, the minimum net rental commitments of
the Company for the periods indicated under the terms of these operating leases
in excess of one year were approximately $6,342,000 as follows: $927,000 in
1997; $811,000 in 1998; $658,000 per year from 1999 to 2005.

NOTE 7--INCOME TAXES

    Prior to the Strategic Merger, GAIMCO was included in the consolidated
Federal income tax returns of General American and its provisions for income
taxes have been computed as if GAIMCO had filed a separate return. The
provision for Federal and state income tax for the years ended December 31,
1994, 1995 and 1996, is as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               1994          1995           1996
<S>                                          <C>          <C>            <C>
Current income tax provision............     $827,165     $1,755,497     $4,651,708
Deferred income tax provision...........           --        603,392        199,326
                                             --------     ----------     ----------
Total income tax provision..............     $827,165     $2,358,889     $4,851,034
                                             ========     ==========     ==========
</TABLE>

    The differences between the expected United States Federal income tax
provision at the statutory rate of 35% for 1994, 1995 and 1996 and the
Company's actual Federal income tax rate are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                1994           1995            1996
<S>                                          <C>            <C>            <C>
Income before income taxes..............     $2,111,997     $5,771,040     $11,063,265
Federal income taxes at statutory
  rate..................................        739,198      2,019,864       3,872,143
Increases in income taxes resulting
  from:
    State tax, net of Federal...........         85,221        219,974         619,251
    Amortization of goodwill............             --        147,737         354,568
    Other, net..........................          2,746        (28,686)          5,072
                                             ----------     ----------     -----------
Federal income tax provision............     $  827,165     $2,358,889     $ 4,851,034
                                             ==========     ==========     ===========
</TABLE>

                                     F-17

<PAGE> 88
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

    The components of deferred income taxes for the years ended December 31,
1995 and 1996 are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                1995         1996
<S>                                          <C>         <C>
Accrued rent liability..................     $ 43,441    $  82,612
Employee costs..........................       54,759     (706,227)
Partnership investments.................       97,821      168,972
Accrued expense reserves................      421,657      252,396
Other, net..............................      (14,286)     401,573
                                             --------    ---------
Total deferred income tax provision.....     $603,392    $ 199,326
                                             ========    =========
</TABLE>

    The Company's net deferred income tax assets represent the estimated future
tax effects attributable to future taxable or deductible temporary difference
between amounts recognized in the financial statements and income tax returns.
At December 31, 1995 and 1996, the net deferred income tax asset is as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                1995            1996
<S>                                          <C>            <C>
Accrued rent liability..................     $1,621,496     $1,538,884
Employee costs..........................        160,420        203,228
Other, net..............................        641,531        389,135
                                             ----------     ----------
Gross deferred income tax assets........      2,423,447      2,131,247
Valuation allowance.....................             --             --
                                             ----------     ----------
Deferred income tax assets, net of
  valuation allowance...................      2,423,447      2,131,247
                                             ----------     ----------
Depreciation............................       (152,162)      (192,324)
Unrealized appreciation on
  investments...........................       (314,830)            --
Employee costs..........................       (285,315)      (132,421)
Partnership investments.................        (64,671)      (233,643)
                                             ----------     ----------
Gross deferred income tax liabilities...       (816,978)      (558,388)
                                             ----------     ----------
Net deferred income tax assets..........     $1,606,469     $1,572,859
                                             ==========     ==========
</TABLE>

    A valuation allowance is provided when it is more likely than not that some
portion of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. Management believes
the deferred tax assets will be fully realized in the future based upon
consideration of the reversal of existing temporary differences, anticipated
future earnings, and all other available evidence. Accordingly, no valuation
allowance is established.

NOTE 8--DEBT

Long term:

    On August 11, 1995, the Company borrowed $13,000,000 from General American
to fund certain payments made in connection with the Strategic Merger. Interest
is payable on January 1 and September 1 at an annual rate of 7.0%. Principal
payments are due in three equal annual installments of $4,333,333 commencing
September 1, 2003. The Company prepaid $4,000,000 and $7,000,000 of principal
plus accrued interest of $323,750 and $412,805 in 1995 and 1996, respectively.
Management estimates the carrying value of long term debt approximates fair
value.

    On February 26, 1997, the Company paid the remaining $2,000,000 outstanding
on its long term debt along with accrued interest expense of $27,222.

Short term:

    On August 11, 1995, the Company borrowed $2,500,000 from General American
to fund certain payments made in connection with the Strategic Merger. Interest
is payable on January 1 and August 1 at an annual rate of 6.75%.

                                     F-18

<PAGE> 89
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

Principal is due on August 11, 1996. The Company prepaid $2,000,000 and
$500,000 of principal plus accrued interest of $58,688 and $14,250 during 1995
and 1996, respectively, which is included in the consolidated statements of
income.

Lines of credit:

    At December 31, 1995 the Company had a line of credit with a commercial
bank for $1,200,000. During 1996, the Company terminated the line of credit.
There were no outstanding borrowings during 1995.

    At December 31, 1995 and 1996, the Company had a Revolving Subordinated
Loan Agreement (the "Agreement") with a commercial bank for $2,000,000. The
interest rate is agreed upon by the lender and the Company at the time of an
advance. The Agreement expires on December 31, 1997. During 1996, the Company
borrowed $2,000,000 for less than one week. There were no borrowings during
1995.

NOTE 9--PREFERRED STOCK

    The preferred stock of the Company is subject to the Shareholders Agreement
and consists of (i) Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, par value $.01 per
share and (ii) Series B Convertible Preferred Stock, par value $.01 per share.

    At December 31, 1995 and 1996, 3,190,000 shares of Series A Convertible
Preferred Stock (the "Series A Preferred Stock") were authorized, issued and
outstanding. The Series A Preferred Stock pays dividends quarterly based on the
90 day United States Treasury Bill rate in effect on the previous payment date.
Such dividends are cumulative. The Company declared dividends on the Series A
Preferred Stock of $0.11 and $0.28 for the years ended December 31, 1995 and
1996, respectively. Declared but unpaid dividends totaling $223,300 are
included in the Preferred Dividends Payable on the consolidated balance sheet
at December 31, 1995 and 1996. The Series A Preferred Stock carries no voting
rights and was issued as part of the Strategic Merger. Each share of Series A
Preferred Stock is convertible into one share of Non-Voting Common Stock at the
holder's election, or Voting Common Stock upon an initial public offering
(IPO). Pursuant to the Shareholders Agreement, if no IPO has occurred prior to
August 11, 1998, the holders have a right to put their shares to General
American at any time thereafter at fair value.

    On November 8, 1996, the Company commenced a private offering to certain
employees and directors. This offering was for a new class of preferred stock
designated Series B Convertible Preferred Stock (the "Series B Preferred
Stock"). A total of 460,000 shares were sold at $5.33 per share adding
$2,451,800 to preferred stock. In order to exercise the conversion, payment to
the Company of an additional $1.67 per share is required.

    At December 31, 1996, 600,000 shares of Series B Preferred Stock were
authorized and 460,000 shares were issued and outstanding. The Series B
Preferred Stock pays dividends quarterly at a rate of 5% per annum and such
dividends are cumulative. Declared but unpaid dividends totaling $12,515 are
included in Preferred Dividends Payable on the consolidated balance sheet at
December 31, 1996. The Series B Preferred Stock carries no voting rights. Each
share of Series B Preferred Stock is convertible into one share of Non-Voting
Common Stock at the holder's election and upon payment of the additional $1.67
per share to the Company.

    During January 1997, the Company issued an additional 15,000 shares of
Series B Preferred Stock at $5.33 per share. If no IPO has occurred prior to
November 22, 2001, the holders of the Series B Preferred Stock have a right to
put their shares to the Company at any time thereafter at fair value.

NOTE 10--SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY

    The board of directors of the Company is authorized to issue up to
20,000,000 shares each of Voting Common Stock and Non-Voting Common Stock, each
with a par value of $.01 per share.

                                     F-19

<PAGE> 90
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 11--OTHER RELATED PARTY ACTIVITIES

    CAM acts as an investment adviser for the general and separate accounts of
General American and its insurance subsidiaries as well as the General American
Capital Company family of funds. Investment management fees earned from these
affiliated entities for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996
amounted to $2,618,635, $12,573,489 and $14,300,267 respectively. The total
investment management fees receivable from these affiliated entities at
December 31, 1995 and 1996 amounted to $825,924 and $1,042,294, respectively.
Certain officers and directors of the Company are also officers of General
American and officers and/or directors of other General American affiliates.

    The Company is directly or indirectly, through intermediary partnerships,
the managing general partner of certain private equity funds with an equity
ownership interest of 1% in each fund. In total, the Company managed zero,
seven and five funds during 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively. Fees for
managing these funds were $0, $1,295,330 and $4,006,038 for the years ended
December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively.

    The Company received underwriting fees and concessions in connection with
the offering of shares of two companies which were partially owned by certain
private equity funds managed by the Company. Such fees and concessions are
included in research services and related fees and amounted to $0, $0 and
$2,177,269 for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996.

    In connection with the November 8, 1996 private offering of Series B
Preferred Stock, General American holds demand recourse notes from certain
employees totaling $2,185,300. The notes bear interest of 6% which is payable
semi-annually beginning July 1997.

    General American provides administrative services on request of the Company
including disbursements, tax, facility management and other administrative
support to the Company pursuant to an administrative services agreement. The
following table list the expenses recorded by the Company for significant
services provided by General American for the years ended December 31, 1995 and
1996:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                      1995            1996
<S>                                <C>             <C>
Employee costs................     $ 6,341,164     $ 7,103,724

Administrative accounting
fees..........................       2,108,624       2,765,129

Marketing and production
costs.........................         753,091       1,076,195

Professional services.........         802,221       1,002,482

Rent..........................         624,414         612,822

Computer services.............          50,591         118,008

All other operating costs.....       1,627,998       1,932,861
                                   -----------     -----------

                                   $12,308,103     $14,611,221
                                   ===========     ===========
</TABLE>

    Costs for the year ended December 31, 1994 were not broken out in the
components listed above, but rather were charged as one administrative fee in
the amount of $871,221 and were included in other operating expenses.

    The above administrative costs are predominantly based on direct
indentifiable costs incurred by General American on behalf of the Company and
at the Company's request and are charged back to the Company at General
American's cost. Where costs represent the result of allocations, such
allocations are based on customary methodology such as square footage for rent
and number of employees for payroll processing. The Company believes that such
allocation methodologies are reasonable and that the resulting expenses
incurred are not materially different from those that would have been incurred
on a stand-alone basis.

                                     F-20

<PAGE> 91
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 12--STOCK OPTIONS

    On August 11, 1995, the shareholders approved the Company's 1995 Flexible
Stock Plan which provides for the grant of options to purchase up to 2,100,000
shares of the Company's Non-Voting Common Stock to officers and other key
employees of the Company and its affiliates. Terms and conditions (including
price, exercise date and number of shares) are determined by the Board of
Directors, which administers the plan. In the event of an initial public
offering the options become 100% vested. All options were granted at fair
value.

    On November 8, 1996, the shareholders approved the Company's 1996 Flexible
Stock Plan which provides for the grant of options to purchase up to 2,100,000
shares of the Company's Non-Voting Common Stock to officers and other key
employees of the Company and its affiliates. Terms and conditions (including
price, exercise date and number of shares) are determined by the Board of
Directors, which administers the plan.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         WEIGHTED AVERAGE
                                               NUMBER OF SHARES           EXERCISE PRICE
                                            ----------------------      -------------------
                                             DEC. 31,     DEC. 31,      DEC. 31,    DEC. 31,
                                              1995         1996          1995         1996

<S>                                         <C>          <C>             <C>          <C>
Outstanding, beginning of year..........           --    1,000,000       $  --        $5.33

Granted.................................    1,000,000      230,000        5.33         7.00

Exercised...............................           --           --          --           --

Canceled................................           --           --          --           --
                                            ---------    ---------       -----        -----

Outstanding, end of year................    1,000,000    1,230,000       $5.33        $5.64
                                            =========    =========       =====        =====
Exercisable, end of year................           --      200,000       $  --        $5.33
                                            =========    =========       =====        =====
</TABLE>

    The Company applies APB Opinion No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to
Employees," ("APB 25"), in accounting for both the 1996 and 1995 Flexible
Stock Plans and, accordingly, no compensation cost has been recognized for its
stock options in the financial statements. The weighted-average grant-date fair
value of stock options granted during the year and the weighted-average
significant assumptions used to determine those fair values, using a modified
Black-Scholes option pricing model, and the pro forma effect on earnings of the
fair value accounting for stock options under FAS 123 are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    1995            1996
<S>                                                              <C>            <C>
Grant-date fair value per share.............................     $     0.91  $        1.13

Significant assumptions:

    Risk-free interest rate at grant date...................           6.05%          5.70%

    Expected dividend payout................................     $        0     $        0

    Expected stock price volatility.........................            n/a            n/a

    Expected life to exercise (years).......................            2.5            2.5

Net Income..............................  As reported.......     $3,412,151     $6,212,231

                                          Pro forma.........     $3,336,484     $6,026,307

Pro forma earnings per common share.....  As reported.......                    $     0.57

                                          Pro forma.........                    $     0.55
</TABLE>

NOTE 13--EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

    The Company has two retirement savings plans, a 401(k) Savings Plan (the
"401(k) Plan") and the General American Life Insurance Company Progress
Sharing Plan and Trust (the "Progress Sharing Plan"). The 401(k) Plan is
available to substantially all Conning employees who were employed by Conning
prior to the Strategic Merger. The Progress Sharing Plan is available to all
employees employed by GAIMCO prior to the Strategic Merger and all employees
employed subsequent to the Strategic Merger. The Company contributed $0,
$286,170 and $547,127 on

                                     F-21

<PAGE> 92
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

behalf of eligible employees for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and
1996, respectively. Direct charges to the Company from General American for the
Progress Sharing Plan were approximately $22,000, $359,000 and $310,000 for the
years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996 which is included in the charges
for administrative services from General American. One of the investment
vehicles offered in the 401(k) Plan is managed by Conning.

    Pension Plan--Substantially all personnel who were employees of GAIMCO
prior to the Strategic Merger were eligible for a defined benefit plan
sponsored by General American through December 31, 1996. All costs are born and
retained by General American. The plan is over funded as of December 31, 1995
and 1996. Therefore, no charges were made by General American to GAIMCO.

NOTE 14--LITIGATION

    One legal claim has arisen against Conning & Company during the normal
course of the Company's non-securities and non-investment advisory services
businesses. Although the matter is subject to uncertainty, as it remains in the
preliminary stages and discovery has not been completed, the Company believes
that Conning & Company has meritorious defenses to all claims and that the
probable outcome should not have a material adverse effect upon the Company,
its liquidity or its operations.

NOTE 15--COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

    The Company through its subsidiary is, directly or through intermediary
partnerships, a 1% general partner in certain private equity funds that the
Company also manages. Capital contributions by the partners are called as
needed for investments by the funds. At December 31, 1996, the Company's future
commitment to fund such required capital contributions was approximately
$273,000.

    The Company through its subsidiary has committed to Conning Connecticut
Investors, L.L.C. (the "L.L.C."), a limited liability company of which the
Company is the general partner and managing member, up to approximately
$4,040,000 for purposes of capitalizing the general partner. The amount is
payable only in the event of insolvency on the part of the L.L.C.

NOTE 16--NET CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS

    C&C is a registered broker-dealer and a member of the National Association
of Securities Dealers, Inc. and therefore is subject to a requirement of the
SEC's Uniform Net Capital Rule, requiring the maintenance of certain minimal
capital levels. At December 31, 1996, C&C had net capital, as defined by the
Uniform Net Capital Rule, of $2,428,221 which was $1,824,367 in excess of the
required net capital. CAM is also subject to minimum net capital requirements
which are determined by state regulations in each of the states in which CAM is
licensed to do business. As of December 31, 1996 and 1995, CAM was in
compliance with all minimum state requirements.

NOTE 17--CONCENTRATION OF CREDIT RISK

    Financial instruments which potentially subject the Company to
concentration of credit risk consist principally of trade account receivables
and short term investments. Short term investments consist of investment grade
commercial paper and approximate fair value because of the short maturity of
these items. With the exception of trade receivables from General American and
its affiliates, credit risk with respect to trade accounts receivable is
limited due to the large number of customers and their dispersion across
geographical areas. Investment management fees receivable from General American
and their affiliated entities at December 31, 1995 and 1996 amounted to
$825,924 and $1,042,294 respectively.

NOTE 18--PRO FORMA EARNINGS PER SHARE

    Pro forma earnings per share for the year ended December 31, 1996 is
computed by dividing net income by the weighted average number of shares of
common stock and dilutive common stock equivalents. For the purpose of this

                                     F-22

<PAGE> 93
                     CONNING CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

calculation, outstanding shares of Series A and Series B Convertible Preferred
Stock and stock options are considered common stock equivalent shares for all
periods presented. Pursuant to Securities and Exchange Commission Staff
Accounting Bulletin No. 83, all common and common equivalent shares issued
during the twelve month period prior to the date of the initial filing of the
Company's Registration Statement have been included in the calculation, using
the treasury stock method, as if they were outstanding for all periods
presented. Specifically such common and common equivalent shares are comprised
of (i) 475,000 shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock issued during
such period (see Note 9), (ii) 230,000 options granted in 1996 (see Note 11)
and (iii) 7,500 options granted in January 1997. The assumed initial public
offering price for the purposes of this calculation only was $13.50 per share.

    Given that only 1996 results include full consolidated operations (see Note
1), the Company believes that presentation of historical earnings per share
prior to 1996 would not be meaningful.

NOTE 19--INDUSTRY SEGMENT

    The Company is primarily engaged in a single line of business as a provider
of investment management services, which comprises several types of services,
such as discretionary asset management, investment accounting and reporting
services, mortgage origination and servicing, private equity investments and
institutional investment research. These activities constitute a single
business segment.

NOTE 20--NEW ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENT

    In February 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued SFAS No.
128, "Earnings Per Share". SFAS No. 128 specifies new standards designed to
improve the earnings per share ("EPS") information provided in financial
statements by simplifying the existing computational guidelines, reviewing the
disclosure requirements and increasing the comparability of EPS data on an
international basis. Some of the changes made to simplify the EPS computations
include: (a) eliminating the presentation of primary EPS and replacing it with
basic EPS, with the principal difference being that common stock equivalents
are not considered in computing basic EPS, (b) eliminating the modified
treasury stock method and the three percent materiality provision and (c)
revising the contingent share provisions and the supplemental EPS data
requirements. SFAS No. 128 also makes a number of changes to existing
disclosure requirements. SFAS No. 128 is effective for financial statements
issued for periods ending after December 15, 1997, including interim periods.
The Company has not yet determined the impact of the implementation of SFAS No.
128.

NOTE 21--SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

    In June, 1997, General American, pursuant to a call right, purchased
1,594,995 shares of the Company's Series A Preferred Stock from existing
shareholders for $11.25 per share.

    In September, 1997, the Company filed a preliminary registration statement
with the SEC to register 2,500,000 shares of Common Stock (excluding the
over-allotment option) to be sold by the Company in an initial public offering.

                                     F-23

<PAGE> 94
                                  SCHEDULE I

                              CONNING CORPORATION
                             (PARENT COMPANY ONLY)

                           CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                ---------------------------
                                                                                   1995            1996
<S>                                                                             <C>             <C>
                                  ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents..................................................     $        --     $   424,263
Investments in subsidiaries................................................      31,079,378      31,230,081
Due from affiliates........................................................          30,150              --
Capitalized software, less accumulated depreciation of $0 and $311,667.....              --       1,388,333
Prepaid expenses and other assets..........................................          94,400           4,418
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total assets...................................................     $31,203,928     $33,047,095
                                                                                ===========     ===========
                   LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY
Book overdraft.............................................................     $   349,959     $        --
Accrued expenses...........................................................         228,550         241,648
Due to affiliates..........................................................              --         848,282
Long term debt.............................................................       9,000,000       2,000,000
Other payable..............................................................              --         640,000
Deferred liabilities.......................................................              --         167,730
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total liabilities..............................................       9,578,509       3,897,660
                                                                                -----------     -----------
Series A convertible preferred stock, $.01 par value: 3,190,000 shares
  authorized, issued and outstanding.......................................      17,002,704      22,330,004
Series B convertible preferred stock, $.01 par value: 600,000 shares
  authorized, 460,000 issued and outstanding...............................              --       2,451,800
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total convertible preferred stock..............................      17,002,704      24,781,804
                                                                                -----------     -----------
Common stock, $.01 par value: 20,000,000 shares authorized; 6,710,000
  shares issued and outstanding............................................          67,100          67,100
Additional paid in capital.................................................       2,944,647       2,944,647
Retained earnings..........................................................       1,376,668       1,355,884
Unrealized appreciation on investments, net of deferred income taxes.......         234,300              --
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total common shareholder's equity..............................       4,622,715       4,367,631
                                                                                -----------     -----------
            Total liabilities and shareholder's equity.....................     $31,203,928     $33,047,095
                                                                                ===========     ===========

           See accompanying notes to condensed financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-24

<PAGE> 95
<TABLE>
                                    CONNING CORPORATION
                                   (PARENT COMPANY ONLY)

                              CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                      FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND 1996

<CAPTION>
                                                                         1995           1996
<S>                                                                   <C>            <C>
Revenues:
    Dividend from subsidiary.....................................     $4,546,667     $5,925,000
    Management advisory fees.....................................             --        300,000
    Other income.................................................          5,291          5,644
                                                                      ----------     ----------
            Total revenues.......................................      4,551,958      6,230,644
                                                                      ----------     ----------

Expenses:
    Other expenses...............................................         18,317         67,899
    Interest expense.............................................        329,000        413,389
                                                                      ----------     ----------
            Total expenses.......................................        347,317        481,288
                                                                      ----------     ----------
    Income before benefit from income taxes......................      4,204,641      5,749,356
    Benefit from income taxes....................................        130,399         77,871
                                                                      ----------     ----------
    Income before equity in undistributed earnings of
      subsidiaries, net of taxes.................................      4,335,040      5,827,227
    Equity in undistributed earnings (loss) of subsidiaries, net
      of taxes...................................................       (922,889)       385,004
                                                                      ----------     ----------
    Net income...................................................      3,412,151      6,212,231
    Preferred stock dividends....................................        350,900        905,715
                                                                      ----------     ----------
    Net earnings available to common shareholders................     $3,061,251     $5,306,516
                                                                      ==========     ==========

           See accompanying notes to condensed financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-25

<PAGE> 96
<TABLE>
                              CONNING CORPORATION
                             (PARENT COMPANY ONLY)

                      CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND 1996

<CAPTION>
                                                         1995            1996
<S>                                                  <C>             <C>
Operating activities:
    Net income....................................   $  3,412,151    $  6,212,231
    Adjustment for items not affecting cash:
        Amortization of capitalized software......             --         311,667
        Changes in:
            Investment in subsidiaries............     (4,854,296)     (6,310,003)
            Due to/from affiliates................        (30,150)        878,432
            Prepaid expenses and other assets.....        (94,400)         89,982
            Accrued expenses......................        228,550          13,098
            Deferred liabilities..................             --         167,730
                                                     ------------    ------------
                Net cash provided by (used in)
                   operating activities...........     (1,338,145)      1,363,137
                                                     ------------    ------------
Investing activities:
    Purchase of software..........................             --        (940,000)
    Dividends received from subsidiaries..........      4,546,667       5,925,000
                                                     ------------    ------------
                Net cash provided by investing
                   activities.....................      4,546,667       4,985,000
                                                     ------------    ------------
Financing activities:
    Borrowings on long term debt..................     13,000,000              --
    Repayments on long term debt..................     (4,000,000)     (7,000,000)
    Repayments on other payables..................             --        (120,000)
    Acquisition of Conning, net of cash
      acquired....................................    (12,207,581)             --
    Issuance of Series B preferred stock..........             --       2,451,800
    Dividends on preferred stock..................       (350,900)       (905,715)
                                                     ------------    ------------
                Net cash provided by (used in)
                   financing activities...........     (3,558,481)     (5,573,915)
                                                     ------------    ------------
Net change in cash and cash equivalents...........       (349,959)        774,222
Book overdraft, beginning of year.................             --        (349,959)
                                                     ------------    ------------
Cash and cash equivalents (book overdraft), end of
  year............................................   $   (349,959)   $    424,263
                                                     ============    ============
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:
    Cash paid for:
        Interest..................................   $    323,750    $    412,806
        Income taxes..............................             --              --
    Supplemental disclosure of non-cash
      information:
        Contribution of GAIMCO....................   $  1,327,164              --
        Accretion on Series A Preferred Stock.....             --    $  5,327,300

           See accompanying notes to condensed financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-26

<PAGE> 97
                              CONNING CORPORATION
                             (PARENT COMPANY ONLY)

                    NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                          DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND 1996

NOTE 1--ORGANIZATION

    The condensed financial statements of Conning Corporation (the "Company")
should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements of
Conning Corporation and Subsidiaries and the notes thereto. Investment in
subsidiary is accounted for under the equity method.

NOTE 2--RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

    During 1996, the Company provided the use of its software to its
subsidiaries through administrative services agreements. Charges were $312,000
during 1996 which approximated the amortization of the software during the
period.

    The amount of cash dividends paid to the Company by consolidated
subsidiaries of the Company amounted to approximately $4,547,000 and $5,925,000
for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively. There are no
restrictions on the payment of dividends, except for those stipulated by
certain regulatory authorities applicable to Conning & Company. Conning &
Company's ability to pay dividends is limited to capital in excess of a defined
minimum requirement as set forth in Securities and Exchange Commission Rule
15c3-1.

NOTE 3--CAPITAL TRANSACTIONS

    The board of directors of the Company is authorized to issue up to
20,000,000 shares of Common Stock with a par value of $0.01 per share. There
were 6,710,000 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 1995 and 1996.

    The preferred stock of the Company consists of (i) Series A Convertible
Preferred Stock, par value $0.01 per share and (ii) Series B Convertible
Preferred Stock, par value $0.01 per share.

    At December 31, 1995, 3,190,000 shares of Series A Convertible Preferred
Stock (the "Series A Preferred Stock") were authorized, issued and
outstanding. The Series A Preferred Stock pays dividends quarterly based on the
90 day United States Treasury Bill rate in effect on the previous payment date.
Such dividends are cumulative. The Company declared dividends on the Series A
Preferred Stock of $0.11 and $0.28 per share for the years ended December 31,
1995 and 1996, respectively.

    On November 8, 1996, the Company commenced a private offering to certain
employees and directors. This offering was for a new class of non-voting
preferred stock designated Series B Convertible Preferred Stock (the "Series B
Preferred Stock"). A total of 460,000 shares were sold at $5.33 per share
adding $2,451,800 to preferred stock. At December 31, 1996, 600,000 shares of
Series B Preferred Stock were authorized and 460,000 shares were issued and
outstanding. The Series B Preferred Stock pays dividends quarterly at a rate of
5% per annum and such dividends are cumulative. The Series B Preferred Stock
carries no voting rights and each share is convertible into one share of
Non-Voting Common Stock at the holder's election and upon payment of an
additional $1.67 per share to the Company.

    During January 1997, the Company issued an additional 15,000 shares of
Series B Preferred Stock at $5.33 per share.

    The carrying value of the convertible preferred stock is at original issue
price plus accretion relating to any increase in the redemption value of the
stock during the period. During 1995 and 1996, such accretion was $0 and
$5,327,300, respectively.

                                     F-27

<PAGE> 98
                         INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT

The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Conning, Inc.:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Conning, Inc.
and subsidiaries as of June 30, 1995, and the related consolidated statements
of income, shareholders' equity, and cash flows for the six-month period ended
June 30, 1995. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility
of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on
these consolidated financial statements based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of
material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence
supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial
statement presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis
for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present
fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Conning, Inc. and
subsidiaries as of June 30, 1995 and the results of their operations and their
cash flows for the six-month period ended June 30, 1995, in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles.

                                                     /s/  KPMG Peat Marwick LLP

St. Louis, Missouri
November 14, 1997
                                     F-28

<PAGE> 99
<TABLE>
                   CONNING INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                    CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                           JUNE 30, 1995

<S>                                                    <C>
                              ASSETS

Current assets:

    Cash and cash equivalents.....................     $ 3,408,483

    Short-term investments........................       4,487,422

    Accounts receivable, net......................       3,270,269

    Marketable equity securities..................       1,043,290

    Prepaid expenses and other current assets.....         422,752
                                                       -----------

            Total current assets..................      12,632,216

Non-marketable investments at value...............       1,341,771

Equipment and leasehold improvements, at cost,
  less accumulated depreciation and amortization
  of $2,330,448...................................       1,120,484

Deferred income taxes.............................         908,740
                                                       -----------

            Total assets..........................     $16,003,211
                                                       ===========

               LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY

Current liabilities:

    Compensation payable..........................       1,436,526

    Deferred revenue..............................         288,959

    Accounts payable and other accrued expenses...       2,948,303

    Income taxes payable..........................          39,153
                                                       -----------

            Total current liabilities.............       4,712,941

Accrued rent liability............................       2,214,525
                                                       -----------

            Total liabilities.....................       6,927,466
                                                       -----------

8% Cumulative senior preferred stock, $0.01 par
  value: 1,000,000 shares authorized;
  160,000 issued and outstanding at stated value
  of $22.82 per share.............................       3,650,000
                                                       -----------

            Total preferred stock.................       3,650,000
                                                       -----------

Non-voting common stock, $0.01 par value: 100,000
  shares authorized; 24,350 shares issued and
  outstanding.....................................             244

Common stock, $.01 par value: 1,000,000 shares
  authorized; 83,204 shares issued and outstanding             832

Additional paid in capital........................       1,428,796

Retained earnings.................................       4,954,707

Unrealized appreciation on investments, net of
  deferred income taxes...........................         158,020

Treasury stock, at cost (22,633 common shares)....      (1,116,854)
                                                       -----------

            Total common shareholder's equity.....       5,425,745
                                                       -----------

            Total liabilities and shareholder's
             equity...............................     $16,003,211
                                                       ===========

   See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-29

<PAGE> 100
<TABLE>
                   CONNING INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                 CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
             FOR THE SIX MONTH PERIOD ENDED JUNE 30, 1995

<S>                                                   <C>
Revenues:

    Asset management and related fees.............    $ 5,661,690

    Research services.............................      4,563,802

    Other income..................................        275,122
                                                      -----------

            Total revenues........................     10,500,614
                                                      -----------

Expenses:

    Employee compensation and benefits............      5,322,480

    Occupancy and equipment costs.................        715,532

    Marketing and production costs................      1,176,887

    Professional services.........................        548,325

    Other operating expenses......................        645,931
                                                      -----------

            Total expenses........................      8,409,155
                                                      -----------

    Income before provision for income taxes......      2,091,459

    Provision for income taxes....................        808,838
                                                      -----------

    Net income....................................    $ 1,282,621
                                                      ===========

    Preferred stock dividends.....................        160,000
                                                      -----------

    Net earnings available to common
      shareholders................................    $ 1,122,621
                                                      ===========

     See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-30

<PAGE> 101
                                                 CONNING INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
<TABLE>
                                    CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMMON SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                         FOR THE SIX MONTH PERIOD ENDED JUNE 30, 1995

<CAPTION>
                                                                                         UNREALIZED
                                                                                         APPRECIATION                     TOTAL
                                                              ADDITIONAL                     ON                           COMMON
                                                   COMMON      PAID IN       RETAINED    INVESTMENTS,    TREASURY      SHAREHOLDERS'
                                                    STOCK      CAPITAL       EARNINGS        NET           STOCK           EQUITY
<S>                                                <C>       <C>            <C>           <C>           <C>             <C>
Balance, December 31, 1994.....................    $1,065    $1,357,382     $3,832,086    $ 46,728      $(1,051,327)    $4,185,934

Exercise of stock options for 1,100 common
  shares.......................................        11        71,414                                                     71,425

Purchase of 1,735 common shares of treasury
  stock........................................                                                             (65,527)       (65,527)

Change in unrealized appreciation of
  investment, net of
  deferred income taxes........................                                            111,292                         111,292

Dividend on Preferred Stock....................                               (160,000)                                   (160,000)

Net income.....................................                              1,282,621                                   1,282,621
                                                   ------    ----------     ----------    --------      -----------     ----------

Balance, June 30, 1995.........................    $1,076    $1,428,796     $4,954,707    $158,020      $(1,116,854)    $5,425,745
                                                   ======    ==========     ==========    ========      ===========     ==========

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-31

<PAGE> 102
                         CONNING INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
<TABLE>
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
                 FOR THE SIX MONTH PERIOD ENDED JUNE 30, 1995

<S>                                                   <C>
Operating activities:

    Net income....................................    $ 1,282,621

    Adjustment for items not affecting cash:

        Depreciation..............................        150,441

        Net unrealized appreciation on
          non-marketable securities...............         (2,672)

        Accretion of discounts on short-term
          investments.............................       (130,886)

        Net appreciation on securities purchased
          held for market making..................       (247,040)

        Changes in:

            Accounts receivable...................        (18,599)

            Prepaid expenses and other assets.....       (632,510)

            Accounts payable and other accrued
              expenses............................      1,049,004

            Deferred revenue......................         23,303

            Accrued rent liability................        (49,012)

            Compensation payable..................       (488,297)
                                                      -----------

                Net cash provided by operating
                   activities.....................        936,353
                                                      -----------

Investing activities:

    Purchases of non-marketable securities........        (28,283)

    Purchases of short-term investments...........     (4,368,258)

    Maturities of short-term investments..........      4,600,000

    Purchases of equipment, net...................       (285,309)
                                                      -----------

                Net cash used in investing
                   activities.....................        (81,850)
                                                      -----------

Financing activities:

    Dividend on 8% Cumulative Senior Preferred
      Stock.......................................       (160,000)

    Purchase of treasury stock....................        (65,527)

    Exercise of stock options.....................         71,425
                                                      -----------

                Net cash used in financing
                   activities.....................       (154,102)
                                                      -----------

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents.........        700,401

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period....      2,708,082
                                                      -----------

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period..........    $ 3,408,483
                                                      ===========

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:

Cash paid for:

    Interest......................................    $        --

    Income taxes..................................      1,345,594

      See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-32

<PAGE> 103
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

                                 JUNE 30, 1995

NOTE 1--ORGANIZATION

    Conning Inc. and subsidiaries (the "Corporation", formerly known as
Conning Corporation), a Delaware corporation, is a holding company whose
wholly-owned subsidiary, Conning & Company ("Conning"), is a registered
investment adviser with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the
Investment Advisers Act and is primarily an asset management and research
company concentrating on the insurance industry. Conning is also a registered
broker dealer and a member of the National Association of Securities Dealers,
Inc. The Corporation also owns another inactive subsidiary having no operations
or activity since 1992.

NOTE 2--SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

    The accompanying consolidated financial statements of the Corporation have
been prepared in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. The
significant accounting policies followed by the Corporation and its
subsidiaries are summarized below:

    Principles of Consolidation--The consolidated financial statements include
the accounts of the Corporation and its subsidiaries after elimination of
intercompany balances and transactions.

    Revenue Recognition--Asset management fees are determined based on
contractual provisions and are earned at varying percentages of the assets
under management. Such fees are accrued into income in the period in which the
service is provided. Research fees, primarily in the form of commissions
derived from securities transactions effected by the Company and, to a lesser
extent, subscription fees for research publications, are recorded in income
when services are provided or earned.

    Cash and Cash Equivalents--Cash and cash equivalents for purposes of the
financial statements represent cash and highly liquid investments with original
maturities of three months or less.

    Short-Term Investments--Short-term investments are comprised of U.S.
Government Securities and investment grade commercial paper having a maturity
of one year or less, and are carried at amortized cost, which approximates fair
value.

    Investments--Marketable equity securities classified as trading securities
are presented at fair value with corresponding unrealized gains or losses
included in current period income. Marketable equity securities classified as
available-for-sale are presented at fair value with corresponding unrealized
gains or losses included as a separate component of shareholders' equity, net
of deferred income taxes. Non-marketable investments in various private equity
funds are held at fair value by the Company's broker-dealer in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles for broker-dealers. Such investments
are recorded using the equity method basis of accounting (including unrealized
gains and losses). The changes in fair values are included in the consolidated
statements of income.

    Equipment and Leasehold Improvements--Equipment is stated at cost, less
accumulated depreciation provided on an accelerated method over periods not
exceeding eight years. Leasehold improvements are stated at cost, less
accumulated amortization provided on a straight line basis over the term of the
lease.

    Income Taxes--Income tax expense is based on income reported in the
financial statements. Deferred federal and state income taxes are provided
based on an asset and liability approach which requires the recognition of
deferred income tax assets and liabilities for the expected future tax
consequences of temporary differences between the financial statement carrying
amounts and the tax basis of assets and liabilities. The Corporation files
consolidated federal and combined state income tax returns with its
subsidiaries. The Corporation records a valuation allowance against the
deferred income tax asset for that portion of the asset that may not be
realized.

    Rent Expense--The Corporation received financial incentives as well as a
stepped rental rate structure regarding its lease at the Corporation's main
premises. The Corporation is recording all incentives and rental rates in its
results of operations as if they occurred evenly throughout the term of the
lease. In connection with such incentives, the

                                     F-33

<PAGE> 104
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

Corporation issued a $350,000 letter of credit to the landlord in the event of
default under the lease. The letter of credit was outstanding at June 30, 1995.

    Compensation Payable--Compensation payable represents amounts payable to
employees as a result of the Company's incentive compensation programs during
the normal course of business. Amounts are accrued in the period earned.

    Non-cash employee compensation--The Company uses the intrinsic value method
to account for stock option plans as prescribed by the Accounting Principles
Opinion Board No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees" ("APB
25"). Under this method, compensation expense is recognized for awards of
options to purchase shares of stock to employees under compensatory plans if
the fair market value of the stock at the option grant date (or other
measurement date, if later) is greater than the amount the employee must pay to
acquire the stock.

    Other income--Other income is comprised of investment income and other
miscellaneous revenues.

    Use of estimates--Management of the Company has made a number of estimates
and assumptions relating to the reporting of assets and liabilities in the
preparation of the financial statements. Actual results could differ from these
estimates.

    New Accounting Pronouncement--In October 1995, the Financial Accounting
Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123,
"Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" ("FAS 123"). FAS 123 permits
companies to adopt a new fair value based method to account for stock option
plans or to continue using the intrinsic method and provide pro forma
disclosures. This statement is effective for periods beginning after December
15, 1995. The Company intends to continue using the intrinsic value method and
will provide the pro forma disclosures in the notes to the consolidated
financial statements.

NOTE 3--ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE

    Accounts receivable include primarily amounts due for management fees,
selling concessions due from underwriters and amounts due from other business
activities of the Corporation. At June 30, 1995, an allowance for doubtful
accounts of $212,750 was applied as a reduction of accounts receivable.

NOTE 4--INVESTMENTS

    At June 30, 1995, the estimated fair value of marketable and non-marketable
investments were as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Marketable Equity Securities--Trading (cost
  $285,921)...........................................  $  283,290
Marketable Equity Securities--Available-for-sale (cost
  $490,000)...........................................     760,000
                                                        ----------
  Total marketable securities.........................  $1,043,290
                                                        ----------
Non-marketable equity securities (cost $16,625).......      18,933
Non-marketable partnership investments (cost
  $1,300,483).........................................   1,322,838
                                                        ----------
Total non-marketable investments......................  $1,341,771
                                                        ==========
</TABLE>

    The Corporation is a 1% general partner in various private equity funds.
The value of the non-marketable partnership investments is accounted for using
the equity method and updated periodically based upon changes in fair values
and recorded in the consolidated statements of income. Additionally, the
Company had no derivative investments as of or during the six month period
ended June 30, 1995.

                                     F-34

<PAGE> 105
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 5--EQUIPMENT AND LEASEHOLD IMPROVEMENTS

    Equipment and leasehold improvements as of June 30, 1995 comprised the
following:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Office equipment......................................  $1,300,406
Data processing equipment.............................   1,704,284
Leasehold improvements................................     446,242
                                                        ----------
                                                         3,450,932
Less accumulated depreciation and amortization........   2,330,448
                                                        ----------
                                                        $1,120,484
                                                        ==========
</TABLE>

    Depreciation expense for the six month period ended June 30, 1995, was
$150,441 on the above and is included in other operating expenses in the
consolidated statement of income. The Corporation occupies premises and rents
certain office equipment under leases that are accounted for as operating
leases and that have expiration dates through 2005. Rentals under these leases
aggregated approximately $511,700 for the six month period ended June 30, 1995,
after reduction for rent received from subleases of approximately $75,050
during the period.

    At June 30, 1995, the minimum net rental commitments of the Corporation for
the periods indicated under the terms of these operating leases in excess of
one year were approximately $7,353,000 as follows: $417,000 remaining in 1995,
$829,000 in 1996, $777,000 in 1997, $743,000 in 1998; $734,000 per year from
1999-2004, and $183,000 in 2005.

NOTE 6--INCOME TAXES

    The provision for federal and state income taxes for the six month period
ended is as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Current income tax provision..........................  $1,607,599
Deferred income tax benefit...........................    (798,761)
                                                        ----------
Total income tax provision............................  $  808,838
                                                        ==========
</TABLE>

    The differences between the expected United States Federal income tax
provision at the statutory rate of 34% and the Corporation's actual Federal
income tax rate for the six month period ended June 30, 1995 are as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Income before income taxes............................  $2,091,459
Federal income taxes at statutory rate................     711,096
Changes in income taxes resulting from:
    State tax, net of federal.........................     159,407
    Other, net........................................     (61,665)
                                                        ----------
Federal income tax provision..........................  $  808,838
                                                        ==========
</TABLE>

    The components of deferred income taxes for the six month period ended June
30, 1995, are as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Accrued rent liability................................  $  24,037
Partnership investments...............................   (719,167)
Accrued expense reserves..............................    (14,441)
Other, net............................................    (89,190)
                                                        ---------
Total deferred income tax benefit.....................  $(798,761)
                                                        =========
</TABLE>

                                     F-35

<PAGE> 106
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

    The Corporation's net deferred income tax assets represent the estimated
future tax effects attributable to future taxable or deductible temporary
difference between amounts recognized in the financial statements and income
tax returns. At June 30, 1995, the net deferred income tax assets are as
follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Accrued rent liability................................  $ 917,369
Partnership investments...............................    710,637
Other, net............................................    290,076
                                                        ---------
Gross deferred income tax assets......................  1,918,082
Valuation allowance...................................   (701,251)
                                                        ---------
Deferred income tax assets, net of valuation
  allowance...........................................  1,216,831
                                                        ---------
Depreciation..........................................   (158,961)
Unrealized appreciation on investments................   (149,130)
                                                        ---------
Gross deferred income tax liabilities.................   (308,091)
                                                        ---------
Net deferred income tax assets........................  $ 908,740
                                                        =========
</TABLE>

NOTE 7--SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS

    At June 30, 1995, the Corporation had a line of credit with a commercial
bank for $1,200,000. The interest rate is based on LIBOR plus 150 basis points.
There were no outstanding borrowings during the six month period ended June 30,
1995.

NOTE 8--PREFERRED STOCK AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY

    The board of directors of the Corporation is authorized to issue up to
1,000,000 shares of common stock, 100,000 shares of non-voting common stock and
1,000,000 shares of preferred stock. All shares have a par value of $.01 per
share. The board of directors is authorized to set the terms, limitations,
preferences and series of preferred stock.

    On February 25, 1993, a non-affiliated financial services insurance holding
company (Insurance Holding Company) purchased all of the then outstanding
Corporation's Non-Voting Series A Preferred Stock, which was subject to
mandatory redemption, from the previous shareholders. On the same date, the
Corporation entered into an agreement with the Insurance Holding Company to
exchange the shares of Non-Voting Series A Preferred Stock for 160,000 shares
of 8% Cumulative Senior Preferred Stock ("Senior Preferred Stock") valued at
$22.8125 per share ($3,650,000 aggregate), all of the 24,350 shares of
non-voting common stock valued at $36.50 per share ($888,775 aggregate) and
cash of $261,225. The Senior Preferred Stock was issued at a discount from a
face value of $4,000,000. The holders of the Senior Preferred Stock have voting
rights only with respect to certain matters, including an election of two
members of the board of directors representing less than a majority of the
board, and are entitled to receive cumulative dividends at the annual rate of
$2.00 per share payable semi-annually.

    The Senior Preferred Stock, plus any accrued and unpaid dividends, may be
redeemed by the Corporation on or after March 31, 1994 with the approval of the
Corporation's Board of Directors. No redemptions occurred during the six month
period ended June 30, 1995. The Preferred Stock was redeemable at $24.0625 per
share ($3,850,000 aggregate) if redeemed between March 31, 1994 through March
30, 1997; and at $25.00 per share ($4,000,000 aggregate) if redeemed on or
after March 31, 1997. In connection with the exchanges as described above, the
Corporation has issued warrants to subsidiaries of the Insurance Holding
Company to purchase 31% of the Corporation's fully diluted common shares, at a
price determined by the common stock book value per share, if the Senior
Preferred Stock was not fully redeemed by February 25, 1999.

    The voting shareholders of common stock are entitled to vote on all matters
requiring shareholder action. All voting common shares issued by the
Corporation are subject to a Shareholder's Agreement. Under this agreement, no
transfer of shares is permitted except with the consent of the Corporation's
Board of Directors. Upon termination of

                                     F-36

<PAGE> 107
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

employment, or other event as described in the agreement, all voting common
stock shares of the Corporation held must be sold back to the Corporation at a
price determined in accordance with the agreement.

    The Corporation did not declare any dividends on common stock shares
outstanding during the six month period ended June 30, 1995. The Corporation is
also restricted as to the amount of dividends that can be declared since
Conning is a registered broker-dealer who is required to maintain a minimum net
capital balance of approximately $273,000 at June 30, 1995, pursuant to the
Securities and Exchange Commission's Uniform Net Capital Rule (Rule 15c3-1).

NOTE 9--RELATED PARTY ACTIVITIES

    The Corporation is the holder of notes receivable for the principal sum of
$200,000 bearing interest at the rate of 8.0% per annum from a non-public
reinsurance broker of which the Corporation owns a nominal interest. Members of
the board of directors of the Corporation, who are also members of senior
management, serve as Board members of the reinsurance broker. The notes were
due in installments of $125,000 and $75,000 on September 1, 1995 and August 1,
1997, respectively. Subsequently, the notes were paid in full in October, 1995.
Interest is due semi-annually and interest income of $8,000 is included in the
statement of income for the six month period ended June 30, 1995.

    The Corporation provided investment management services to the holder of
the non-voting common stock. Investment management fees of approximately
$346,000 were earned for the six month period ended June 30, 1995. The
Corporation also is the general partner for six affiliated private equity funds
with a 1% equity ownership interest in each fund. Fees for managing these funds
were approximately $1,632,000 for the six month period ended June 30, 1995.

NOTE 10--STOCK OPTIONS AND EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

    The Corporation has a Stock Option Plan (the "Plan") that allows the
Board of Directors to grant incentive and/or non-qualified stock options to key
employees and directors of the Corporation and its affiliates. The options are
exercisable in equal installments over a period of two years from the date of
grant and no later than ten years from the date of grant. A total of 83,876
shares of the Corporation's common stock have been reserved for issuance
pursuant to the Plan. Transactions under the stock option plan as of June 30,
1995 are summarized as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                            AVERAGE
                                                                              NUMBER       EXERCISE
                                                                             OF SHARES       PRICE
                                                                             ---------     --------
<S>                                                                           <C>            <C>
Outstanding, beginning of period........................................      34,535         $35.92
Granted.................................................................          --             --
Exercised...............................................................       1,100          64.93
Canceled................................................................         826          38.11
                                                                              ------         ------
Outstanding, end of period..............................................      32,609         $34.89
                                                                              ======         ======
Exercisable, end of period..............................................      25,369         $28.13
                                                                              ======         ======
</TABLE>

    401(k) Savings Plan--Conning has a 401(k) savings plan ("the 401(k)
Plan") for which substantially all employees are eligible. In addition to
employee contributions, Conning accrued approximately $259,800 on behalf of the
eligible employees for the six month period ended June 30, 1995. The 401(k)
Plan offers six investment vehicles in addition to a self-directed option. One
of the investment vehicles is managed by Conning.

NOTE 11--NET CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS

    The Corporation's principal subsidiary, Conning, is subject to a
requirement of the SEC's Uniform Net Capital Rule, requiring the maintenance of
certain minimal capital levels. At June 30, 1995, Conning had net capital, as
defined by the Uniform Net Capital Rule, of approximately $6,263,000, which was
approximately $5,990,000 in excess of the required net capital.

                                     F-37

<PAGE> 108
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 12--COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

    Two legal claims have arisen during the normal course of business of the
Corporation's non-securities and non-investment advisory services businesses.
While the Corporation believes it has meritorious defenses against the suits,
the ultimate resolution of the matters and the related impact on these
financial statements is based upon estimates of the likely outcome. Management
of the Corporation, after consultation with legal counsel, believes its
aggregate accrual relating to litigation is adequate as of June 30, 1995.
Subsequent to June 30, 1995, one of the two claims was resolved with no
material impact to the financial statements.

    Conning is a 1% general partner in certain private equity funds that the
subsidiary also manages. At June 30, 1995, Conning's future commitment to fund
such required capital contributions was approximately $440,000.

NOTE 13--SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

    On August 11, 1995 all of the outstanding common stock of the Corporation
was acquired by Conning Corporation, formerly known as Conning Asset Management
Company--name change effective July 31, 1996. Conning Corporation is owned by
General American Holding Company, a wholly owned subsidiary of General American
Life Insurance Company.

    As a result of the acquisition by Conning Corporation, the shareholders of
Conning Inc. contributed all of their stock to Conning Corporation in a Section
351 merger transaction (the "Strategic Merger") in exchange for cash and
convertible preferred stock of Conning Corporation. Additionally, all of the
outstanding shares of the 8% Cumulative Senior Preferred Stock were redeemed
and retired.

    In September 1997, Conning Corporation filed a preliminary registration
statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission to register 2,500,000
shares of Common Stock (excluding the over-allotment option) to be sold by
Conning Corporation in an initial public offering.
                                     F-38

<PAGE> 109
                       REPORT OF INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS

February 21, 1995, except for Note 12, as to which the date is September 19,
1997

To the Board of Directors and
Shareholders of Conning Inc.

    In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated statements of financial
condition and the related consolidated statements of operations, of changes in
shareholders' equity and of cash flows present fairly, in all material
respects, the financial position of Conning Inc. & Subsidiaries (formerly known
as Conning Corporation) at December 31, 1994, and the results of its operations
and its cash flows for the year then ended in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management; our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our
audits of these statements in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards which require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable
assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the
accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and
evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our
audits provide a reasonable basis for the opinion expressed above.

    As discussed in Note 2 to the financial statements, the Company changed its
method for accounting for equity investments in 1994.

/s/ Price Waterhouse LLP

                                     F-39

<PAGE> 110
<TABLE>
                    CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

           CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
                         DECEMBER 31, 1994
<CAPTION>
                      ASSETS
<S>                                                 <C>
Cash and cash equivalents.........................  $ 2,708,082
Short-term investments............................    4,588,279
Underwriting fees and commissions receivable......      657,130
Accounts receivable...............................    2,205,076
Affiliate receivables.............................      389,464
Investments.......................................    1,917,066
Equipment and leasehold improvements, at cost,
  less accumulated depreciation and amortization
  of $2,180,005...................................      985,616
Prepaid expenses and deferred charges.............      308,668
Other assets......................................      469,021
                                                    -----------
    Total assets..................................  $14,228,402
                                                    ===========

       LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
Amounts and notes payable to former
  shareholders....................................  $   569,009
Compensation payable..............................    1,924,823
Deferred revenue..................................      265,656
Accrued rent expense..............................    2,263,537
Accounts payable and other accrued expenses.......    1,369,443
                                                    -----------
    Total liabilities.............................    6,392,468
                                                    -----------
8% Cumulative senior preferred stock, $.01 par
  value: 1,000,000 share authorized; 160,000
  issued and outstanding at stated value of
  $22.82 per share................................    3,650,000
                                                    -----------
Non voting common stock, $.01 par value: 100,000
  shares authorized; 24,350 shares issued and
  outstanding.....................................          244
Common stock, $.01 par value: 1,000,000 shares
  authorized; 82,104 shares issued and
  outstanding.....................................          821
Capital in excess of par value....................    1,357,382
Retained earnings.................................    3,832,086
Unrealized appreciation on investments, net of
  deferred income taxes...........................       46,728
Treasury stock, at cost (20,898 shares)...........   (1,051,327)
                                                    -----------
    Total common shareholders' equity.............    4,185,934
                                                    -----------
    Total shareholders' equity....................    7,835,934
                                                    -----------
    Total liabilities and shareholders' equity....  $14,228,402
                                                    ===========

     See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-40

<PAGE> 111
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES
<TABLE>
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994

<S>                                                 <C>
Revenue
    Asset management and related fees.............  $ 9,839,771
    Research services.............................    8,164,765
    Other.........................................      472,211
                                                    -----------
        Total revenue.............................   18,476,747
                                                    -----------

Expenses
    Employee compensation and benefits............   10,195,854
    Occupancy and equipment costs.................    1,450,080
    Marketing and production costs................    2,029,390
    Professional fees.............................      784,507
    Other operating expenses......................    1,265,603
                                                    -----------
        Total expenses............................   15,725,434
                                                    -----------
    Income before provision for income taxes......    2,751,313
    Provision for income taxes....................    1,243,822
                                                    -----------
    Net income....................................  $ 1,507,491
                                                    ===========
   See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-41

<PAGE> 112
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES
<TABLE>
          CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994

<CAPTION>
                                                                  COMMON SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                              ---------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                          CAPITAL IN                    UNREALIZED
                              PREFERRED       COMMON     EXCESS OF PAR    RETAINED        STOCK
                                STOCK         STOCK          VALUE        EARNINGS     APPRECIATION   TREASURY STOCK
<S>                           <C>             <C>         <C>            <C>              <C>          <C>
Balance, December 31,
  1993...................     $3,650,000      $  927      $  486,706     $2,644,595                    $  (579,871)
Issuance of 13,775 shares
  of common stock........                        138         870,676
Purchase of treasury
  stock, 7,830 shares....                                                                                 (471,456)
Unrealized appreciation
  of investments, net of
  deferred income
  taxes..................                                                                 $46,728
Dividend on 8% Cumulative
  Senior Preferred
  Stock..................                                                  (320,000)
Net Income...............                                                 1,507,491
                              ----------      ------      ----------     ----------       -------      -----------
Balance, December 31,
  1994...................     $3,650,000      $1,065      $1,357,382     $3,832,086       $46,728      $(1,051,327)
                              ==========      ======      ==========     ==========       =======      ===========

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
</TABLE>

                                     F-42

<PAGE> 113
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES
<TABLE>
                    CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
                    FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994

<S>                                                 <C>
Operating activities:
    Net income....................................  $ 1,507,491
    Adjustment for items not affecting cash
        Depreciation and amortization.............      441,930
        Deferred income tax provision.............       49,272
        Net unrealized appreciation on
         non-marketable securities................      (39,639)
        Net purchases of securities held for
         market making............................      (23,000)
        Accretion of discounts on short-term
         investments..............................      (82,709)
        Changes in:
            Receivables...........................      572,924
            Prepaid expenses, deferred charges and
             other assets.........................       (3,780)
            Payables..............................     (613,395)
            Deferred revenue......................      (98,256)
            Accrued rent expense..................       (9,521)
            Compensation payable..................    1,664,625
                                                    -----------
                Net cash provided by operating
                  activities......................    3,365,942
                                                    -----------
Investing activities:
        Purchases of non-marketable securities....      (76,650)
        Distribution from non-marketable
         partnership investments..................      127,431
        Purchases of equipment, net...............      (29,094)
        Purchases of short-term investments.......   (6,005,570)
        Maturities of short-term investments......    1,500,000
                                                    -----------
                Net cash (used for) provided by
                  investing activities............   (4,483,883)
                                                    -----------
Financing activities:
        Dividend on 8% Cumulative Senior Preferred
         Stock....................................     (320,000)
        Issuance of common stock, net of issuance
         cost.....................................      870,814
        Issuance of employee loans................     (324,081)
        Repayments of employee loans..............      143,036
        Payments to former shareholders...........      (66,900)
        Purchase of treasury stock................      (26,845)
                                                    -----------
            Net cash provided by (used for)
             financing activities.................      276,024
                                                    -----------
Non-cash financing activities:
        Notes and amounts payable to former
         shareholders.............................      444,611
        Purchase of treasury stock................     (444,611)
                                                    -----------
Net non-cash financing activities.................           --
                                                    -----------
Net change in cash and cash equivalents...........     (841,917)
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year......    3,549,999
                                                    -----------
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year............  $ 2,708,082
                                                    ===========
Cash paid for:
    Interest......................................  $        --
    Income taxes..................................  $ 1,719,889

         See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

</TABLE>
                                     F-43

<PAGE> 114
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1--ORGANIZATION

    Conning Inc. (the "Corporation", formerly known as Conning Corporation),
a Delaware corporation, is a holding company whose wholly-owned subsidiary,
Conning & Company ("Conning"), is a registered investment adviser with the
Securities and Exchange Commission under the Investment Advisers Act and is
primarily an asset management and research company concentrating on the
insurance industry. Conning is also a registered broker dealer and a member of
the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc.

NOTE 2--SUMMARY OF ACCOUNTING POLICIES

    The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared in
conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. The significant
accounting policies followed by the Corporation and its subsidiaries are
summarized below.

    Accounting Changes--Effective January 1, 1994, the Corporation adopted the
provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 115, "Accounting
for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities" (FAS 115) which
requires that investments be classified in one of three categories:
held-to-maturity, available-for-sale or trading. The Corporation classified
equity investments held for market making activities as trading securities and
all other marketable equity securities as available-for-sale. At January 1,
1994, there was no effect on the financial position of the Corporation upon
implementation of FAS 115 as investments held for market making activities were
previously carried at fair value with corresponding gains or losses recorded
through income. No other marketable equity securities were held at January 1,
1994.

    Principles of Consolidation--The consolidated financial statements include
the accounts of the Corporation and its subsidiaries after elimination of
intercompany balances and transactions.

    Revenue Recognition--Asset management fees, institutional research fees and
financial advisory fees are recorded in income when services are provided.
Consulting fees are recorded as income at the completion of the contract or at
the time of receipt in the case of non-refundable fees earned. Fee income for
industry research publications is recorded as income ratably over the
subscription period, which is generally one year. Related expenses are recorded
as incurred.

    Cash and Cash Equivalents--Cash and cash equivalents represent cash and
highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less.

    Short-Term Investments--Short-term investments are comprised of U.S.
Government Securities and are carried at amortized cost, which approximates
fair value.

    Investments--Marketable equity securities classified as trading securities
are presented at fair value with corresponding unrealized gains or losses
included in current period income. Marketable equity securities classified as
available-for-sale are presented at fair value with corresponding unrealized
gains or losses included as a separate component of shareholders' equity, net
of deferred income taxes.

    Non-marketable securities are valued at fair value as determined in good
faith by the management of the Corporation. The changes in the resulting
difference between cost and market (or fair value) are included in the
consolidated statement of operations.

    Equipment and Leasehold Improvements--Equipment is stated at cost, less
accumulated depreciation provided on an accelerated method over periods not
exceeding eight years. Leasehold improvements are stated at cost, less
accumulated amortization provided on a straight line basis over the term of the
lease.

    Income Taxes--Income tax expense is based on income reported in the
financial statements. Deferred federal and state income taxes are provided
based on an asset and liability approach which requires the recognition of
deferred income tax assets and liabilities for the expected future tax
consequences of temporary differences between the financial statement carrying
amounts and the tax basis of assets and liabilities. The Corporation files
consolidated

                                     F-44

<PAGE> 115
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

federal and combined state income tax returns with its subsidiaries. Net
deferred income taxes are included in other assets. The Corporation records a
valuation allowance against the deferred income tax asset for that portion of
the asset that may not be realized.

    Deferred Charges--Deferred charges represent costs incurred to establish
certain private equity funds. These costs are being amortized on a straight
line method over an estimated useful life of eight years. Amortization of
$81,386 was charged against revenue during 1994.

    Rent Expense--The Corporation received financial incentives as well as a
stepped rental rate structure regarding its lease at the Corporation's main
premises. The Corporation is recording all incentives and rental rates in its
results of operations as if they occurred evenly throughout the term of the
lease. In connection with such incentives, the Corporation issued a $350,000
letter of credit to the landlord in the event of default under the lease. The
letter of credit was outstanding at December 31, 1994.

    Other revenue--Realized and unrealized gains on investments, interest
income and other miscellaneous revenues are also included.

NOTE 3--UNDERWRITINGS, COMMISSIONS AND ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE

    Accounts receivable include amounts due for management fees, consulting
engagements and other business activities of the Corporation. Underwriting fees
and commissions receivable are amounts due from customers for securities
transactions and selling concessions due from underwriters. At December 31,
1994, an allowance for doubtful accounts of $212,750 was applied as a reduction
of accounts receivable.

NOTE 4--INVESTMENTS

    At December 31, 1994 the estimated fair value of marketable and
non-marketable investments were as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                       <C>
Marketable Equity Securities--Trading
  (cost $37,150)........................  $   36,250

Marketable Equity
  Securities--Available-for-sale (cost
  $490,000).............................     570,000

Non-marketable equity securities (cost
 $16,625)...............................      18,310

Non-marketable partnership investments
 (cost $1,272,200)......................   1,292,506
                                          ----------

Total...................................  $1,917,066
                                          ==========
</TABLE>

    The Corporation owns one security classified as available-for-sale with an
original cost of $400,000 and a carrying value at the date of adopting FAS 115
of $490,000. The Corporation is directly, or indirectly through intermediary
partnerships, the managing general partner for six private equity funds with an
equity ownership interest of 1% in each fund. Fees for managing the six funds
were $3,191,855 for the year ended December 31, 1994. The Corporation owns a
42.5% share in the joint venture. During 1994, the Corporation recorded
$270,000 in revenue relating to this joint venture.

NOTE 5--EQUIPMENT AND LEASEHOLD IMPROVEMENTS

    Equipment and leasehold improvements comprised the following:

<TABLE>
<S>                             <C>
Office equipment..............  $1,191,233

Data processing equipment.....   1,604,349

Leasehold improvements........     370,039
                                ----------

                                 3,165,621

Less accumulated depreciation
  and amortization............   2,180,005
                                ----------

                                $  985,616
                                ==========
</TABLE>

                                     F-45

<PAGE> 116
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

    Depreciation expense for the year ended December 31, 1994 was $360,544. The
Corporation occupies premises and rents certain office equipment under leases
that are accounted for as operating leases and that have expiration dates
through 2005. Rentals under these leases aggregated $1,069,139 for the year
ended December 31, 1994, after reduction for rent received from subleases of
$150,041.

    At December 31, 1994, the minimum net rental commitments of the Corporation
for the periods indicated under the terms of the operating leases in excess of
one year were approximately $7,737,000 as follows: $834,000 in 1995; $819,000
in 1996; $769,000 in 1997; $740,000 in 1998; $732,000 per year from 1999 to
2004 and $183,000 in 2005. At December 31, 1994, the minimum due under a
sublease agreement in excess of one year is approximately $100,000 as follows:
$63,000 in 1995, and $37,000 in 1996. The commitments include future repayments
of approximately $2,264,000 in rent expense accrued and rent incentives
recorded at December 31, 1994.

NOTE 6--INCOME TAXES

    The provision for federal and state income taxes for the year ended
December 31, 1994 are as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                       <C>
Current income tax provision............  $1,194,550

Deferred income tax provision...........      49,272
                                          ----------

Total income tax provision..............  $1,243,822
                                          ==========
</TABLE>

    The components of deferred income taxes for the year ended December 31,
1994 are as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                        <C>
Accrued rent............................   $   3,237

Realization of loss carryforwards.......     111,520

Change in valuation allowance...........      64,074

Accrued expense reserves................    (127,500)

Other, net..............................      (2,059)
                                           ---------
Total deferred income tax provisions....   $  49,272
                                           =========
</TABLE>

    Under the provisions of FAS 109, the Corporation's net deferred income tax
assets represent the estimated future tax effects attributable to future
taxable or deductible temporary difference between amounts recognized in the
financial statements and income tax returns. At December 31, 1994 the net
deferred income tax assets are as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                       <C>
Accrued rent............................  $  769,603

State income tax, net...................     176,447

Other, net..............................     231,479
                                          ----------

Gross deferred income tax assets........   1,177,529
                                          ----------

Depreciation............................    (145,897)

Unrealized appreciation on
 investments............................     (57,800)

Investments in affiliates...............      (6,973)
                                          ----------

Gross deferred income tax liabilities...    (210,670)
                                          ----------

Net deferred income tax assets before
  valuation allowance...................     966,859

Valuation allowance.....................    (778,172)
                                          ----------

Net deferred income tax assets..........  $  188,687
                                          ==========
</TABLE>

                                     F-46

<PAGE> 117
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

    The Corporation's effective federal income tax rate was 36.8% for the year
ended December 31, 1994. The differences between the hypothetical United States
federal income tax provision at the statutory rate of 34% and the Corporation's
actual federal income tax rate are as follows:

<TABLE>
<S>                                       <C>
Income before income taxes..............  $2,751,313

State income tax provision..............    (364,510)
                                          ----------

Income before federal income taxes......  $2,386,803
                                          ==========
Federal income taxes at statutory
 rates..................................     811,513

Changes in valuation allowance..........      23,215

Other, net..............................      44,584
                                          ----------

Federal income tax provision............  $  879,312
                                          ==========
</TABLE>

NOTE 7--SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS

    At December 31, 1994 the Corporation had a line of credit with a commercial
bank for $1,650,000. The interest rate is based on LIBOR plus 150 basis points.
The line of credit reduces to $1,200,000 on April 1, 1995, $650,000 on April 1,
1996 and expires on April 1, 1997. There were no outstanding borrowings at
December 31, 1994.

NOTE 8--SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY

    The board of directors of the Corporation is authorized to issue up to
1,000,000 shares of common stock, 100,000 shares of non-voting common stock and
1,000,000 shares of preferred stock. All shares have a par value of $.01 per
share. The board of directors is authorized to set the terms, limitations,
preferences and series of preferred stock.

    On February 25, 1993, PennCorp Financial ("PennCorp") purchased all of
the then outstanding Corporation's Non-Voting Series A Preferred Stock, which
were subject to mandatory redemption, from the previous shareholders. On the
same date, the Corporation entered into an agreement with PennCorp to exchange
the shares of Non-Voting Series A Preferred Stock for 160,000 shares of 8%
Cumulative Senior Preferred Stock ("Senior Preferred Stock") valued at
$22.8125 per share ($3,650,000 aggregate), all of the 24,350 shares of
non-voting common stock valued at $36.50 per share ($888,775 aggregate) and
cash of $261,225. The Senior Preferred Stock was issued at a discount from a
face value of $4,000,000. The holders of the Senior Preferred Stock have voting
rights only with respect to certain matters, including an election of two
members of the board of directors representing less than a majority of the
board, and are entitled to receive cumulative dividends at the annual rate of
$2.00 per share payable semi-annually.

    The Senior Preferred Stock, plus any accrued and unpaid dividends, may be
redeemed by the Corporation on or after March 31, 1994 with the approval of the
Corporation's Board of Directors. No redemptions occurred during 1994. The
Preferred Stock is redeemable at $24.0625 per share ($3,850,000 aggregate) if
redeemed between March 31, 1994 through March 30, 1997; and at $25.00 per share
($4,000,000 aggregate) if redeemed on or after March 31, 1997. In connection
with the exchanges as described above, the Corporation has issued warrants to
subsidiaries of PennCorp to purchase 31% of the Corporation's fully diluted
common shares, at a price determined by the common stock book value per share,
if the Senior Preferred Stock is not fully redeemed by February 25, 1999.

    The voting shares of common stock are entitled to vote on all matters
requiring shareholder action. All voting common shares issued by the
Corporation are subject to a Shareholder's Agreement. Under this agreement, no
transfer of shares is permitted except with the consent of the Corporation's
Board of Directors. Upon termination of employment, or other event as described
in the agreement, all voting common stock shares of the Corporation held must
be sold back to the Corporation at a price determined in accordance with the
agreement.

    The Corporation did not declare any dividends on common stock shares
outstanding during 1994 and it is anticipated that there will be no dividends
declared in the near future. The Corporation is also restricted as to the
amount of dividends that can be declared since Conning is a registered
broker-dealer who is required to maintain a

                                     F-47

<PAGE> 118
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

minimum net capital balance of approximately $225,572 at December 31, 1994
pursuant to the Securities and Exchange Commission's Uniform Net Capital Rule
(Rule 15c3-1).

    On September 13, 1994, the Corporation held a private offering to certain
employees which closed on September 28, 1994. A total of 7,575 shares were sold
at $65.85 per share adding $498,814 to shareholders' equity. As of December 31,
1994, the Corporation was owed $211,041 from certain employees for their
purchases of common stock, and such amounts were repaid in January 1995.

    During 1994, the Corporation purchased 7,830 shares of common stock for
treasury at a total cost of $471,456.

NOTE 9--OTHER RELATED PARTY ACTIVITIES

    The Corporation is the holder of notes receivable for the principal sum of
$200,000 bearing interest at the rate of 8.0% per annum from Tennant Risk
Services, Inc. ("Tennant"), a Connecticut corporation of which the
Corporation owns a nominal interest. Members of the board of directors of the
Corporation who are also members of senior management serve as Board members of
Tennant. The notes are due in installments of $125,000 and $75,000 on September
1, 1995 and August 1, 1997 respectively. Interest is due semi-annually and
interest income of $16,000 is included in the statement of operations for the
year ended December 31, 1994.

    The Corporation provided investment management services to PennCorp.
Investment management fees of $638,142 were earned for the year ended December
31, 1994.

NOTE 10--STOCK OPTIONS AND EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

    The Corporation has a Stock Option Plan (the "Plan") that allows the
Board of Directors to grant incentive and/or non-qualified stock options to key
employees and directors of the Corporation and its affiliates. The options are
exercisable in equal installments over a period of two years from the date of
grant and no later than ten years from the date of grant. A total of 83,876
shares of the Corporation's common stock have been reserved for issuance
pursuant to the Plan. Transactions under the stock option plan are summarized
as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          AVERAGE
                                             NUMBER OF    EXERCISE
                                              SHARES       PRICE

<S>                                          <C>           <C>
Outstanding, beginning of year..........      35,866       $24.32

Granted.................................       9,225        62.52

Exercised...............................          --           --

Canceled................................     (10,556)       19.76
                                             -------       ------

Outstanding, end of year................      34,535       $35.92
                                             =======       ======
Exercisable, end of year................      24,136       $28.81
                                             =======       ======
</TABLE>

    401(k) Savings Plan--Conning has a 401(k) savings plan ("the 401(k)
Plan") for which substantially all employees are eligible. In addition to
employee contributions, Conning contributed $351,286 on behalf of the eligible
employees for the year ended December 31, 1994. The 401(k) Plan offers six
investment vehicles in addition to a self-directed option. One of the
investment vehicles is managed by Conning.

NOTE 11--NET CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS

    The Corporation's principal subsidiary, Conning, is subject to a
requirement of the SEC's Uniform Net Capital Rule, requiring the maintenance of
certain minimal capital levels. At December 31, 1994, Conning had net capital,
as defined by the Uniform Net Capital Rule, of $5,324,070 which was $5,098,498
in excess of the required net capital.

                                     F-48

<PAGE> 119
                          CONNING INC. & SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 12--SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

    On August 11, 1995, all of the outstanding common stock of the Corporation
was acquired by Conning Corporation, formerly known as Conning Asset Management
Company--name change effective July 31, 1996. Conning Corporation is owned by
General American Holding Company, a wholly owned subsidiary of General American
Life Insurance Company.

    In September 1997, Conning Corporation filed a preliminary registration
statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission to register 2,500,000
shares of Common Stock (excluding the over-allotment option) to be sold by
Conning Corporation in an initial public offering.

                                     F-49

<PAGE> 120
                                   GLOSSARY

    "ASSET" typically refers to anything having a commercial or exchange
value that is owned by a business, institution or individual. In this context
`asset' refers to the financial holdings of the Company's clients, primarily
insurance companies.

    "ASSET BACKED SECURITIES" are bonds or notes typically backed by loan
paper or accounts receivable originated by banks, credit card companies or
other providers of credit.

    "ASSET LIABILITY MATCHING" refers to the quantitative analytic techniques
applied to the estimation of the time frame in which a client's liabilities
will become payable and the program designed to appropriately match the
duration of the investment portfolio to that time frame.

    "ASSET MANAGEMENT" refers to the services offered by the Company which
include the allocation of the clients funds to basic security classes and the
active buying, trading and selling that accompanies the investment function.

    "CORPORATE BONDS" are debt instruments issued by a private corporation as
distinct from a government agency or a municipality.

    "DISCRETIONARY ASSET MANAGEMENT" refers to the active management of an
investment portfolio including the asset allocation and purchasing, trading and
selling activities.

    "EQUITIES" are securities representing the ownership interest in a
corporation.

    "GOVERNMENTS" are securities issued by the U.S. government, such as
Treasury Bills, bonds, notes and savings bonds, as well as debt issues of
federal agencies which are not directly backed by the U.S. government.

    "INDEXED EQUITIES" are pools of funds which are invested in a portfolio
which seeks to match that of a broad-based securities index. This may include
the Standard & Poor's 500 index, indexes of mid- and small-capitalization
stocks, foreign stock indexes and bond indexes.

    "INVESTMENT ADVISORY SERVICES" are services which support the analysis
and needs of clients and result in advice pertaining to the general structure
of the client's portfolio, but do not include advice relative to specific
investments.

    "MASTER SERVICER" is an entity which provides administrative services to
securitized pools of mortgage-backed securities.

    "MORTGAGE LOANS" are debt instruments by which the borrower, either
corporate or individual, grants the lender a lien on property as security for
the repayment of the loan.

    "MUNICIPAL BONDS" are debt obligations of a state or local government
entity.

    "NON-CAPTIVE INSURANCE COMPANY" refers to an insurance company that is
not formed primarily for the purpose of providing insurance to its parent and
affiliated entities.

    "PRIVATE EQUITY FUNDS" refer to the funds for which the Company has
raised capital from institutional investors for the purpose of investing in
privately held companies.

    "PRIVATE PLACEMENTS" refer to stocks, bonds or other investments which
are sold directly to an institutional investor, and which are typically
restricted as to resale.

    "REAL ESTATE" refers to a piece of land and all the physical property
relating to it, and may include the air and subsurface rights.

    "RECURRING FEE BASED REVENUE" refers to the on going fees the Company
collects, in the ordinary course of its business, from its clients on business
including discretionary asset management, investment advisory, investment
accounting & reporting, real estate, research, and private equity management.

    "SCHEDULE B" refers to the detail schedule of mortgages included in the
standard insurance department regulatory statutory annual statement.

    "SCHEDULE D" refers to the detail schedule of investments included in the
standard insurance department regulatory statutory annual statement.

    "SHORT-TERM OBLIGATIONS" typically refer to investments which have a
maturity of one year or less.

    "SPECIAL SERVICER" means an entity which provides asset management and
resolution services for non-performing or under-performing loans within a pool
of performing loans or mortgages.

                                      G-1

<PAGE> 121
================================================================================

    NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS IN CONNECTION WITH THIS OFFERING
OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH
INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN
AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY OR ANY OF THE UNDERWRITERS. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT
CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY ANY OF THE
SECURITIES OFFERED HEREBY BY ANYONE IN ANY JURISDICTION IN WHICH SUCH OFFER OR
SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED OR IN WHICH THE PERSON MAKING SUCH OFFER OR
SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO SO OR TO ANY PERSON TO WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL
TO MAKE SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS PROSPECTUS NOR
ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES, CREATE ANY IMPLICATION
THAT THE INFORMATION HEREIN IS CORRECT AS OF ANY TIME SUBSEQUENT TO THE DATE
HEREOF OR THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE COMPANY SINCE
SUCH DATE.

                               ----------------

   
<TABLE>
                                     TABLE OF CONTENTS
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        PAGE
                                                                                        ----
<S>                                                                                     <C>
Prospectus Summary..............................................................          3
Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.......................          9
Risk Factors....................................................................          9
Use of Proceeds.................................................................         17
Dividend Policy.................................................................         18
Capitalization..................................................................         18
Dilution........................................................................         19
Business........................................................................         20
Selected Consolidated Financial Data............................................         33
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
  Operation.....................................................................         36
Regulation......................................................................         40
Management......................................................................         43
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions..................................         52
Principal Shareholders..........................................................         58
Shares Eligible for Future Sale.................................................         60
Description of Capital Stock....................................................         62
Certain Charter and Bylaw Provisions............................................         63
Underwriting....................................................................         67
Legal Matters...................................................................         69
Experts.........................................................................         69
Additional Information..........................................................         69
Index to Financial Statements...................................................        F-1
Glossary........................................................................        G-1
</TABLE>
    

                              ------------------

UNTIL              , 1997 (25 DAYS AFTER THE DATE OF THIS PROSPECTUS), ALL
DEALERS EFFECTING TRANSACTIONS IN THE COMMON STOCK, WHETHER OR NOT
PARTICIPATING IN THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS.
THIS IS IN ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION OF DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS WHEN
ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR
SUBSCRIPTIONS.

================================================================================

================================================================================

                               2,500,000 SHARES

                                [CONNING LOGO]
                              CONNING CORPORATION

                                 COMMON STOCK

                                  -----------

                                  PROSPECTUS

                                ---------------

                         DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE
                             SECURITIES CORPORATION


                           A.G. EDWARDS & SONS, INC.

                                  ----------

                                   --, 1997

================================================================================

<PAGE> 122
                                    PART II
                    INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

ITEM 13. OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION

   
    The following table sets forth all expenses, other than underwriting
discounts and commissions, all of which are payable by the Company, in
connection with the issuance and distribution of the securities being
registered. All amounts are estimates except the registration fee, NASD
filing fee and Nasdaq National Market Listing Fee.

<TABLE>

   <S>                                                  <C>
   SEC Registration Fee..............................   $   13,069
   NASD Filing Fee...................................        4,813
   Nasdaq National Market Listing Fee................       50,000
   Printing and Engraving Expenses...................      175,000
   Blue Sky Fees and Expenses........................        7,500
   Registrar and Transfer Agent Fees.................        3,000
   Legal Fees and Expenses...........................      650,000
   Accounting Fees and Expenses......................      400,000
   Miscellaneous.....................................       71,618
                                                        ----------
           Total.....................................   $1,375,000
                                                        ==========

</TABLE>
    

ITEM 14. INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS

    Section 351.355(1) of the Revised Statutes of Missouri provides that a
corporation may indemnify a director, officer, employee or agent of the
corporation in any action, suit or proceeding other than an action by or in the
right of the corporation, against expenses (including attorney's fees),
judgments, fines and settlement amounts actually and reasonably incurred by him
in connection with such action, suit or proceeding if he acted in good faith
and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best
interests of the corporation and, with respect to any criminal action, had no
reasonable cause to believe his conduct was unlawful. Section 351.355(2)
provides that the corporation may indemnify any such person in any action or
suit by or in the right of the corporation against expenses (including
attorneys' fees) and settlement amounts actually and reasonably incurred by him
in connection with the defense or settlement of the action or suit if he acted
in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to
the best interests of the corporation, except that he may not be indemnified in
respect of any matter in which he has been adjudged liable for negligence or
misconduct in the performance of his duty to the corporation, unless authorized
by the court. Section 351.355(3) provides that a corporation shall indemnify
any such person against expenses (including attorney's fees) actually and
reasonably incurred by him in connection with the action, suit or proceeding if
he has been successful in defense of such action, suit or proceeding and if
such action, suit or proceeding is one for which the corporation may indemnify
him under Section 351.355(1) or (2). Section 351.355(7) provides that a
corporation shall have the power to give any further indemnity to any such
person, in addition to the indemnity otherwise authorized under Section
351.355, provided such further indemnity is either (i) authorized, directed or
provided for in the articles of incorporation of the corporation or any duly
adopted amendment thereof or (ii) is authorized, directed or provided for in
any by-law or agreement of the corporation which has been adopted by a vote of
the shareholders of the corporation, provided that no such indemnity shall
indemnify any person from or on account of such person's conduct which was
finally adjudged to have been knowingly fraudulent, deliberately dishonest or
willful misconduct.

    The Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of the Company filed as
Exhibit 3.1 to this Registration Statement contain provisions indemnifying its
directors and officers to the extent authorized specifically by Sections
351.355(1), (2), (3) and (7).

    Directors or officers of the Company who are directors or officers of
General American may also be entitled to indemnification under the provisions
of General American's Articles of Incorporation, which provide indemnification
to them since they serve, at General American's request, as directors or
officers of the Company. Such individuals are also covered by General
American's director's and officer's liability insurance policy.

                                     II-1

<PAGE> 123

    The form of Underwriting Agreement filed as Exhibit 1.1 to this
Registration Statement provides for the mutual indemnification of the Company
and any Underwriters, their respective controlling persons, directors and
certain of their officers, against certain liabilities, including liabilities
under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

    General American Mutual Holding Company maintains a policy of insurance
under which the directors and officers of the Company are insured, subject to
the limits of the policy, against certain losses, as defined in the policy,
arising from claims made against such directors and officers by reason of any
wrongful acts, as defined in the policy, in their respective capacities as
directors or officers of the Company.

ITEM 15. RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES

    In August 1995, the Company issued certain securities in connection with
its formation (the "Strategic Merger"), as follows: (i) General American
Holding Company contributed all of the issued and outstanding common stock of
GAIMCO (now known as Conning Asset Management Company) to the Company in
exchange for 6,710,000 shares of Company Common Stock; and (ii) each of the 21
shareholders and option holders of Conning, Inc., other than three non-employee
directors and two institutional shareholders (the "Non-Contributing
Shareholders"), contributed all of the common stock of Conning, Inc. then
owned by such shareholders to the Company and canceled all of their options to
purchase Conning, Inc. Common Stock in exchange for $4,505,002 in cash and
3,190,000 shares of the Company's Series A Convertible Preferred Stock. The
shares of Conning, Inc. owned by the Non-Contributing Shareholders were
acquired in exchange for cash payments. In connection with this transaction,
the Company relied on the exemption from registration contained in Section 4(2)
of the Securities Act and Rule 506 of Regulation D promulgated thereunder.

    In connection with the Strategic Merger, the Company awarded employee stock
options exercisable for 1,000,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to
25 employees of the Company; none of the options have been exercised. In
connection with this transaction, the Company relied on exemptions from
registration contained in Section 4(2) of the Securities Act and Rule 506 of
Regulation D promulgated thereunder and Rule 701 of the Securities Act.

    In November 1996 through June 1997, the Company issued 475,000 shares of
Series B Convertible Preferred Stock and awarded employee stock options
exercisable for 237,500 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to 29
employees and directors of the Company pursuant to a 1996 employee stock
purchase and option grant program and amended and restated certain provisions
of a shareholder's agreement; none of the options have been exercised. In April
1997, the Company issued 110,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to
three executive officers or directors of the Company upon conversion of an
equal number of shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock. In connection
with these transactions, the Company relied on exemptions from registration
contained in Section 4(2) and Regulation D promulgated thereunder and Rule 701
of the Securities Act.

    Concurrent with the closing of this offering, the 3,190,000 issued and
outstanding shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock will be converted
into an equal number of shares of Common Stock of the Company and outstanding
stock options to purchase Class B Non-Voting Common Stock will become options
to purchase Common Stock. In connection with this transaction, the Company
intends to rely on the exemption from registration contained in Section 3(a)(9)
of the Securities Act. Concurrent with or prior to the closing of this
offering, the 365,000 issued and outstanding shares of Series B Convertible
Preferred Stock will be converted into an equal number of shares of Common
Stock of the Company at $1.67 per share. In connection with this transaction,
the Company intends to rely on the exemption from registration contained in
Section 4(2) of the Securities Act and Regulation D promulgated thereunder and
Rule 701 of the Securities Act.

                                     II-2

<PAGE> 124
ITEM 16. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

    The exhibits and financial statement schedules filed as part of this
Registration Statement are as follows:

    (a) Exhibits.
        See Index to Exhibits.

    (b) Financial Statement Schedules.

        See Index to Financial Statements for Schedule I. Other Financial
        Statement Schedules have been omitted for the reason that they are not
        required, are not applicable or that the equivalent information has
        been included in the consolidated financial statements, and notes
        thereto, or elsewhere herein.

ITEM 17. UNDERTAKINGS

    (a) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the
Underwriters at the closing specified in the Underwriting Agreement,
certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by
the Underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.

    (b) Insofar as indemnification for liabilities under the Securities Act of
1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
registrant pursuant to the provisions of Item 14, or otherwise, the registrant
has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission
such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities
Act of 1933 and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for
indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the
registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling
person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or
proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in
connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in
the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling
precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question of
whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the
Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

    (c) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:

        (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act
    of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part
    of this Registration Statement in reliance on Rule 430A and contained in
    the form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1)
    or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of
    this Registration Statement as of the time it was declared effective.

        (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities
    Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of
    prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to
    the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that
    time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

                                     II-3

<PAGE> 125
                                  SIGNATURES

   
    Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant
has duly caused this amendment no. 3 to registration statement to be signed on
its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of St.
Louis, State of Missouri, on this 11th day of December, 1997.
    

                                        CONNING CORPORATION


                                      By:  /s/  LEONARD M. RUBENSTEIN
                                          ------------------------------------
                                          Leonard M. Rubenstein
                                          Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

   
    Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment
no. 3 to registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the
capacities and on the dates indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
             NAME                            TITLE                         DATE

<S>                              <C>                             <C>
<F*>                             Director                        December 11, 1997
- ----------------------------
John A. Fibiger

<F*>                             Director                        December 11, 1997
- ----------------------------
Richard A. Liddy

/s/LEONARD M. RUBENSTEIN         Chairman and Chief Executive    December 11, 1997
- ----------------------------     Officer (Principal Executive
Leonard M. Rubenstein            Officer

/s/FRED M. SCHPERO               Senior Vice President and       December 11, 1997
- ----------------------------     Chief Financial Officer
Fred M. Schpero                  (Principal Financial and
                                 Accounting Officer)

<F*>                             Director                        December 11, 1997
- ----------------------------
John C. Shaw

/s/MAURICE W. SLAYTON            President and Director          December 11, 1997
- ----------------------------
Maurice W. Slayton


<F*>By: /s/LEONARD M. RUBENSTEIN
        ----------------------------
        Leonard M. Rubenstein
        Attorney-in-fact
</TABLE>

                                     II-4

<PAGE> 126
<TABLE>
                              CONNING CORPORATION

                                 EXHIBIT INDEX
<CAPTION>

EXHIBIT
NUMBER                                             DESCRIPTION
<C>           <S>

1.1           Form of Underwriting Agreement among Conning Corporation (the "Company") and Donaldson, Lufkin &
              Jenrette Securities Corporation and A.G. Edwards & Sons, Inc., as Representatives of the Several
              Underwriters

2.1<F**>      Contribution Agreement dated July 24, 1995 by and among the Company (formerly Conning Asset
              Management Company), General American Life Insurance Company ("General American"), General
              American Holding Company, Conning Asset Management Company (formerly General American Investment
              Management Company) ("CAM"), Conning & Company, Conning, Inc. (formerly Conning Corporation) and
              the Shareholders and Option Holders of the Company<FDAG>

3.1           Restated Articles of Incorporation of the Company

3.2<F**>      Form of Amendment to Restated Articles of Incorporation of the Company (to be filed subsequent to
              completion of this offering)

3.3<F**>      Bylaws of the Company

4.1<F**>      See Exhibits 3.1 and 3.2

4.2<F**>      See Exhibit 3.3

5.1           Opinion of Legal Counsel

10.1<F**>     Investment Advisory Agreement dated as of May 1, 1995 between General American and CAM relating to
              General American's general account

10.2<F**>     Investment Advisory Agreement dated as of July 2, 1990 between General American and CAM relating to
              General American's separate accounts

10.3<F**>     Investment Advisory Agreement dated as of July 23, 1997 between General American Capital Company and
              CAM

10.4<F**>     Lease Agreement dated as of July 31, 1996 between General American and CAM<FDAG>

10.5          Sublease effective as of July 19, 1995 between General American and CAM

10.6<F**>     Administrative Services Agreement effective as of August 11, 1995 between the Company and General
              American

10.7<F**>     Tax Sharing Agreement effective as of July 24, 1995 between the Company, CAM and General American

10.8<F**>     Amended and Restated Shareholders' Agreement effective as of November 22, 1996 among the Company,
              General American, General American Holding Company, and the Shareholders and Option Holders of the
              Company

10.9          Registration Rights Agreement dated as of June 12, 1997 among the Company, General American and
              General American Holding Company

10.10<F**>    Tax Allocation and Tax Sharing Agreement dated as of June 12, 1997 between the Company, Conning,
              Inc., Conning & Company, CAM and General American Mutual Holding Company

10.11<F**>    Form of Employment Agreement dated August 11, 1995 between the Company (formerly Conning Asset
              Management Company), Conning & Company and Employee, including Messrs. Hansen and Schpero

10.12         Employment Agreement dated August 11, 1995 between the Company (as assignee) and Leonard M. Rubenstein

                                     II-5

<PAGE> 127
<CAPTION>
                           EXHIBIT INDEX (CONTINUED)


EXHIBIT
NUMBER                                             DESCRIPTION

<C>           <S>
10.13<F**>    Employment Agreement dated August 11, 1995 between the Company (formerly Conning Asset Management
              Company), Conning & Company and Maurice W. Slayton

10.14<FDDAG>  Software License Agreement effective as of January 27, 1996 among CAM, General American and SS&C
              Technologies, Inc. (formerly Securities, Software & Consulting Inc.)

10.15<F**>    1995 Flexible Stock Plan

10.16<F**>    1996 Flexible Stock Plan

10.17         1997 Flexible Stock Plan

10.18<F**>    Form of Incentive Stock Option Award and Terms and Conditions under 1995 Flexible Stock Plan

10.19<F**>    Form of Incentive Stock Option Award and Terms and Conditions under 1996 Flexible Stock Plan

10.20         Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Award and Terms and Conditions under 1997 Flexible Stock Plan

10.21<F**>    Office Lease dated August 22, 1989 among Hartford CityPlace L.L.C., Conning, Inc. and Conning &
              Company, as amended as of June 30, 1997

10.22<F**>    Venture Carried Interests Allocation Plan, as amended

10.23         Amended and Restated Limited Partnership Agreement of Conning Investment Partners Limited Partner-
              ship III, as amended

10.24<F**>    Limited Liability Company Agreement of Conning Connecticut Investors, L.L.C.

10.25<F**>    Limited Liability Company Agreement of Conning Investment Partners II, L.L.C.

10.26<F**>    Limited Liability Company Agreement of Conning Investment Partners V, L.L.C., dated as of October
              31, 1997

11.1<F**>     Statement Re: Computation of Per Share Earnings

21.1<F**>     Subsidiaries of the Company

23.1          Consent of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP

23.2          Consent of Price Waterhouse LLP

23.3          Consent of Legal Counsel (included in Exhibit 5.1)

23.4<F**>     Consent of Eager & Associates

23.5<F**>     Consent of OneSource Information Services, Inc.

24.1<F**>     Power of Attorney

27.1<F**>     Financial Data Schedule

27.2<F**>     Financial Data Schedule

<FN>
- --------

<F**>    Previously filed

<FDAG>   Schedules omitted pursuant to Regulation S-K, Item 601(b)(2) of the
         Commission. The registrant hereby undertakes to furnish such schedules
         to the Commission supplementally upon request.

<FDDAG>  Incorporated by reference from Exhibit No. 10.15 to the Registration
         Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-3094) filed by SS&C Technologies, Inc.
         Pursuant to Rule 406 under the Securities Act, confidential treatment
         has been requested with respect to certain portions of this exhibit.
         Omitted portions will be filed separately with the Commission.
</TABLE>
    

                                     II-6

<PAGE> 128

                                APPENDIX

      Pages 23 and 27 contain bar graphs. The information contained in the
graphs are presented in a tabular format that may be processed by the EDGAR
system.


<PAGE> 1


                            2,500,000 Shares

                          CONNING CORPORATION

                              Common Stock

                         UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT
                         ----------------------




                                                        December 15, 1997





DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE
  SECURITIES CORPORATION
A.G. EDWARDS & SONS, INC.
  As representatives of the
    several underwriters
    named in Schedule I hereto
  c/o Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette
       Securities Corporation
      277 Park Avenue
      New York, New York  10172

Ladies and Gentlemen:

            Conning Corporation, a Missouri corporation (the "Company"),
proposes to issue and sell 2,500,000 shares of its Common Stock, par value
$0.01 per share (the "Firm Shares"), to the several underwriters named in
Schedule I hereto (the "Underwriters").  The Company also proposes to issue
and sell to the several Underwriters not more than 375,000 additional shares
of its Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share (the "Additional Shares"), if
requested by the Underwriters as provided in Section 2 hereof.  The Firm
Shares and the Additional Shares are hereinafter collectively referred to as
the "Shares".  The shares of common stock of the Company to be outstanding
after giving effect to the sales contemplated hereby are hereinafter referred
to as the "Common Stock".


            1.      Registration Statement and Prospectus.  The Company has
                    -------------------------------------
prepared and filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
"Commission") in accordance with the provisions of the Securities Act of
1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder
(collectively called the "Act"), a registration statement on Form S-1 (No.
333-35993) including a prospectus relating to the Shares, which may be
amended.  The registration statement as amended at the time that it becomes
effective, including a registration statement (if any) filed pursuant to Rule
462(b) under the Act increasing the size of the offering registered under the
Act and information (if any) deemed to be part of the registration statement
at the time of effectiveness pursuant to Rule 430A under the Act, is
hereinafter referred to as the "Registration Statement"; and the prospectus
in the form



<PAGE> 2

first used to confirm sales of Shares is hereinafter referred to as the
"Prospectus".

            2.      Agreements to Sell and Purchase.  On the basis of the
                    -------------------------------
representations and warranties contained in this Agreement, and subject to
its terms and conditions, the Company agrees to issue and sell, and each
Underwriter agrees, severally and not jointly, to purchase from the Company
at a price per share of $------ (the "Purchase Price") the number of Firm
Shares set forth opposite the name of such Underwriter in Schedule I hereto.

            On the basis of the representations and warranties contained in
this Agreement, and subject to its terms and conditions, the Company agrees
to issue and sell the Additional Shares and the Underwriters shall have the
right to purchase, severally and not jointly, up to 375,000 Additional Shares
from the Company at the Purchase Price.  Additional Shares may be purchased
solely for the purpose of covering over-allotments made in connection with
the offering of the Firm Shares.  The Underwriters may exercise their right
to purchase Additional Shares in whole or in part from time to time by giving
written notice thereof to the Company within 30 days after the date of this
Agreement.  You shall give any such notice on behalf of the Underwriters and
such notice shall specify the aggregate number of Additional Shares to be
purchased pursuant to such exercise and the date for payment and delivery
thereof.  The date specified in any such notice shall be a business day (i)
no earlier than the Closing Date (as hereinafter defined), (ii) no later than
ten business days after such notice has been given and (iii) no earlier than
two business days after such notice has been given.  If any Additional Shares
are to be purchased, each Underwriter, severally and not jointly, agrees to
purchase from the Company the number of Additional Shares (subject to such
adjustments to eliminate fractional shares as you may determine) which bears
the same proportion to the total number of Additional Shares to be purchased
from the Company as the number of Firm Shares set forth opposite the name of
such Underwriter in Schedule I bears to the total number of Firm Shares.

            The Company hereby agrees and the Company shall, concurrently
with the execution of this Agreement, deliver an agreement executed by (i)
each of the directors and officers of the Company and (ii) each stockholder
listed on Annex I hereto, pursuant to which each such person agrees not to
offer, sell, contract to sell, grant any option to purchase, or otherwise
dispose of any common stock of the Company or any securities convertible into
or exercisable or exchangeable for such common stock or in any other manner
transfer all or a portion of the economic consequences associated with the
ownership of any such common stock, except to the Underwriters pursuant to
this Agreement, for a period of 180 days after the date of the Prospectus
without the prior written consent of Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities
Corporation.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, during such 180-day period, (a)
the Company may (i) issue shares of common stock of the Company or any
securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for such common
stock in connection with acquisitions in which the acquiror or acquirors of
such shares or options agree(s) to the transfer restrictions set forth in
this paragraph, (ii) grant stock options or other stock-based awards or
issue shares of common stock pursuant to the 1997 Flexible Stock Plan of the
Company (as filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement) or any other
employee benefit plan of the Company and (iii) issue shares of its common
stock upon the exercise of an option or warrant or the conversion of a
security outstanding on the date hereof and (b) shares of common stock of the
Company may be (i) transferred to a trust for the benefit of the holder of
such shares or for the benefit of the spouse or descendants of such holder or
to the estate, heirs or devisees of the holder of such shares upon the death
of such holder and (ii) pledged as security for obligations of the holders
thereof.

            3.      Terms of Public Offering.  The Company is advised by
                    ------------------------
you that the Underwriters propose (i) to make a public offering of their
respective portions of the Shares as soon after the effective date of the
Registration Statement as in your judgment is advisable and (ii) initially to
offer the Shares upon the terms set forth in the Prospectus.

            4.      Delivery and Payment.  The Shares shall be represented
                    --------------------
by definitive certificates and shall be issued in such authorized denominations
and registered in such names as Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities
Corporation shall request not later than two business days prior to the
Closing Date or the applicable Option Closing Date (as defined below), as the
case may be.  The Company shall deliver the Shares, with any transfer taxes
thereon duly paid by the Company, to Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities
Corporation through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company ("DTC"),
for the respective accounts of the several Underwriters, against payment to
the Company of the Purchase Price therefor by wire transfer of Federal or
other funds immediately available in New



<PAGE> 3

York City.  The Certificates representing the Shares shall be made available for
inspection not later than 9:30 A.M., New York City time, on the business day
prior to the Closing Date or the applicable Option Closing Date, as the case may
be, at the office of DTC or its designated custodian (the "Designated Office").
The time and date of delivery and payment for the Firm Shares shall be 9:00
A.M., New York City time, on December 18, 1997 or such other time and date as
Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation and the Company shall agree
in writing (the "Closing Date").  The time and date of delivery and payment for
any Additional Shares to be purchased by the Underwriters shall be 9:00 A.M.,
New York City time, on the date specified in the applicable exercise notice
given by you pursuant to Section 2 or such other time and date as Donaldson,
Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation and the Company shall agree in writing
(an "Option Closing Date").

            The documents to be delivered on the Closing Date or any Option
Closing Date on behalf of the parties hereto pursuant to Section 8 of this
Agreement shall be delivered at the offices of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett,
425 Lexington Avenue, New York, New York 10017 and the Shares shall be
delivered at the Designated Office, all on the Closing Date or such Option
Closing Date, as the case may be.

            5.      Agreements of the Company.  The Company agrees with
                    -------------------------
you:

            (a)     To use its reasonable best efforts to cause the
      Registration Statement to become effective at the earliest possible
      time after December 11, 1997.

            (b)     To advise you promptly and, if requested by you, to
      confirm such advice in writing, (i) when the Registration Statement has
      become effective and when any post-effective amendment to it becomes
      effective, (ii) of any request by the Commission for amendments to the
      Registration Statement or amendments or supplements to the Prospectus
      or for additional information, (iii) of the issuance by the Commission
      of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration
      Statement or of the suspension of qualification of the Shares for
      offering or sale in any jurisdiction, or the initiation of any
      proceeding for such purposes, and (iv) of the happening of any event
      during the period referred to in paragraph (e) below which makes any
      statement of a material fact made in the Registration Statement or the
      Prospectus untrue or which requires the making of any additions to or
      changes in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus in order to
      make the statements therein not misleading.  If at any time the
      Commission shall issue any stop order suspending the effectiveness of
      the Registration Statement, the Company will make every reasonable
      effort to obtain the withdrawal or lifting of such order at the
      earliest possible time.

            (c)     To furnish to you, without charge, three signed copies of
      the Registration Statement as first filed with the Commission and of
      each amendment to it, including all exhibits, and to furnish to you and
      each Underwriter designated by you such number of conformed copies of
      the Registration Statement as so filed and of each amendment to it,
      without exhibits, as you may reasonably request.

            (d)     Not to file any amendment or supplement to the
      Registration Statement, whether before or after the time when it
      becomes effective, or to make any amendment or supplement to the
      Prospectus of which you shall not previously have been advised or to
      which you shall reasonably object; and to prepare and file with the
      Commission, promptly upon your reasonable request, any amendment to the
      Registration Statement or supplement to the Prospectus which may be
      necessary or advisable in connection with the distribution of the
      Shares by you, and to use its reasonable best efforts to cause the same
      to become promptly effective.

            (e)     Promptly after the Registration Statement becomes
      effective, and from time to time thereafter for such period as in the
      opinion of counsel for the Underwriters a prospectus is required by law
      to be delivered in connection with sales by an Underwriter or a dealer,
      to furnish to each Underwriter and dealer as many copies of the
      Prospectus (and of any amendment or supplement to the Prospectus) as
      such Underwriter or dealer may reasonably request.

            (f)     If during the period specified in paragraph (e) any event
      shall occur as a result of which, in the



<PAGE> 4

      opinion of counsel for the Underwriters, it becomes necessary to amend or
      supplement the Prospectus in order to make the statements therein, in the
      light of the circumstances when the Prospectus is delivered to a
      purchaser, not misleading, or if it is necessary to amend or supplement
      the Prospectus to comply in all material respects with any law, forthwith
      to prepare and file with the Commission an appropriate amendment or
      supplement to the Prospectus so that the statements in the Prospectus, as
      so amended or supplemented, will not in the light of the circumstances
      when it is so delivered, be misleading, or so that the Prospectus will
      comply with law, and to furnish to each Underwriter and to such dealers as
      you shall specify, such number of copies thereof as such Underwriter or
      dealers may reasonably request.

            (g)     Prior to any public offering of the Shares, to cooperate
      with you and counsel for the Underwriters in connection with the
      registration or qualification of the Shares for offer and sale by the
      several Underwriters and by dealers under the state securities or Blue
      Sky laws of such jurisdictions as you may request, to continue such
      qualification in effect so long as required for distribution of the
      Shares and to file such consents to service of process or other
      documents as may be necessary in order to effect such registration or
      qualification; provided that the Company and its subsidiaries will not
      be required to qualify generally to do business in any jurisdiction
      where it is not then so qualified or to take any action which would
      subject it to general service of process or to taxation in any such
      jurisdiction where it is not then so subject.

            (h)     To mail and make generally available to its stockholders
      as soon as reasonably practicable an earnings statement covering a
      period of at least twelve months after the effective date of the
      Registration Statement (but in no event commencing later than 90 days
      after such date) which shall satisfy the provisions of Section 11(a) of
      the Act, and to advise you in writing when such statement has been so
      made available.

            (i)     During the period of one year after the date of this
      Agreement, (i) to mail as soon as reasonably practicable after the end
      of each fiscal year to the record holders of its Common Stock a
      financial report of the Company and its subsidiaries on a consolidated
      basis (and a similar financial report of all unconsolidated
      subsidiaries, if any), all such financial reports to include a
      consolidated balance sheet, a consolidated statement of operations, a
      consolidated statement of cash flows and a consolidated statement of
      shareholders' equity as of the end of and for such fiscal year,
      together with comparable information as of the end of and for the
      preceding year, certified by independent certified public accountants,
      and (ii) to mail and make generally available as soon as practicable
      after the end of each quarterly period (except for the last quarterly
      period of each fiscal year) to such holders, an unaudited consolidated
      balance sheet and an unaudited consolidated statement of income (or
      alternatively, upon the consent of Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities
      Corporation, a summary consolidated balance sheet and summary consolidated
      statement of income) (and similar financial reports of all unconsolidated
      subsidiaries, if any) as of the end of and for such period, and for the
      period from the beginning of such year to the close of such quarterly
      period, together with comparable information for the corresponding periods
      of the preceding year.

            (j)     During the period referred to in paragraph (i), to
      furnish to you promptly upon your request a copy of each report or
      other publicly available information of the Company mailed to the
      holders of Common Stock or filed with the Commission.

            (k)     To pay all costs, expenses, fees and taxes incident to
      (i) the preparation, printing, filing and distribution under the Act of
      the Registration Statement (including financial statements and
      exhibits), each preliminary prospectus and all amendments and
      supplements to any of them prior to or during the period specified in
      paragraph (e), (ii) the printing and delivery of the Prospectus and all
      amendments or supplements to it during the period specified in
      paragraph (e), (iii) the photocopying and delivery of this Agreement,
      the Preliminary and Supplemental Blue Sky Memoranda and all other
      agreements, memoranda, correspondence and other documents photocopied
      and delivered in connection with the offering of the Shares (including
      in each case any disbursements of counsel for the Underwriters relating
      to such photocopying and delivery), (iv) the registration or
      qualification of the Shares for offer and sale under the securities or
      Blue Sky laws of the several states (including in each case the
      reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for the Underwriters
      relating to such registration or qualification and memoranda relating
      thereto which shall not exceed $7,500), (v) filings and clearance with
      the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. (the



<PAGE> 5

      "NASD") in connection with the offering, (vi) the listing of the Shares on
      the Nasdaq National Market, (vii) furnishing such copies of the
      Registration Statement, the Prospectus and all amendments and
      supplements thereto as may be requested for use in connection with the
      offering or sale of the Shares by the Underwriters or by dealers to
      whom Shares may be sold and (viii) the performance by the Company of
      its other obligations under this Agreement; provided, that in no event
      shall the Company be responsible for the fees and expenses of your
      counsel, except as provided in the foregoing clauses (iii) and (iv).

            (l)     On the date of this Agreement, its intent is to use its
      reasonable best efforts to maintain the inclusion of the Common Stock
      on the Nasdaq National Market (or on a national securities exchange)
      for a period of three years after the effective date of the
      Registration Statement.

            (m)     To use its reasonable best efforts to do and perform all
      things required or necessary to be done and performed under this
      Agreement by the Company prior to the Closing Date or any Option
      Closing Date, as the case may be, and to satisfy all conditions
      precedent to the delivery of the Shares.

            6.      Representations and Warranties of the Company.  The
                    ---------------------------------------------
Company represents and warrants to each Underwriter that:

            (a)     The Registration Statement has become effective; no stop
      order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement is in
      effect, and no proceedings for such purpose are pending before or, to
      the Company's knowledge, threatened by the Commission.

            (b)   (i)  Each part of the Registration Statement, when such
      part became effective, did not contain, and each such part, as amended
      or supplemented, if applicable, will not contain, any untrue statement
      of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be
      stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
      misleading, (ii) the Registration Statement and the Prospectus comply
      and, as amended or supplemented, if applicable, will comply in all
      material respects with the Act and (iii) the Prospectus does not
      contain and, as amended or supplemented, if applicable, will not
      contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
      material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of
      the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading, except
      that the representations and warranties set forth in this paragraph (b)
      do not apply to statements or omissions in the Registration Statement
      or the Prospectus based upon information relating to any Underwriter
      furnished to the Company in writing by such Underwriter through you
      expressly for use therein.

            (c)     Each preliminary prospectus filed as part of the
      registration statement as originally filed or as part of any amendment
      thereto, or filed pursuant to Rule 424 under the Act, and each
      Registration Statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Act, if
      any, complied when so filed in all material respects with the Act; and
      did not contain an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state
      a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the
      statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they
      were made, not misleading, except that the representations and
      warranties set forth in this paragraph (c) do not apply to statements
      or omissions in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus based upon
      information relating to any Underwriter furnished to the Company in
      writing by such Underwriter through you expressly for use therein.

            (d)     Each of the Company and its subsidiaries has been duly
      incorporated, is validly existing as a corporation in good standing
      under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation and has the
      corporate power and authority to carry on its business as it is
      currently being conducted and to own, lease and operate its properties,
      and each is duly qualified and is in good standing as a foreign
      corporation authorized to do business in each jurisdiction in which the
      nature of its business or its ownership or leasing of property requires
      such qualification, except where the failure to be so qualified would
      not have a material adverse effect on the Company and its subsidiaries,
      taken as a whole.

            (e)     All of the outstanding shares of capital stock of, or
      other ownership interests in, each of the Company's subsidiaries have
      been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully paid and
      non-assessable,



<PAGE> 6

      and are owned by the Company, free and clear of any security interest,
      claim, lien, encumbrance or adverse interest of any nature.

            (f)     All the outstanding shares of capital stock of the
      Company have been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully
      paid, non-assessable and not subject to any preemptive or similar
      rights which have not been waived; and the Shares have been duly
      authorized and, when issued and delivered to the Underwriters against
      payment therefor as provided by this Agreement, will be validly issued,
      fully paid and non-assessable, and the issuance of such Shares will not
      be subject to any preemptive or similar rights.

            (g)     The authorized capital stock of the Company, including
      the Common Stock, conforms as to legal matters in all material respects
      to the description thereof contained in the Prospectus.

            (h)     Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries is (i) in
      violation of its respective charter or by-laws or (ii) in default in
      the performance of any obligation, agreement or condition contained in
      any bond, debenture, note or any other evidence of indebtedness or in
      any other agreement, indenture or instrument, in each case material to
      the conduct of the business of the Company or any of its subsidiaries,
      to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or by which
      it or any of its subsidiaries or their respective properties are bound,
      except where such default in this clause (ii) would not have a material
      adverse effect on the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

            (i)     The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement
      by the Company, compliance by the Company with all the provisions
      hereof and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby by
      the Company will not require any consent, approval, authorization or
      other order of any court, regulatory body, administrative agency or
      other governmental body (except as such has been obtained or may be
      required under the securities or Blue Sky laws of the various states)
      and will not (x) conflict with or constitute a breach of any of the
      terms or provisions of, or a default under, the charter or by-laws of
      the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any agreement, indenture or
      other instrument to which it or any of its subsidiaries is a party or
      by which it or any of its subsidiaries or their respective properties
      are bound, or (y) violate or conflict with any laws, administrative
      regulations or rulings or court decrees applicable to the Company, any
      of its subsidiaries or their respective properties, except where such
      conflict, breach, default or violation would not have a material
      adverse effect on the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

            (j)     Except as otherwise set forth in the Prospectus, there
      are no material legal or governmental proceedings pending to which the
      Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or of which any of their
      respective properties are the subject, and, to the best of the
      Company's knowledge, no such proceedings are threatened or
      contemplated.  No contract or document of a character required to be
      described in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or to be
      filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement is not so described
      or filed as required.

            (k)     Each of Conning & Company and Conning Asset Management
      Company ("CAMCO") is, and, upon consummation of this Agreement, will
      be, registered as an investment adviser with the Commission under the
      Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended (the "Advisers Act"), and
      each is duly registered, licensed or qualified as an investment adviser
      in each jurisdiction where the conduct of its respective business
      requires such registration and each is in compliance in all material
      respects with the Advisers Act and all other applicable United States
      federal and state laws requiring any such registration, licensing or
      qualification.  Neither the Company nor any other subsidiary of the
      Company is required to be registered, licensed or qualified as an
      investment adviser under the laws of the United States or any state in
      which it or its subsidiaries conduct business.

            (l)     Consummation of the transactions contemplated by this
      Agreement will not constitute an assignment, as defined in the Advisers
      Act or the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the "1940 Act"),
      such that any investment advisory agreement of Conning & Company or
      CAMCO would be automatically terminated or would require client consent
      to continue in effect.



<PAGE> 7

            (m)     Each of the investment advisory agreements and service
      agreements to which any of the Company's subsidiaries is a party is a
      legal and valid obligation of such subsidiaries, and none of the
      Company's subsidiaries is in breach or violation of or in default under
      any such agreement, except when such breach or violation would not have
      a material adverse effect on the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as
      a whole.

            (n)     Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries is
      required to register with the Commission as an investment company under
      the 1940 Act.

            (o)     Conning & Company is duly registered as a broker-dealer
      under the Exchange Act and under the securities laws of each United
      States jurisdiction where the conduct of its business requires such
      registration and has complied and is in compliance in all material
      respects with the Exchange Act, all applicable rules and regulations of
      the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. and all other
      United States federal and state laws requiring any such registration.
      Neither the Company nor any of its other subsidiaries is required to
      register, license or qualify as a broker-dealer with the Commission
      under the Exchange Act or under the laws requiring any such
      registration, licensing or qualification in any state in which it or,
      in the case of the Company, its subsidiaries conduct business.

            (p)     Each of Conning & Company and CAMCO has adopted a written
      code of ethics and a written policy regarding insider trading.  Such
      code of ethics complies in all material respects with Section 17(j) of
      the 1940 Act and Rule 17j-1 thereunder and such written policy complies
      in all material respects with Section 204A of the Advisers Act.  The
      restrictions, internal procedures or disclosure practices used by each
      of Conning & Company and CAMCO with respect to conflicts of interest
      are as set forth in the most recent Form ADV thereof (or incorporated
      by reference therein), as amended.  To the knowledge of the Company,
      there have been no material violations or allegations of material
      violations of such restrictions, internal policies or disclosure
      practices.

            (q)     None of Conning & Company, CAMCO, their respective
      subsidiaries or, to the knowledge of the Company, any Fund which
      Conning & Company or CAMCO or their respective subsidiaries has
      sponsored or organized, and, to the knowledge of the Company, no person
      "associated" (as defined under the Advisers Act) with Conning &
      Company, CAMCO or their respective subsidiaries, has been convicted of
      any crime or is or has engaged in any conduct that would be a basis for
      denial, suspension or revocation of registration of an investment
      adviser under Section 203(e) of the Advisers Act or Rule 206(4)-4(b)
      thereunder or, with respect to Conning & Company, of a broker-dealer
      under Section 15 of the Exchange Act, or for disqualification as an
      investment adviser for any registered investment company (as defined in
      the 1940 Act) (an "Investment Company") pursuant to Section 9(a) of the
      1940 Act, and to the knowledge of the Company, there is no basis for,
      or proceeding or investigation that is reasonably likely to become the
      basis for, any such disqualification, denial, suspension or revocation.
      For purposes of this Agreement, "Fund" means any Investment Company and
      any company that would be an Investment Company but for the exemption
      contained in Section 3(c)(1), the final clause of Section 3(c)(3) or
      Section 3(c)(11) of the 1940 Act, in each case to which as of the date
      of this Agreement Conning & Company or CAMCO provides investment
      management or investment advisory services.

            (r)     Each of Conning & Company and CAMCO, in managing the
      account of each client (including any Fund) to which it provides
      investment management, investment advisory, administrative or
      distribution services as of the date of this Agreement (each such
      client, a "Client"), has complied and is in compliance in all material
      respects with such Client's objectives, guidelines and restrictions
      disclosed to Conning & Company or CAMCO, including, without limitation,
      any limitation set forth in the applicable prospectus (in the case of a
      Fund) or governing instruments for such Client, and including
      compliance in all material respects with any other offering,
      advertising and marketing materials of any Fund; and each of Conning &
      Company and CAMCO, in advising its Clients, has complied and is in
      compliance in all material respects with the 1940 Act.

            (s)     Conning & Company or CAMCO, as the case may be, has
      managed the accounts of each



<PAGE> 8

      Client (other than a client that is a Client solely by reason of its
      investment in a Fund that is an Investment Company) that has represented
      to Conning & Company or CAMCO, as the case may be, that it is (i) an
      employee benefit plan, as defined in Section 3(3) of the Employee
      Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA") (unless the
      Client has represented to Conning & Company or CAMCO, as the case may be,
      that it is a governmental plan, church plan or otherwise not subject to
      Title I of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
      amended (the "Code"), or Conning & Company or CAMCO, as the case may be,
      reasonably believes that it is not subject to Title I of ERISA or Section
      4975 of the Code), or (ii) a person acting on behalf of such a plan, in
      compliance in all material respects with the applicable requirements of
      ERISA, except where such lack of compliance or violation would not have a
      material adverse effect on the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a
      whole.

            (t)     Each Client that is a registered Investment Company has
      elected to be treated as a "regulated investment company" under
      Subchapter M of Chapter 1 of Subtitle A of the Code, has at all times
      since the end of the most recent taxable year of such Client that has
      been closed and for which the statute of limitations for assessments
      has expired qualified as a regulated investment company and, to the
      knowledge of the Company, each such Client has complied in all material
      respects with all applicable provisions of law necessary to preserve
      and retain such Client's election and status as a regulated investment
      company or has determined not to retain such status.

            (u)     Each Client has operated and is currently operating in
      compliance in all material respects with the Act, the 1940 Act and the
      rules and regulations thereunder, to the extent the Company or any of
      its subsidiaries has legal responsibility for such compliance as a
      matter of law or due to its contractual relationship with such Client.

            (v)     The operation of the business of each Fund which is not
      registered as an Investment Company under the 1940 Act, including
      without limitation the offering of interests therein, has been in
      compliance in all material respects with the 1940 Act or the relevant
      exemptions therefrom.

            (w)     Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has
      violated (x) any federal or state law relating to discrimination in the
      hiring, promotion or pay of employees nor any applicable federal or
      state wages and hours laws, nor any provisions of ERISA or the rules
      and regulations promulgated thereunder, nor (y) any state or local law
      or regulation relating to the mortgage origination and servicing
      activities of the Company and its subsidiaries described in the
      Prospectus, which in the case of each of clauses (x) and (y) might,
      individually or in the aggregate, result in any material adverse change
      in the business, prospects, financial condition or results of
      operations of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

            (x)     Except where the failure to do so would not have a
      material adverse effect on the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a
      whole, the Company and each of its subsidiaries has such other permits,
      licenses, franchises and authorizations of governmental or regulatory
      authorities ("permits") as are necessary to own, lease and operate its
      respective properties and to conduct its business; the Company and each
      of its subsidiaries has fulfilled and performed all of its material
      obligations with respect to such permits and no event has occurred
      which allows, or after notice or lapse of time would allow, revocation
      or termination thereof or results in any other material impairment of
      the rights of the holder of any such permit; and, except as may be
      described in the Prospectus, such permits contain no restrictions that
      are materially burdensome to the Company or any of its subsidiaries.

            (y)     Except as otherwise set forth in the Prospectus or such
      as are not material to the business, prospects, financial condition or
      results of operations of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a
      whole, the Company and each of its subsidiaries have good and
      marketable title, free and clear of all liens, claims, encumbrances and
      restrictions except liens for taxes not yet due and payable, to all
      property and assets described in the Registration Statement as being
      owned by them.  All material leases to which the Company or any of its
      subsidiaries is a party are valid and binding and no default has
      occurred or is continuing thereunder which might, individually or in
      the aggregate with any such other defaults, result in any material
      adverse change in the business, prospects, financial condition or
      results of operations of the



<PAGE> 9

      Company and its subsidiaries taken as a whole, and the Company and its
      subsidiaries enjoy peaceful and undisturbed possession under all such
      leases to which any of them is a party as lessee with such exceptions as
      do not materially interfere with the use made by the Company or such
      subsidiary.

            (z)     The Company and each of its subsidiaries maintain
      insurance reasonably deemed adequate for their businesses.

            (aa)    KPMG Peat Marwick LLP are independent public accountants
      with respect to the Company as required by the Act.

            (ab)    The financial statements, together with related schedules
      and notes forming part of the Registration Statement and the Prospectus
      (and any amendment or supplement thereto), present fairly in all
      material respects the consolidated financial position, results of
      operations and changes in financial position of the Company and its
      subsidiaries on the basis stated in the Registration Statement at the
      respective dates or for the respective periods to which they apply;
      such statements and related schedules and notes have been prepared in
      accordance with generally accepted accounting principles consistently
      applied throughout the periods involved, except as disclosed therein;
      and the other financial and statistical information and data set forth
      in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus (and any amendment or
      supplement thereto) is, in all material respects, accurately presented
      and prepared on a basis consistent with such financial statements and
      the books and records of the Company.

            (ac)    No holder of any security of the Company has any right to
      require registration of shares of Common Stock or any other security of
      the Company, except as disclosed in the Registration Statement or
      Prospectus.

            (ad)    The Company has filed a registration statement pursuant
      to Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act to register the Common Stock, has
      filed an application to list the Shares on the Nasdaq National Market,
      and has received notification that the listing has been approved,
      subject to notice of issuance of the Shares.

            (ae)    There are no outstanding subscriptions, rights, warrants,
      options, calls, convertible securities, commitments of sale or liens
      related to or entitling any person to purchase or otherwise to acquire
      any shares of the capital stock of, or other ownership interest in, the
      Company or any subsidiary thereof except as otherwise disclosed in the
      Registration Statement.

            (af)    There is (i) no significant unfair labor practice
      complaint pending against the Company or any of its subsidiaries or, to
      the best knowledge of the Company, threatened against any of them,
      before the National Labor Relations Board or any state or local labor
      relations board, and no significant grievance or more significant
      arbitration proceeding arising out of or under any collective
      bargaining agreement is so pending against the Company or any of its
      subsidiaries or, to the best knowledge of the Company, threatened
      against any of them, and (ii) no significant strike, labor dispute,
      slowdown or stoppage pending against the Company or any of its
      subsidiaries or, to the best knowledge of the Company, threatened
      against it or any of its subsidiaries except for such actions specified
      in clause (i) or (ii) above, which, singly or in the aggregate, could
      not reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the
      Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

            (ag)    The Company and each of its subsidiaries maintains a
      system of internal accounting controls sufficient to provide reasonable
      assurance that (i) transactions are executed in accordance with
      management's general or specific authorizations; (ii) transactions are
      recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in
      conformity with generally accepted accounting principles and to
      maintain asset accountability; (iii) access to assets is permitted only
      in accordance with management's general or specific authorization; and
      (iv) the recorded accountability for assets is compared with the
      existing assets at reasonable intervals and appropriate action is taken
      with respect to any differences.



<PAGE> 10

            (ah)    All material tax returns required to be filed by the
      Company and each of its subsidiaries in any jurisdiction have been
      filed, other than those filings being contested in good faith, and all
      material taxes currently due and payable, including withholding taxes,
      penalties and interest, assessments, fees and other charges due
      pursuant to such returns or pursuant to any assessment received by the
      Company or any of its subsidiaries have been paid, other than those
      being contested in good faith or for which adequate reserves have been
      provided.

            7.      Indemnification.  (a)  The Company agrees to indemnify
                    ---------------
and hold harmless each Underwriter, its directors, its officers and each
person, if any, who controls any Underwriter within the meaning of Section 15
of the Act or Section 20 of the Exchange Act, from and against any and all
losses, claims, damages, liabilities and judgments (including, without
limitation, any legal or other expenses incurred in connection with
investigating or defending any matter, including any action, that could give
rise to any such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or judgments) caused by
any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained
in the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), the Prospectus (or
any amendment or supplement thereto) or any preliminary prospectus, or caused
by any omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required
to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
misleading, except insofar as such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or
judgments are caused by any such untrue statement or omission or alleged
untrue statement or omission based upon information relating to any
Underwriter furnished in writing to the Company by such Underwriter through
you expressly for use therein; provided, however, that the foregoing
indemnity agreement with respect to any preliminary prospectus shall not
inure to the benefit of any Underwriter who failed to deliver a Prospectus
(as then amended or supplemented, provided by the Company to the several
Underwriters in the requisite quantity and on a timely basis to permit proper
delivery on or prior to the Closing Date) to the person asserting any losses,
claims, damages and liabilities and judgments caused by any untrue statement
or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any preliminary
prospectus, or caused by any omission or alleged omission to state therein a
material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the
statements therein not misleading, if such material misstatement or omission
or alleged material misstatement or omission was cured in such Prospectus and
the delivery of such Prospectus was required by law to be delivered at or
prior to the written confirmation of sale to such person.

            (b)  Each Underwriter agrees, severally and not jointly, to
indemnify and hold harmless the Company, its directors, its officers who sign
the Registration Statement and each person, if any, who controls the Company
within the meaning of Section 15 of the Act or Section 20 of the Exchange
Act, to the same extent as the foregoing indemnity from the Company to such
underwriter but only with reference to information relating to such
Underwriter furnished in writing to the Company by such Underwriter through
you expressly for use in the Registration Statement (or any amendment
thereto), the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) or any
preliminary prospectus.

            (c)  In case any action shall be commenced involving any person
in respect of which indemnity may be sought pursuant to Section 7(a) or 7(b)
(the "indemnified party"), the indemnified party shall promptly notify the
person against whom such indemnity may be sought (the "indemnifying party")
in writing (provided, however, that the failure to give such notice in a
prompt manner shall not relieve any of the indemnifying parties of its
obligations or liabilities except to the extent that such failure results in
the loss of any material rights or defenses) and the indemnifying party shall
assume the defense of such action, including the employment of counsel
reasonably satisfactory to the indemnified party and the payment of all fees
and expenses of such counsel, as incurred (except that in the case of any
action in respect of which indemnity may be sought pursuant to both Sections
7(a) and 7(b), the Underwriter shall not be required to assume the defense of
such action pursuant to this Section 7(c), but may employ separate counsel
and participate in the defense thereof, but the fees and expenses of such
counsel, except as provided below, shall be at the expense of such
Underwriter).  Any indemnified party shall have the right to employ separate
counsel in any such action and participate in the defense thereof, but the
fees and expenses of such counsel shall be at the expense of the indemnified
party unless (i) the employment of such counsel shall have been specifically
authorized in writing by the indemnifying party, (ii) the indemnifying party
shall have failed to assume the defense of such action or employ counsel
reasonably satisfactory to the indemnified party or (iii) the named parties
to any such action (including any impleaded parties) include both the
indemnified party and the indemnifying party, and the indemnified party shall
have been advised by such counsel that there may be one or more legal
defenses



<PAGE> 11

available to it which are different from or additional to those
available to the indemnifying party (in which case the indemnifying party
shall not have the right to assume the defense of such action on behalf of
the indemnified party).  In any such case, the indemnifying party shall not,
in connection with any one action or separate but substantially similar or
related actions in the same jurisdiction arising out of the same general
allegations or circumstances, be liable for the fees and expenses of more
than one separate firm of attorneys (in addition to any local counsel) for
all indemnified parties and all such fees and expenses shall be reimbursed as
they are incurred.  Such firm shall be designated in writing by Donaldson,
Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation, in the case of parties indemnified
pursuant to Section 7(a), and by the Company, in the case of parties
indemnified pursuant to Section 7(b).  The indemnifying party shall indemnify
and hold harmless the indemnified party from and against any and all losses,
claims, damages, liabilities and judgments by reason of any settlement of any
action (i) effected with its written consent or (ii) effected without its
written consent if the settlement is entered into more than forty business
days after the indemnifying party shall have received a request from the
indemnified party for reimbursement for the fees and expenses of counsel (in
any case where such fees and expenses are at the expense of the indemnifying
party) and, prior to the date of such settlement, the indemnifying party
shall have failed to comply with such reimbursement request.  No indemnifying
party shall, without the prior written consent of the indemnified party,
effect any settlement or compromise of, or consent to the entry of judgment
with respect to, any pending or threatened action in respect of which the
indemnified party is or could have been a party and indemnity or contribution
may be or could have been sought hereunder by the indemnified party, unless
such settlement, compromise or judgment (i) includes an unconditional release
of the indemnified party from all liability arising out of such action and
(ii) does not include a statement as to or an admission of fault, culpability
or a failure to act, by or on behalf of the indemnified party.

            (d)  To the extent the indemnification provided for in this
Section 7 is unavailable to an indemnified party in respect of any losses,
claims, damages, liabilities or judgments referred to therein, then each
indemnifying party, in lieu of indemnifying such indemnified party, shall
contribute to the amount paid or payable by such indemnified party as a
result of such losses, claims, damages, liabilities and judgments (i) in such
proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative benefits received by the
Company on the one hand and the Underwriters on the other hand from the
offering of the Shares or (ii) if the allocation provided by clause 7(d)(i)
above is not permitted by applicable law, in such proportion as is
appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred to in clause
7(d)(i) above but also the relative fault of the Company on the one hand and
the Underwriters on the other hand in connection with the statements or
omissions which resulted in such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or
judgments, as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.  The
relative benefits received by the Company on the one hand and the
Underwriters on the other hand shall be deemed to be in the same proportion
as the total net proceeds from the offering (after deducting underwriting
discounts and commissions, but before deducting expenses) received by the
Company, and the total underwriting discounts and commissions received by the
Underwriters, bear to the total price to the public of the Shares, in each
case as set forth in the table on the cover page of the Prospectus.  The
relative fault of the Company on the one hand and the Underwriters on the
other hand shall be determined by reference to, among other things, whether
the untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or the omission or
alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by
the Company or the Underwriters and the parties' relative intent, knowledge,
access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or
omission.

            The Company and the Underwriters agree that it would not be just
and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 7(d) were determined
by pro rata allocation (even if the Underwriters were treated as one entity
for such purpose) or by any other method of allocation which does not take
account of the equitable considerations referred to in the immediately
preceding paragraph.  The amount paid or payable by an indemnified party as a
result of the losses, claims, damages, liabilities or judgments referred to
in the immediately preceding paragraph shall be deemed to include, subject to
the limitations set forth above, any legal or other expenses reasonably
incurred by such indemnified party in connection with investigating or
defending any matter, including any action that could have given rise to such
losses, claims, damages, liabilities or judgments.  Notwithstanding the
provisions of this Section 7, no Underwriter shall be required to contribute
any amount in excess of the amount by which the total price at which the
Shares underwritten by it and distributed to the public were offered to the
public exceeds the amount of any damages which such Underwriter has otherwise
been required to pay by reason of such untrue or alleged untrue statement or
omission or alleged omission.  No person guilty of fraudulent



<PAGE> 12

misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Act) shall be
entitled to contribution from any person who was not guilty of such
fraudulent misrepresentation.  The Underwriters' obligations to contribute
pursuant to this Section 7(d) are several in proportion to the respective
number of Shares purchased by each of the Underwriters hereunder and not
joint.

            (e)  The remedies provided for in this Section 7 are not
exclusive and shall not limit any rights or remedies which may otherwise be
available to any indemnified party at law or in equity.

            8.      Conditions of Underwriters' Obligations.  The several
                    ---------------------------------------
obligations of the Underwriters to purchase the Firm Shares under this
Agreement are subject to the satisfaction of each of the following
conditions:

            (a)     All the representations and warranties of the Company
      contained in this Agreement shall be true and correct on the Closing
      Date with the same force and effect as if made on and as of the Closing
      Date.

            (b)     The Registration Statement shall have become effective
      not later than 5:30 P.M. (and in the case of a Registration Statement
      filed under Rule 462(b) of the Act, not later than 9:00 A.M. the next
      business day), New York City time, on the date of this Agreement or at
      such later date and time as you may approve in writing, and at the
      Closing Date no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the
      Registration Statement shall have been issued and no proceedings for
      that purpose shall have been commenced or shall be pending before or
      contemplated by the Commission.

            (c)   (i)  Since the date of the latest balance sheet included in
      the Registration Statement and the Prospectus, there shall not have
      been any material adverse change, or any development involving a
      prospective material adverse change, in the condition, financial or
      otherwise, or in the earnings, affairs or business prospects, whether
      or not arising in the ordinary course of business, of the Company, (ii)
      since the date of the latest balance sheet included in the Registration
      Statement and the Prospectus, there shall not have been any material
      adverse change, or any development involving a prospective material
      adverse change, in the capital stock or in the long-term debt of the
      Company from that set forth in the Registration Statement and the
      Prospectus, (iii) the Company and its subsidiaries shall have no
      liability or obligation, direct or contingent, which is material to the
      Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole, other than those
      reflected in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus and (iv) on
      the Closing Date you shall have received a certificate dated the
      Closing Date, signed by the Chief Executive Officer and the President
      of the Company, solely in their capacities as such, in the name and on
      behalf of the Company confirming the matters set forth in paragraphs
      (a), (b) and (c) of this Section 8.

            (d)     You shall have received on the Closing Date an opinion
      (satisfactory to you and counsel for the Underwriters), dated the
      Closing Date, of Bryan Cave LLP, counsel for the Company, to the effect
      that:

                        (i)     the Company has been duly incorporated, is
            validly existing as a corporation in good standing under the laws
            of its jurisdiction of incorporation and has the corporate power
            and authority required to carry on its business in all material
            respects as it is currently being conducted and to own, lease and
            operate its properties;

                        (ii)    all of the outstanding shares of Common Stock
            have been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully paid,
            non-assessable and not subject to any preemptive or similar
            rights which have not been waived;

                        (iii)   the Shares have been duly authorized and,
            when issued and delivered to the Underwriters against payment
            therefor as provided by this Agreement, will be validly issued,
            fully paid and non-assessable and not subject to any preemptive
            or similar rights under Missouri law or the Company's charter
            which have not been waived;

                        (iv)    this Agreement has been duly authorized,
            executed and delivered by the



<PAGE> 13

            Company and is a valid and binding agreement of the Company
            enforceable in accordance with its terms (except as rights to
            indemnity and contribution hereunder may be limited by applicable
            law and except to the extent that enforceability may be limited by
            applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, receivership,
            moratorium, fraudulent transfer and other similar laws relating to
            or affecting the rights and remedies of creditors generally and by
            general principles of equity including, without limitation, concepts
            of reasonableness, materiality, good faith and fair dealing and the
            possible unavailability of specific performance, injunctive
            relief or other equitable remedies, regardless of whether
            enforceability is considered in a proceeding in equity or at
            law);

                        (v)     the authorized capital stock of the Company,
            including the Common Stock, conforms as to legal matters in all
            material respects to the description thereof contained in the
            Prospectus;

                        (vi)    the Registration Statement has become
            effective under the Act, and to such counsel's knowledge, no stop
            order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement
            has been issued and no proceedings for that purpose are pending
            before or threatened by the Commission;

                        (vii)   the statements set forth in the Prospectus
            under the headings "Certain Relationships and Related
            Transactions", "Description of Capital Stock" and "Certain
            Charter and Bylaw Provisions" and in Items 14 of Part II of the
            Registration Statement, insofar as such statements constitute a
            summary of legal matters or agreements referred to therein,
            fairly present in all material respects the information called
            for with respect to such legal matters or agreements;

                        (viii)  the execution, delivery and performance of
            this Agreement by the Company and the consummation by the Company
            of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement will not
            require any consent, approval, authorization or other order of
            any federal or Missouri governmental body or agency (except as
            such may be required under the Act, under other securities or
            Blue Sky laws or by the NASD) and will not violate or constitute
            a breach of any of the terms or provisions of, or a default
            under, the charter or by-laws of the Company or any of its
            subsidiaries, or any agreement, indenture or other instrument
            filed or incorporated by reference as an exhibit to the
            Registration Statement, or violate any federal or Missouri
            statute or any rule or regulation that has been issued pursuant
            to any federal or Missouri statute (which rule or regulation such
            counsel would, in its experience, recognize as directly
            applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries or any of their
            properties) or any order known to such counsel issued pursuant to
            any federal or Missouri statute by any court or governmental
            agency or body or court having jurisdiction over the Company or
            any of its subsidiaries or any of their properties (except for
            breaches or defaults which would not have a material adverse
            effect on the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole);

                        (ix)    to such counsel's knowledge, there are no
            legal or governmental proceedings pending or threatened to which
            the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party, or to which
            any of their respective properties is subject, which is required
            to be described in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus
            and is not described, or of any contract or other document of a
            character required to be described in the Registration Statement
            or the Prospectus or to be filed as an exhibit to the
            Registration Statement which is not described or filed;

                        (x)     each of Conning & Company and CAMCO is duly
            registered as an investment adviser under the Advisers Act;

                        (xi)    consummation of the transactions contemplated
            by this Agreement will not constitute an assignment, as defined
            in the Advisers Act or the 1940 Act, such that, pursuant to
            either such act, any investment advisory agreement of Conning &
            Company or CAMCO would be automatically terminated or would
            require client consent to continue in effect;



<PAGE> 14

                        (xii)   the Company is not currently required and,
            giving effect to the application of the net proceeds from the
            sale of the Shares as described in the Registration Statement or
            Prospectus, is not required to register with the Commission as an
            investment company under the 1940 Act;

                        (xiii)  Conning & Company is duly registered as a
            broker-dealer under the Exchange Act;

                        (xiv)   to such counsel's knowledge, no holder of any
            security of the Company has any right to require registration of
            shares of Common Stock or other security of the Company, other
            than as described in the Registration Statement or Prospectus;
            and

                        (xv)   the Registration Statement and the Prospectus
            and any supplement or amendment thereto comply as to form in all
            material respects with the requirements of the Act and the
            applicable rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder, it
            being understood that such counsel need express no opinion with
            respect to the financial statements and the notes thereto and the
            schedules and other financial and statistical data included in
            any of the documents mentioned in this clause or as to the
            accuracy, completeness or fairness of the Prospectus or the
            Registration Statement, as amended or supplemented.

            In addition to the matters set forth above, such counsel shall
state that during such counsel's participation in the preparation of the
Registration Statement and the Prospectus, such counsel participated in
conferences with officers and other representatives of the Company,
representatives of the independent public accountants of the Company, your
representatives and your counsel at which conferences the contents of the
Registration Statement and Prospectus and related matters were discussed,
reviewed and revised.  Although such counsel is not passing upon, and does
not assume responsibility for, the accuracy, completeness or fairness of the
statements made or included in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus,
both as amended or supplemented, no facts have come to such counsel's
attention that cause such counsel to believe that the Registration Statement,
as of its effective date and including any further amendment or supplement
thereto made by the Company prior to the Closing Date, contained any untrue
statement of a material fact or omitted to state any material fact required
to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein not
misleading or that the Prospectus, as of the Closing Date, contains any
untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state any material fact
necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading (it being understood
that such counsel need express no opinion with respect to the financial
statements and the notes thereto and the schedules and other financial and
statistical data included in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus).

            The opinion of Bryan Cave LLP described in this paragraph (d)
shall be rendered to you at the request of the Company and shall so state
therein.  Such opinions may recite that no opinion is expressed with respect
to, and that such counsel is not passing upon, and does not assume
responsibility for any matters relating to insurance laws, statutes, rules,
regulations or policies.  In addition, such opinions may contain customary
recitals, conditions and qualifications.

            (e)     You shall have received on the Closing Date an opinion
      (satisfactory to you and counsel for the Underwriters), dated the
      Closing Date, of Matthew P. McCauley, Esq., General Counsel and
      Secretary of the Company, to the effect that:

                        (i)     each of the Company and its subsidiaries is
            duly qualified and is in good standing as a foreign corporation
            authorized to do business in each jurisdiction in which the
            nature of its business or its ownership or leasing of property
            requires such qualification, except where the failure to be so
            qualified would not have a material adverse effect on the Company
            and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole;



<PAGE> 15

                        (ii)    each of the Company's subsidiaries has been
            duly incorporated, is validly existing as a corporation in good
            standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation and
            has the corporate power and authority required to carry on its
            business in all material respects as it is currently being
            conducted and to own, lease and operate its properties;

                        (iii)   all of the outstanding shares of capital
            stock of, or other ownership interests in, each of the Company's
            subsidiaries have been duly and validly authorized and issued and
            are fully paid and non-assessable, and are owned of record by the
            Company, directly or indirectly through one or more subsidiaries,
            free and clear of any security interest, claim, lien or other
            encumbrance;

                        (iv)    neither the Company nor any of its
            subsidiaries is in violation of its respective charter or by-laws
            and, to the best of such counsel's knowledge after due inquiry,
            neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries is in default in
            the performance of any obligation, agreement or condition
            contained in any bond, debenture, note or any other evidence of
            indebtedness or in any other agreement, indenture or instrument
            material to the conduct of the business of the Company and its
            subsidiaries, taken as a whole, to which the Company or any of
            its subsidiaries is a party or by which the Company or any of its
            subsidiaries or their respective properties are bound;

                        (v)     the statements set forth in Item 15 of Part
            II of the Registration Statement, insofar as such statements
            constitute a summary of legal matters or agreements referred to
            therein, fairly present in all material respects the information
            called for with respect to such legal matters or agreements;

                        (vi)    each of Conning & Company and CAMCO is duly
            registered as an investment adviser under the Advisers Act and is
            in compliance in all material respects with all United States
            Federal and state laws requiring any such registration; and
            neither the Company nor any of its other subsidiaries is required
            to register, license or qualify as an investment adviser under
            the Advisers Act;

                        (vii)   none of the Company's subsidiaries is
            currently required and, giving effect to the application of the
            net proceeds from the sale of the Shares as described in the
            Prospectus, is required to register with the Commission as an
            investment company under the 1940 Act;

                        (viii)  Conning & Company is duly registered as a
            broker-dealer under the Exchange Act and is in compliance in all
            material respects with all United States Federal and state laws
            requiring any such registration; and neither the Company nor any
            of its other subsidiaries is required to register, license or
            qualify as a broker-dealer under the Exchange Act;

                        (ix)    to such counsel's knowledge, each of the
            Company and its subsidiaries has such other permits, licenses,
            franchises and authorizations of governmental or regulatory
            authorities ("permits") as are necessary to own, lease and
            operate its respective properties and to conduct its business in
            all material respects in the manner described in the Prospectus;
            to such counsel's knowledge, each of the Company and its
            subsidiaries has fulfilled and performed all of its material
            obligations with respect to such permits and no event has
            occurred which allows, or after notice or lapse of time would
            allow, revocation or termination thereof or results in any other
            material impairment of the rights of the holder of any such
            permit, subject in each case to such qualification as may be set
            forth in the Prospectus; and, except as may be described in the
            Prospectus, such permits contain no restrictions that are
            materially burdensome to the Company or any of its subsidiaries;

            In addition to the matters set forth above, such counsel shall
state that during such counsel's participation in the preparation of the
Registration Statement and the Prospectus, such counsel or persons under such



<PAGE> 16

counsel's direct supervision participated in conferences with officers and
other representatives of the Company, representatives of the independent
public accountants of the Company, your representatives and your counsel at
which conferences the contents of the Registration Statement and Prospectus
and related matters were discussed, reviewed and revised.  Although such
counsel is not passing upon, and does not assume responsibility for, the
accuracy, completeness or fairness of the statements made or included in the
Registration Statement and the Prospectus, both as amended or supplemented,
no facts have come to such counsel's attention that cause such counsel to
believe that the Registration Statement, as of its effective date and
including any further amendment or supplement thereto made by the Company
prior to the Closing Date, contained any untrue statement of a material fact
or omitted to state any material fact required to be stated therein or
necessary in order to make the statements therein not misleading or that the
Prospectus, as of the Closing Date, contains any untrue statement of a
material fact or omits to state any material fact necessary in order to make
the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they
were made, not misleading (it being understood that such counsel need express
no opinion with respect to the financial statements and the notes thereto and
the schedules and other financial and statistical data included in the
Registration Statement or the Prospectus).

            (f)     You shall have received on the Closing Date an opinion,
      dated the Closing Date, of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett, counsel for the
      Underwriters, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to you,
      covering such matters as are customarily covered in such an opinion.

            (g)     You and the Board of Directors of the Company shall have
      received a letter on and as of the Closing Date, in form and substance
      reasonably satisfactory to you, from KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, independent
      public accountants, with respect to the financial statements and
      certain financial information contained in the Registration Statement
      and the Prospectus and confirming as of such date the substance of the
      letter delivered to you and the Board of Directors of the Company by
      KPMG Peat Marwick LLP on the date of this Agreement.

            (h)     The Company shall have delivered to you the agreements
      specified in the third paragraph of Section 2 hereof.

            (i)     The Company shall not have failed at or prior to the
      Closing Date to perform or comply with any of the agreements herein
      contained and required to be performed or complied with by the Company
      at or prior to the Closing Date.

The several obligations of the Underwriters to purchase any Additional Shares
hereunder are subject to the delivery to you on the applicable Option Closing
Date of such documents as you may reasonably request with respect to the good
standing of the Company, the due authorization and issuance of such
Additional Shares and other matters related to the issuance of such
Additional Shares consistent with the foregoing.

            9.      Effective Date of Agreement and Termination.  (a)  This
                    -------------------------------------------
Agreement shall become effective upon the later of (i) execution of this
Agreement and (ii) when notification of the effectiveness of the Registration
Statement has been released by the Commission.

            (a)     This Agreement may be terminated at any time prior to the
Closing Date by you by written notice to the Company if any of the following
has occurred: (i) since the respective dates as of which information is given
in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus, any material adverse change
or development involving a prospective material adverse change in the
condition, financial or otherwise, of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken
as a whole, or the earnings, affairs or business prospects of the Company and
its subsidiaries, taken as a whole, whether or not arising in the ordinary
course of business, which would, in your judgment, make it impracticable to
market the Shares on the terms and in the manner contemplated in the
Prospectus, (ii) any outbreak or escalation of hostilities or other national
or international calamity or crisis or change in economic conditions or in
the financial markets of the United States or elsewhere that, in your
judgment, is material and adverse and would, in your judgment, make it
impracticable to market the Shares on the terms and in the manner
contemplated in the Prospectus, (iii) the suspension or material limitation
of trading in securities on the New York Stock Exchange, the American Stock
Exchange or the Nasdaq National Market or material limitation on prices for
securities on any such



<PAGE> 17

exchange or national market system, (iv) the enactment, publication, decree or
other promulgation of any federal or state statute, regulation, rule or order of
any court or other governmental authority which in your opinion materially and
adversely affects, or will materially and adversely affect, the business or
operations of the Company or any of its subsidiaries, (v) the declaration of a
banking moratorium by either federal or New York State authorities or (vi) the
taking of any action by any federal, state or local government or agency in
respect of its monetary or fiscal affairs which in your opinion has a material
adverse effect on the financial markets in the United States.

            (b)     If on the Closing Date or on an Option Closing Date, as
the case may be, any one or more of the Underwriters shall fail or refuse to
purchase the Firm Shares or Additional Shares, as the case may be, which it
or they have agreed to purchase hereunder on such date and the aggregate
number of Firm Shares or Additional Shares, as the case may be, which such
defaulting Underwriter or Underwriters, as the case may be, agreed but failed
or refused to purchase is not more than one-tenth of the total number of
Shares to be purchased on such date by all Underwriters, each non-defaulting
Underwriter shall be obligated severally, in the proportion which the number
of Firm Shares set forth opposite its name in Schedule I bears to the total
number of Firm Shares which all the non-defaulting Underwriters, as the case
may be, have agreed to purchase, or in such other proportion as you may
specify, to purchase the Firm Shares or Additional Shares, as the case may
be, which such defaulting Underwriter or Underwriters, as the case may be,
agreed but failed or refused to purchase on such date; provided that in no
                                                       --------
event shall the number of Firm Shares or Additional Shares, as the case may
be, which any Underwriter has agreed to purchase pursuant to Section 2 hereof
be increased pursuant to this Section 9 by an amount in excess of one-ninth
of such number of Firm Shares or Additional Shares, as the case may be,
without the written consent of such Underwriter.  If on the Closing Date or
on an Option Closing Date, as the case may be, any Underwriter or
Underwriters shall fail or refuse to purchase Firm Shares, or Additional
Shares, as the case may be, and the aggregate number of Firm Shares or
Additional Shares, as the case may be, with respect to which such default
occurs is more than one-tenth of the aggregate number of Shares to be
purchased on such date by all Underwriters and arrangements satisfactory to
you and the Company for purchase of such Shares are not made within 48 hours
after such default, this Agreement will terminate without liability on the
part of any non-defaulting Underwriter and the Company.  In any such case
which does not result in termination of this Agreement, either you or the
Company shall have the right to postpone the Closing Date or the applicable
Option Closing Date, as the case may be, but in no event for longer than
seven days, in order that the required changes, if any, in the Registration
Statement and the Prospectus or any other documents or arrangements may be
effected.  Any action taken under this paragraph shall not relieve any
defaulting Underwriter from liability in respect of any default of any such
Underwriter under this Agreement.

            10.     Miscellaneous.  Notices given pursuant to any provision
                    -------------
of this Agreement shall be addressed as follows:  (a) if to the Company, to
Conning Corporation, 700 Market Street, St. Louis, Missouri 63101, Attention:
Fred M. Schpero (with a copy to Bryan Cave LLP, One Metropolitan Square, 211
North Broadway, Suite 3600, St. Louis, Missouri 63102, Attention: R. Randall
Wang); and (b) if to any Underwriter or to you, to you c/o Donaldson, Lufkin
& Jenrette Securities Corporation, 277 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10172,
Attention:  Syndicate Department, or in any case to such other address as the
person to be notified may have requested in writing.

            The respective indemnities, contribution agreements,
representations, warranties and other statements of the Company, its officers
and directors and of the several Underwriters set forth in or made pursuant
to this Agreement shall remain operative and in full force and effect, and
will survive delivery of and payment for the Shares, regardless of (i) any
investigation, or statement as to the results thereof, made by or on behalf
of any Underwriter or by or on behalf of the Company, the officers or
directors of the Company or any controlling person thereof, (ii) acceptance
of the Shares and payment for them hereunder and (iii) termination of this
Agreement.

            If this Agreement shall be terminated by the Underwriters because
of any failure or refusal on the part of the Company to comply with the terms
or to fulfill any of the conditions of this Agreement, the Company agrees to
reimburse the several Underwriters for all out-of-pocket expenses (including
the fees and disbursements of counsel) reasonably incurred by them, provided
that the Underwriters furnish reasonably satisfactory documentation thereof.

            The statements set forth in (i) the footnotes to the tables on
the cover page of any Preliminary



<PAGE> 18

Prospectus and the Prospectus, (ii) the last paragraph of the cover page of any
Preliminary Prospectus and the Prospectus, (iii) the "stabilization legend" on
page 2 of any Preliminary Prospectus and the Prospectus and (iv) the fifth,
ninth, tenth and eleventh paragraphs and the third sentence of the third
paragraph and the fourth sentence of the sixth paragraph under the caption
"Underwriting" in any Preliminary Prospectus and the Prospectus constitute the
only information furnished to the Company by the Underwriters for use in any
Preliminary Prospectus and the Prospectus.

            Except as otherwise provided, this Agreement has been and is made
solely for the benefit of and shall be binding upon the Company, the
Underwriters, any controlling persons referred to herein and their respective
successors and assigns, all as and to the extent provided in this Agreement,
and no other person shall acquire or have any right under or by virtue of
this Agreement.  The term "successors and assigns" shall not include a
purchaser of any of the Shares from any of the several Underwriters merely
because of such purchase.

            This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of New York.

            This Agreement may be signed in various counterparts which
together shall constitute one and the same instrument.



<PAGE> 19

            Please confirm that the foregoing correctly sets forth the
agreement among the Company and the several Underwriters.



                                     Very truly yours,

                                     CONNING CORPORATION


                                     By:
                                         ------------------------------
                                         Name:
                                         Title:



DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE
  SECURITIES CORPORATION
A.G. EDWARDS & SONS, INC.

Acting severally on behalf of
  themselves and the several
  Underwriters named in
  Schedule I hereto

By DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE
      SECURITIES CORPORATION


   By:-----------------------------
      Name:
      Title:




<PAGE> 20

                                                          SCHEDULE I
                                                          ----------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                          Number of Firm Shares
      Underwriters                           to be Purchased
      ------------                        ---------------------

<S>                                       <C>
Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette
      Securities Corporation              [ ]
A.G. Edwards & Sons, Inc.                 [ ]



                    [ remainder to come ]

                                                ---------
                                          2,500,000
</TABLE>



<PAGE> 21

                                                       ANNEX I
                                                       -------


              Required Stockholder Lock-up Agreements
              ---------------------------------------

                            [ to come ]




<PAGE> 1
                               RESTATED
                      ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION
                                  OF
                         CONNING CORPORATION

                          ARTICLE ONE - NAME

            The name of the corporation (hereinafter referred to as the
"Corporation") is:  Conning Corporation.

                   ARTICLE TWO - REGISTERED OFFICE

            The address of the Corporation's registered office in the State
of Missouri is 700 Market Street, St. Louis, Missouri 63101 and the name of
its registered agent at such address is Matthew P. McCauley.

                 ARTICLE THREE - AUTHORIZED SHARES

            The aggregate number, class and par value of shares which the
Corporation shall have authority to issue is ninety-three million seven
hundred ninety thousand (93,790,000) shares of stock, all of which shall have
a par value of One Cent ($0.01) per share, divided into (a) fifty million
(50,000,000) shares of Class A Voting Common Stock, (b) twenty million
(20,000,000) shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and (c) twenty-three
million seven hundred ninety thousand (23,790,000) shares of Preferred Stock.

            The preferences, qualifications, limitations, restrictions, and
the special or relative rights, including convertible rights, if any, in
respect of the shares of each class are as follows:

      A.    Preferred Stock.

            1.    Subject to the requirements of the General and Business
Corporation Law of Missouri (the "GBCL") and the provisions of these Articles
of Incorporation, the Preferred Stock may be issued from time to time by the
Board of Directors as shares of one or more series.  The description of
shares of each series of Preferred Stock, including any preferences,
conversion and other rights, voting powers, restrictions, limitations as to
dividends, qualifications, and terms and conditions of redemption shall be as
set forth in these Articles of Incorporation or any amendment hereto or in a
resolution or resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors and, to the
extent set forth in any such resolution or resolutions, such information
shall be certified to the Secretary of State of Missouri filed as required by
law from time to time prior to the issuance of any shares of such series.

            2.    The Board of Directors is expressly authorized, prior to
issuance, by adopting resolutions providing for the issuance of, or providing
for a change in the number of, shares of any particular series of Preferred
Stock and, if and to the extent from time to time required


                                    1
<PAGE> 2

by law, by filing certification thereto with the Secretary of State of Missouri,
to set or change the number of shares to be included in each series of Preferred
Stock and to set or change in any one or more respects the designations,
preferences, conversion or other rights, voting powers, restrictions,
limitations as to dividends, qualifications, or terms and conditions of
redemption relating to the shares of each such series.  Notwithstanding the
foregoing, the Board of Directors shall not be authorized to change the right
of the Class A Voting Common Stock of the Corporation to vote one vote per
share on all matters submitted for stockholder action.  The authority of the
Board of Directors with respect to each series of Preferred Stock shall
include, but not be limited to, setting or changing the following:

                  (a) the distinctive serial designation of such series
      and the number of shares constituting such series (provided that the
      aggregate number of shares constituting all series of Preferred
      Stock shall not exceed twenty-three million seven hundred ninety
      thousand (23,790,000) shares).

                  (b) the annual dividend rate, if any, on shares of such
      series, whether and the extent to which dividends shall be
      cumulative or non-cumulative, the relative rights of priority, if
      any, of payment of any dividends, and the time at which, and the
      terms and conditions on which, any dividends shall be paid;

                  (c) whether the shares of such series shall be
      redeemable or purchasable and, if so, the terms and conditions of
      such redemption or purchase, including the date or dates upon and
      after which such shares shall be redeemable or purchasable, and the
      amount per share payable in case of redemption or purchase, which
      amount may vary under different conditions and at different
      redemption or purchase dates;

                  (d) the obligation, if any, of the Corporation to retire
      shares of such series pursuant to a sinking fund and the terms and
      conditions of any such sinking fund;

                  (e) whether shares of such series shall be convertible
      into, or exchangeable for, shares of stock of any other class or
      classes and, if so, the terms and conditions of such conversion or
      exchange, including the price or prices or the rate or rates of
      conversion or exchange and the terms of adjustment, if any;

                  (f) whether the shares of such series shall have voting
      rights, in addition to the voting rights provided by law, and, if
      so, the terms of such voting rights;

                  (g) the rights of the holders of shares of such series
      in the event of voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or
      winding up of the Corporation, and the relative rights of priority,
      if any, of such holders with respect thereto; and

                  (h) any other relative rights, powers, preferences,
      qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof relating to such
      series.


                                    2
<PAGE> 3

            3.    The shares of Preferred Stock of any one series shall be
identical with each other in all respects except as to the dates from and
after which dividends thereon shall cumulate, if cumulative.

      B.    Series A Convertible Preferred Stock.

            A total of 3,190,000 shares of the Company's Preferred Stock, par
value One Cent ($.01) per share, designated as "Series A Convertible
Preferred Stock" ("Series A Preferred Stock"), are hereby authorized for
issuance with the voting powers, preferences and other special rights, and
qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof set forth below.

            1.    Designation and Amount.  The number of shares of Series A
                  ----------------------
Preferred Stock to be authorized for issuance shall be 3,190,000.

            2.    Dividends and Distributions.  The holders of shares of
                  ---------------------------
Series A Preferred Stock shall be entitled to receive out of funds legally
available for the purpose, quarterly dividends payable in cash on the first
business day of January, April, July and October in each year (each such date
being referred to herein as a "Quarterly Dividend Payment Date"), commencing
on the first Quarterly Dividend Payment Date after the issuance of the Series
A Preferred Stock, in an amount per share (rounded to the nearest cent) equal
to the Applicable Dividend Rate multiplied by the Liquidation Value.  The
Applicable Dividend Rate shall be the ninety (90) day United States Treasury
Bill rate (as published in The Wall Street Journal in the "Ask Yield" column)
                           -----------------------
in effect on the previous Quarterly Dividend Payment Date.  Such dividends
shall be cumulative and shall accrue from the relevant date of issue whether
or not there are any funds of the Company legally available for the payment
of dividends.

            3.    Voting Rights.  The Series A Preferred Stock shall carry no
                  -------------
voting rights.

            4.    Conversion.
                  ----------

                  a.    Conversion Events.
                        -----------------

                        (1)   At any time and from time to time, any holder
      of Series A Preferred Stock may convert all or any portion of the
      Series A Preferred Stock (including any fraction of a share) held
      by such holder into the number of shares of the Company's
      non-voting common stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Non-Voting
      Common Stock"), computed by dividing the number of shares of Series
      A Preferred Stock to be converted by the Conversion Rate (as
      defined below) then in effect.

                        (2)   If during the three-year period ending on the
      third anniversary of the issuance of the Series A Preferred Stock,
      the Company sells any capital stock pursuant to an initial public
      offering (an "IPO") of any class of the Company's capital stock in
      which the common stock equivalent per share price at which such
      stock is sold is equal to or greater than the Liquidation Value
      multiplied by the Conversion Rate (a "Qualified IPO"), then each
      share of the Series A Preferred Stock shall, immediately prior


                                    3
<PAGE> 4

      to the consummation of such Qualified IPO, automatically convert to a
      number (or fraction) of shares of the Company's voting common
      stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Voting Common Stock"), equal
      to one (1) divided by the Conversion Rate then in effect.

                  b.    Conversion Rate.  The Conversion Rate shall equal one
                        ---------------
(1) divided by the number of shares of Non-Voting Common Stock or Voting
Common Stock (the "Conversion Stock") into which each share of Series A
Preferred Stock is convertible.  The initial Conversion Rate shall be one
(1), entitling a holder of Series A Preferred Stock to one share of
Non-Voting Common Stock or Voting Common Stock, as the case may be, for each
share of Series A Preferred Stock.  In order to prevent certain types of
dilution of the conversion rights granted under this Section 4, the
Conversion Rate shall be subject to adjustment from time to time as follows:

                        (1)   In the event that there is any change in the
      number of shares of Conversion Stock outstanding by reason of an
      Extraordinary Conversion Stock Event (defined below), the Conversion
      Rate in effect immediately prior thereto shall be adjusted so that
      the holder of a share of Series A Preferred Stock surrendered for
      conversion after the record date fixing stockholders to be affected
      by such event shall be entitled to receive, upon conversion, the
      number of shares of Conversion Stock which such holder would have
      owned or have been entitled to receive after the happening of such
      event had such share of Series A Preferred Stock been converted
      immediately prior to the record or other effective date of such
      change in the Company's capitalization.  An "Extraordinary Conversion
      Stock Event" shall mean (i) the issue of additional shares of
      Conversion Stock as a dividend or other non-cash distribution on
      outstanding shares of Conversion Stock, (ii) a subdivision of
      outstanding shares of Conversion Stock into a greater number of
      shares of Conversion Stock, or (iii) a combination or reverse stock
      split of outstanding shares of Conversion Stock into a smaller number
      of shares of Conversion Stock.

                        (2)   In the event of an issuance of Conversion
      Stock by the Company (whether such sale is in consideration for cash
      or securities) to General American Holding Company ("GAHC") or an
      affiliate of GAHC at a price per share less than the Liquidation
      Value multiplied by the Conversion Rate then in effect, unless
      approved by the holders of 75% of the Series A Preferred Stock
      outstanding, the Conversion Rate shall be adjusted so as to provide
      that each holder of Series A Preferred Stock will maintain, upon
      conversion of such Series A Preferred Stock, the same percentage
      equity interest in the Company on a fully diluted basis as such
      holder had prior to such issuance of Conversion Stock to GAHC or an
      affiliate of GAHC.

                        (3)   If the Conversion Stock shall be changed into
      the same or different number of shares of any class or classes of
      capital stock, whether by capital reorganization, recapitalization,
      reclassification or otherwise (other than a subdivision or
      combination of shares or stock dividend provided for elsewhere in
      this Section 4(b)) or in the event of a merger or consolidation of
      the Company with or into another corporation or the sale of
      substantially all of the Company's assets to any other person, then
      and in each such event the holders of the Series A Preferred Stock
      shall have the right thereafter to


                                    4
<PAGE> 5

      convert such shares into the kind and amount of shares of capital stock
      and other securities and property receivable upon such reorganization,
      recapitalization, reclassification, merger, consolidation, sale or other
      change by the holders of the number of shares of Conversion Stock into
      which such shares of Series A Preferred Stock might have been converted
      immediately prior to such reorganization, recapitalization,
      reclassification, merger, consolidation, sale or change.

            c.    Conversion Procedure.
                  --------------------

                  (1)   Each optional conversion of Series A Preferred
      Stock shall be deemed to have been effected as of the close of
      business on the date on which the certificate or certificates
      representing the Series A Preferred Stock to be converted are
      surrendered at the principal office of the Company.  At such time
      as such conversion has been effected, the rights of the holder of
      such Series A Preferred Stock as such holder with respect to such
      shares of Series A Preferred Stock shall cease and such holder
      shall be deemed to have become the holder of record of the shares
      of Conversion Stock represented thereby; provided, however, that if
      such holder is entitled to accrued dividends with respect to the
      shares of Series A Preferred Stock converted that have not been
      paid prior to such conversion, such holder's entitlement thereto
      shall not be affected by such conversion and the Company shall pay
      such dividends to the converting holder as soon thereafter as funds
      of the Company are legally available for such payment.

                  (2)   Upon the occurrence of the conversion event
      occasioned by the occurrence of a Qualified IPO, (i) the holders of
      the Series A Preferred Stock shall, upon notice from the Company,
      surrender the certificates representing such shares at the office
      of the Company or of its transfer agent.  Thereupon, there shall be
      issued and delivered to such holder a certificate or certificates
      for the number of shares of Conversion Stock into which the shares
      of Series A Preferred Stock so surrendered were convertible on the
      date on which such conversion occurred.  The Company shall not be
      obligated to issue such certificates unless certificates evidencing
      the shares of Series A Preferred Stock being converted are either
      delivered to the Company or any such transfer agent, or the holder
      notifies the Company that such certificates have been lost, stolen
      or destroyed and executes an agreement satisfactory to the Company
      to indemnify the Company from any loss incurred by it in connection
      therewith.

                  (3)   As soon as possible after a conversion has been
      effected (but in any event within five business days after the
      surrender of the shares of Series A Preferred Stock to be
      converted), the Company shall deliver to the converting holder a
      certificate or certificates representing the number of shares of
      Conversion Stock issuable by reason of such conversion.

                  (4)   The issuance of certificates for shares of
      Conversion Stock upon conversion of Series A Preferred Stock shall
      be made without charge to the holders of such Series A Preferred
      Stock for any issuance tax in respect thereof or other cost
      incurred by the Company in connection with such conversion and the
      related issuance of shares of


                                    5
<PAGE> 6
      Conversion Stock.  Upon conversion of each share of Series A Preferred
      Stock, the Company shall take all such actions as are necessary in order
      to insure that the Conversion Stock issuable with respect to such
      conversion shall be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

            5.    Preemptive Rights.
                  -----------------

                  a.    If the Company issues, sells, transfers or otherwise
disposes of any shares of the capital stock of the Company of any class or
series (collectively, the "Equity Securities") for cash in a transaction not
described in Section 4(b)(2) (a "Third Party Sale"), each holder of Series A
Preferred Stock (an "Eligible Investor") shall have an option to purchase, on
the terms and conditions (including price) of the Third Party Sale, up to
that amount of the Equity Securities sold in such Third Party Sale as would
maintain such Eligible Investor's percentage equity interest in the Company
on a fully diluted basis.

                  b.    No less than twenty (20) days prior to the consummation
of a Third Party Sale, the Company shall notify each Eligible Investor of the
Third Party Sale and the terms and conditions thereof.  Within fifteen (15)
days after receipt of such notice, each Eligible Investor shall notify the
Company as to the amount of the Equity Securities such Eligible Investor
desires to purchase.  If an Eligible Investor gives the Company timely notice
that the Eligible Investor desires to purchase any of the Equity Securities
offered by the Company, then payment for the Equity Securities shall be by
bank cashier's or certified check or wire transfer against delivery of the
securities at the executive offices of the Company at the time of the
scheduled closing therefor.  Each Eligible Investor shall cooperate with the
Company in taking such actions as may be necessary or desirable in order to
ensure that the sale of Equity Securities to such Eligible Investor complies
with all applicable federal and state securities laws.  In no event will the
Company be required to sell Equity Securities to an Eligible Investor if, in
the Company's reasonable opinion, such sale would violate federal or state
securities or any other applicable law, rule or regulation.

            6.    Certain Restrictions.
                  --------------------

                  a.    The Company shall not, without the prior written consent
of the holders of a majority of the Series A Preferred Stock, increase the
authorized number of shares of Series A Preferred Stock or issue any
securities of the Company ranking on a parity with or senior in priority to
the Series A Preferred Stock.

                  b.    Whenever quarterly dividends or other dividends or
distributions payable on the Series A Preferred Stock as provided in Section
2 are in arrears, thereafter and until all accrued and unpaid dividends and
distributions, whether or not declared, on shares of Series A Preferred Stock
outstanding shall have been paid in full, the Company shall not:

                        (1)   declare or pay dividends on or make any other
      distributions on any shares of stock ranking junior (either as to
      dividends or upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up) to the
      Series A Preferred Stock; or

                                    6

<PAGE> 7

                        (2)   declare or pay dividends on or make any other
      distributions on any shares of stock ranking on a parity (either
      as to dividends or upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up)
      with the Series A Preferred Stock, except dividends paid ratably
      on the Series A Preferred Stock and all such parity stock on
      which dividends are payable or in arrears in proportion to the
      total amounts to which the holders of all such shares are then
      entitled.

                  c.    In the event that in any given quarter the Board of
Directors of the Company shall declare a dividend payable upon the then
outstanding shares of stock ranking junior to the Series A Preferred Stock
("Junior Securities") (other than a stock dividend on the Conversion Stock
distributed in the form of additional shares of Conversion Stock) in an
amount which exceeds the amount per share on an as converted basis of
dividends required pursuant to Section 2 hereof to be paid in such quarter
with respect to the Preferred Stock (such amount being the "Excess
Dividend"), each holder of shares of Series A Preferred Stock shall be
entitled to participate in such Excess Dividend in an amount equal to the
amount of dividends as would be declared payable on the largest number of
whole shares of Conversion Stock into which the shares of Series A Preferred
Stock held by such holder could be converted pursuant hereto, such number
determined as of the record date for the determination of holders of stock
ranking junior to the Series A Preferred Stock entitled to receive such
Excess Dividend.

                  d.    The Company agrees not to enter, or permit any of its
subsidiaries to enter, into any transaction, including, without limitation,
any loan or extension of credit, guarantee, management contract or royalty
agreement, deferred or contingent compensation agreement, consulting or other
agreement with any affiliate except in the ordinary course of and pursuant to
the reasonable requirements of the Company's or such subsidiary's business
and upon fair and reasonable terms no less favorable to the Company or such
subsidiary than would obtain in a comparable arm's length transaction with a
person not an affiliate.  The promissory notes dated August 11, 1995 made
payable to General American Life Insurance Company by the Company and Conning
Corporation shall not be deemed to violate the provisions of this paragraph.

                  e.    The Company agrees at all times that it will not, by
any amendment of the Company's articles of incorporation, or through any
consolidation, merger, reorganization, transfer of assets, dissolution, issue
or sale of securities or any other voluntary action, seek to avoid the
observance or performance hereof, but will at all times take such actions as
are necessary or appropriate in order to protect the rights of the holders of
the Series A Preferred Stock hereunder against impairment.

                  f.    Nothing contained herein shall be deemed to prohibit
the Company from issuing shares of its capital stock in exchange for non-cash
consideration, and such issuance shall not trigger the preemptive rights
provided in Section 5 hereof.

            7.    Reacquired Shares.  Any shares of Series A Preferred Stock
                  -----------------
purchased or otherwise acquired by the Company in any manner whatsoever shall
be retired and canceled promptly after the acquisition thereof.  All such
shares shall upon their cancellation become authorized but unissued shares of
Preferred Stock and may be reissued as part of a new series of


                                    7
<PAGE> 8

Preferred Stock to be created by resolution or resolutions of the Board of
Directors, subject to the conditions and restrictions on issuance set forth
herein.

            8.    Liquidation, Dissolution, or Winding Up.  Upon any
                  ---------------------------------------
liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company, each holder of Series
A Preferred Stock shall be entitled to be paid per share of Series A
Preferred Stock, before any distribution or payment is made upon any Junior
Securities, $5.33 plus accrued but unpaid dividends (the "Liquidation
Value"), and the holders of Series A Preferred Stock shall not be entitled to
any further payment.  If upon any such liquidation, dissolution or winding up
of the Company, the Company's assets to be distributed among the holders of
the Series A Preferred Stock are insufficient to permit payment to such
holders of the aggregate amount which they are entitled to be paid, then the
entire assets to be distributed shall be distributed ratably among such
holders based upon the aggregate Liquidation Value of the Series A Preferred
Stock held by each such holder.  Neither the consolidation or merger of the
Company into or with any other entity or entities, nor the sale or transfer
by the Company of all or any part of its assets, nor the reduction of the
capital stock of the Company, shall be deemed to be a liquidation,
dissolution or winding up of the Company within the meaning of this Section.

            9.    Registration of Transfer.  The Company shall keep at its
                  ------------------------
principal office a register for the registration of Series A Preferred Stock.
Upon the surrender of any certificate representing Series A Preferred Stock
at such place, the Company shall, at the request of the record holder of such
certificate, execute and deliver (at the Company's expense) a new certificate
or certificates in exchange therefor representing in the aggregate the number
of shares of Series A Preferred Stock represented by the surrendered
certificate.  Each such new certificate shall be registered in such name and
shall represent such number of shares of Series A Preferred Stock as is
requested by the holder of the surrendered certificate and shall be
substantially identical in form to the surrendered certificate, and dividends
shall accrue on the Series A Preferred Stock represented by such new
certificate from the date to which dividends have been fully paid on such
Series A Preferred Stock represented by the surrendered certificate.

            10.   Replacement.
                  -----------

                  Upon receipt of evidence reasonably satisfactory to the
Company (an affidavit of the registered holder shall be satisfactory) of the
ownership and the loss, theft, destruction or mutilation of any certificate
evidencing shares of Series A Preferred Stock, and in the case of any such
loss, theft or destruction, upon receipt of indemnity reasonably satisfactory
to the Company, or, in the case of any such mutilation, upon surrender of
such certificate, the Company shall (at its expense) execute and deliver in
lieu of such certificate a new certificate of like kind representing the
number of shares of such class represented by such lost, stolen, destroyed or
mutilated certificate and dated the date of such lost, stolen, destroyed or
mutilated certificate, and dividends shall accrue on the Series A Preferred
Stock represented by such new certificate from the date to which dividends
have been fully paid on such lost, stolen, destroyed or mutilated
certificate.


                                    8
<PAGE> 9

      C.    Series B Convertible Preferred Stock.

            A total of 600,000 shares of the Company's Preferred Stock, par
value One Cent ($.01) per share, designated as "Series B Convertible
Preferred Stock" ("Series B Preferred Stock"), are hereby authorized for
issuance with the voting powers, preferences and other special rights, and
qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof set forth below.

            1.    Designation; Amount and Rank.
                  ----------------------------

                  a.    The number of shares of Series B Preferred Stock to
be authorized for issuance shall be 600,000.

                  b.    The Series B Preferred Stock, with respect to
dividend rights and rights upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the
Company, shall rank senior to the Company's non-voting common stock, par
value $.01 per share (the "Non-Voting Common Stock") and the Company's voting
common stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Voting Common Stock"), and to
all other classes and series of equity securities of the Company, except for
the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, par value $.01 per share ("Series A
Preferred Stock"), with which the Series B Preferred Stock shall be of equal
rank.

            2.    Dividends and Distributions.  The holders of shares of
                  ---------------------------
Series B Preferred Stock shall be entitled to receive out of funds legally
available for the purpose, quarterly dividends payable in cash on the first
business day of January, April, July and October in each year (each such date
being referred to herein as a "Quarterly Dividend Payment Date"), commencing
on the first Quarterly Dividend Payment Date after the issuance of the Series
B Preferred Stock, in an amount per share (rounded to the nearest cent) equal
to five percent (5%) per annum multiplied by the Liquidation Value.  Such
dividends shall be cumulative and shall accrue from the relevant date of
issue whether or not there are any funds of the Company legally available for
the payment of dividends.

            3.    Voting Rights.  The Series B Preferred Stock shall carry no
                  -------------
voting rights.

            4.    Conversion.
                  ----------

                  a.    Conversion Right.  At any time and from time to time,
                        ----------------
any holder of Series B Preferred Stock may convert all or any portion of the
Series B Preferred Stock (including any fraction of a share) held by such
holder into a number of shares of the Company's Non-Voting Common Stock
computed by dividing the number of shares of Series B Preferred Stock to be
converted by the Conversion Rate (as defined below) then in effect.  To
convert shares of Series B Preferred Stock pursuant to this Section 4(a), the
holder of such shares shall pay the Company an amount equal to the applicable
Conversion Price (as defined below) multiplied by the number of shares of
Series B Preferred Stock to be converted.

                  b.    Conversion Rate.  The Conversion Rate shall equal one
                        ---------------
(1) divided by the number of shares of Non-Voting Common Stock (the
"Conversion Stock") into which each


                                    9
<PAGE> 10

share of Series B Preferred Stock is convertible.  The initial Conversion Rate
shall be one (1), entitling a holder of Series B Preferred Stock to one share of
Non-Voting Common Stock for each share of Series B Preferred Stock.  In order to
prevent certain types of dilution of the conversion rights granted under this
Section 4, the Conversion Rate shall be subject to adjustment from time to time
as follows:

                        (1)   In the event that there is any change in
      the number of shares of Conversion Stock outstanding by reason of
      an Extraordinary Conversion Stock Event (defined below), the
      Conversion Rate in effect immediately prior thereto shall be
      adjusted so that the holder of a share of Series B Preferred Stock
      surrendered for conversion after the record date fixing
      stockholders to be affected by such event shall be entitled to
      receive, upon conversion, the number of shares of Conversion Stock
      which such holder would have owned or have been entitled to
      receive after the happening of such event had such share of Series
      B Preferred Stock been converted immediately prior to the record
      or other effective date of such change in the Company's
      capitalization.  An "Extraordinary Conversion Stock Event" shall
      mean (i) the issue of additional shares of Conversion Stock as a
      dividend or other non-cash distribution on outstanding shares of
      Conversion Stock, (ii) a subdivision of outstanding shares of
      Conversion Stock into a greater number of shares of Conversion
      Stock, or (iii) a combination or reverse stock split of
      outstanding shares of Conversion Stock into a smaller number of
      shares of Conversion Stock.

                        (2)   If the Conversion Stock shall be changed
      into the same or different number of shares of any class or
      classes of capital stock, whether by capital reorganization,
      recapitalization, reclassification or otherwise (other than a
      subdivision or combination of shares or stock dividend provided
      for elsewhere in this Section 4(b)) or in the event of a merger or
      consolidation of the Company with or into another corporation or
      the sale of substantially all of the Company's assets to any other
      person, then and in each such event the holders of the Series B
      Preferred Stock shall have the right thereafter to convert such
      shares into the kind and amount of shares of capital stock and
      other securities and property receivable upon such reorganization,
      recapitalization, reclassification, merger, consolidation, sale or
      other change by the holders of the number of shares of Conversion
      Stock into which such shares of Series B Preferred Stock might
      have been converted immediately prior to such reorganization,
      recapitalization, reclassification, merger, consolidation, sale or
      change.

                  c.    Conversion Procedure.
                        --------------------

                        (1)   Each conversion of Series B Preferred
      Stock shall be deemed to have been effected as of the close of
      business on the date on which the certificate or certificates
      representing the Series B Preferred Stock to be converted are
      surrendered at the principal office of the Company, together with
      payment of the Conversion Price therefor.  At such time as such
      conversion has been effected, the rights of the holder of such
      Series B Preferred Stock as such holder with respect to such
      shares of Series B Preferred Stock shall cease and such holder
      shall be deemed to have become the holder of record of the shares
      of Conversion Stock represented thereby; provided, however, that
      if such holder is entitled to


                                    10
<PAGE> 11

      accrued dividends with respect to the shares of Series B Preferred Stock
      converted that have not been paid prior to such conversion, such holder's
      entitlement thereto shall not be affected by such conversion and the
      Company shall pay such dividends to the converting holder as soon
      thereafter as funds of the Company are legally available for such
      payment.

                        (2)   As soon as possible after a conversion has
      been effected (but in any event within five business days after
      the surrender of the shares of Series B Preferred Stock to be
      converted and payment of the Conversion Price therefor), the
      Company shall deliver to the converting holder a certificate or
      certificates representing the number of shares of Conversion Stock
      issuable by reason of such conversion.

                        (3)   The issuance of certificates for shares of
      Conversion Stock upon conversion of Series B Preferred Stock shall
      be made without charge to the holders of such Series B Preferred
      Stock for any issuance tax in respect thereof or other cost
      incurred by the Company in connection with such conversion and the
      related issuance of shares of Conversion Stock.  Upon conversion
      of each share of Series B Preferred Stock, the Company shall take
      all such actions as are necessary in order to insure that the
      Conversion Stock issuable with respect to such conversion shall be
      validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

                  d.    Conversion Price.  The Conversion Price shall be
                        ----------------
$1.67 per share of Series B Preferred Stock; provided, however, that in the
event of an initial public offering of any class of the Company's capital
stock (an "IPO"), if the price per share (less underwriting discounts and
commissions) at which the Company stock is sold in the IPO (the "IPO Price")
is less than $7.00 per share, then the Conversion Price shall equal the IPO
Price less $5.33.  In the event the Conversion Rate is adjusted pursuant to
Section 4(b), the Conversion Price and this Section 4(d) shall also be
adjusted accordingly.

            5.    Certain Restrictions.
                  --------------------

                  e.    The Company shall not, without the prior written
consent of the holders of a majority of the Series B Preferred Stock,
increase the authorized number of shares of Series B Preferred Stock or issue
any securities of the Company ranking on a parity with or senior in priority
to the Series B Preferred Stock.

                  f.    Whenever quarterly dividends or other dividends or
distributions payable on the Series B Preferred Stock as provided in Section
2 are in arrears, thereafter and until all accrued and unpaid dividends and
distributions, whether or not declared, on shares of Series B Preferred Stock
outstanding shall have been paid in full, the Company shall not:

                        (1)   declare or pay dividends on or make any
      other distributions on any shares of stock ranking junior (either
      as to dividends or upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up) to
      the Series B Preferred Stock; or


                                    11
<PAGE> 12

                        (2)   declare or pay dividends on or make any
      other distributions on any shares of stock ranking on a parity
      (either as to dividends or upon liquidation, dissolution or
      winding up) with the Series B Preferred Stock, except dividends
      paid ratably on the Series B Preferred Stock and all such parity
      stock on which dividends are payable or in arrears in proportion
      to the total amounts to which the holders of all such shares are
      then entitled.

                  g.    In the event that in any given quarter the Board of
Directors of the Company shall declare a dividend payable upon the then
outstanding shares of stock ranking junior to the Series B Preferred Stock
("Junior Securities") (other than a stock dividend on the Conversion Stock
distributed in the form of additional shares of Conversion Stock) in an
amount which exceeds the amount per share on an as converted basis of
dividends required pursuant to Section 2 hereof to be paid in such quarter
with respect to the Series B Preferred Stock (such amount being the "Excess
Dividend"), each holder of shares of Series B Preferred Stock shall be
entitled to participate in such Excess Dividend in an amount equal to the
amount of dividends as would be declared payable on the largest number of
whole shares of Conversion Stock into which the shares of Series B Preferred
Stock held by such holder could be converted pursuant hereto, such number
determined as of the record date for the determination of holders of stock
ranking junior to the Series B Preferred Stock entitled to receive such
Excess Dividend.

                  h.    The Company agrees not to enter, or permit any of its
subsidiaries to enter, into any transaction, including, without limitation,
any loan or extension of credit, guarantee, management contract or royalty
agreement, deferred or contingent compensation agreement, consulting or other
agreement with any affiliate except in the ordinary course of and pursuant to
the reasonable requirements of the Company's or such subsidiary's business
and upon fair and reasonable terms no less favorable to the Company or such
subsidiary than would obtain in a comparable arm's length transaction with a
person not an affiliate.

                  i.    The Company agrees at all times that it will not, by
any amendment of the Company's articles of incorporation, or through any
consolidation, merger, reorganization, transfer of assets, dissolution, issue
or sale of securities or any other voluntary action, seek to avoid the
observance or performance hereof, but will at all times take such actions as
are necessary or appropriate in order to protect the rights of the holders of
the Series B Preferred Stock hereunder against impairment.

                  j.    Nothing contained herein shall be deemed to prohibit
the Company from issuing shares of its capital stock in exchange for non-cash
consideration.

            6.    Reacquired Shares.  Any shares of Series B Preferred Stock
                  -----------------
purchased or otherwise acquired by the Company in any manner whatsoever shall
be retired and canceled promptly after the acquisition thereof.  All such
shares shall upon their cancellation become authorized but unissued shares of
Preferred Stock and may be reissued as part of a new series of Preferred
Stock to be created by resolution or resolutions of the Board of Directors,
subject to the conditions and restrictions on issuance set forth herein.


                                    12
<PAGE> 13

            7.    Liquidation, Dissolution, or Winding Up.  Upon any
                  ---------------------------------------
liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company, each holder of Series
B Preferred Stock shall be entitled to be paid per share of Series B
Preferred Stock, before any distribution or payment is made upon any Junior
Securities, $5.33 plus accrued but unpaid dividends (the "Liquidation
Value"), and the holders of Series B Preferred Stock shall not be entitled to
any further payment.  If upon any such liquidation, dissolution or winding up
of the Company, the Company's assets to be distributed among the holders of
the Company's Series A Preferred Stock and the Series B Preferred Stock are
insufficient to permit payment to such holders of the aggregate amount which
they are entitled to be paid, then the entire assets to be distributed shall
be distributed ratably among such holders in accordance with the respective
amounts which they are entitled to be paid.  Neither the consolidation or
merger of the Company into or with any other entity or entities, nor the sale
or transfer by the Company of all or any part of its assets, nor the
reduction of the capital stock of the Company, shall be deemed to be a
liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company within the meaning of
this Section.

            8.    Registration of Transfer.  The Company shall keep at its
                  ------------------------
principal office a register for the registration of Series B Preferred Stock.
Upon the surrender of any certificate representing Series B Preferred Stock
at such place, the Company shall, at the request of the record holder of such
certificate, execute and deliver (at the Company's expense) a new certificate
or certificates in exchange therefor representing in the aggregate the number
of shares of Series B Preferred Stock represented by the surrendered
certificate.  Each such new certificate shall be registered in such name and
shall represent such number of shares of Series B Preferred Stock as is
requested by the holder of the surrendered certificate and shall be
substantially identical in form to the surrendered certificate, and dividends
shall accrue on the Series B Preferred Stock represented by such new
certificate from the date to which dividends have been fully paid on such
Series B Preferred Stock represented by the surrendered certificate.

            9.    Replacement.  Upon receipt of evidence reasonably
                  -----------
satisfactory to the Company (an affidavit of the registered holder shall be
satisfactory) of the ownership and the loss, theft, destruction or mutilation
of any certificate evidencing shares of Series B Preferred Stock, and in the
case of any such loss, theft or destruction, upon receipt of indemnity
reasonably satisfactory to the Company, or, in the case of any such
mutilation, upon surrender of such certificate, the Company shall (at its
expense) execute and deliver in lieu of such certificate a new certificate of
like kind representing the number of shares of such class represented by such
lost, stolen, destroyed or mutilated certificate and dated the date of such
lost, stolen, destroyed or mutilated certificate, and dividends shall accrue
on the Series B Preferred Stock represented by such new certificate from the
date to which dividends have been fully paid on such lost, stolen, destroyed
or mutilated certificate.

      D.    Common Stock.

            1.    Subject to Article Four hereof or as otherwise provided by
the GBCL, each holder of the Class A Voting Common Stock shall be entitled to
one vote per share of Class A Voting Common Stock on all matters to be voted
on by the shareholders.  The Class A Voting Common Stock and the Class B
Non-Voting Common Stock shall be identical in all respects except that the
holders of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall have no voting power for any
purpose whatsoever unless and until (a) the occurrence of a Qualified IPO (as
such term is defined


                                    13
<PAGE> 14

pursuant to the terms of the Corporation's Series A Convertible Preferred
Stock), in which event each of the then outstanding shares of the Class B
Non-Voting Common Stock shall become one share of Class A Voting Common Stock,
or (b) a holder of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock chooses to sell such holder's
shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and the Corporation elects not to
purchase such shares pursuant to a right of first refusal granted the
Corporation in any then-existing agreement among the shareholders of the
Corporation, in which event each of the shares proposed to be sold by such
holder that is actually sold shall become one share of Class A Voting Common
Stock.

            2.    Except as specifically provided herein, all preemptive
rights of shareholders are hereby denied, so that no stock or other security
of the Corporation shall carry with it and no holder or owner of any share or
shares of stock or other security or securities of the Corporation shall have
any preferential or preemptive right to acquire additional shares of stock or
of any other security of the Corporation.

            3.    All cumulative voting rights are hereby denied, so that no
stock or other security of the Corporation shall carry with it and no holder
or owner of any share or shares of such stock or security shall have any
right to cumulative voting in the election of directors or for any other
purpose.

            4.    The foregoing provisions are not intended to modify or
prohibit any provisions of any voting trust or agreement between or among
holders or owners of shares of stock or other securities of the Corporation.

               ARTICLE FOUR - RESTRICTIONS ON VOTING STOCK

              The following restrictions apply to the Voting Stock (as such
term is defined below) of the Corporation:

       A.   Certain Definitions.

            For purposes of this Section, the following words have the
meanings indicated:

            1.    "Affiliate" means, with respect to any Person, any other
Person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries,
controls, or is controlled by or is under common control with, such Person.
The term "control" (including the terms "controlling," "controlled by" and
"under common control with") means the possession, directly or indirectly, of
the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of
a Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or
otherwise.

            2.    "Associate" means, with respect to any Person, (i) any
other Person (other than the Corporation or a Subsidiary of which a majority
of each class of equity securities is owned by the Corporation) of which such
Person is an officer, director, trustee or partner or is directly or
indirectly the beneficial owner of ten percent (10%) or more of any class of
equity securities; (ii) any trust or other estate in which such Person serves
as a trustee or in a similar fiduciary capacity;


                                    14
<PAGE> 15

(iii) any relative or spouse of such Person, or any relative of such spouse, who
has the same home as such Person; or (iv) any investment company registered
under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, for which such Person or
any Affiliate of such Person serves as investment adviser.

            3.    A Person shall be deemed to "own" any shares of Voting
Stock:

                  (i) that such Person beneficially owns directly or
      indirectly, whether or not of record; or

                  (ii) that such Person has the right to acquire pursuant
      to any agreement, arrangement or understanding or upon exercise of
      conversion rights, warrants or options or otherwise, whether or not
      conditional; or

                  (iii) that are beneficially owned, directly or
      indirectly (including shares deemed to be owned through application
      of clause (ii) above), whether or not of record, by an Affiliate or
      Associate of such Person; or

                  (iv) that are beneficially owned, directly or
      indirectly, whether or not of record, by any other Person (including
      any shares which such other Person has the right to acquire pursuant
      to any agreement, arrangement or understanding or upon exercise of
      conversion rights, warrants or options or otherwise, whether or not
      conditional) with whom such Person has any agreement, arrangement or
      understanding for the purpose of acquiring, holding, voting or
      disposing of Voting Stock; provided, however, that (A) directors,
                                 --------  -------
      officers and employees of the Corporation shall not be deemed to
      have any such agreement, arrangement or understanding solely on the
      basis of their status, or actions taken in their capacities, as
      directors, officers or employees of the Corporation or any
      Affiliates of the Corporation, and (B) a Person shall not be deemed
      the owner of or to own any shares of Voting Stock solely because (x)
      such shares of Voting Stock have been tendered pursuant to a tender
      or exchange offer made by such Person or any of such Person's
      Affiliates or Associates until such tendered shares of Voting Stock
      are accepted for payment or exchange or (y) such Person or any of
      such Person's Affiliates or Associates has or shares the power to
      vote or direct the voting of such shares of Voting Stock pursuant to
      a revocable proxy given in response to a public proxy or consent
      solicitation made to more than ten (10) holders of shares of Voting
      Stock and pursuant to, and in accordance with, applicable rules and
      regulations under the Exchange Act, except if such power (or
      arrangements relating thereto) is then reportable under Item 6 of
      Schedule 13D under the Exchange Act (or any similar provision of a
      comparable or successor report).

            The outstanding shares of capital stock of the Corporation shall
include those shares deemed owned through the application of clauses (ii) and
(iii) above, but shall not include any other shares that may be issuable
pursuant to any agreement, arrangement or understanding or upon exercise of
conversion rights, warrants, options or otherwise, whether or not
conditional.


                                    15
<PAGE> 16

            For all purposes hereof "beneficial" ownership, with respect to
any securities, shall include, without limitation, (i) the power to vote, or
direct the voting of, such securities or (ii) the power to exercise
investment discretion over such securities, including the power to dispose,
or to direct the disposition, of such securities.  Furthermore, a Person
shall be deemed to own "beneficially" any securities that such Person owns
beneficially for purposes of Sections 13(d) of the Exchange Act or any rules
and regulations promulgated thereunder, as in effect from time to time (or
any similar successor provisions of law).

            4.    "Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
as amended, or any successor statute thereto.

            5.    "Group", with respect to any Person, shall include:

                  (i)  such Person;

                  (ii)  any Affiliates and Associates of such Person; and

                  (iii)  those additional Persons that, together with
      such Person, jointly file a statement of beneficial ownership with
      respect to securities of the Corporation pursuant to Section 13(d)
      of the Exchange Act or any successor provision, irrespective of
      any disclaimers of beneficial ownership.

            6.    "Person" means any individual, corporation, association,
partnership, joint venture, trust, organization, business, government or any
government agency or political subdivision thereof or any other entity.

            7.    "Voting Stock" means all outstanding shares of capital
stock of the Corporation entitled to vote in the election of directors; and
each reference to a portion of shares of Voting Stock shall refer to such
proportion of the votes entitled to be cast by such shares.

            8.    "Subsidiary" means any Person of which a majority of any
class of equity security is owned, directly or indirectly, by the
Corporation; provided, however, that for the purposes of Section D of this
             --------  -------
Article Four, the term "Subsidiary" shall mean only a Person of which a
majority of each class of equity security is owned, directly or indirectly,
by the Corporation.

      B.    Limitation on Entitlement to Vote Applicable to Certain
Shareholders.

            With respect to any matter submitted to a vote of the holders of
the Voting Stock at any meeting of such holders or any matter upon which the
holders of Voting Stock propose or purport to take action by written consent
without a meeting:  (i) no Person that owns Voting Stock may vote that number
of such shares that constitutes the Excludable Shares, if any, owned by such
Person (provided, however, that if such Person is a member of a Group, such
        --------  -------
Person shall be subject to clause (ii) below rather than to this clause (i));
(ii) no Person that is a member of a Group of Persons owning Voting Stock
may vote that number of shares owned by such Person that constitutes the
Allocable Excludable Shares, if any, owned by such Person; and (iii) that
number of


                                    16
<PAGE> 17

shares having the status of Excludable Shares (adjusted as necessary to give
effect to the provisos to the definition set forth below of Allocable Excludable
Shares) shall be excluded and deducted from the total number of shares of Voting
Stock deemed to be outstanding for purposes of determining the number of shares
of Voting Stock necessary to constitute a quorum at any such meeting or to
approve a matter submitted for shareholder approval at any such meeting or by
means of any such written consent. For purposes of this Article Four:

                  (a) the term "Excludable Shares" means, with respect to any
Person or Group, that number of shares of Voting Stock owned by such Person
or Group, as the case may be, that would result in such Person or Group, as
the case may be, owning more than twenty percent (20%) of the combined voting
power of the outstanding shares of Voting Stock (with the determination of
the voting power of each Person and Group owning Voting Stock being
calculated and recalculated for this purpose as often as is necessary to give
effect to the exclusion from voting and the determination of shares deemed to
be outstanding for purposes related thereto of Excludable Shares held by
other Persons or Groups); and

                  (b) the term "Allocable Excludable Shares" means, with
respect to each Person that is a member of a Group which owns Excludable
Shares, a number of shares owned by such Person equal to such Person's pro
rata share (based upon the number of shares of Voting Stock owned by such
Person) within such Group of the total amount of Excludable Shares owned by
such Group; provided, however, that shares that are deemed owned by two or
            --------  -------
more Persons who are members of such Group as a result of attributions in
accordance with Section A.3. of this Article Four hereof shall for this
purpose be deemed to be owned by such one of such Persons which most directly
owns such shares; and provided, further, that, with respect to any Person
                      --------  -------
that is a member of more than one such Group, "Allocable Excludable Shares"
means the greatest number of Excludable Shares so allocated with respect to
such Person with respect to any single Group.

      C.    Right of Inquiry of the Corporation.

            The Corporation shall have the right but not the obligation to
inquire of any Person whom the Corporation believes may own Voting Stock or
any other Person who purports to exercise voting rights with respect to any
Voting Stock, and each such Person shall have the obligation to provide such
information to the Corporation as the Corporation may reasonably request,
with respect to any matters pertinent to the operation or implementation of
this Article Four, including, without limitation, (i) the number of shares
owned by such Person, (ii) whether shares owned of record by such Person are
owned by other Persons and the identity of such other Persons and the nature
of their ownership interest, (iii) whether any Affiliates or Associates of
such Person own any Voting Stock, (iv) whether such Person is a member of a
Group of Persons owning Voting Stock, or (v) whether such Person or any of
such Person's Affiliates or Associates has any agreement, arrangement or
understanding with any other Person with respect to any Voting Stock.


      D.    Persons to Whom This Article Does Not Apply.


                                    17
<PAGE> 18

            The provisions of Section B of this Article Four shall not
apply to (i) General American Mutual Holding Company, a Missouri mutual company
("GAMHC"), General American Life Insurance Company, a Missouri corporation
("General American"), General American Holding Company, a Missouri corporation
("Holding  Company"), any Affiliate of GAMHC, General American or Holding
Company, or any Subsidiary, (ii) any savings, profit-sharing, stock bonus or
employee stock ownership plan or plans established by the Corporation or a
Subsidiary and qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of
1986, as amended, or any successor provision, which holds shares of Voting Stock
on behalf of participating employees and their beneficiaries with the right to
instruct the trustee how to vote such shares of Voting Stock with respect to all
matters submitted to shareholders for voting, or (iii) participating employees
and beneficiaries under the plans referred to in the immediately preceding
clause (ii) because of their participation in such savings, profit-sharing,
stock bonus or employee ownership plans.  In addition, the provisions of Section
B of this Article Four shall not be applicable with respect to any Person or
Group if the conditions specified in either Section D.1. or D.2 below are met:

            1.    Approval in Advance by the Board of Directors.  The board
of directors of the Corporation (the "Board of Directors") (i) has expressly
approved in advance either (A) the acquisition of outstanding shares of
Voting Stock by such Person or Group that caused such Person or Group to
become the owner of Excludable Shares, or (B) the issue or sale by the
Corporation of shares of Voting Stock to such Person or Group that caused
such effect, and (ii) in advance of such acquisition or issue or sale have
expressly determined that such provisions shall not be applicable to such
Person or Group.

            2.    Approval by Board of Directors.  The Board of Directors has
determined that such provision shall not apply to such Person or Group.

      E.    Powers of the Board of Directors.

            The Board of Directors shall have the power, but not the
obligation, to determine, for the purposes of this Article Four, on the basis
of information actually known to it or, in its discretion, after reasonable
inquiry, all facts necessary to determine compliance with or implementation
of this Article Four, including, without limitation, (i) the number of shares
of Voting Stock owned by any Person or Group or a member of any Group
(including, without limitation, in accordance with the first proviso to the
definitions of Excludable Shares and Allocable Excludable Shares set forth in
Section B of this Article Four), (ii) whether two or more Persons constitute
a Group, (iii) whether a Person is an Affiliate or Associate of another
Person or a member of any Group, (iv) whether a Person has an agreement,
arrangement or understanding with another Person, (v) the calculation
(including the manner of calculation) of the amount of Excludable Shares held
by any Person or Group or the Allocable Excludable Shares held by any Person
(including, without limitation, in accordance with the first proviso to the
definitions of Excludable Shares and Allocable Excludable Shares set forth in
Section B of this Article Four hereof), and (vi) any other facts which the
Board of Directors determines to be relevant.  Any determinations made by the
Board of Directors pursuant to this Article Four in good faith and on the
basis of such information as was actually known by the Board of Directors and
advice as was then actually provided to the Board of Directors for such
purpose shall be conclusive and binding upon the Corporation and its
shareholders.


                                    18
<PAGE> 19

                     ARTICLE FIVE - INCORPORATOR

            The name and place of residence of the incorporator of the
Corporation is:

         Name                                         Address
         ----                                         -------

         Connie B. Walsh                              454 Tree Top Lane
                                                      St. Louis, MO 63122

                       ARTICLE SIX - DIRECTORS

      A.    Number and Classification.

            The number of Directors to constitute the Board of Directors is
five.  Hereafter, the number of Directors shall be fixed by or in the manner
provided in the Bylaws of the Corporation, but in no event shall there be
fewer than three (3) Directors.  The Directors shall be divided into three
classes, as nearly equal in number as reasonably possible, with the mode of
such classification to be provided for in the Bylaws of the Corporation.
Directors other than certain Directors constituting the existing Board of
Directors at the time of the adoption of this provision shall be elected to
hold office for a term of three years, with the term of office of one class
expiring each year.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, whenever the holders of
any one or more classes or series of stock of the Corporation, other than
shares of Common Stock, shall have the right, voting separately by class or
series, to elect Directors, the election, term of office, filling of
vacancies and other features of such directorship shall be governed by the
terms of the Articles of Incorporation of the Corporation or any Certificate
of Designation thereunder applicable thereto; and such directors so elected
shall not be divided into classes pursuant to this Article Six unless
expressly provided by such terms.  As used in these Articles of
Incorporation, the term "entire Board of Directors" or the "entire Board"
means the total number of Directors fixed by, or in accordance with, these
Articles of Incorporation and the Bylaws of the Corporation.

      B.    Removal of Directors.

            Subject to the rights, if any, of the holders of any class of
capital stock of the Corporation (other than the Common Stock) then
outstanding or any limitation imposed by law, (1) any Director, or the entire
Board of Directors, may be removed from office at any time prior to the
expiration of his, her or their term of office only for cause and only by the
affirmative vote of the holders of record of outstanding shares representing
at least 85% of all of the then outstanding shares of capital stock of the
Corporation then entitled to vote generally in the election of Directors,
voting together as a single class at a special meeting of shareholders called
expressly for that purpose (such vote being in addition to any required class
or other vote); and (2) any Director may be removed from office by the
affirmative vote of a majority of the entire Board of Directors at any time
prior to the expiration of his or her term of office, as provided by law, in
the event that the Director fails to meet any qualifications stated in the
Bylaws for election as a Director or in the


                                    19
<PAGE> 20

event that the Director is in breach of any agreement between the Director and
the Corporation relating to the Director's service as a Director or employee of
the Corporation.

      C.    Vacancies.

            Subject to the rights, if any, of the holders of any class of
capital stock of the Corporation (other than the Common Stock) then
outstanding, any vacancies in the Board of Directors which occur for any
reason prior to the expiration of the respective term of office of the class
in which the vacancy occurs, including vacancies which occur by reason of an
increase in the number of Directors or the removal of a Director, shall be
filled only by the Board of Directors, acting by the affirmative vote of a
majority of the remaining Directors then in office (although less than a
quorum).

                      ARTICLE SEVEN - DURATION

            The duration of the Corporation is perpetual.

                      ARTICLE EIGHT - PURPOSES

            The Corporation is formed to engage in any lawful act or activity
for which a corporation now or hereafter may be organized under the laws of
the State of Missouri.

                  ARTICLE NINE - AMENDMENT OF BYLAWS

            The Bylaws of the Corporation may be amended, altered, changed or
repealed, and a provision or provisions inconsistent with the provisions of
the Bylaws as they may exist from time to time may be adopted, only by a
majority of the entire Board of Directors.

                    ARTICLE TEN - INDEMNIFICATION

      A.    Actions Involving Directors and Officers.

            The Corporation shall indemnify each person (other than a party
plaintiff suing on his or her own behalf or in the right of the Corporation)
who at any time is serving or has served as a Director or officer of the
Corporation against any claim, liability or expense incurred as a result of
such service, or as a result of any other service on behalf of the
Corporation, or service at the request of the Corporation as a director,
officer, employee, member, or agent of another corporation, partnership,
joint venture, trust, trade or industry association, or other enterprise
(whether incorporated or unincorporated, for-profit or not-for-profit), to
the maximum extent permitted by law.  Without limiting the generality of the
foregoing, the Corporation shall indemnify any such person who was or is a
party (other than a party plaintiff suing on his or her behalf or in the
right of the Corporation), or is threatened to be made a party, to any
threatened, pending or


                                    20
<PAGE> 21

completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or
investigative (including, but not limited to, an action by or in the right of
the Corporation) by reason of such service against expenses (including, without
limitation, attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection with such action,
suit or proceeding.

      B.    Actions Involving Employees or Agents.

            1.    Permissive Indemnification.  The Corporation may, if it
deems appropriate and as may be permitted by this Article Ten, indemnify any
person (other than a party plaintiff suing on his or her own behalf or in the
right of the Corporation) who at any time is serving or has served as an
employee or agent of the Corporation against any claim, liability or expense
incurred as a result of such service, or as a result of any other service on
behalf of the Corporation, or service at the request of the Corporation as a
director, officer, employee, member, or agent of another corporation,
partnership, joint venture, trust, trade or industry association, or other
enterprise (whether incorporated or unincorporated, for-profit or not-for-
profit), to the maximum extent permitted by law or to such lesser extent as
the Corporation, in its discretion, may deem appropriate.  Without limiting
the generality of the foregoing, the Corporation may indemnify any such
person who was or is a party (other than a party plaintiff suing on his or
her own behalf or in the right of the Corporation), or is threatened to be
made a party, to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or
proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative
(including, but not limited to, an action by or in the right of the
Corporation) by reason of such service, against expenses (including, without
limitation, attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection with such
action, suit or proceeding.

            2.    Mandatory Indemnification.  To the extent that an employee
or agent of the Corporation has been successful on the merits or otherwise in
defense of any action, suit or proceeding referred to in Section B.1 of this
Article Ten, or in defense of any claim, issue or matter therein, he or she
shall be indemnified against expenses (including attorneys' fees) actually
and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection with the action, suit or
preceding.

      C.    Determination of Right to Indemnification in Certain
Circumstances.

            Any indemnification required under Section A of this Article Ten
or authorized by the Corporation in a specific case pursuant to Section B of
this Article Ten (unless ordered by a court) shall be made by the Corporation
unless a determination is made reasonably and promptly that indemnification
of the Director, officer, employee or agent is not proper under the
circumstances because he or she has not met the applicable standard of
conduct set forth in or established pursuant to this Article Ten.  Such
determination shall be made (1) by the Board of Directors by a majority vote
of a quorum consisting of Directors who were not parties to such action, suit
or proceeding, or (2) if such a quorum is not obtainable, or even if
obtainable a quorum of disinterested Directors so directs, by independent
legal counsel in a written opinion, or (3) by majority vote of the
shareholders; provided that no such determination shall preclude an action
brought in an appropriate court to challenge such determination.


                                    21
<PAGE> 22

      D.    Advance Payment of Expenses.

            Expenses incurred by a person who is or was a Director or officer
of the Corporation in defending a civil or criminal action, suit or
proceeding shall be paid by the Corporation in advance of the final
disposition of an action, suit or proceeding, and expenses incurred by a
person who is or was an employee or agent of the Corporation in defending a
civil or criminal action, suit or proceeding may be paid by the Corporation
in advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or proceeding as
authorized by the Board of Directors, in either case upon receipt of an
undertaking by or on behalf of the Director, officer, employee or agent to
repay such amount if it shall ultimately be determined that he or she is not
entitled to be indemnified by the Corporation as authorized in or pursuant to
this Article Ten.

      E.    Article Ten Provisions Not Exclusive Right.

            The indemnification provided by this Article Ten shall not be
deemed exclusive of any other rights to which those seeking indemnification
may be entitled, whether under the Bylaws of the Corporation or any statute,
agreement, vote of shareholders or disinterested Directors or otherwise, both
as to action in an official capacity and as to action in another capacity
while holding such office.

      F.    Indemnification Agreements Authorized.

            Without limiting the other provisions of this Article Ten, the
Corporation is authorized from time to time, without further action by the
shareholders of the Corporation, to enter into agreements with any Director,
officer, employee or agent of the Corporation providing such rights of
indemnification as the Corporation may deem appropriate, up to the maximum
extent permitted by law.  Any agreement entered into by the Corporation with
a Director may be authorized by the other Directors, and such authorization
shall not be invalid on the basis that different or similar agreements may
have been or may thereafter be entered into with other Directors.

      G.    Standard of Conduct.

            Except as may otherwise be permitted by law, no person shall be
indemnified pursuant to this Article Ten (including without limitation
pursuant to any agreement entered into pursuant to Section F of this Article
Ten) from or on account of such person's conduct which is finally adjudged to
have been knowingly fraudulent, deliberately dishonest or willful misconduct.
The Corporation may (but need not) adopt a more restrictive standard of
conduct with respect to the indemnification of any employee or agent of the
Corporation.

      H.    Insurance.

            The Corporation may purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of
any person who is or was a Director, officer, employee or agent of the
Corporation, or who is or was otherwise serving on behalf or at the request
of the Corporation in any capacity against any claim, liability or


                                    22
<PAGE> 23

expense asserted against him or her and incurred by him or her in any such
capacity, or arising out of his or her status as such, whether or not the
Corporation would have the power to indemnify him or her against such liability
under the provisions of this Article Ten.

      I.    Certain Definitions.

            For the purposes of this Article Ten:

            1.    Service in Representative Capacity.  Any Director or
officer of the Corporation who shall serve as a director, officer or employee
of any other corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other
enterprise of which the Corporation, directly or indirectly, is or was the
owner of 20% or more of either the outstanding equity interests or the
outstanding voting stock (or comparable interests), shall be deemed to be so
serving at the request of the Corporation, unless the Board of Directors of
the Corporation shall determine otherwise.  In all other instances where any
person shall serve as a director, officer, employee or agent of another
corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise of which
the Corporation is or was a stockholder or creditor, or in which it is or was
otherwise interested, if it is not otherwise established that such person is
or was serving as a director, officer, employee or agent at the request of
the Corporation, the Board of Directors of the Corporation may determine
whether such service is or was at the request of the Corporation, and it
shall not be necessary to show any actual or prior request for such service.

            2.    Predecessor Corporations.  References to a corporation
include all constituent corporations absorbed in a consolidation or merger as
well as the resulting or surviving corporation so that any person who is or
was a director, officer, employee or agent of a constituent corporation or is
or was serving at the request of a constituent corporation as a director,
officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint
venture, trust or other enterprise shall stand in the same position under the
provisions of this Article Ten with respect to the resulting or surviving
corporation as he or she would if he or she had served the resulting or
surviving corporation in the same capacity.

            3.    Service for Employee Benefit Plan.  The term "other
enterprise" shall include, without limitation, employee benefit plans and
voting or taking action with respect to stock or other assets therein; the
term "serving at the request of the Corporation" shall include, without
limitation, any service as a director, officer, employee or agent of a
corporation which imposes duties on, or involves services by, a director,
officer, employee or agent with respect to any employee benefit plan, its
participants, or beneficiaries; and a person who acted in good faith and in a
manner he or she reasonably believed to be in the interest of the
participants and beneficiaries of an employee benefit plan shall be deemed to
have satisfied any standard of care required by or pursuant to this Article
Ten in connection with such plan; the term "fines" shall include, without
limitation, any excise taxes assessed on a person with respect to an employee
benefit plan and shall also include any damages (including treble damages)
and any other civil penalties.


                                    23
<PAGE> 24

      J.    Survival.

            Any indemnification rights provided pursuant to this Article Ten
shall continue as to a person who has ceased to be a Director, officer,
employee or agent and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, executors and
administrators of such a person.  Notwithstanding any other provisions in
these Articles of Incorporation, any indemnification rights arising under or
granted pursuant to this Article Ten shall survive amendment or repeal of
this Article Ten with respect to any acts or omissions occurring prior to the
effective time of such amendment or repeal and persons to whom such
indemnification rights are given shall be entitled to rely upon such
indemnification rights with respect to such acts or omissions as a binding
contract with the Corporation.

      K.    Liability of the Directors.

            It is the intention of the Corporation to limit the personal
liability of the Directors of the Corporation, in their capacity as such,
whether to the Corporation, its shareholders or otherwise, to the fullest
extent permitted by law.  Consequently, should the GBCL or any other
applicable law be amended or adopted hereafter so as to permit the
elimination or limitation of such liability, the liability of the Directors
of the Corporation shall be so eliminated or limited without the need for
amendment of these Articles or further action on the part of the shareholders
of the Corporation.

          ARTICLE ELEVEN - AMENDMENT OF ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION

            The Corporation reserves the right to amend, alter, change or
repeal any provision contained in these Articles of Incorporation in the
manner now or hereafter prescribed by law, and all rights and powers
conferred herein on the shareholders, Directors and officers of the
Corporation are subject to this reserved power; provided, that (in addition
to any required class or other vote) the affirmative vote of the holders of
record of outstanding shares representing at least 85% of all of the
outstanding shares of capital stock of the Corporation then entitled to vote
generally in the election of Directors, voting together as a single class,
shall be required to amend, alter, change or repeal, or adopt any provision
or provisions inconsistent with, Articles Four, Six, Nine, Ten, Twelve,
Thirteen or this Article Eleven of these Articles of Incorporation.

               ARTICLE TWELVE - BUSINESS COMBINATIONS

            The Corporation hereby subjects itself to and accepts the
provisions of Section 351.459 of the GBCL, provided that General American or
Holding Company  or any Affiliate of General American or Holding Company or
any Subsidiary (as each of such terms is defined in Article Four hereof)
shall not be deemed to constitute "interested shareholders" for purposes of
Section 351.459.

              ARTICLE THIRTEEN - CONTROL SHARE ACQUISITIONS

            Section 351.407 of the GBCL shall not apply to control share
acquisitions (as defined therein) of shares of the Corporation.


                                    24

<PAGE> 1

                        [letterhead of Bryan Cave LLP]

                              December 11, 1997


Board of Directors
Conning Corporation
700 Market Street
St. Louis, MO  63101



To the Board of Directors of Conning Corporation:

      We have acted as special counsel for Conning Corporation, a Missouri
corporation (the "Company"), in connection with various legal matters
relating to the filing of a Registration Statement on Form S-1, No. 333-35993
(the "Registration Statement") under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended
(the "Act"), covering the offering and sale of up to 2,875,000 shares
(including 375,000 shares subject to the Underwriters' over-allotment option)
of the Company's Common Stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Shares").

      In connection therewith, we have examined and relied without
investigation as to matters of fact upon the Registration Statement,
certificates of public officials, statements and certificates of officers of
the Company, and originals or copies certified to our satisfaction of the
Restated Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws of the Company, as amended,
proceedings of the Board of Directors of the Company and such other corporate
records, documents, certificates and instruments as we have deemed necessary
or appropriate in order to enable us to render the opinion expressed below.

      In rendering this opinion, we have assumed the genuineness of all
signatures on all documents examined by us, the authenticity of all documents
submitted to us as originals and the conformity to authentic originals of all
documents submitted to us as certified or photostatted copies.  We have also
assumed the due authorization, execution and delivery of all documents.

      Based on the foregoing and in reliance thereon, we are of the opinion
that the Shares of the Company, if sold in accordance with the terms set
forth in the Registration Statement, will be legally issued, fully paid and
non-assessable.

      This opinion is not rendered with respect to any laws other than The
General and Business Corporation Law of Missouri.

<PAGE> 2
The Board of Directors
  of Conning Corporation
December 11, 1997
Page 2

      We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as Exhibit 5.1 to the
Registration Statement and to the use of our name under the caption "Legal
Matters" in the Prospectus filed as a part thereof.  We also consent to your
filing copies of this opinion as an exhibit to the Registration Statement
with agencies of such states as you deem necessary in the course of complying
with the laws of such states regarding the offering and sale of the Shares.
In giving this consent, we do not admit that we are in the category of
persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Act or the rules and
regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                    Very truly yours,

                                    /s/ Bryan Cave LLP

                                    BRYAN CAVE LLP


<PAGE> 1
                               SUBLEASE
                               --------

            THIS SUBLEASE (the "Sublease") is effective as of July 19, 1995
(the "Effective Date"), between General American Life Insurance Company, a
Missouri corporation ("Sublessor"), and General American Investment
Management Company ("GAIMCO"), a Missouri corporation ("Sublessee").

                               RECITALS
                               --------

            A.    Pursuant to certain leases (individually a "Master Lease"
and collectively the "Master Leases"), various landlords (each a "Master
Lessor" and collectively the "Master Lessors") leased to Sublessor certain
spaces (each a "Master Lease Space" and collectively the "Master Lease
Spaces").

            B.    Sublessee desires to sublease from Sublessor, and Sublessor
desires to sublet to Sublessee certain spaces (each a "Space" and
collectively the "Spaces") which constitute the Master Lease Spaces.  The
Spaces are described on Exhibit A attached hereto.
                        ---------

            IN CONSIDERATION OF THE ABOVE, Sublessor and Sublessee agree as
follows:

            1.    Demise.  Sublessor hereby subleases and demises to
                  ------
Sublessee and Sublessee hereby takes and hires from Sublessor the Spaces,
subject to the provisions hereinafter set forth.

            2.    Term.  The initial term of this Sublease (the "Initial
                  ----
Term") shall commence on the Effective Date, and shall expire, with respect
to each particular Space listed on Exhibit A, at midnight on the day prior
                                   ---------
to the expiration date of the current term of the Master Lease, unless such
Master Lease is earlier terminated.

            This Sublease may be terminated with respect to one or more
Spaces at any time by 90 days advance written notice by the Sublessee to the
Sublessor at the address for notices provided herein.  Upon expiration of the
Initial Term of this Sublease and any extension or renewal thereof (the
"Expiration Date"), Sublessor and Sublessee shall be released from all
liabilities and obligations hereunder except as may be expressly provided
herein.

            3.    Condition and Use of Spaces.  Sublessee accepts the
                  ---------------------------
Spaces from Sublessor in their present condition and acknowledges that Sublessor
shall not be required to make any improvements or alterations to the Spaces.
Sublessor represents and warrants that it has asserted no claim of default on
the part of any Master Lessor


                                    1
<PAGE> 2

under any Master Lease and that, to the best of its knowledge, no default has
occurred and is continuing on the part of any Master Lessor under any Master
Lease.  Sublessor further represents and warrants that it has received no
notice alleging default by it from any Master Lessor and that it has performed
all of its obligations to be performed by Sublessor under each Master Lease.
Sublessor agrees that as between itself and Sublessee, Sublessee shall have the
benefit of all claims and warranties inuring to the benefit of Sublessor in
respect of the Spaces, if any.

            4.    Rent and Other Charges.  During the Initial Term of this
                  ----------------------
Sublease, Sublessee shall pay rent ("Rent") and all other amounts in
accordance with the terms of the Master Leases to Sublessor, at the address
for notices provided herein, in lawful money of the United States, in monthly
payments in advance on or before the first day of each month, as specified in
the Master Leases with respect to each Space listed on Exhibit A.
                                                       ---------

            5.    Surrender of Spaces.  Upon the Expiration Date or earlier
                  -------------------
termination of this Sublease, Sublessee shall (a) surrender the Spaces to
Sublessor in good condition and repair, broom-clean, ordinary wear and tear
and casualty loss or loss by condemnation excepted and otherwise in the
condition required by the Master Lease, and (b) to the extent required of
Sublessor or Sublessee under corresponding Master Leases, repair any damage
to the Spaces occasioned by the removal of Sublessee's trade fixtures,
furnishings, equipment and personal property which Sublessee may remove under
the terms of such Master Leases.

            6.    Subordination.  Subject to the provisions of Paragraph 25
                  -------------
hereof, this Sublease is subject and subordinate to each Master Lease and to
all matters to which such Master Leases are subject and subordinate.

            7.    Indemnification.  Sublessor shall defend, indemnify and
                  ---------------
hold Sublessee harmless from and against any and all losses, liabilities,
claims, causes of action, damages, costs and expenses (including attorneys'
fees and expert witnesses' fees) arising or resulting from (i) any
intentional or negligent act or omission of Sublessor or Sublessor's
officers, agents, employees, contractors, invitees or licensees (collectively
"Sublessor's Agents"), occurring or accruing during the term of this Sublease
and/or (ii) any breach occurring or accruing on or after the Effective Date
by Sublessor or Sublessor's Agents of any term, condition or covenant under
this Sublease or any breach of any term, condition or covenant under the
Master Leases occurring or accruing during the term of this Sublease, except
to the extent incorporated herein as an obligation of Sublessee.  In case any
action or proceeding is brought against Sublessee by reason of any such
claim, Sublessor, upon written notice from Sublessee, shall, at Sublessor's
expense, resist or defend such action or proceeding by counsel reasonably
approved by Sublessee.  Sublessee shall defend,


                                    2
<PAGE> 3

indemnify and hold Sublessor harmless from and against any and all losses,
liabilities, claims, causes of action, damages, costs and expenses (including
attorneys' fees and expert witnesses' fees) arising or resulting from (i) any
intentional or negligent act or omission of Sublessee or Sublessee's officers,
agents, employees, contractors, invitees or licensees (collectively
"Sublessee's Agents"), occurring or accruing during the term of this Sublease,
and/or (ii) any breach occurring or accruing on or after the Effective Date by
Sublessee or Sublessee's Agents of any term, condition or covenant under this
Sublease or under the Master Leases to the extent incorporated herein as
applying to Sublessee, and/or (iii) any intentional or negligent act or
omission of Sublessee or Sublessee's Agents which constitutes a breach or
creates an obligation for reimbursement or indemnification on Sublessor's part
to one or more Master Lessors under the terms of the Master Leases.  In case
any action or proceeding is brought against Sublessor by reason of any such
claim, Sublessee, upon written notice from Sublessor, shall, at Sublessee's
expense, resist or defend such action or proceeding by counsel reasonably
approved by Sublessor.  The foregoing indemnities in this Paragraph 7 shall
survive the expiration, cancellation or termination of this Sublease.

            8.    Insurance.  The Sublessee shall maintain at its expense
                  ---------
throughout the term of this Sublease, insurance against loss or liability in
connection with bodily injury, death, property damage or destruction,
occurring within the Spaces or arising out of the use thereof by the
Sublessee or its agents, employees, officers, invitees, visitors and guests,
under one or more policies of general public liability insurance affording
Sublessor protection in an amount not less than the amount of such insurance
maintained by Sublessor pursuant to the terms of the Master Leases.  Each
such policy shall (a) name as the insureds thereunder, as their interests may
appear, the Sublessor and the Sublessee, (b) by its terms, be cancelable or
materially altered only on at least thirty (30) days' prior written notice to
Sublessor, and (c) be issued by an insurer of recognized responsibility
licensed to issue such policy in the state in which the Spaces are located,
and rated at least A by Best's Key Rating Guide for Property Liability or
otherwise as may be acceptable to Sublessor.  To the extent Master Lessor
under the Master Lease may require Sublessee separately to provide any
evidence of insurance benefiting or naming Master Lessor as a named or
additional insured, Sublessee shall promptly upon request of Sublessor cause
such evidence of insurance to be issued and delivered to Master Lessor.  Any
waiver of subrogation rights provided in the Master Lease shall not apply
between the parties hereto.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary
contained in this Paragraph 8, Sublessee shall not be required to carry any
insurance in excess of the amount of insurance coverage required to be
maintained by Sublessor under the Master Leases.

            Sublessee and Sublessor each hereby relieve the other, and waive
their entire right of recovery against the other for loss or damage arising
out of or incident to the perils insured against by either party to the
extent of insurance proceeds actually


                                    3
<PAGE> 4

received, which perils occur in, on or about the Spaces or the Master Lease
Spaces, whether due to the negligence of Sublessor or Sublessee or their
agents, employees, contractors and/or invitees.  Sublessee and Sublessor shall
give notice to their insurance carrier or carriers that the foregoing mutual
waiver of subrogation is contained in this Sublease.

            9.    Other Provisions.  Except for the paragraphs of the
                  ----------------
Master Lease which relate to (i) the payment of rent, (ii) the term of the
Lease, (iii) any options to purchase the Master Lease Spaces, renew any Master
Lease or expand the Master Lease Spaces, (iv) any rights to assignment and
subletting, and (v) personal property or public liability insurance to be
carried by Sublessor covering the Master Lease Spaces, and to the extent not
otherwise consistent with the agreements and understandings expressed
elsewhere in this Sublease or applicable only to the original parties to the
Master Leases, the provisions of the Master Leases are hereby incorporated
herein by reference on the following understandings:

                  (a)   The term "premises" (or other word of similar import)
as used therein shall refer to the Spaces.

                  (b)   The terms "tenant" or "lessee" (or other word of
similar import) as used therein shall refer to Sublessee.

                  (c)   The terms "lessor", "landlord" or "owner" (or other
word of similar import) as used therein shall refer to Sublessor.

                  (d)   Sublessee acknowledges that the applicable Master
Lessors and not Sublessor shall be responsible for any work, services,
repairs, utilities, common areas, repainting and restoration or the
performance of other obligations required of or imposed upon Master Lessor
under each Master Lease.  Sublessor agrees to deliver to such Master Lessor
any request relating to such services if requested to do so by Sublessee, or
Sublessee may make such requests directly of such Master Lessor if Sublessee
so elects.  Sublessee shall perform such maintenance and repairs with respect
to the Spaces as required to be performed by Sublessor under applicable
Master Leases.  To the extent that each Master Lease permits any right of
self help, Sublessee may exercise such right of self-help with respect to the
corresponding Space.

                  (e)   Except as otherwise provided in this Paragraph 9,
Sublessor and Sublessee shall perform and comply with the provisions of the
Master Leases incorporated herein with respect to the Spaces to be performed
by, respectively, the "landlord" and "tenant" (or like words of similar
import) thereunder.  Accordingly, Sublessee hereby assumes and agrees to
perform all of the obligations of the "tenant"


                                    4
<PAGE> 5

under the Master Leases accruing or arising during the term of this Sublease in
the manner and within the time required under the Master Leases as if the
Spaces were the only space demised under the Master Leases.  Sublessee and
Sublessor each further covenant that it will neither commit, nor permit to be
committed by any third party, any act or omission which would violate any
material term or condition of the Master Leases to be performed by it or on its
behalf, nor be cause for termination of any Master Lease by a Master Lessor.
Sublessee's obligations hereunder are to Sublessor and Sublessee shall have no
duties or obligations to any Master Lessors under the Master Leases, except as
may otherwise be agreed to between Sublessee and a Master Lessor or as
specifically provided in the Master Leases.

                  (f)   In the event of a default by a Master Lessor under a
Master Lease, Sublessor agrees that Sublessee may at Sublessee's option
institute an action for enforcement of Sublessor's rights under such Master
Lease in the name, place and stead of Sublessor.

            10.   Sublessee's Sign.  If any Master Lease contains
                  ----------------
limitations on the number of signs that may be placed on the corresponding
Master Lease Space, such right shall be allocated between the parties on a
proportionate basis with respect to each party's relative square footage of use.
Notwithstanding the above, Sublessee's rights to install and maintain a sign
on the any Space shall be limited to the provisions of the corresponding
Master Lease and shall otherwise be conditioned upon receipt of prior written
consent of the applicable Master Lessor if so required under the terms of the
Master Lease.

            11.   Assignment and Subletting.  Subject to obtaining any
                  -------------------------
consents required under the Master Leases, Sublessee shall obtain Sublessor's
prior written consent to any assignment or subletting, which consent shall
not be unreasonably withheld or delayed.  Notwithstanding the foregoing,
Sublessee shall not have the right to assign this Sublease or sublet all or
any portion of a Space without first obtaining the prior written consent of
the applicable Master Lessor where such consent is required under the terms
of the Master Lease.  No assignment of this Sublease (whether or not
Sublessor's consent is required) shall relieve Sublessee of its obligations
hereunder.

            Each assignee of this Sublease shall assume all obligations of
Sublessee under this Sublease and shall be and remain liable jointly and
severally with Sublessee for the payment of Rent, and for the performance of
all the terms, covenants, conditions and agreements herein contained on
Sublessee's part to be performed.  No assignment shall be binding on
Sublessor unless the assignee or Sublessee shall deliver to Sublessor a
counterpart of the assignment and an instrument in recordable form that
contains a covenant of assumption by the assignee reasonably satisfactory in
substance and form to Sublessor, consistent with the requirements of this
paragraph,


                                    5
<PAGE> 6

but the failure or refusal of the assignee to execute such instrument of
assumption shall not release or discharge the assignee from its liability as
set forth above.

            12.   Options to Renew.  Sublessor shall have no obligation,
                  ----------------
and Sublessee shall have no right or power, to exercise any option to renew or
extend the term of the Master Lease.

            13.   Notices.  Any notice, demand, consent or approval,
                  -------
request or other communication or document to be provided pursuant to this
Sublease shall be in writing and shall be sent by registered or certified United
States mail, return receipt requested, or by personal delivery during normal
business hours with evidence of delivery requested, with all postage and fees
prepaid, to Sublessor or Sublessee, respectively, at the following addresses,
or at such other address as such party shall designate by written notice to
the other party.  Such addresses are:

            SUBLESSOR:

            General American Life Insurance Company
            700 Market Street
            St. Louis, MO  63101
            Attn:  Real Estate Department

            SUBLESSEE:

            General American Investment Management Company
            (at the address of the Space or at such other place as
            Sublessee may from time to time designate by notice
            to Sublessor)

Such notices shall be deemed to have been received and to be effective for
all purposes upon receipt or refusal to accept delivery at such address as
indicated on the return receipt or other record of delivery.

            14.   No Oral Agreements.  There are no oral agreements or
                  ------------------
understandings between the parties hereto affecting this Sublease.  This
Sublease cannot be changed or terminated orally but only by an agreement in
writing signed by the party against whom enforcement or any waiver, change,
modification or discharge is sought.


                                    6
<PAGE> 7

            15.   Governing Law.  This Sublease shall be governed and
                  -------------
construed, as to each of the respective Spaces, in accordance with the laws
of the state in which each such Space is located.

            16.   Incorporation of Exhibit(s).  The Exhibit(s) attached
                  ---------------------------
hereto is (are) incorporated herein by this reference.

            17.   Consent.  When consent or approval of either Sublessor or
                  -------
Sublessee is required by any provision of this Sublease or of the Master
Lease to the extent incorporated herein, such consent or approval shall not
be unreasonably withheld or delayed (unless otherwise expressly provided in
this Sublease or in the Master Leases as incorporated herein).  Neither
Sublessor nor Sublessee shall take or omit to take any action requiring a
Master Lessor's consent under a Master Lease without first obtaining such
consent in accordance with the terms of the Master Lease.  Upon request of
Sublessee, Sublessor will request a Master Lessor's consent to any action or
omission of Sublessee for which such consent is required.

            18.   Parties Not Relieved of Liability.  No assignment of this
                  ---------------------------------
Sublease or subletting of the Spaces, in whole or in part, as provided in
this Sublease, shall relieve either Sublessor or Sublessee of its obligations
under this Sublease.

            19.   Severability.  If any provision of this Sublease is
                  ------------
determined to be unenforceable for any reason, it shall be modified rather
than voided, if possible, in order to achieve the intent of Sublessor and
Sublessee to the extent possible.  In any event, the remaining provisions
shall be deemed valid and enforceable to the maximum extent possible.

            20.   Notice of Default.  Sublessor and Sublessee shall,
                  -----------------
respectively, promptly give written notice to the other of any notice of
default they may receive from the Master Lessor under any Master Lease.

            21.   Attorney's Fees.  In the event of any legal action or
                  ---------------
proceeding to enforce the terms of this Sublease, the prevailing party shall
be entitled to recover its reasonable attorney's fees, costs and expenses.

            22.   No Third Party Beneficiary.  This Sublease is intended to
                  --------------------------
confer benefits on Sublessee, Sublessor and their respective successors and
permitted assigns only, and is not intended to result in any rights or benefits
to any third party, including without limitation, any Master Lessor. Nothing
contained in this Sublease shall be construed to create privity of estate or of
contract between Sublessee and any Master Lessor.

                                    7
<PAGE> 8

            23.   Effectiveness.  This Sublease shall be binding against
                  -------------
Sublessor and Sublessee effective as of the Effective Date hereof.  Sublessor
agrees to seek the consent of the Master Lessors to this Sublease were
required to do so by the terms of particular Master Leases.  In the event
that subsequent to the Effective Date Sublessor delivers written notice to
Sublessee that Sublessor has been unable to obtain the consent of one or more
Master Lessors to this Sublease, this Sublease shall be null and void as to
the corresponding Spaces, and neither party shall have any obligation to the
other hereunder with respect to such Spaces, except that Sublessee shall
vacate and surrender such Spaces to Sublessor in the same condition delivered
to Sublessee, ordinary wear and tear excepted.  Notwithstanding the
foregoing, Sublessor shall permit Sublessee to negotiate with any Master
Lessor regarding any changes to the form of consent agreement required by
such Master Lessor, provided such provisions do not modify or impair any
rights or duties of Sublessor under the applicable Master Lease or this
Sublease.

            The effectiveness of this Sublease shall be further conditioned,
at Sublessee's option, on Sublessee's receipt from each Master Lessor,
concurrently with such Master Lessor's consent to this Sublease, of (i) an
estoppel letter verifying that the Lease provided separately by Sublessor to
Sublessee and identified by Sublessor as the Master Lease in effect with
respect to such Master Lessor is a true and complete copy of the applicable
Master Lease, and that no default has occurred and is continuing on the part
of Sublessor thereunder.

            IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have entered into this Agreement
as of the day and year first above written.

            SUBLESSOR:

                GENERAL AMERICAN LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY

                By: /s/ Matthew P. McCauley
                    ----------------------------------------------
                Name: Matthew P. McCauley
                      --------------------------------------------
                Title: Vice President
                       -------------------------------------------

            SUBLESSEE:

                GENERAL AMERICAN INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT COMPANY

                By: /s/ Leonard M. Rubenstein
                    ----------------------------------------------
                Name: Leonard M. Rubenstein
                      --------------------------------------------
                Title: Chief Executive Officer
                       -------------------------------------------


                                    8
<PAGE> 9

<TABLE>
                                               EXHIBIT A TO SUBLEASE

                                         CONNING ASSET MANAGEMENT COMPANY
                                     REAL ESTATE FIELD OFFICE LEASE SUMMARY
                                                    SUB-LEASES

<CAPTION>
FIELD OFFICE                                     ANNUAL RENT         SQUARE FEET         LEASE EXPIRATION
- ----------------------------------------         -----------         -----------         ----------------
<S>                                                <C>                  <C>                <C>
ATLANTA INVESTMENT OFFICE                          $25,688              1,352              Feb. 28, 2002
The Day Building, Suite 185
4725 Peachtree Corners Circle
Norcross, GA 30092

CHICAGO INVESTMENT OFFICE                          $20,200              1,437              March 31, 1999
300 Park Blvd., Suite 290
Itasca, IL 60143

DALLAS REAL ESTATE OFFICE                          $25,568              1,598              Oct. 31, 2000
One Lincoln Centre, Suite 945
5400 LBJ Freeway
Dallas, TX 75240

NORTHERN PACIFIC INVESTMENT                        $24,402              1,162              Sept. 14, 2000
3000 Executive Parkway, Sutie 212
San Ramon, CA 94583

ORLANDO INVESTMENT OFFICE                          $27,602              1,492              Dec. 31, 1998
Landmark Center I, Station 275
315 East Robinson Street
Orlando, FL 32801

SOUTHERN CALIFORNIA (CBC)   (IP-519)               $17,102              1,296              Month-to-Month
Corporate Business Center   (IP-531)                $8,640              1,440              (storage) M-T-M
25884 Business Center Dr., Suite A
Redlands, CA 92374

WASHINGTON D.C. INVESTMENT                         $22,915              1,540              Sept. 30, 1999
950 Herndon Parkway, Suite 240
Herndon, VA 20170-5531
</TABLE>


<PAGE> 1
                   REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT
                   -----------------------------

      REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT dated as of June 12, 1997, among CONNING
CORPORATION, a Missouri corporation (the "Company"), GENERAL AMERICAN LIFE
INSURANCE COMPANY, a Missouri life insurance corporation ("General
American"), and GENERAL AMERICAN HOLDING COMPANY, a Missouri corporation and
a wholly owned subsidiary of General American ("Holding Company").

                             RECITALS

      1.    General American is the beneficial owner and Holding Company is
the record owner of 6,710,000 shares of Common Stock of the Company and on
the Closing Date (as defined below), General American will beneficially own
more than 60% of the outstanding Common Stock as of such date.

      2.    General American, through Holding Company, may desire, in the
future, to sell to the public some or all of such shares of Common Stock.

      3.    The Company, General American and Holding Company therefore deem
it to be in their respective best interests to set forth the rights of
General American and Holding Company and certain other holders of such shares
of Common Stock of the Company in connection with public offerings and sales
of such shares.

      NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and mutual covenants
and obligations hereinafter set forth, and intending to be legally bound
hereby, the Company, General American and Holding Company hereby agree as
follows:

      1.    Definitions.   For purposes of this Agreement:
            -----------

            (a)   "Common Stock" shall mean the common stock, par value $.01
      per share, of the Company and any other securities into which or for which
      such common stock has been converted or exchanged pursuant to a plan of
      recapitalization, reorganization, merger, sale of assets, or otherwise.

            (b)   "Closing Date" shall mean the date on which the initial
      public offering of the Company's Common Stock closes.

            (c)   "Effective Date" shall mean the date on which the SEC
      declares the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1 relating to the
      initial public offering of shares of the Common Stock effective.

            (d)   "Exchange Act" shall mean the Securities Exchange Act of
      1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

            (e)   "Form S-3" means such form of registration statement under
      the Securities Act on the date hereof or any registration form under
      the Securities Act



<PAGE> 2
      subsequently adopted by the SEC that permits the inclusion or
      incorporation of substantial information by reference to other
      documents filed by the Company with the SEC.

            (f)   "Holder" means General American or Holding Company, so long
      as it holds any Registrable Securities, and any direct or indirect
      subsidiary of General American or Holding Company, any direct or
      indirect parent corporation of General American or Holding Company,
      or any direct or indirect subsidiary of any such parent corporation
      owning Registrable Securities who is a permitted assignee of rights
      under Section 12 of this Agreement.

            (g)   The terms "register," "registered," and "registration,"
      refer to a registration effected by the preparation and filing of a
      Registration Statement in compliance with the Securities Act, and the
      declaration or ordering of effectiveness of such Registration
      Statement by the SEC.

            (h)   "Registrable Securities" shall mean the 6,710,000 shares of
      Common Stock beneficially owned by General American prior to the
      Closing Date or owned by any subsequent Holder or Holders, and, in
      each case, all shares of Common Stock issued as (or issuable upon the
      conversion or exercise of any warrant, right or other security which
      is issued as) a dividend or other distribution with respect to, in
      exchange for, or in replacement of such shares of Common Stock.  The
      term "Registrable Securities" excludes, however, any security (i) the
      sale of which had been effectively registered under the Securities
      Act and which had been disposed of in accordance with a Registration
      Statement, (ii) that has been sold by a Holder in a transaction
      exempt from the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of
      the Securities Act under Section 4(1) thereof (including, without
      limitation, transactions pursuant to Rules 144 and 144A) such that
      the further disposition of such securities by the transferee or
      assignee is not restricted under the Securities Act, (iii) that have
      been sold by a Holder in a transaction in which such Holder's rights
      under this Agreement are not, or cannot be, assigned, or (iv) for
      which the registration rights provided under this Agreement have
      expired pursuant to Section 16 of this Agreement.

            (i)   "Registration Expenses" shall mean (i) registration,
      qualification and filing fees; (ii) fees and expenses of compliance
      with state securities or blue sky laws (including reasonable fees and
      disbursements of counsel in connection with blue sky qualification of
      any Registrable Securities being registered); (iii) printing
      expenses; (iv) internal expenses (including, without limitation, all
      salaries and expenses of officers and employees performing legal or
      accounting duties); (v) fees and disbursements of counsel for the
      Company and customary fees and expenses for independent certified
      public accountants retained by the Company (including the expenses of
      any comfort letters or costs associated with the delivery by
      independent certified public accountants of comfort letters
      customarily requested by underwriters); (vi) fees and expenses of
      listing any Registrable Securities on any securities exchange on
      which the Common Stock is then listed; and (vii) fees and
      disbursements of underwriters customarily paid by issuers or


                                    2
<PAGE> 3
      sellers of securities, but excluding any underwriting fees, discounts
      or commissions attributable to the sale of any Registrable Securities
      and any fees and expenses of underwriters' counsel (other than as
      provided in clause (ii) above).

            (j)   "Registration Statement" shall mean any registration
      statement or similar document that covers any of the Registrable
      Securities pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement, including
      the prospectus or preliminary prospectus included therein, all
      amendments and supplements to such Registrable Statement, including
      post-effective amendments, all exhibits to such Registration
      Statement, and all material incorporated by reference in such
      Registration Statement.

            (k)   "Rule 144" shall mean Rule 144 promulgated under the
      Securities Act or any successor rule thereto.

            (l)   "Rule 144A" shall mean Rule 144A promulgated under the
      Securities Act or any successor rule thereto.

            (m)   "SEC" shall mean the Securities and Exchange Commission.

            (n)   "Securities Act" shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as
      amended, and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

      2.    Demand Registration.
            -------------------

            (a)   If the Company shall receive at any time on or after the
      first anniversary of the Effective Date, a written request, in the
      manner provided in Section 19, from the Holders of Registrable
      Securities representing at least ten percent (10%) of the Common
      Stock then outstanding that the Company file a registration statement
      under the Securities Act covering the registration of any or all of
      such Holders' Registrable Securities, then the Company shall (i)
      within 10 days of the receipt thereof, give written notice, in the
      manner provided in Section 19, of such request to all Holders of
      outstanding Registrable Securities known to the Company, and (ii)
      subject to the limitations contained in this Section 2, use its
      reasonable best efforts to effect, as soon as practicable and in any
      event within 120 days of the receipt of such request, the
      registration under the Securities Act of all Registrable Securities
      for which the Company receives a request from the Holders thereof in
      the manner provided in Section 19, within 20 days of the mailing of
      such notice by the Company.  The Company, however, shall not be
      required to effect a registration pursuant to this Section 2 unless
      the aggregate number of shares requested to be registered represents
      at least ten percent (10%) of the Common Stock then outstanding.

            (b)   If the Holder(s) initiating the registration request
      hereunder (collectively, the "Initiating Holder") intends to
      distribute the Registrable Securities covered by its request by means
      of an underwriting, it shall so advise the Company as a part of its
      request made pursuant to Section 2(a) and the Company shall include
      such information in the written notice to the Holders referred to in
      Section 2(a).  In such event,


                                    3
<PAGE> 4
      the right of any Holder to include its Registrable Securities in such
      registration shall be conditioned upon such Holder's participation in
      such underwriting and the inclusion of such Holder's Registrable
      Securities in the underwriting to the extent provided herein.  All
      Holders proposing to sell securities through such underwriting
      (together with the Company as provided in Section 5(g) of this
      Agreement and any other holder of shares of Common Stock permitted to
      participate in such registration pursuant to this Section 2(b)) shall
      enter into an underwriting agreement in customary form with the
      underwriter or underwriters selected for such underwriting by the
      Initiating Holder (provided the same are underwriters of recognized
      national standing reasonably acceptable to the Company), upon the
      terms and conditions agreed upon between the Company and such
      underwriter(s).  Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section
      2, if the underwriter(s) advise the Initiating Holder in writing that
      marketing or other factors require a limitation of the number of
      Registrable Securities to be underwritten, then the Company shall so
      advise Holders of Registrable Securities that would otherwise be
      underwritten pursuant hereto, and the number of Registrable
      Securities that may be included in the underwriting shall be
      allocated among all Holders thereof, including the Initiating Holder,
      in proportion (as nearly as practicable) to the number of Registrable
      Securities which each Holder requested be included in such
      registration.  If the number of Registrable Securities to be
      underwritten has not been so limited, the Company may include shares
      of Common Stock for its own account (or for the account of other
      shareholders) in such registration if the underwriter(s) so agree and
      to the extent that, in the opinion of such underwriter(s), the
      inclusion of such additional shares will not adversely affect the
      offering of the Registrable Securities included in such registration.

            (c)   The Company shall not be obligated to effect a total of more
      than two registrations pursuant to this Section 2, Section 4 and
      Section 3 (provided, with respect to registrations under Section 3,
      that the Holder was able to dispose of at least 80% of the
      Registrable Securities it requested be registered) and shall not be
      obligated to effect more than one registration in any twelve-month
      period pursuant to this Section 2 or Section 4.

            (d)   A registration effected pursuant to this Section 2, if
      effected by the Company on Form S-3, shall be counted as a Form S-3
      registration effected pursuant to Section 4.

      3.    Incidental Registration.
            -----------------------

            (a)   After the Effective Date, if (but without any obligation to
      do so) the Company proposes to register (excluding a registration
      effected by the Company for shareholders other than the Holders,
      except in the case of a firm commitment underwriting) any shares of
      Common Stock under the Securities Act in connection with the public
      offering of such shares solely for cash on any form of Registration
      Statement in which the inclusion of Registrable Securities is
      appropriate (other than a registration (i)


                                    4
<PAGE> 5
      relating solely to the sale of securities to participants in a
      Company stock plan, (ii) pursuant to a Registration Statement on Form
      S-4 or Form S-8 (or any successor forms) or any form that does not
      include substantially the same information, other than information
      relating to the selling shareholders or their plan of distribution,
      as would be required to be included in a registration statement
      covering the sale of Registrable Securities, (iii) in connection with
      any dividend reinvestment or similar plan, or (iv) for the sole
      purpose of offering securities to another entity or its
      securityholders in connection with the acquisition of assets or
      securities of such entity or any similar transaction), the Company
      shall promptly give each Holder written notice of such registration
      in the manner provided in Section 19 at least 20 days before the
      anticipated filing date of any such Registration Statement.  Upon the
      written request of any Holder given in the manner provided in Section
      19 within 10 days after the mailing of such notice by the Company,
      the Company shall, subject to the provisions of Section 8 hereof,
      cause to be registered under the Securities Act all of the
      Registrable Securities that such Holder has so requested to be
      registered.  The Company shall not be required to proceed with, or
      maintain the effectiveness of, any registration of its securities
      after giving the notice herein provided, and the right of any Holder
      to have Registrable Securities included in such Registration
      Statement shall be conditioned upon participation in any underwriting
      to the extent provided herein.  The Company shall not be required to
      include any Registrable Securities in such underwriting unless the
      Holders thereof enter into an underwriting agreement in customary
      form, and upon terms and conditions agreed upon between the Company
      and the underwriter(s) (except as to monetary obligations of the
      Holders not contemplated by Section 7 of this Agreement), with the
      underwriter(s) selected by the Company.  In the event that the
      underwriter(s) shall advise the Company that marketing or other
      factors require a limitation of the number of shares to be
      underwritten, then the Company shall so advise all Holders of
      Registrable Securities that would otherwise be underwritten pursuant
      hereto.  The underwriter(s) may exclude some or all of the
      Registrable Securities from such underwriting and the number of
      Registrable Securities, if any, that may be included in the
      underwriting shall be allocated among all Holders thereof in
      proportion (as nearly as practicable) to the number of Registrable
      Securities which each Holder requested be included in such
      registration.  Nothing in this Section 3 is intended to diminish the
      number of securities to be included by the Company in such
      underwriting.  The Company and the underwriter(s) selected by the
      Company shall make all determinations with respect to the timing,
      pricing, and other matters related to the offering.

            (b)   A registration effected pursuant to this Section 3 shall be
      counted as a Form S-3 registration under Section 4 if the Holder was
      able to dispose of at least 80% of the Registrable Securities it
      requested be registered.

      4.    Form S-3 Registration.
            ---------------------

            (a)   In case, after the first anniversary of the
      Effective Date, the Company shall receive from any Holder(s) of
      Registrable Securities representing at least ten percent (10%) of the
      Common Stock then outstanding a written request or requests


                                    5
<PAGE> 6
      that the Company effect a registration on Form S-3 and any related
      qualifications or compliance with respect to any or all such
      Registrable Securities owned by such Holder(s), the Company shall (i)
      promptly give written notice of the proposed registration, and any
      related qualification or compliance, to all other Holders of
      Registrable Securities in the manner provided in Section 19, and (ii)
      as soon as practicable, and, subject to the further provisions of
      this Section 4, in any event within 90 days of the initial request,
      effect such registration and all such qualifications and compliances
      as may be so requested and as would permit or facilitate the sale and
      distribution of all of the Registrable Securities specified in such
      request, together with all of the Registrable Securities of any other
      Holder or Holders as are specified in a request given in the manner
      provided in Section 19 within 15 days after mailing of such notice by
      the Company.

            (b)   The Company shall not be obligated to effect any
      registration, qualification or compliance pursuant to this Section 4
      if (i) Form S-3 is not available for such offering by the requesting
      Holder(s) or (ii) the Holders, together with the holders of any other
      securities of the Company entitled to inclusion in such registration,
      propose to sell Registrable Securities and such other securities, if
      any, at an aggregate price to the public (net of any underwriters'
      discounts or commissions) of less than $5,000,000.

            (c)   The Company shall not be obligated to effect more than a
      total of two registrations pursuant to this Section 4 and shall not
      be obligated to effect more than one registration in any twelve-month
      period pursuant to this Section 4, Section 2 and Section 3 (provided,
      with respect to registrations under Section 3, that the Holder was
      able to dispose of at least 80% of the Registrable Securities it
      requested be registered).

            (d)   A registration effected pursuant to this Section 4 shall be
      counted as a demand registration effected pursuant to Section 2.

      5.    Registration Procedure.   Whenever required under this
            ----------------------
Agreement to effect the registration of any Registrable Securities, the
Company shall, as expeditiously as reasonable practicable:

            (a)   Prepare and file with the SEC a new Registration Statement
      with respect to such Registrable Securities and use its reasonable
      best efforts to cause such registration statement to become
      effective, and keep such Registration Statement effective for up to
      90 days or such shorter period as shall be required to sell all of
      the Registrable Securities covered by such Registration Statement
      (except as provided in Section 3); provided, however, that if such
      Registration Statement is on Form S-3 and related to a distribution
      by the Holders on a delayed or continuous basis other than by means
      of an underwriting, the Company shall keep such Registration
      Statement effective for one year following the initial date of
      effectiveness thereof; provided further that no Registration
      Statement need remain in effect after all Registrable Securities
      covered thereby have been sold.


                                    6
<PAGE> 7

            (b)   Prepare and file with the SEC such amendments and
      supplements to such Registration Statement and the prospectus used in
      connection with such Registration Statement as may be necessary to
      comply with the provisions of the Securities Act with respect to the
      disposition of all securities covered by such Registration Statement.

            (c)   Furnish to the Holders of Registrable Securities to be
      registered, without charge, such number of copies of a prospectus,
      including a preliminary prospectus, and any amendment or supplement
      thereto as they may reasonably request and a reasonable number of
      copies of the then-effective Registration Statement and any
      post-effective amendment thereto, including financial statements and
      schedules, all documents incorporated therein by reference and all
      exhibits (including those incorporated by reference).

            (d)   Promptly after the filing of any document that is to be
      incorporated by reference into a Registration Statement or
      prospectus, provide copies of such document to the Holders of
      Registrable Securities covered thereby and any underwriter.

            (e)   Use its reasonable best efforts to register and qualify the
      securities covered by such Registration Statement under such other
      securities or blue sky laws of such jurisdictions as shall be
      reasonably requested by the Holders; provided, however, that the
      Company shall not be required to qualify to do business or to file a
      general consent to service of process in any such states or
      jurisdictions where it would not otherwise be required to so qualify
      to do business or consent to service of process or subject itself to
      taxation in any such jurisdiction.

            (f)   Cooperate with the Holders of Registrable Securities and
      each underwriter participating in the disposition of such Registrable
      Securities and their respective counsel in connection with any
      filings required to be made with the National Association of
      Securities Dealers, Inc.

            (g)   In the event of any underwritten public offering, enter into
      and perform its obligations under an underwriting agreement, in usual
      and customary form, with the underwriter(s) of such offering, with
      such terms and conditions as the Company and the underwriter(s) may
      agree.  Each Holder participating in such underwriting shall also
      enter into and perform its obligations under such an agreement.

            (h)   Notify each Holder of Registrable Securities covered by such
      Registration Statement, at any time when a prospectus relating
      thereto is required to be delivered under the Securities Act, of the
      happening of any event as a result of which the prospectus included
      in such Registration Statement, as then in effect, includes an untrue
      statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact
      required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements
      therein not misleading in the light of the circumstances then
      existing.


                                    7
<PAGE> 8

            (i)   Cause all Registrable Securities covered by the Registration
      Statement to be listed on each securities exchange or automated
      quotation system on which shares of the Company's Common Stock are
      then listed.  If any of such shares are not so listed, the Company
      shall cause such shares to be listed on such securities exchange or
      automated quotation system as may be reasonably requested by the
      Holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities being registered.

            (j)   In the case of an underwritten public offering, furnish, at
      the request of any Holder requesting registration pursuant to this
      Agreement, on the date that such Registrable Securities are delivered
      to the underwriters for sale in connection with a registration
      pursuant to this Agreement, (A) an opinion of counsel representing the
      Company for the purposes of such registration, and (B) a letter from
      independent certified public accountants of the Company, in each case
      to be dated such date and to be in form and substance as is
      customarily given by counsel or independent certified public
      accountants, as the case may be, to underwriters in an underwritten
      public offering, addressed to the underwriters.

            (k)   Permit a representative of any Holder of Registrable
      Securities, any underwriter participating in any disposition pursuant
      to such registration, and any attorney or accountant retained by such
      Holder or underwriter, to participate, at each person's own expense,
      in the preparation of the Registration Statement, and cause the
      Company's officers, directors and employees to supply all information
      reasonably requested by any such representative, underwriter,
      attorney or accountant in connection with such registration;
      provided, however, that, if requested by the Company, such
      representatives, underwriters, attorneys or accountants enter into a
      confidentiality agreement, in form and substance reasonably
      satisfactory to the Company, prior to the release or disclosure of
      any such information.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company may delay, suspend or withdraw any
registration or qualification of Registrable Securities required pursuant to
this Agreement for a period not exceeding 120 days if the Company shall in
good faith determine that any such registration would adversely affect a
public or private offering or contemplated offering of any securities of the
Company or any other anticipated or contemplated material corporate event.
In addition, the Company shall not be required to register Registrable
Securities within twelve months after the effective date of a Registration
Statement referred to in Section 3 pursuant to which the Holders were
afforded the opportunity to register Registrable Securities.

      6.    Holder's Obligation to Furnish Information.   It shall be a
            ------------------------------------------
condition precedent to the obligations of the Company to take any action
pursuant to this Agreement with respect to any Registrable Securities that
the Holder of such securities furnish to the Company such information
regarding itself, the Registrable Securities held by it, and the intended
method of disposition of such securities as shall be required to effect the
registration of such Holder's Registrable Securities.


                                    8
<PAGE> 9

      Each Holder agrees that, upon receipt of any notice from the Company,
such Holder will forthwith discontinue disposition of Registrable Securities
pursuant to the then current prospectus until (i) such Holder is advised in
writing by the Company that a new Registration Statement covering the reoffer
of Registrable Securities has become effective under the Securities Act or
(ii) such Holder receives copies of a supplemental or amended prospectus
contemplated by Section 5 hereof, or until such Holder is advised in writing
by the Company that the use of the prospectus may be resumed.  The Company
shall use its reasonable best efforts to limit the duration of any
discontinuance of disposition of Registrable Securities pursuant to this
paragraph.

      7.    Registration Expenses.
            ---------------------

            (a)   In the case of any demand registration pursuant to Section 2
      and any registration on Form S-3 pursuant to Section 4, the Company
      shall pay all Registration Expenses; provided, however, that the
      Company shall not be required to pay for any expenses of any
      registration proceeding begun pursuant to Section 2 or Section 4 if
      the registration request is subsequently withdrawn at the request of
      the Holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities to be
      registered (in which case all participating Holders shall bear such
      expenses), unless the Holders of a majority of Registrable Securities
      to be registered agree to forfeit their right to one demand
      registration pursuant to Section 2 or Section 4, as the case may be;
      provided further, however, that if at the time of such withdrawal,
      the Holders have learned of a material adverse change in the
      condition, business, or prospects of the Company from that known to
      the Holders at the time of their request, then the Holders shall not
      be required to pay any of such expenses and shall retain their rights
      pursuant to Section 2 or Section 4, as the case may be.

            (b)   In the case of any incidental registration pursuant to
      Section 3, the requesting Holders shall bear any incremental
      Registration Expenses, including, without limitation, incremental
      registration and qualification fees and expenses (including
      underwriter's fees, discounts and commissions), and any incremental
      costs and disbursements (including legal fees and expenses) that
      result from the inclusion of the Registrable Securities included in
      such registration, with such incremental expenses being borne by the
      requesting Holders on a pro rata basis.

      8.    Effectiveness of Registration.   A registration requested
            -----------------------------
pursuant to Section 2 or Section 4 will not be deemed to have been effected
if (i) the registration statement has not been kept effective for the period
required under Section 5(a) of this Agreement, (ii) the offering of
Registrable Securities pursuant to such registration is interfered with by
any stop order, injunction or other order or requirement of the SEC or other
governmental agency or court, or (iii) the conditions to the closing of any
such registration that is underwritten are not satisfied.

      9.    Delay of Registration.   No Holder shall have any right to
            ---------------------
obtain or seek an injunction restraining or otherwise delaying any
registration of the Company's securities as the result of any controversy
that might arise with respect to the interpretation or implementation of this
Agreement.


                                    9
<PAGE> 10

      10.   Indemnification and Contribution.   In the event any
            --------------------------------
Registrable Securities are included in a Registration Statement pursuant to
this Agreement:

            (a)   The Company will indemnify and hold harmless each Holder,
      its directors, officers and employees and each person, if any, who
      "controls" such Holder (within the meaning of the Securities Act)
      against all losses, claims, damages, or liabilities, joint or
      several, or actions in respect thereof to which such Holder or other
      person entitled to indemnification hereunder may become subject under
      the Securities Act, or otherwise, insofar as such loss, claims,
      damages, liabilities or actions in respect thereof arise out of, or
      are based upon, any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of
      any material fact contained in such Registration Statement, any
      related preliminary prospectus, or any related prospectus or any
      amendment or supplement thereto, or arise out of, or are based upon,
      the omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact
      required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements
      therein not misleading, and will reimburse such Holder or other
      person entitled to indemnification hereunder for any legal or other
      expenses reasonably incurred by it in connection with investigating
      or defending any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action;
      provided, however, that the Company will not be so liable to the
      extent that any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises
      out of, or is based upon, an untrue statement or alleged untrue
      statement of a material fact or an omission or alleged omission to
      state a material fact in such Registration Statement, such
      preliminary prospectus, or such prospectus, or any such amendment or
      supplement thereto in reliance upon, and in conformity with, written
      information furnished to the Company by or on behalf of a Holder or
      an underwriter specifically for use therein; and provided further
      that the Company will not be liable, and this indemnification
      agreement shall not apply, in any such case to the extent that any
      such loss, claim, damage, liability or action is solely attributable
      to the failure of such Holder (or underwriter or agent acting on its
      behalf) to deliver a final prospectus (or amendment or supplement
      thereto) that corrects a material misstatement or omission contained
      in the preliminary prospectus (or final prospectus).  The Company
      will also indemnify underwriters, selling brokers, dealer managers
      and similar securities industry professionals participating in the
      distribution, their officers and directors and each person who
      "controls" such persons (within the meaning of the Securities Act) to
      the same extent as provided above with respect to the indemnification
      of the Holders, if so requested, except with respect to information
      furnished in writing specifically for use in any prospectus or
      Registration Statement by any selling Holders or any such
      underwriters.

            (b)   With respect to written information furnished  to the
      Company by or on behalf of a Holder specifically for use in a
      Registration Statement, any related preliminary prospectus, or any
      related prospectus or any supplement or amendment thereto, such
      Holder will severally indemnify and hold harmless the Company, and
      its directors, officers and employees and each person, if any, who
      "controls" the Company (within the meaning of the Securities Act)
      against any losses, claims, damages or liabilities, joint or several,
      or actions in respect thereof, to which the Company or such other
      person entitled to indemnification hereunder may become subject under
      the Securities Act, or otherwise, insofar as such losses, claims,
      damages, liabilities or actions


                                    10
<PAGE> 11
      in respect thereof arise out of, or are based upon, any untrue
      statement or alleged untrue statement of any material fact contained
      in such Registration Statement, such preliminary prospectus, or such
      prospectus, or any such amendment or supplement thereto, or arise out
      of, or are based upon, the omission or alleged omission to state
      therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to
      make the statements therein not misleading; and such Holder will
      reimburse the Company and such other persons for any legal or other
      expenses reasonably incurred by them in connection with investigating
      or defending any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action, in
      each case to the extent, but only to the extent, that the same arises
      out of, or is based upon, an untrue statement or alleged untrue
      statement of a material fact or an omission or alleged omission to
      state a material fact in such Registration Statement, such
      preliminary prospectus, or such prospectus or any such amendment or
      supplement thereto in reliance upon, and in conformity with, such
      written information.  The Company shall be entitled to receive
      indemnities from underwriters, selling brokers, dealer managers and
      similar securities industry professionals participating in the
      distribution, to the same extent as provided above with respect to
      the information so furnished in writing by such persons specifically
      for inclusion in any prospectus or Registration Statement.  The
      Holder will also indemnify underwriters, selling brokers, dealer
      managers and similar securities industry professionals participating
      in the distribution, their officers and directors and each person who
      "controls" such persons (within the meaning of the Securities Act) to
      the same extent as provided above with respect to the indemnification
      of the Company, if so requested.

            (c)   Promptly after receipt by an indemnified party of notice of
      any claim or the commencement of any action, the indemnified party
      will, if a claim in respect thereof is to be made against the
      indemnifying party, notify the indemnifying party in writing of the
      claim or the commencement of that action; provided, however, that the
      failure to notify the indemnifying party will not relieve it from any
      liability that it may have to the indemnified party except to the
      extent it was actually damaged or suffered any loss or incurred any
      additional expense as a result thereof.  If any such claim or action
      is brought against an indemnified party, and it notified the
      indemnifying party thereof, the indemnifying party will be entitled
      to assume the defense thereof with counsel selected by the
      indemnifying party and reasonably satisfactory to the indemnified
      party.  After notice from the indemnifying party to the indemnified
      party of its election to assume the defense of such claim or action,
      (i) the indemnifying party will not be liable to the indemnified
      party for any legal or other expense subsequently incurred by the
      indemnified party in connection with the defense thereof, (ii) the
      indemnifying party will not be liable for the costs and expenses of
      any settlement of such claim or action unless such settlement was
      effected with the written consent of the indemnifying party or the
      indemnified party waived any rights to indemnification hereunder in
      writing, in which case the indemnified party may effect a settlement
      without such consent, and (iii) the indemnified party will be
      obligated to cooperate with the indemnifying party in the
      investigation of such claim or action; provided, however, that the
      Holders and their respective controlling persons who may be subject
      to liability arising out of any claim in respect of which indemnity
      may be sought by such Holders against the Company may employ their
      own counsel if they have been advised by counsel in writing that, in
      the


                                    11
<PAGE> 12
      reasonable judgment of such counsel, it is advisable for such Holders
      and their controlling persons to be represented by separate counsel
      due to the presence of conflicts of interest, and in that event the
      fees and expenses of such separate counsel will also be paid by the
      Company; provided that the Company shall not be liable for the
      reasonable fees and expenses of more than one separate counsel at any
      time for all such indemnified parties.  An indemnifying party shall
      not, without the prior written consent of the indemnified parties,
      settle, compromise or consent to the entry of any judgment with
      respect to any pending or threatened claim, action, suit or
      proceeding in respect of which indemnification or contribution may be
      sought hereunder (whether or not the indemnified parties are actual
      or potential parties to such claim or action) unless such settlement,
      compromise or consent includes a release of such indemnified party
      reasonably acceptable to such indemnified party from all liability
      arising out of such claim, action, suit or proceeding or unless the
      indemnifying party shall confirm in a written agreement reasonably
      acceptable to such indemnified party, that notwithstanding any
      federal, state or common law, such settlement, compromise or consent
      shall not adversely affect the right of any indemnified party to
      indemnification or contribution as provided in this Agreement.

            (d)   If for any reason the indemnification provided for in
      Sections 10(a) or (b) is unavailable to an indemnified party or is
      insufficient to hold it harmless as contemplated therein, then the
      indemnifying party shall contribute to the amount paid or payable by
      the indemnified party as a result of such loss, claim, damage or
      liability in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only
      the relative benefits received by the indemnifying and the
      indemnified party, but also the relative fault of the indemnifying
      party and the indemnified party, as well as any other relevant
      equitable considerations.  No person guilty of fraudulent
      misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the
      Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person who
      was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

            (e)   The obligations under this Section 10 shall survive the
      completion of any offering of Registrable Securities in a
      Registration Statement pursuant to this Agreement, and otherwise.

      11.   Reports Under Exchange Act.   With a view to making available
            --------------------------
to the Holders the benefits of Rule 144 and any other rule or regulation of
the SEC that may at any time permit a Holder to sell securities of the
Company to the public without registration or pursuant to registration on
Form S-3, the Company agrees to:

            (a)   Make and keep public information available, as those terms
      are understood and defined in Rule 144, at all times after 90 days
      after the Effective Date;

            (b)   Take such action, including the voluntary registration of
      its Common Stock under Section 4 of the Exchange Act, as is necessary
      to enable the Holders to utilize Form S-3 for the sale of their
      Registrable Securities, such action to be taken as soon as
      practicable after the end of the fiscal year in which the first
      Registration


                                    12
<PAGE> 13
      Statement filed by the Company for the offering of its securities to
      the general public is declared effective;

            (c)   File with the SEC in a timely manner all reports and other
      documents required of the Company under the Securities Act and the
      Exchange Act; and

            (d)   Furnish to any Holder, so long as the Holder owns any
      Registrable Securities, upon request (i) a written statement by the
      Company as to its compliance with the reporting requirements of Rule
      144 (at any time after 90 days after the Effective Date), the
      Securities Act and the Exchange Act (at any time after it has become
      subject to such reporting requirements), or as to its qualification
      that it qualifies as a registrant whose securities may be resold
      pursuant to Form S-3 (at any time after it so qualifies), (ii) a copy
      of the most recent annual or quarterly report of the Company and such
      other reports and documents so filed by the Company, and (iii) such
      other information as may be reasonably requested in availing any
      Holder of any rule or regulation of the SEC which permits the selling
      of any such securities without registration or pursuant to such form.

      12.   Assignment of Registration Rights.
            ---------------------------------

            (a)   The rights to cause the Company to register Registrable
      Securities pursuant to this Agreement may be assigned by General
      American or Holding Company to a direct or indirect subsidiary of
      General American or Holding Company or any direct or indirect parent
      of General American or Holding Company or any other direct or
      indirect subsidiary of any such parent entity (each, a "Permitted
      Assign"); provided, however, that (i) the Company is, promptly upon
      such transfer, furnished with written notice of the name and address
      of such transferee or assignee and the securities with respect to
      which such registration rights are being assigned, (ii) the transfer
      of such securities may be effected in accordance with all applicable
      securities law, (iii) immediately following such transfer the further
      disposition of such securities by the transferee or assignee is
      restricted under the Securities Act, and (iv) the transferee executes
      and agrees to be bound by this Agreement, an executed counterpart of
      which shall be furnished to the Company.

            (b)   Except in connection with a transfer permitted under Section
      12(a) above, in no event may the rights of Holders hereunder be
      transferred or assigned, it being intended that the rights of General
      American and Holding Company under this Agreement may be exercised
      only by General American or Holding Company or a Permitted Assign,
      subject to the provisions and restrictions of Section 12(a) above.

      13.   Limitations on Subsequent Registration Rights.  From and
            ---------------------------------------------
after the date of this Agreement, except as otherwise contemplated by the
Series  A Purchase Notice dated May 12, 1997 and the Series B Call Notice
dated March 23, 1997, the Company shall not, without the prior written
consent of the Holders of a majority of the outstanding Registrable


                                    13
<PAGE> 14
Securities, enter into any agreement with any holder or prospective holder of
any securities of the Company which would allow such holder or prospective
holder to (i) include such securities in any registration filed under Section
2, 3 or 4 hereof, or (ii) require the Company to effect a registration,
unless under the terms of such agreement, such holder or prospective holder
may include such securities in any such registration only to the extent that
the inclusion of such holder's securities will not reduce the amount of the
Registrable Securities included in such registration and such agreement
includes the equivalent of Section 15 as a term.

      14.   Amendment of Registration Rights.  Any provision of this
            --------------------------------
Agreement may be amended or the observance thereof may be waived (either
generally or in a particular instance and either retroactively or
prospectively), only with the written consent of the Company and the holders
of a majority of Registrable Securities then outstanding.  Any amendment or
waiver effected in accordance with this Section shall be binding upon each
Holder of any Registrable Securities, each future Holder of such securities
and the Company.

      15.   "Market Stand-Off" Agreement.  Any Holder, if requested by
            ----------------------------
the Company or an underwriter of an underwritten public offering, agrees not
to sell, make any short sale of, loan, grant any option for the purchase of,
or otherwise transfer or dispose of any Common Stock held by such Holder
(other than Registrable Securities included in the registration) without the
prior written consent of the Company or such underwriter(s), as the case may
be, during a period of up to seven days prior to and 180 days following the
effective date of any underwritten registration of the Company's securities
effected pursuant to Section 2, 3 or 4 hereof.  Such agreement shall be in
writing in form satisfactory to the Company and such underwriter, and may be
included in the underwriting agreement.  The Company may impose stop-transfer
instructions with respect to the securities subject to the foregoing
restriction until the end of the required stand-off period.

      16.   Termination of Registration Rights.  If the number of shares
            ----------------------------------
of Registrable Securities owned by a Holder represents less than one percent
(1%) of the total number of shares of Common Stock then outstanding, then
such Holder's registration rights under this Agreement relating to such
Registrable Securities shall terminate on the date such Holder is able to
dispose of all of its shares of Registrable Securities in any 90-day period
pursuant of Rule 144.  All registration rights (except for rights previously
exercised in connection with an underwritten public offering pursuant to
Section 3) of a Holder under this Agreement shall terminate on the date on
which all of such Holder's shares of Registrable Securities can be sold
pursuant to Rule 144(k).

      17.   Effective Date of Agreement.  This Agreement shall become
            ---------------------------
effective June 12, 1997.

      18.   Information Confidential.  No Holder may use any confidential
            ------------------------
information received by it pursuant to this Agreement in violation of the
Exchange Act or reproduce, disclose, or disseminate such information to any
other person (other than its employees or agents having a need to know the
contents of such information and its attorneys), except to the extent
reasonably related to the exercise of rights under this Agreement, unless
such


                                    14
<PAGE> 15
information has been made available to the public generally (other than by
such recipient in violation of this Section 18) or such recipient is required
to disclose such information by a governmental body or regulatory agency or
by law in connection with a transaction that is not otherwise prohibited
hereby.

      19.   Notices.  All notices and other communications provided for or
            -------
permitted hereunder shall be made in writing by hand-delivery, registered
first-class mail, or air-courier guaranteeing overnight delivery:

            (a)   If to a Holder of Registrable Securities, initially one copy
      each to the Chief Executive Officer and General Counsel at 700 Market
      Street, St. Louis, Missouri 63101, Attention: Matthew P. McCauley
      (facsimile:  (314) 444-0510), and thereafter at such other address as
      may be designated from time to time by notice given in the manner
      provided in this Section 19.

            (b)   If to the Company, initially at 700 Market Street, St.
      Louis, Missouri 63101, Attention: Fred M. Schpero (facsimile:  (314)
      444-0676), and thereafter at such other address as may be designated
      from time to time by notice given in the manner provided in this
      Section 19.

            (c)   All such notices and other communications shall be deemed to
      have been delivered and received (i) in the case of personal
      delivery, telex, telecopier or telegram, on the date of such
      delivery, (ii) in the case of air courier, on the business day after
      the date when sent and (iii) in the case of mailing, on the third
      business day following such mailing.

            (d)   From time to time as the Company may request, each Holder
      shall provide to the Company such evidence or documentation
      reasonably satisfactory to the Company, in its sole discretion,
      certified by an appropriate officer of such Holder, regarding the
      number of shares of Common Stock beneficially owned by such Holder
      and its status as an "affiliate" under the Securities Act.

      20.   Successors and Assigns.  Subject to the provisions of Section
            ----------------------
12 hereof, this Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and be binding upon
the successors and permitted assigns of each of the parties.

      21.   Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed in any number of
            ------------
counterparts and by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of
which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original and all of which
taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.

      22.   Headings.  The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of
            --------
reference only and shall not limit or otherwise affect the meaning hereof.

      23.   Governing Law.  This Agreement shall be governed by and
            -------------
constructed in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Missouri.


                                    15
<PAGE> 16

      24.   Severability.  In the event that any one or more of the
            ------------
provisions contained herein, or the application thereof in any circumstance,
is held invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and
enforceability of any such provision in every other respect and of the
remaining provisions contained herein shall not be affected or impaired
thereby.

      25.   Entire Agreement.  This Agreement is intended by the parties as
            ----------------
a final expression of their agreement and intended to be a complete and
exclusive statement of the agreement and understanding of the parties hereto
in respect of the subject matter contained herein.  This Agreement supersedes
all prior agreements and understandings between the parties with respect to
such subject matter.


                                    16
<PAGE> 17
      IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Registration
Rights Agreement as of the date first written above.


                              CONNING CORPORATION



                              By: /s/ Leonard M. Rubenstein
                                 ---------------------------------------
                                 Name: Leonard M. Rubenstein
                                 Title: Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

                              GENERAL AMERICAN LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY



                              By: /s/ Richard A. Liddy
                                 ---------------------------------------
                                 Name: Richard A. Liddy
                                 Title: Chairman, President and Chief
                                         Executive Officer

                              GENERAL AMERICAN HOLDING COMPANY



                              By: /s/ Richard A. Liddy
                                 ---------------------------------------
                                 Name: Richard A. Liddy
                                 Title: President




                                    17


<PAGE> 1

                      EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
                      --------------------

          THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT is made and entered into as
of August 11, 1995 by and between General American Life Insurance
Company, a Missouri mutual life insurance company (the
"Company"), and Leonard M. Rubenstein ("Employee").

          WHEREAS, the Company indirectly controls Conning Asset
Management Company, a Missouri corporation ("CAM"), which in turn
controls General American Investment Management Company, a
Missouri corporation ("GAIMCO"), Conning Corp., a Delaware
corporation ("Conning Corp."), and Conning & Company, a
Connecticut corporation ("Conning").

          WHEREAS, Employee possesses skills and experience which
Company believes are of value to the success of Company's and its
Affiliates' (as hereinafter defined) business operations;

          WHEREAS, Company wishes to employ Employee subject to
the terms and conditions of this Agreement, and Employee wishes
to accept such employment subject to the terms and conditions of
this Agreement;

          WHEREAS, the Company and its Affiliates are in the
business of rendering investment advice, with a special expertise
in advising insurance companies in the United States, and have
accumulated valuable, confidential information including trade
secrets and know-how relating to portfolio construction and
management, technology, formulas, marketing plans, business
strategies, and other business records; and

          WHEREAS, the giving of the covenants contained herein
is a condition precedent to the employment of Employee, and
Employee acknowledges that the execution of this Agreement and
the entering into of these covenants is an express condition of
his or her employment and that said covenants are given in
consideration for such employment and the other benefits
conferred upon him by this Agreement.

          NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual
promises, covenants, and agreements herein set forth, the parties
hereto agree as follows:

          1.   Employment and Duties.  Company hereby agrees to
               ---------------------
employ Employee to provide services to GAIMCO, CAM and Conning
and Employee agrees to enter the employ of the Company for the
Term herein specified.  During the Term, Employee shall serve as
and shall be employed as the Chairman and CEO of CAM and as the
President of GAIMCO and shall perform such duties as the Board of
Directors or officers of Company may reasonably assign to
Employee, and shall devote his or her full time, attention, and
effort to the business and affairs of GAIMCO, CAM and Conning.


<PAGE> 2

          2.   Term.  The term of this Agreement shall be for the
               ----
period commencing on date hereof and ending three years after the
date hereof (the "Term"), unless terminated prior thereto as
provided in Section 4.

          3.   Compensation and Benefits.
               -------------------------

               a.   In consideration of his or her services,
Employee shall receive during the Term hereof a base salary
at the rate of not less than $257,500 per year ("Annual
Base Salary"), payable in substantially equal installments in
accordance with Company's usual paying practices, but not less
frequently than monthly.  Employee shall be eligible to receive
increases in Employee's Annual Base Salary pursuant to periodic
salary reviews consistent with the Company's corporate policies,
it being understood such increases are not guaranteed, but are
subject to evaluation of Employee's job performance.  In addition
to the foregoing compensation, Employee will be eligible, in the
sole discretion of the Board of Directors of the Company, to
participate in the Company's Bonus Plan as in effect from time to
time.

               b.   As further consideration for the covenants
contained herein, the Company will provide Employee with such
insurance, welfare, sick leave, and other benefits as may be
established by the Company from time to time with respect to its
employees and will reimburse Employee for authorized business
expenses in accordance with policies established by the Company
from time to time.  Employee shall be entitled to vacation in
accordance with the Company's vacation policies, as in effect
from time to time.

          4.   Termination.
               -----------

               a.   Termination Without Cause.  Employee's
                    -------------------------
employment may be terminated without cause:

                    (1)  At any time upon the mutual written
     agreement of the parties hereto;

                    (2)  Immediately upon Employee's Total
     Disability (as defined in Section 4(f));

                    (3)  Upon not less than 30 days' advance
     written notice from Employee of Employee's desire to
     terminate this Agreement, provided, however, that, following
     such notice, the Company shall have the right to terminate
     Employee's employment immediately, provided that the Company
     pays Employee the compensation due him or her as if the
     Termination Date occurred 30 days from the date of such
     notice; or

                                    2
<PAGE> 3

                    (4)  Upon not less than 30 days' advance
     written notice from the Company of the Company's desire to
     terminate this Agreement.

               b.   Termination For Cause.  Employee's employment
                    ---------------------
may be terminated by the Company upon written notice to Employee
at any time for any of the following reasons, each of which shall
constitute "termination for cause":

                         (1)  Any material breach of this
     Agreement by Employee which is not cured within 20 days
     after written notice by the Company;

                         (2)  Employee's fraud, embezzlement,
     dishonesty, or unlawful acts in connection with the business
     of the Company or its Affiliates;

                         (3)  Employee's conviction for any
     felony; or

                         (4)  Employee's substantial and
     continuing willful failure to perform, or grossly negligent
     performance of, the duties of Employee's position.

               c.   Termination Date.  Employee's last day of
                    ----------------
employment with the Company (if such date occurs prior to the
third anniversary of this Agreement) shall be referred to in this
Agreement as the "Termination Date" and shall constitute the end
of the Term of this Agreement.

               d.   Effect of Termination.
                    ---------------------

                    (1)  Upon any termination of the employment
pursuant to this Section 4, this Agreement shall terminate and
the Company shall have no obligation of any kind whatsoever to
Employee except to pay Employee the compensation due him or her
through the Termination Date, the amount of such compensation due
Employee under Section 3(a) hereof being apportioned for the
portion of the fiscal period Employee was actually employed, and
any deferred compensation then due to Employee hereunder.  The
obligations under Section 6 and 7 shall survive the end of the
Term of this Agreement according to their terms.

                    (2)  In addition, upon termination pursuant
to Section 4(a)(4), the Company shall (i) pay Employee an amount
equal to 150% of the Annual Base Salary for each year (or portion
thereof, pro rated) through the balance of the Term and (ii)
provide all benefits described in Section 3(b) through the
balance of the Term.  Payment pursuant to this Section 4(d)(2)
shall not apply to any termination other than one pursuant to
Section 4(a)(4).

                                    3
<PAGE> 4

               e.   Release.  In the event Employee becomes
                    -------
entitled to payments pursuant to Section 4(d)(2) hereof, Employee
shall, as a condition to such payments being made, execute and
deliver to the Company, and any Affiliates of the Company
designated by the Company, a release of all Employee's claims for
employment, employment-related compensation or employee benefits
or any form of damages as a result of termination of employment
in such form as is reasonably satisfactory to the Company, which
document shall include a covenant not to bring any claim, action
or suit with respect to the matters which are the subject of such
release.

               f.   Definition of Total Disability.  "Total
                    ------------------------------
Disability" means having a physical or mental condition which
renders Employee permanently incapable of performing his duties
and responsibilities with the Company.  Determination of Total
Disability will be made by a physician selected by the Company.
If the determination of such physician differs from the opinion
as to disability of the Employee's physician, the two physicians
shall select a third physician, whose determination shall be
binding on both parties.

          5.   Company Policies.  Employee agrees to abide by the
               ----------------
policies, rules, regulations, and usages applicable to Employee
as they are established by the Company from time to time, and to
perform the duties assigned to him faithfully and loyally.

          6.   Non-Disclosure.  Employee agrees that he will
               --------------
never disclose, directly or indirectly, to any other firm or
person any of Company's or Company's Affiliates' confidential or
proprietary information including customer lists, trade secrets,
and know-how relating to its or their business.  Confidential or
proprietary information shall not include any information which
is or hereafter comes in the public domain or is or becomes
generally known or available in the industry through no act of
Employee prohibited by this Agreement.

          7.   Non-Compete Agreement.
               ---------------------

               a.   Covenant.  Employee recognizes that (i) the
                    --------
Company and CAM, GAIMCO, Conning Corp. and Conning (the
"Controlled Subsidiaries") have spent substantial money, time and
effort over the years in developing and solidifying their
relationships with their customers and in developing their
confidential information; (ii) long-term customer relationships
often can be difficult to develop and require a significant
investment of time, effort, and expense; (iii) the Company pays
its employees to, among other things, develop and preserve
business information, customer goodwill and customer loyalty for
and on behalf of the Company and the Controlled Subsidiaries; and
(iv) the Company is hereby agreeing to employ and pay Employee
based upon Employee's assurances and promises contained herein
not to divert the Company's and the Controlled Subsidiaries'

                                    4
<PAGE> 5

customers' goodwill and not to put himself or herself in a
position during or following Employee's employment with the
Company in which the confidentiality of the Company's and the
Controlled Subsidiaries' proprietary information might be
compromised.  Accordingly, Employee covenants and agrees that for
a period of three years following the date hereof, regardless of
whether Employee remains employed by the Company and regardless
of whether Employee's termination, if any, is with or without
cause, neither Employee nor any entity controlling, controlled by
or under common control with Employee shall (i) engage in, or
have any direct or indirect interest in any other person, firm,
corporation, or other entity engaged in any business activities
competitive with the business activities of the Controlled
Subsidiaries, or (ii) become an employee, director, advisor,
consultant, independent contractor, or agent of any such person,
firm, corporation, or other entity, except with the Company's
prior written consent.

               b.   Acknowledgement Regarding Restrictions.
                    --------------------------------------
Employee recognizes and agrees that the restraints contained in
Section 7(a) are reasonable and enforceable in view of the
legitimate interests of the Controlled Subsidiaries in protecting
their confidential information and customer goodwill, and that
the limitations contained therein on the duration and geographic
scope of, and activities prohibited by, such restraints are
reasonable and binding upon Employee.

               c.   Enforceability.
                    --------------

                    (1)  The covenants contained in this
Section 7 shall be deemed to be a series of separate covenants,
one for each aspect of the Controlled Subsidiaries' businesses
and locations.  Each separate covenant shall hereinafter be
referred to as a "Separate Covenant."

                    (2)  If any court or tribunal of competent
jurisdiction shall refuse to enforce one or more of the Separate
Covenants because the time limit applicable thereto is deemed
unreasonable, it is expressly understood and agreed that such
Separate Covenant or Separate Covenants shall not be void but
that for the purpose of such proceedings such time limitation
shall be deemed to be reduced to the extent necessary to permit
the enforcement of such Separate Covenant or Separate Covenants.

                    (3)  If any court or tribunal of competent
jurisdiction shall refuse to enforce any or all of the Separate
Covenants because, taken together, they are more extensive
(whether as to geographic area, scope of business, or otherwise)
than is deemed to be reasonable, it is expressly understood and
agreed between the parties that such Separate Covenant or
Separate Covenants shall not be void but that for the purpose of
such proceedings the restrictions contained therein (whether as
to geographic area, scope of business, or otherwise) shall be

                                    5
<PAGE> 6

deemed to be reduced to the extent necessary to permit the
enforcement of such Separate Covenant or Separate Covenants.

               d.   Ownership of Securities.  Nothing contained
                    -----------------------
herein shall restrict Employee from owning 2% or less of the
corporate securities of any entity in competition with the
Controlled Subsidiaries' businesses, which securities are listed
on any national securities exchange or authorized for listing on
the Nasdaq National Market, if Employee has no other connection
or relationship, direct or indirect, with the issuer of such
securities.

          8.   Non-Waiver of Rights.  The Company's failure to
               --------------------
enforce at any time any of the provisions of this Agreement or to
require at any time performance by Employee of any of the
provisions hereof shall in no way be construed to be a waiver of
such provisions or to affect either the validity of this
Agreement, or any part hereof, or the right of Company thereafter
to enforce each and every provision in accordance with the terms
of this Agreement.

          9.   The Company's Right to Injunctive Relief.  In the
               ----------------------------------------
event of a breach or threatened breach of any of Employee's
duties and obligations under the terms and provisions of Sections
6 or 7 hereof, the Company shall be entitled, in addition to any
other legal or equitable remedies it may have (including any
right to damages that it may suffer), to temporary, preliminary,
and permanent injunctive relief restraining such breach or
threatened breach.  Employee hereby expressly acknowledges that
the harm which might result to the Company's business as a result
of any noncompliance by Employee with any of the provisions of
Sections 6 or 7 would be largely irreparable.  Employee
specifically agrees that if there is a question as to the
enforceability of any of the provisions of Sections 6 or 7
hereof, Employee will not engage in any conduct inconsistent with
or contrary to such Sections until after the question has been
resolved by a final judgment of a court of competent
jurisdiction.

          10.  Employee Representations.  Employee represents
               ------------------------
that the execution and delivery of this Agreement and Employee's
employment with the Company do not violate any previous
employment agreement or other contractual obligation of Employee.
Employee also represents and agrees that Employee has not
disclosed, and will not disclose, to the Company any information,
whether confidential, proprietary, or otherwise, which Employee
has in Employee's possession and which Employee is not legally
free to disclose.

          11.  The Company's Right to Recover Costs and Fees.
               ---------------------------------------------
Employee and the Company each undertakes and agrees that if such
party breaches this Agreement, such party shall be liable for any

                                    6
<PAGE> 7

attorneys' fees and costs incurred by the other party in
enforcing its rights hereunder.

          12.  Definition of Affiliate.  "Affiliate" shall for
               -----------------------
purposes of this Agreement mean any person or entity (the
"Specified Person") (a) who directly or indirectly controls, is
controlled by, or is under common control with the Company, (b)
who owns or controls thirty percent (30%) or more of the
Company's outstanding voting securities or percentage interests;
(c) in whom the Company owns or controls thirty percent (30%) or
more of the outstanding voting securities or percentage
interests; (d) who is a director, partner, manager, executive
officer or trustee of the Company; (e) in whom the Company is a
partner; or (f) who has any relationship with the Specified
Person by blood, marriage or adoption, not more remote than first
cousin, and shall include, without limitation, the Controlled
Subsidiaries.

          13.  Miscellaneous.  Neither this Agreement nor any
               -------------
rights hereunder shall be assignable by either party hereto.

          This agreement contains the entire agreement between
the parties with respect to the terms of Employee's employment by
Company, free of any other representation, promise, or
understanding.  This Agreement may be modified or amended only by
a written agreement executed by both parties to this Agreement.

          This Agreement may be assigned by the Company at any
time, without Employee's consent, to CAM or GAIMCO.  Employee may
not assign this Agreement.

          Nothing in this Agreement shall be construed as
creating a joint venture or partnership between Employee and the
Company or any of its Affiliates.

          Section headings are provided in this Agreement for
convenience only and shall not be deemed to alter the content of
such sections.

                                    7
<PAGE> 8

PLEASE NOTE:  BY SIGNING THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT, EMPLOYEE IS
- -----------
HEREBY CERTIFYING THAT EMPLOYEE (A) HAS RECEIVED A COPY OF THIS
AGREEMENT FOR REVIEW AND STUDY BEFORE EXECUTING IT; (B) HAS READ
THIS AGREEMENT CAREFULLY BEFORE SIGNING IT; (C) HAS HAD
SUFFICIENT OPPORTUNITY BEFORE SIGNING THE AGREEMENT TO ASK ANY
QUESTIONS EMPLOYEE HAS ABOUT THE AGREEMENT AND HAS RECEIVED
SATISFACTORY ANSWERS TO ALL SUCH QUESTIONS; AND (D) UNDERSTANDS
EMPLOYEE'S RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS UNDER THE AGREEMENT.

          This Agreement shall be construed and interpreted under
the laws of Missouri.

          IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this
agreement on the date first set out above.


                              GENERAL AMERICAN LIFE INSURANCE
                              COMPANY



                              By:  /s/ Richard A. Liddy
                                 -------------------------------
                              Name:  Richard A. Liddy
                              Title: President


                              EMPLOYEE



                                 /s/ Leonard M. Rubenstein
                               -------------------------------
                              Name: Leonard M. Rubenstein
                              Address: 105 Bon Chateau
                                       St. Louis, MO 63141

                                    8

<PAGE> 1
                         CONNING CORPORATION

                       1997 FLEXIBLE STOCK PLAN



<PAGE> 2

<TABLE>
                                         CONNING CORPORATION
                                       1997 FLEXIBLE STOCK PLAN
<CAPTION>

                                          TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                                                   Page
                                                                                                   ----
<S>                                                                                                 <C>
ARTICLE 1 - NAME AND PURPOSE                                                                         1
      1.1    Name                                                                                    1
      1.2    Purpose                                                                                 1

ARTICLE II - DEFINITIONS OF TERMS AND RULES OF CONSTRUCTION                                          1
      2.1    General Definitions                                                                     1
              (a) Agreement                                                                          1
              (b) Benefit                                                                            1
              (c) Board                                                                              1
              (d) Cash Award                                                                         1
              (e) Change in Control                                                                  1
              (f) Code                                                                               2
              (g) Committee                                                                          2
              (h) Common Stock                                                                       2
              (i) Company                                                                            2
              (j) Effective Date                                                                     2
              (k) Employee                                                                           2
              (l) Employer                                                                           2
              (m) Exchange Act                                                                       2
              (n) Executive Compensation Committee                                                   2
              (o) Executive Officer                                                                  2
              (p) Fair Market Value                                                                  2
              (q) Fiscal Year                                                                        2
              (r) General Compensation Committee                                                     2
              (s) ISO                                                                                3
              (t) Non-Employee Director                                                              3
              (u) NQSO                                                                               3
              (v) Option                                                                             3
              (w) Other Stock Based Award                                                            3
              (x) Participant                                                                        3
              (y) Performance-Based Compensation                                                     3
              (z) Performance Share                                                                  4
              (aa) Plan                                                                              4
              (bb) Reload Option                                                                     4
              (cc) Restricted Stock                                                                  4
              (dd) Rule 16b-3                                                                        4
              (ee) SEC                                                                               4
              (ff) Section 162(m)                                                                    4
              (gg) Share                                                                             4
              (hh) SAR                                                                               4
              (ii) Subsidiary                                                                        4
      2.2    Other Definitions                                                                       4
      2.3    Conflicts                                                                               4


                                    1
<PAGE> 3

ARTICLE III - COMMON STOCK                                                                           5
      3.1    Number of Shares                                                                        5
      3.2    Reusage                                                                                 5
      3.3    Adjustments                                                                             5

ARTICLE IV - ELIGIBILITY                                                                             5
      4.1    Determined by Committee                                                                 5

ARTICLE V - ADMINISTRATION                                                                           6
      5.1    Committee                                                                               6
      5.2    Authority                                                                               6
      5.3    Delegation                                                                              7
      5.4    Adjudication of Claims                                                                  7

ARTICLE VI - AMENDMENT                                                                               7
      6.1    Power of Board                                                                          7
      6.2    Limitations                                                                             7

ARTICLE VII - TERM AND TERMINATION                                                                   8
      7.1    Term                                                                                    8
      7.2    Termination                                                                             8

ARTICLE VIII - MODIFICATION OR TERMINATION OF BENEFITS                                               8
      8.1    General                                                                                 8
      8.2    Committee's Right                                                                       8

ARTICLE IX - CHANGE IN CONTROL                                                                       8
      9.1    Right of Committee                                                                      8

ARTICLE X - AGREEMENTS AND CERTAIN BENEFITS                                                          9
      10.1    Grant Evidenced by Agreement                                                           9
      10.2    Provisions of Agreement                                                                9
      10.3    Transferability                                                                        9

ARTICLE XI - REPLACEMENT AND TANDEM AWARDS                                                          10
      11.1    Replacement                                                                           10
      11.2    Tandem Awards                                                                         10

ARTICLE XII - PAYMENT, DIVIDENDS, DEFERRAL AND WITHHOLDING                                          10
      12.1    Payment                                                                               10
      12.2    Dividend Equivalents                                                                  10
      12.3    Deferral                                                                              10
      12.4    Withholding                                                                           11


                                    2
<PAGE> 4

ARTICLE XIII - OPTIONS                                                                              11
      13.1    Types of Options                                                                      11
      13.2    Shares for ISOs                                                                       11
      13.3    Grant of ISOs and Option Price                                                        11
      13.4    Other Requirements for ISOs                                                           11
      13.5    NQSOs                                                                                 11
      13.6    Determination by Committee                                                            11

ARTICLE XIV - SARS                                                                                  11
      14.1    Grant and Payment                                                                     11
      14.2    Grant of Tandem Award                                                                 11
      14.3    ISO Tandem Award                                                                      12
      14.4    Payment of Award                                                                      12

ARTICLE XV - ANNUAL LIMITATIONS                                                                     12
      15.1    Limitation on Options and SARs                                                        12
      15.2    Computations                                                                          12

ARTICLE XVI - RESTRICTED STOCK AND PERFORMANCE SHARES                                               12
      16.1    Restricted Stock                                                                      12
      16.2    Cost of Restricted Stock                                                              12
      16.3    Non-Transferability                                                                   12
      16.4    Performance Shares                                                                    12
      16.5    Grant                                                                                 13

ARTICLE XVII - CASH AWARDS                                                                          13
      17.1    Grant                                                                                 13
      17.2    Restrictions                                                                          13

ARTICLE XVIII - OTHER STOCK BASED AWARDS AND OTHER BENEFITS                                         13
      18.1    Other Stock Based Awards                                                              13
      18.2    Other Benefits                                                                        13

ARTICLE XIX - MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS                                                              13
      19.1    Underscored References                                                                13
      19.2    Number and Gender                                                                     13
      19.3    Unfunded Status of Plan                                                               14
      19.4    Termination of Participant Status                                                     14
      19.5    Designation of Beneficiary                                                            14
      19.6    Governing Law                                                                         14
      19.7    Purchase for Investment                                                               14
      19.8    No Employment Contract                                                                14
      19.9    No Effect on Other Benefits                                                           15

</TABLE>

                                    3
<PAGE> 5

                         CONNING CORPORATION
                      1997 FLEXIBLE STOCK PLAN

                             ARTICLE I
                             ---------

                         NAME AND PURPOSE
                         ----------------

      1.1  Name.  The name of this Plan is the "Conning Corporation 1997
           ----
Flexible Stock Plan."

      1.2  Purpose.  The Company has established this Plan to attract,
           -------
retain, motivate and reward Employees and other individuals, to encourage
ownership of the Company's Common Stock by Employees and other individuals,
and to promote and further the best interests of the Company by granting cash
and other awards.

                            ARTICLE II
                            ----------

          DEFINITIONS OF TERMS AND RULES OF CONSTRUCTION
          ----------------------------------------------

      2.1  General Definitions.  The following words and phrases, when used
           -------------------
in the Plan, unless otherwise specifically defined or unless the context
clearly otherwise requires, shall have the following respective meanings:

      (a)  (a)     Agreement.  The document which evidences the grant of any
                   ---------
Benefit under the Plan and which sets forth the Benefit and the terms,
conditions and provisions of, and restrictions relating to, such Benefit.

      (b)  Benefit.  Any benefit granted to a Participant under the Plan.
           -------

      (c)  Board.  The Board of Directors of the Company.
           -----

      (d)  Cash Award.  A Benefit payable in the form of cash.
           ----------

      (e)  Change in Control. (i) The acquisition, without the approval of the
           -----------------
      Board, by any "person" or "group" (as that term is used in Section
      13(d) and 14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act), other than the Company or a
      Related Entity (as defined below), of beneficial ownership (as defined
      in Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act) of outstanding voting securities
      of the Company carrying more than 20% of the combined voting power in
      the election of directors through a tender offer, exchange offer or
      otherwise; (ii) the liquidation or dissolution of the Company following
      a sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of its assets;
      (iii) a merger or consolidation involving the Company as a result of
      which persons who were shareholders of the Company immediately prior to
      the effective date of the merger or consolidation shall have beneficial
      ownership of less than 50% of the combined voting power in the election
      of directors of the surviving corporation following


                                    1
<PAGE> 6

      the effective date of such merger or consolidation; or (iv) a change in
      the majority of the members of the Board (other than as a result of death
      or disability) during any period of two years or less unless the election
      or nomination for election of such members was approved by at least
      two-thirds of (x) the then remaining members of the Board who were
      members at the beginning of such period plus (y) the then remaining
      members whose election or nomination for election was approved by at
      least two-thirds of the members of the Board who were members at the
      start of the two-year period).  A "Related Entity" is (a) General
      American Mutual Holding Company and its direct and indirect
      subsidiaries, (b) the Company, (iii) a Subsidiary, or (iv) any employee
      benefit plan (including a trust forming a part of such a plan)
      maintained by any of the foregoing.

      (f)  Code.  The Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.  Any
           ----
      reference to the Code includes the regulations promulgated pursuant to
      the Code.

      (g)  Committee.  The entity described in Section 5.1.
           ---------

      (h)  Common Stock.  The Company's common stock which presently has a par
           ------------
      value of $.01 per Share.

      (i)  Company.  Conning Corporation, a Missouri corporation.
           -------

      (j)  Effective Date.  The date that the Plan is approved by the
           --------------
      shareholders of the Company, which must occur within one year before or
      after approval by the Board.  Any grants of Benefits prior to the
      approval by the shareholders of the Company shall be void if such
      approval is not obtained.

      (k)  Employee.  Any person employed by an Employer.
           --------

      (l)  Employer.  The Company and all Subsidiaries.
           --------

      (m)  Exchange Act.  The Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
           ------------

      (n)  Executive Compensation Committee.  The Executive Compensation
           --------------------------------
      Committee of the Board, or any successor committee established by the
      Board, which committee shall at all times consist solely of two or more
      members of the Board, each of whom is a "non-employee" director as
      defined in Rule 16b-3 and an "outside director" as defined in Section
      162(m).

      (o)  Executive Officer.  An Employee or officer of the Company who is
           -----------------
      subject to Section 16 of the Exchange Act.

      (p)  Fair Market Value.  The closing price of Shares on The Nasdaq
           -----------------
      National Market on a given date, or, in the absence of sales on a given
      date, the closing price on The Nasdaq National Market on the last day
      on which a sale occurred prior to such date, provided that,


                                    2
<PAGE> 7

      in the case of NQSOs granted as of the closing date of the Company's
      initial public offering, Fair Market Value shall mean the initial public
      offering price.

      (q)  Fiscal Year.  The taxable year of the Company, which is the
           -----------
      calendar year.

      (r)  General Compensation Committee.  The General Compensation Committee
           ------------------------------
      of the Board, or any successor committee established by the Board.

      (s)  ISO.  An Incentive Stock Option as defined in Section 422 of the
           ---
      Code.

      (t)  Non-Employee Director.  A member of the Board who is not an
           ---------------------
      Employee.

      (u)  NQSO.  A Non-Qualified Stock Option, which is an Option that does
           ----
      not qualify as an ISO.

      (v)  Option.  An option to purchase Shares granted under the Plan.
           ------

      (w)  Other Stock Based Award.  An award under ARTICLE XVIII that is
           -----------------------
      valued in whole or in part by reference to, or is otherwise based on,
      Common Stock.

      (x)  Participant.  An individual who is granted a Benefit under the
           -----------
      Plan.  Benefits may be granted only to (i) Employees, (ii) Non-Employee
      Directors, (iii) employees and owners of entities which are not
      Affiliates but which have a direct or indirect ownership interest in an
      Employer or in which an Employer has a direct or indirect ownership
      interest, (iv) individuals who, and employees and owners of entities
      which, are customers and suppliers of an Employer, (v) individuals who,
      and employees and owners of entities which, render services to an
      Employer, and (vi) individuals who, and employees and owners of
      entities which, have ownership or business affiliations with any
      individual or entity described in any of clauses (i) through (v).

      (y)  Performance-Based Compensation.  Compensation which meets the
           ------------------------------
      requirements of Section 162(m)(4)(C) of the Code.  The maximum annual
      award that can be granted to any Participant for any Fiscal Year is
      $1,000,000.  Awards which constitute Performance-Based Compensation are
      based upon attainment of pre-established goals relating to Company,
      division or individual performance or in comparison with peer group
      performance.  Company and division goals consist of revenues, operating
      income (whether excluding or including unusual or non-recurrring
      items), income before provision for income taxes (whether excluding or
      including unusual or non-recurrring items), net income, EBITDA
      (operating income plus amortization of goodwill and other plus
      depreciation and amortization), earnings per share, stock price
      performance, stock price/earnings ratio, cash flow, return on equity,
      net assets, return on net assets, return on assets, return on capital,
      return on revenues, and book value; and individual goals consist of
      product development, client development and revenues, as well as, in
      certain cases, intangible items such as leadership.  To the extent that
      the attainment of any non-objective goal or the occurrence of any non-
      objective factor (such as termination of employment, change of position
      or salary


                                    3
<PAGE> 8

      or leadership) may be considered in the determination of a
      Participant's award for a Fiscal Year under the terms of the Plan, the
      Participant will initially be deemed to have earned the maximum award
      payable based on such goal or factor, but the Committee shall have the
      authority to reduce such compensation in whole or in part in its sole
      discretion.  No award will be payable unless and until the Committee
      certifies that the performance gals and any other material terms have
      been met.

      (z)  Performance Share.  A Share awarded to a Participant under ARTICLE
           -----------------
      XVI of the Plan.

      (aa) Plan.  The Conning Corporation 1997 Flexible Stock Plan and all
           ----
      amendments and supplements to it.

      (bb) Reload Option.  An Option to purchase the number of Shares used by
           -------------
      a Participant to exercise an Option and to satisfy any withholding
      requirement incident to the exercise of such Option.

      (cc) Restricted Stock.  Shares issued under ARTICLE XV of the Plan.
           ----------------

      (dd) Rule 16b-3.  Rule 16b-3 promulgated by the SEC, as amended, or any
           ----------
      successor rule in effect from time to time.

      (ee) SEC.  The Securities and Exchange Commission.
           ---

      (ff) Section 162(m).  Section 162(m) of the Code or any successor
           --------------
      section in effect from time to time.

      (gg) Share.  A share of Common Stock.
           -----

      (hh) SAR.  A stock appreciation right, which is the right to receive an
           ---
      amount equal to the appreciation, if any, in the Fair Market Value of a
      Share from the date of the grant of the right to the date of its
      payment.

      (ii) Subsidiary.  Any corporation, other than the Company, in an
           ----------
      unbroken chain of corporations beginning with the Company if, at the
      time of grant of an Option or other Benefit, each of the corporations,
      other than the last corporation in the unbroken chain, owns stock
      possessing 50% or more of the total combined voting power of all
      classes of stock in one of the other corporations in such chain.

      2.2  Other Definitions.  In addition to the above definitions, certain
           -----------------
words and phrases used in the Plan and any Agreement may be defined in other
portions of the Plan or in such Agreement.

      2.3   Conflicts.  In the case of any conflict in the terms of the Plan
            ---------
relating to a Benefit, the provisions in the ARTICLE of the Plan which
specifically grants such Benefit shall control

                                    4
<PAGE> 9
those in a different ARTICLE. In the case of any conflict between the terms of
the Plan relating to a Benefit and the terms of an Agreement relating to a
Benefit, the terms of the Plan shall control.

                                  ARTICLE III
                                  -----------

                                  COMMON STOCK
                                  ------------

      3.1  Number of Shares.  The number of Shares which may be issued or
           ----------------
sold or for which Options, SARs or Performance Shares may be granted under
the Plan shall be 2,200,000 Shares.

      3.2  Reusage.  If an Option or SAR expires or is terminated,
           -------
surrendered, or canceled without having been fully exercised, if Restricted
Shares or Performance Shares are forfeited, or if any other grant results in
any Shares not being issued, the Shares covered by such Option or SAR, grant
of Restricted Shares, Performance Shares or other grant, as the case may be,
shall again be available for use under the Plan.  Any Shares which are used
as full or partial payment to the Company upon exercise of an Option or for
any other Benefit that requires a payment to the Company shall be available
for purposes of the Plan.

      3.3  Adjustments.  If there is any change in the Common Stock of the
           -----------
Company by reason of any stock dividend, spin-off, split-up, spin-out,
recapitalization, merger, consolidation, reorganization, combination or
exchange of shares, the number of SARs and number, kind and class of shares
available for Options and grants of Restricted Stock, Performance Shares and
Other Stock Based Awards and the number, kind or class of Shares subject to
outstanding Options, SARs, grants of Restricted Stock and Performance Shares,
and Other Stock Based Awards, and the price thereof, as applicable, shall be
appropriately adjusted by the Committee.  The issuance of Shares for
consideration and the issuance of Share rights shall not be considered a
change in the Company's capital structure.  No adjustment provided for in
this section shall require the issuance of any fractional shares.

                                   ARTICLE IV
                                   ----------

                                  ELIGIBILITY
                                  -----------

      4.1  Determined by Committee.  The Participants and the Benefits they
           -----------------------
receive under the Plan shall be determined solely (i) with respect to
Participants who are Executive Officers, by the Executive Compensation
Committee of the Board (unless the Benefit is a Cash Award that is not
Performance-Based Compensation, in which case the determination may be made
either by the General Compensation Committee or the Executive Compensation
Committee), (ii) with respect to Non-Employee Directors, by the full Board of
Directors, and (iii) with respect to all other Participants, by the General
Compensation Committee of the Board.  For purposes of this Plan and any
Agreement, references to "the Committee" shall refer to the General
Compensation Committee, the Executive Compensation Committee or the full
Board, as appropriate.  In making its determinations, the Committee shall
consider past, present and expected future contributions of Participants and
potential Participants to the Employer, including, without limitation, the
performance of, or the refraining from the performance of, services.  Unless
specifically provided otherwise herein, all determinations of the Committee
in connection with the Plan or an Agreement shall be made in its sole
discretion.

                                    5
<PAGE> 10

                                   ARTICLE V
                                   ---------

                                 ADMINISTRATION
                                 --------------

      5.1  Committee.  The Plan shall be administered by the Committee.  The
           ---------
members of the Committee shall be appointed by and shall serve at the
pleasure of the Board, which may from time to time appoint members in
substitution for members previously appointed and fill vacancies, however
caused, in the Committee, subject to the above restrictions.  The Committee
may select one of its members as its Chairman and shall hold its meetings at
such times and places as it may determine.  A majority of its members shall
constitute a quorum.  All determinations of the Committee shall be made by a
majority of its members.  Any decision or determination reduced to writing
and signed by a majority of the members shall be fully as effective as if it
had been made by a majority vote at a meeting duly called and held.

      5.2  Authority.  Subject to the terms of the Plan, the Committee shall
           ---------
have discretionary authority to:

      (a) determine the individuals to whom Benefits are granted, the type
      and amounts of Benefits to be granted and the date of issuance and
      duration of all such grants;

      (b) determine the terms, conditions and provisions of, and restrictions
      relating to, each Benefit granted;

      (c) interpret and construe the Plan and all Agreements;

      (d) prescribe, amend and rescind rules and regulations relating to the
      Plan;

      (e) determine the content and form of all Agreements;

      (f) determine all questions relating to Benefits under the Plan;

      (g) maintain accounts, records and ledgers relating to Benefits;

      (h) maintain records concerning its decisions and proceedings;

      (i) employ agents, attorneys, accountants or other persons for such
      purposes as the Committee considers necessary or desirable;

      (j) take, at any time, any action permitted by Section 9.1 irrespective
      of whether any Change in Control has occurred or is imminent;

      (k) to determine, except to the extent otherwise provided in the Plan,
      whether and the extent to which Benefits under the Plan will be
      structured to conform to the requirements applicable to Performance-
      Based Compensation, and to take such action, establish such procedures,
      and impose such restrictions at the time such Benefits are granted as
      the Committee determines to be necessary or appropriate to conform to
      such requirements; and

                                    6
<PAGE> 11
      (l) do and perform all acts which it may deem necessary or appropriate
      for the administration of the Plan and carry out the purposes of the
      Plan.

      5.3  Delegation.  Except as required by Rule 16b-3 or, with respect to
           ----------
awards made to Executive Officers (other than Cash Awards that are not
Performance-Based Compensation) as required by Section 162(m), or as required
by other applicable law, the Committee may delegate all or any part of its
authority under the Plan to any Employee, Employees, committee or
sub-committee.

      5.4  Adjudication of Claims.  The Committee shall have discretionary
           ----------------------
authority to make all determinations as to the right to Benefits under the
Plan.  In the event that a Participant believes he has not received the
Benefits to which he is entitled under the Plan, a claim shall be made in
writing to the Committee.  The claim shall be reviewed by the Committee.  If
the claim is approved or denied, in full or in part, the Committee shall
provide a written notice of approval or denial within 90 days with, in the
case of a denial, the specific reasons for the denial and specific reference
to the provisions of the Plan and/or Agreement upon which the denial is
based.  A claim shall be deemed denied if the Committee does not take any
action within the aforesaid 90 day period.  If a claim is denied or deemed
denied and a review is desired, the Participant shall notify the Committee in
writing within 60 days of the receipt of notice of denial or the date on
which the claim is deemed to be denied, as the case may be.  In requesting a
review, the Participant may review the Plan or any document relating to it
and submit any written issues and comments he may deem appropriate.  The
Committee shall then review the claim and provide a written decision within
60 days.  This decision, if adverse to the Participant, shall state the
specific reasons for the decision and shall include reference to specific
provisions of the Plan and/or Agreement on which the decision is based.  The
Committee's decision on review shall be final and binding on all persons.

                                   ARTICLE VI
                                   ----------

                                   AMENDMENT
                                   ---------

      6.1  Power of Board.  Except as hereinafter provided, the Board shall
           --------------
have the sole right and power to amend the Plan at any time and from time to
time.

      6.2  Limitations.
           -----------

      (a)  The Board may not amend the Plan, without approval of the
      shareholders of the Company:

                  (i)   in a manner which would cause Options which are
           intended to qualify as ISOs to fail to qualify;

                  (ii)  in a manner which would cause the Plan to fail to
           meet the requirements of Rule 16b-3; or

                                    7
<PAGE> 12
                  (iii) in a manner which would violate applicable law.

      (b)  No Board member may participate in any decision regarding
      an award to such member under the Plan or which otherwise involves a
      determination of such member's rights or obligations under the Plan or
      under an Agreement.

                                  ARTICLE VII
                                  -----------

                              TERM AND TERMINATION
                              --------------------

      7.1  Term.  The Plan shall commence as of the Effective Date and,
           ----
subject to the terms of the Plan, including those requiring approval by the
shareholders of the Company and those limiting the period over which ISOs or
any other Benefits may be granted, shall continue in full force and effect
until terminated.

      7.2  Termination.  The Plan may be terminated at any time by the
           -----------
Board.

                                  ARTICLE VIII
                                  ------------

                    MODIFICATION OR TERMINATION OF BENEFITS
                    ---------------------------------------

      8.1  General.  Subject to the provisions of Section 8.2, the amendment
           -------
or termination of the Plan shall not adversely affect a Participant's right
to any Benefit granted prior to such amendment or termination.

      8.2  Committee's Right.  Subject to the provisions of Section 6.2, any
           -----------------
Benefit granted may be converted, modified, forfeited or canceled, in whole
or in part, by the Committee if and to the extent permitted in the Plan or
applicable Agreement or with the consent of the Participant to whom such
Benefit was granted.  Except as may be provided in an Agreement, the
Committee may, in its sole discretion, in whole or in part, waive any
restrictions or conditions applicable to, or accelerate the vesting of, any
Benefit.

                                   ARTICLE IX
                                   ----------

                               CHANGE IN CONTROL
                               -----------------

      9.1  Right of Committee.  In order to maintain a Participant's rights
           ------------------
in the event of a Change in Control, the Committee, in its sole discretion,
may, in any Agreement evidencing a Benefit, or at any time prior to, or
simultaneously with or after a Change in Control, provide such protection as
it may deem necessary.  Without, in any way, limiting the generality of the
foregoing sentence or requiring any specific protection, the Committee may,
without the approval or consent of the Participant:

                                    8
<PAGE> 13

      (a)  provide for the acceleration of any time periods relating to the
      exercise or realization of such Benefit so that such Benefit may be
      exercised or realized in full on or before a date fixed by the
      Committee;

      (b)  provide for the purchase of such Benefit, upon the Participant's
      request, for an amount of cash equal to the amount which could have
      been attained upon the exercise or realization of such Benefit had such
      Benefit been currently exercisable or payable;

      (c)  make such adjustment to the Benefits then outstanding as the
      Committee deems appropriate to reflect such transaction or change;
      and/or

      (d)  cause the Benefits then outstanding to be assumed, or new Benefits
      substituted therefor, by the surviving corporation in such change.

                                   ARTICLE X
                                   ---------

                        AGREEMENTS AND CERTAIN BENEFITS
                        -------------------------------

      10.1 Grant Evidenced by Agreement.  The grant of any Benefit under the
           ----------------------------
Plan may be evidenced by an Agreement which shall describe the specific
Benefit granted and the terms and conditions of the Benefit.  The granting of
any Benefit shall be subject to, and conditioned upon, the recipient's
execution of any Agreement required by the Committee.  Except as otherwise
provided in an Agreement, all capitalized terms used in the Agreement shall
have the same meaning as in the Plan, and the Agreement shall be subject to
all of the terms of the Plan.

      10.2 Provisions of Agreement.  Each Agreement shall contain such
           -----------------------
provisions that the Committee shall determine to be necessary, desirable and
appropriate for the Benefit granted which may include, but not necessarily be
limited to, the following with respect to any Benefit:  description of the
type of Benefit; the Benefit's duration; its transferability; if an Option,
the exercise price, the exercise period and the person or persons who may
exercise the Option; the effect upon such Benefit of the Participant's death,
disability, changes of duties or termination of employment; the Benefit's
conditions; when, if, and how any Benefit may be forfeited, converted into
another Benefit, modified, exchanged for another Benefit, or replaced; and
the restrictions on any Shares purchased or granted under the Plan.

      10.3 Transferability. Unless otherwise specified in an Agreement or
           ---------------
permitted by the Committee, each Benefit granted shall be not transferable
other than by will or the laws of descent and distribution and shall be
exercisable during his lifetime only by him, his guardian or his legal
representative.

                                    9
<PAGE> 14

                                   ARTICLE XI
                                   ----------

                         REPLACEMENT AND TANDEM AWARDS
                         -----------------------------

      11.1 Replacement.  The Committee may permit a Participant to elect to
           -----------
surrender a Benefit in exchange for a new Benefit.

      11.2 Tandem Awards.  Awards may be granted by the Committee in tandem.
           -------------
However, no Benefit may be granted in tandem with an ISO except SARs.

                                  ARTICLE XII
                                  -----------

                  PAYMENT, DIVIDENDS, DEFERRAL AND WITHHOLDING
                  --------------------------------------------

      12.1 Payment.  Upon the exercise of an Option or in the case of any
           -------
other Benefit that requires a payment by a Participant to the Company, the
amount due the Company is to be paid:

      (a)  in cash, including by means of a so-called "cashless exercise" of
      an Option;

      (b)  by the surrender of all or part of a Benefit (including the Benefit
      being exercised);

      (c)  by the tender to the Company of Shares owned by the Participant and
      registered in his name having a Fair Market Value equal to the amount
      due to the Company;

      (d)  in other property, rights and credits deemed acceptable by the
      Committee, including the Participant's promissory note if permitted
      under applicable law;

      (e)  by any combination of the payment methods specified in paragraphs
      (a) through (d) above.

      Notwithstanding, the foregoing, any method of payment other than as
described in paragraph (a) may be used only with the consent of the Committee
or if and to the extent so provided in an Agreement.  The proceeds of the
sale of Shares purchased pursuant to an Option and any payment to the Company
for other Benefits shall be added to the general funds of the Company or to
the Shares held in treasury, as the case may be, and used for the corporate
purposes of the Company as the Board shall determine.

      12.2 Dividend Equivalents.  Grants of Benefits in Shares or Share
           --------------------
equivalents may include dividend equivalent payments or dividend credit
rights.

      12.3 Deferral.  The right to receive any Benefit under the Plan may,
           --------
at the request of the Participant, be deferred for such period and upon such
terms as the Committee shall determine, which may include crediting of
interest on deferrals of cash and crediting of dividends on deferrals
denominated in Shares.

                                    10
<PAGE> 15

      12.4 Withholding.  The Company may, at the time any distribution is
           -----------
made under the Plan, whether in cash or in Shares, or at the time any Option
is exercised, withhold from such distribution or Shares issuable upon the
exercise of an Option, any amount necessary to satisfy federal, state and
local income and/or other tax withholding requirements with respect to such
distribution or exercise of such Options.  The Committee or the Company may
require a participant to tender to the Company cash and/or Shares in the
amount necessary to comply with any such withholding requirements.

                                  ARTICLE XIII
                                  ------------

                                    OPTIONS
                                    -------

      13.1 Types of Options.  It is intended that both ISOs and NQSOs, which
           ----------------
may be Reload Options, may be granted by the Committee under the Plan.

      13.2 Shares for ISOs.  The number of Shares for which ISOs may be
           ---------------
granted on or after the Effective Date shall not exceed 1,000,000 Shares.

      13.3 Grant of ISOs and Option Price.  Each ISO must be granted to an
           ------------------------------
Employee and granted within ten years from the earlier of the date of
adoption by the Board or the Effective Date.  The purchase price for Shares
under any ISO shall be no less than the Fair Market Value of the Shares at
the time the Option is granted.

      13.4 Other Requirements for ISOs.  The terms of each Option which is
           ---------------------------
intended to qualify as an ISO shall meet all requirements of Section 422 of
the Code.

      13.5 NQSOs.  The terms of each NQSO shall provide that such Option
           -----
will not be treated as an ISO.  The purchase price for Shares under any NQSO
shall be no less than the Fair Market Value of the Shares at the time the
Option is granted.

      13.6 Determination by Committee.  Except as otherwise provided in
           --------------------------
Sections 13.2 through 13.5, the terms of all Options shall be determined by
the Committee.

                                  ARTICLE XIV
                                  -----------

                                      SARS
                                      ----

      14.1 Grant and Payment.  The Committee may grant SARs.  Upon electing
           -----------------
to receive payment of a SAR, a Participant shall receive payment in cash, in
Shares, or in any combination of cash and Shares, as the Committee shall
determine.

      14.2 Grant of Tandem Award.  The Committee may grant SARs in tandem
           ---------------------
with an Option, in which case:  the exercise of the Option shall cause a
correlative reduction in SARs standing to a Participant's credit which were
granted in tandem with the Option; and the payment of SARs shall cause a
correlative reduction of the Shares under such Option.

                                    11
<PAGE> 16

      14.3 ISO Tandem Award.  When SARs are granted in tandem with an ISO,
           ----------------
the SARs shall have such terms and conditions as shall be required for the
ISO to qualify as an ISO.

      14.4 Payment of Award.  SARs shall be paid by the Company to a
           ----------------
Participant, to the extent payment is elected by the Participant (and is
otherwise due and payable), as soon as practicable after the date on which
such election is made.

                                   ARTICLE XV
                                   ----------

                               ANNUAL LIMITATIONS
                               ------------------

      15.1 Limitation on Options and SARs.  The maximum number of (a) Shares
           ------------------------------
with respect to which (i) ISOs plus (ii) NQSOs and (b) SARs which may be
granted to any Participant in any one year period shall not exceed 500,000.

      15.2 Computations.  For purposes of Section 15.1:  Shares covered by
           ------------
an Option that is canceled shall count against the maximum, and, if the
exercise price under an Option is reduced, the transaction shall be treated
as a cancellation of the Option and a grant of a new Option; and SARs covered
by a grant of SARs that is canceled shall count against the maximum, and, if
the Fair Market Value of a Share on which the appreciation under a grant of
SARs will be calculated is reduced, the transaction will be treated as a
cancellation of the SARs and the grant of a new grant of SARs.

                                  ARTICLE XVI
                                  -----------

                    RESTRICTED STOCK AND PERFORMANCE SHARES
                    ---------------------------------------

      16.1 Restricted Stock.  The Committee may grant Benefits in Shares
           ----------------
available under ARTICLE III of the Plan as Restricted Stock.  Shares of
Restricted Stock shall be issued and delivered at the time of the grant or as
otherwise determined by the Committee, but shall be subject to forfeiture
until provided otherwise in the applicable Agreement or the Plan.  Each
certificate representing Shares of Restricted Stock shall bear a legend
referring to the Plan and the risk of forfeiture of the Shares and stating
that such Shares are nontransferable until all restrictions have been
satisfied and the legend has been removed.  At the discretion of the
Committee, the grantee may or may not be entitled to full voting and dividend
rights with respect to all shares of Restricted Stock from the date of grant.

      16.2 Cost of Restricted Stock.  Unless otherwise determined by the
           ------------------------
Committee, grants of Shares of Restricted Stock shall be made at a per Share
cost to the Participant equal to par value.

      16.3 Non-Transferability.  Shares of Restricted Stock shall not be
           -------------------
transferable until after the removal of the legend with respect to such
Shares.

      16.4 Performance Shares.  Performance Shares are the right of an
           ------------------
individual to whom a grant of such Shares is made to receive Shares or cash
equal to the Fair Market Value of such

                                    12
<PAGE> 17
Shares at a future date in accordance with the terms and conditions of such
grant. The terms and conditions shall be determined by the Committee, in its
sole discretion, but generally are expected to be based substantially upon the
attainment of targeted profit and/or performance objectives.

      16.5 Grant.  The Committee may grant an award of Performance Shares.
           -----
The number of Performance Shares and the terms and conditions of the grant
shall be set forth in the applicable Agreement.

                                  ARTICLE XVII
                                  ------------

                                  CASH AWARDS
                                  -----------

      17.1 Grant.  The Committee may grant Cash Awards at such times and in
           -----
such amounts as it deems appropriate.

      17.2 Restrictions.  Cash Awards may be subject or not subject to
           ------------
conditions (such as an investment requirement), restricted or nonrestricted,
vested or subject to forfeiture and may be payable currently or in the future
or both.

                                 ARTICLE XVIII
                                 -------------

                  OTHER STOCK BASED AWARDS AND OTHER BENEFITS
                  -------------------------------------------

      18.1 Other Stock Based Awards.  The Committee shall have the right to
           ------------------------
grant Other Stock Based Awards which may include, without limitation, the
grant of Shares based on certain conditions, the payment of cash based on the
performance of the Common Stock, and the grant of securities convertible into
Shares.

      18.2 Other Benefits.  The Committee shall have the right to provide
           --------------
types of Benefits under the Plan in addition to those specifically listed, if
the Committee believes that such Benefits would further the purposes for
which the Plan was established.

                                  ARTICLE XIX
                                  -----------

                            MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
                            ------------------------

      19.1 Underscored References.  The underscored references contained in
           ----------------------
the Plan are included only for convenience, and they shall not be construed
as a part of the Plan or in any respect affecting or modifying its
provisions.

      19.2 Number and Gender.  The masculine and neuter, wherever used in
           -----------------
the Plan, shall refer to either the masculine, neuter or feminine; and,
unless the context otherwise requires, the singular shall include the plural
and the plural the singular.

                                    13
<PAGE> 18

      19.3 Unfunded Status of Plan.  The Plan is intended to constitute an
           -----------------------
"unfunded" plan for incentive and deferred compensation.  With respect to any
payments or deliveries of Shares not yet made to a Participant by the
Company, nothing contained herein shall give any rights that are greater than
those of a general creditor of the Company.  The Committee may authorize the
creation of trusts or other arrangements to meet the obligations created
under the Plan to deliver Shares or payments hereunder consistent with the
foregoing.

      19.4 Termination of Participant Status.  If a person who has been
           ---------------------------------
awarded Benefits ceases to be a Participant (as defined in Section 2.1) for
any reason, except as otherwise provided in an Agreement, all unexercised,
deferred, and unpaid Benefits may be exercisable or paid only in accordance
with rules established by the Committee.  These rules may provide, as the
Committee may deem appropriate, for the expiration, forfeiture, continuation,
or acceleration of the vesting of all or part of the Benefits.

      19.5 Designation of Beneficiary.  A Participant may file with the
           --------------------------
Committee a written designation of a beneficiary or beneficiaries (subject to
such limitations as to the classes and number of beneficiaries and contingent
beneficiaries as the Committee may from time to time prescribe) to exercise,
in the event of the death of the Participant, an Option, or to receive, in
such event, any Benefits.  The Committee reserves the right to review and
approve beneficiary designations.  A Participant may from time to time revoke
or change any such designation of beneficiary and any designation of
beneficiary under the Plan shall be controlling over any other disposition,
testamentary or otherwise; provided, however, that if the Committee shall be
in doubt as to the right of any such beneficiary to exercise any Option or to
receive any Benefit, the Committee may determine to recognize only an
exercise by the legal representative of the recipient, in which case the
Company, the Committee and the members thereof shall not be under any further
liability to anyone.

      19.6 Governing Law.  This Plan shall be construed and administered in
           -------------
accordance with the laws of the State of Missouri.

      19.7 Purchase for Investment.  The Committee may require each person
           -----------------------
purchasing Shares pursuant to a Benefit to represent to and agree with the
Company in writing that such person is acquiring the Shares for investment
and without a view to distribution or resale.  The certificates for such
Shares may include any legend which the Committee deems appropriate to
reflect any restrictions on transfer.  All certificates for Shares delivered
under the Plan shall be subject to such stock-transfer orders and other
restrictions as the Committee may deem advisable under all applicable laws,
rules and regulations, and the Committee may cause a legend or legends to be
put on any such certificates to make appropriate references to such
restrictions.

      19.8 No Employment Contract.  Neither the adoption of the Plan nor any
           ----------------------
Benefit granted hereunder shall confer upon any Employee any right to
continued employment nor shall the Plan or any Benefit interfere in any way
with the right of the Employer to terminate the employment of any of its
Employees at any time.

                                    14
<PAGE> 19

      19.9 No Effect on Other Benefits.  The receipt of Benefits under the
           ---------------------------
Plan shall have no effect on any benefits to which a Participant may be
entitled from the Employer, under another plan or otherwise, or preclude a
Participant from receiving any such benefits.

                                    15

<PAGE> 1


                      CONNING CORPORATION

                NON-QUALIFIED STOCK OPTION AWARD

Name of Option Recipient:  [Name]

      On December --, 1997, the Company awarded you a stock option.  You were
granted an option to buy 1,000 shares of the Company's Common Stock, par
value $.01 per share, at the price of $----- per share.

      You may purchase shares under the option as follows:

      CUMULATIVE
      NUMBER OF                             MAY BE PURCHASED
       SHARES                     NOT BEFORE              NOT AFTER
       ------                     ----------              ---------


         66.67                December --, 1998       December --, 2007
          200                 December --, 1999       December --, 2007
          400                 December --, 2000       December --, 2007
          800                 December --, 2001       December --, 2007
         1,000                December --, 2002       December --, 2007

      This option is not, and will not be treated as, an Incentive Stock
Option under Section 422 of the Code.

      The award of this Option is subject to the closing of the Company's
initial public offering ("IPO") on or before December --, 1997. If the
IPO does not close by such date, this Option shall be null and void and
the Participant shall have no rights hereunder effective December --, 1997.

      IMPORTANT:  By signing below, you agree to be bound by, and
acknowledge receipt of, the attached Terms and Conditions of this stock
option.

Read and agreed                         CONNING CORPORATION
to this ----- day of
December 1997.

- ------------------------                By:---------------------------
                                        Name:


<PAGE> 2



                          TERMS AND CONDITIONS
                          --------------------

            NON-QUALIFIED STOCK OPTION AWARD GRANTED UNDER
            ----------------------------------------------

                          CONNING CORPORATION
                          -------------------

                        1997 FLEXIBLE STOCK PLAN
                        ------------------------

      1.      Definitions
              -----------

(a)     Option               The option granted by the Option Award

(b)     Option Award         The Non-Qualified Stock Option Award to which
                             the Terms and Conditions are attached together
                             with, except where the context requires
                             otherwise, these Terms and Conditions.

(c)     Plan                 The Conning Corporation 1997 Flexible Stock
                             Plan, as amended from time to time.

All capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings
given to such terms by the Plan.

      2.      Evidence of Option Grant and incentive Stock Option
              ---------------------------------------------------

              The Option Award evidences a grant to the Participant of an
Option to purchase that number of shares ("Optioned Shares") of Common Stock,
par value $.01 per share, of the Company ("Stock") set forth on the Option
Award.  The Participant may exercise the Option as shown on the Option Award.
in no event shall the Option or any part of the Option be exercisable after
December ---, 1997 (the "Option Expiration Date").  The Option is a
Non-Qualified Stock Option and is not intended to constitute an "Incentive
Stock Option" as defined in Section 422 of the Code.

      3.      Exercise of Option
              ------------------

              The Option shall be exercised by the Participant delivering a
written notice of exercise to the Company's Secretary or Chief Financial
Officer.  This notice shall specify the number of Optioned Shares the
Participant then desires to purchase.

      4.      Payment of Option Price
              -----------------------

              Payment for the Shares purchased under the Option shall be made
to the Company either:

              (a)    in cash (including cashier's check, bank draft or money
                     order); or



<PAGE> 3

              (b)    by the tender to the Company of shares owned by the
                     Participant and registered in his or her name having a
                     Fair Market Value equal to the amount due to the
                     Company; or

              (c)    in cash, but by means of a so-called "cashless
                     exercise"; or

              (d)    by any combination of the payment methods specified in
                     paragraphs (a) through (c) above.

In addition to the foregoing methods of payment, payment of the Option price
may, at the discretion of the Committee, be made in whole or in part in other
property, rights and credits, including, to the extent permitted by
applicable law, the Participant's promissory note.

      5.      Form of Notice of Exercise
              --------------------------

              The Participant's notice as required by Section 3 shall be
signed by the Participant and shall be in substantially the following form
with appropriate adjustments depending on how the Option price is paid:

              "I hereby exercise my Option to purchase ---------- Shares in
      accordance with my Option Award dated ------------, 19--, granted under
      the Company's 1997 Flexible Stock Plan.

      The aggregate Option price of the Shares I am purchasing is $---------.
      I hereby tender in payment of such price the following:

              (a)  my cashier's check, bank draft or money order made payable
              to the Company in the amount of $----------------; and/or

              (b)  ------- Shares having a Fair Market Value of $----------.

              I have forwarded to you under separate cover a stock power
      (with signature guaranteed) authorizing you to transfer my -------
      Shares as per the requirements of this letter and my Option Award.

              I hereby represent to the Company that I own the ---------
      Shares delivered herewith free and clear of all liens and encumbrances
      and that I have the full and lawful right to transfer such Shares to
      the Company.

              If the Shares purchased have not been registered under the
      Securities Act of 1933, I hereby further represent to the Company that
      I am acquiring the -------- Shares that I am purchasing solely for
      investment and solely for my own account and that I have no present
      intention of selling or offering for sale any of such Shares to any
      other person or persons."



<PAGE> 4

      6.      Stock Certificates
              ------------------

              Upon the exercise of the Option solely for cash or cash and
property (other than Shares), rights and/or credits specifically permitted by
the Committee, the Participant shall be entitled to one stock certificate
evidencing the Shares acquired upon exercise.  However, if the Participant
delivers Shares of the Company when exercising the Option, then the
Participant shall be entitled to two or three certificates.

              If the number of Shares tendered is less than or equal to the
number required to pay for all of the Shares purchased, then the Participant
shall be entitled to receive two certificates.  One certificate shall
represent a number of Shares equal to the number of Shares delivered by the
Participant.  The second certificate shall represent the additional Shares
acquired by the Participant upon the exercise of the Option.

              If the number of Shares tendered is more than the number
required to pay for all of the Shares purchased, then the Participant shall
be entitled to receive three certificates, one for the portion of the number
of Shares purchased which is equal to the number of tendered Shares applied
to exercise the Option, a second for the remainder of the number of Shares
purchased upon exercise of the Option, and a third for the number of Shares
tendered which were not applied to purchase the Shares pursuant to the
Option.

      7.      Legends on Certificates
              -----------------------

              The certificate or certificates to be issued under Section 6
shall be issued as soon as practicable.  Such certificate or certificates
shall contain thereon a legend in substantially the following form if the
Shares evidenced by such certificate have not been registered under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended:

              "The shares represented by this certificate have not been
      registered under the Securities Act of 1933 or any applicable state
      law.  They may not be offered for sale, sold, transferred or pledged
      without (1) registration under the Securities Act of 1933 and any
      applicable state law, or (2) at holder's expense, an opinion
      (satisfactory to the Company) that registration is not required."

The certificates shall also contain such other legends as may be appropriate
or required by law.



<PAGE> 5

      8.      Termination of Employment; Nonassignability
              -------------------------------------------

              8.1    Termination for Cause or Voluntary Quit.  If, on or
                     ---------------------------------------
after the date that the Option shall have first become exercisable, the
Participant's employment shall be terminated for any reason other than as
described in Section 8.3, the Participant shall have the right, within 3
months after such termination (but not later than the Option Expiration
Date), to exercise such Option to the extent that such Option or any
installment thereof shall have accrued at the date of such termination and
shall not have been exercised.  In the event of the Participant's death
during such 3-month (or shorter) period, the provisions of Section 8.4 shall
apply.  For purposes of this Section, termination of a Participant's
employment shall mean the later of the termination of the Participant's
employment with an Employer or the Participant's ceasing to serve as a
director of the Company.

              8.2    Disability.  If, on or after the date that the Option
                     ----------
shall first have become exercisable, the Participant's employment shall be
terminated for disability (as such term is defined at Section 422(c)(6) of
the Code), the Participant shall have the right, within 1 year after such
termination (but not later than the Option Expiration Date), to exercise such
Option to the extent that such Option or any installment thereof shall have
accrued at the date of such termination of employment and shall not have been
exercised.  In the event of Participant's death during such 1-year (or
shorter) period, the provisions of Section 8.4 shall apply.  For purposes of
this Section, termination of a Participant's employment shall mean the later
of the termination of the Participant's employment with an Employer or the
Participant's ceasing to serve as a director of the Company.

              8.3    Retirement.  If the Participant's employment shall be
                     ----------
terminated by the Participant on or after (x) the Participant attains age 65
or (y) the Participant attains age 55 and has at least 10 years of service
with an Employer, then all installments of the Option granted hereunder shall
become immediately exercisable (if not already exercisable), and the
Participant shall have the right, within 3 months after such termination (but
not later than the Option Expiration Date), to exercise such Option to the
extent that such Option or any installment thereof shall not have been
exercised.  In the event of the Participant's death during such 3-month (or
shorter) period, the provisions of Section 8.4 shall apply.  For purposes of
this Section, termination of a Participant's employment shall mean the later
of the termination of the Participant's employment with an Employer or the
Participant's ceasing to serve as a director of the Company.

              8.4    Death.  If a Participant shall die within the 3-month
                     -----
(or shorter) period referred to in Section 8.1 or Section 8.3, the 1-year (or
shorter) period referred to in Section 8.2, or while serving as an employee
of an Employer or a director of the Company on or after the date that the
Option shall have first become exercisable, the beneficiary designed pursuant
to Section 8.6 hereof, or, if no such



<PAGE> 6

designation is in effect, the personal representative of the estate of the
decedent or the person or persons to whom the Option shall have been validly
transferred by such personal representative pursuant to will or the laws of
descent and distribution, shall have the right, within 1 year from the date of
the Participant's death (but no later than the Option Expiration Date), to
exercise the Participant's Option to the extent that such Option or any
installment thereof shall have accrued at the date of death and shall not have
been exercised.  No transfer of the Option shall be effective to bind the
Company unless the Company shall have been furnished with written notice of such
transfer and a copy of the will and/or such other evidence as the Committee may
deem necessary to establish the validity of the transfer.  No transfer shall be
effective without the acceptance by the transferee of the terms and conditions
of such Option.

              8.5    Option Not Vested.  Except as provided in Section 8.3,
                     -----------------
if the Participant's employment shall terminate before the Option shall have
first become exercisable, or before any installment or installments are
exercisable, then the Participant's full interest in the Option or such
installment or installments, as the case may be, shall terminate and all
rights thereunder shall cease.  For purposes of this Section, termination of
a Participant's employment shall mean the later of the termination of the
Participant's employment with an Employer or the Participant's ceasing to
serve as a director of the Company.

              8.6    Non-Transferability of Rights; Designation of
                     ---------------------------------------------
Beneficiaries.  The Option shall not be transferable by the Participant
- -------------
otherwise than by will or the laws of descent and distribution or as provided
in this Section 8.6.  During the lifetime of the Participant the Option shall
be exercisable only by the Participant.

              The Participant, however, may file with the Company a written
designation of a beneficiary or beneficiaries to exercise, in the event of
the Participant's death, the Option granted hereunder, subject to all of the
provisions of the Option Award and these Terms and Conditions, including this
Section 8.  A Participant may from time to time revoke or change any such
designation of beneficiary and any designation of beneficiary under the Plan
shall be controlling over any other disposition, testamentary or otherwise;
provided, however, that if the Committee shall be in doubt as to the right of
any such beneficiary to exercise the Option, the Committee may determine to
recognize only an exercise by the personal representative of the estate of
the Participant, in which case the Company, the Committee and the members
thereof shall not be under any further liability to anyone.

              8.7    Limitation on Extensions.  Certain provisions hereof
                     ------------------------
extend the date by which the Option must otherwise be exercised under the
provisions of Section 1 and the Option Award.



<PAGE> 7

Notwithstanding those provisions herein which otherwise extend the time period
in which the Option must be exercised, no extension may extend the Option later
than the Option Expiration Date.

      9.      Withholding
              -----------

              The Company or any Subsidiary shall have the right to deduct
any sums that federal, state or local tax law requires to be withheld with
respect to the exercise of the Option, or as otherwise may be required by
law.  The Company or any such Subsidiary may require as a condition to
issuing Shares upon the exercise of the Option that the Participant or other
person exercising the Option pay any sum that federal, state or local tax law
requires to be withheld with respect to such exercise.  In the alternative,
the Participant or other person exercising the Option, may elect to pay such
sums to the Company or the Subsidiary by delivering written notice of that
election to the Company's Secretary or Chief Financial Officer prior to or
concurrently with exercise.  There is no obligation that the Participant be
advised of the existence of the tax or the amount which the Company or a
Subsidiary will be so required to withhold.

      10.     Changes in Capital Structure
              ----------------------------

              If there is any change in the Common Stock of the Company by
reason of any stock dividend, spin-off, split-up, spin-out, recapitalization,
merger, consolidation, reorganization, combination or exchange of shares, the
number of SARs and number, kind and class of shares available for Options and
grants of Restricted Stock, Performance Shares and Other Stock Based Awards
and the number, kind or class of Shares subject to outstanding Options, SARs,
grants of Restricted Stock and Performance Shares, and Other Stock Based
Awards, and the price thereof, as applicable, shall be appropriately adjusted
by the Committee.  The issuance of Shares for consideration and the issuance
of Share rights shall not be considered a change in the Company's capital
structure.  No adjustment provided for in this section shall require the
issuance of any fractional shares.

      11.     Plan Controls
              -------------

              The Option Award and these Terms and Conditions are subject to
all terms and provisions of the Plan, which terms and provisions are
incorporated herein by reference.  In the event of any conflict, the Plan
shall control over the Option Award and these Terms and Conditions.


<PAGE> 1



================================================================================


                 CONNING INVESTMENT PARTNERS LIMITED PARTNERSHIP III

                           (A Delaware Limited Partnership
                        Organized to Serve as General Partner
                of Conning Insurance Capital Limited Partnership III
                          and Investment General Partner of
                Conning Insurance Capital International Partners III)

                                AMENDED AND RESTATED
                            LIMITED PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT
                            -----------------------------

                             Dated as of March 18, 1994


================================================================================





THESE SECURITIES ARE SUBJECT TO RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFERABILITY AND RESALE
AND MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED OR RESOLD EXCEPT AS PERMITTED UNDER THE SECURITIES
ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED, AND THE APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS, PURSUANT
TO REGISTRATION OR EXEMPTION THEREFROM AND WITH THE APPROVAL OF THE GENERAL
PARTNER.  INVESTORS SHOULD BE AWARE THAT THEY MAY BE REQUIRED TO BEAR THE
RISKS OF THIS INVESTMENT FOR AN INDEFINITE PERIOD OF TIME.



<PAGE> 2
                CONNING INVESTMENT PARTNERS LIMITED PARTNERSHIP III

                                Amended and Restated
                           Limited Partnership Agreement

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                 Table of Contents
                                 -----------------
<S>                                                                       <C>
                                                                                Page
                                                                                ----
I.     DEFINITIONS                                                                 1

       1.1  Definitions                                                            1

II.    ORGANIZATION                                                                1

       2.1  Continuation of Limited Partnership                                    1
       2.2  Name                                                                   1
       2.3  Address                                                                1
       2.4  Purpose                                                                2
       2.5  Powers                                                                 2

III.   GENERAL PARTNER                                                             2

       3.1  Name, Address and Subscription                                         2
       3.2  Management and Control of the Partnership                              2
       3.3  Powers                                                                 2
       3.4  Certificate of Limited Partnership                                     3
       3.5  Duty of Care                                                           3
       3.6  No Salary                                                              4
       3.7  Tax Matters Partner                                                    5

IV.    LIMITED PARTNERS                                                            5

       4.1  Names, Addresses and Subscriptions                                     5
       4.2  Limited Liability                                                      6
       4.3  No Control of Partnership                                              6
       4.4  Bankruptcy, etc.                                                       6

V.     ADMISSION OF ADDITIONAL LIMITED PARTNERS                                    6

       5.1  Admission of Additional Limited Partners                               6
       5.2  Capital Contribution                                                   6
       5.3  Accession to Agreement                                                 7

VI.    CAPITAL OF THE PARTNERSHIP                                                  7

       6.1  Capita1 Contributions                                                  7
       6.2  No Interest or Withdrawals                                             7

                                    - i -
<PAGE> 3

VII.   ACCOUNTS                                                                    7

       7.1  Capital Accounts                                                       7
       7.2  Accounting for Distributions in Kind                                   7
       7.3  Compliance With Treasury Regulations                                   8

VIII. ALLOCATIONS                                                                  8

       8.1  General                                                                8
       8.2  Net Gain or Loss                                                       8
       8.3  Timing of Allocations on Distributions in Kind                         8
       8.4  Regulatory Allocations                                                 9
       8.5  Adjustments to Reflect Chance in Interests                            11
       8.6  Tax Allocations                                                       11
       8.7  Timing of Allocations                                                 12

IX.    DISTRIBUTIONS                                                              12

       9.1  Timing of Distributions                                               12
       9.2  Tax Distributions                                                     12
       9.3  Additional Distributions                                              13
       9.4  Operational Rules                                                     13
       9.5  Tax Withholding                                                       14
       9.6  Certain Distributions Prohibited                                      14
       9.7  Consent to Distributions                                              14

X.     VALUATION OF PARTNERSHIP ASSETS                                            15

       10.1  Valuation by General Partner                                         15
       10.2  Goodwill                                                             15

XI.    DURATION OF PARTNERSHIP                                                    15

       11.1  Term of Partnership                                                  15
       11.2  Dissolution Upon Withdrawal of General Partner                       15
       11.3  No Dissolution on Events Affecting Limited Partners                  15
       11.4  Extension of Term                                                    15

XII.   LIQUIDATION OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS                                       15

       12.1  General Provisions                                                   15
       12.2  Liquidating Distributions                                            16
       12.3  Expenses of Liquidator(s)                                            16
       12.4  Duration of Liquidation                                              16
       12.5  Duty of Care                                                         16
       12.6  No Liability for Return of Capital                                   17

                                    - ii -
<PAGE> 4

XIII.  LIMITATION ON TRANSFER OF INTERESTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS OR
        RETIRED PARTNERS                                                          17

       13.1  Consent of General Partner to Transfers                              17
       13.2  Opinion of Counsel                                                   17
       13.3  Expenses                                                             17
       13.4  Substitution of Limited Partners or Retired Partners                 18
       13.5  Covenants of Limited Partners and Retired Partners                   18

XIV.   WITHDRAWAL OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS                                        19

       14.1  Withdrawals Generally Prohibited                                     19
       14.2  Withdrawal upon Death, Disability, Bankruptcy or Termination
             of Employment                                                        19

XV.    RETIRED LIMITED PARTNERS                                                   19

       15.1  General                                                              19
       15.2  Adjustments to Reflect Retirement                                    19
       15.3  Retired Partner Participation                                        20

XVI.   LIMITATION ON TRANSFER OF INTEREST OF THE GENERAL PARTNER                  20

XVII.  INDEMNIFICATION                                                            20

       17.1  General Provisions                                                   20
       17.2  Advance Payment of Expenses                                          21
       17.3  Insurance                                                            22
       17.4  Limitation or Expansion by Law                                       22

XVIII. ACCOUNTING, RECORDS AND REPORTS                                            22

       18.1  Fiscal Year                                                          22
       18.2  Keeping of Accounts and Records                                      23
       18.3  Inspection Rights                                                    23
       18.4  Annual Financial Statements                                          23
       18.5  Accounting Method                                                    24

XIX.   WAIVER AND AMENDMENT                                                       24

XX.    GENERAL PROVISIONS                                                         24

       20.1  Notices                                                              24
       20.2  Power of Attorney                                                    24
       20.3  Waiver of Partition                                                  26
       20.4  Additional Documents                                                 26
       20.5  Binding on Successors                                                26
       20.6  Counterparts                                                         26
       20.7  Voting                                                               26
       20.8  Governing Law                                                        26

                                    - iii -
<PAGE> 5
       20.9  Securities Act Matters                                               26
       20.10 Authority of General Partner                                         27
       20.11 Contract Construction                                                27
       20.12 Section Headings                                                     27

Names, Addresses, Subscriptions and Percentage Interests of Partners      Schedule A
Vesting Schedules                                                         Schedule B
General Partner's Intention to Reduce Percentage Interest                 Schedule C
Table of Definitions                                                      Appendix A
</TABLE>

                                     - iv -
<PAGE> 6

                 CONNING INVESTMENT PARTNERS LIMITED PARTNERSHIP III

                                Amended and Restated
                            Limited Partnership Agreement
                            -----------------------------

      AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT, dated as of this
18th day of March, 1994 by and among Conning & Company, a Connecticut
corporation, as general partner (the "General Partner") and any individuals,
firms, corporations, and other entities who are admitted to the limited
partnership formed hereby on or after the effective date of this Agreement
who are listed on Schedule A hereto and who execute a counterpart of this
                  ----------
Agreement as limited partners (such limited partners being referred to herein
as the "Limited Partners").  The General Partner and the Limited Partners are
sometimes referred to herein collectively as the "Partners".

      The General Partner and John B. Clinton formed the Partnership by
executing the Limited Partnership Agreement of Conning Investment Partners
Limited Partnership III, dated as of December 28, 1993 (the "Partnership
Agreement") and by filing with the Secretary of State of Delaware a
Certificate of Limited Partnership on December 28, 1993.

      The Partnerships of the Partnership desire to amend and restate the
Partnership Agreement as hereinafter provided, and in consideration of the
premises and the agreements herein contained and intending to be legally
bound hereby agree that the Partnership Agreement shall be amended and
restated in whole to read as follows:

                              ARTICLE I - DEFINITIONS.
                              -----------------------

      1.1   DEFINITIONS.  Capitalized terms used herein without definitions
            -----------
shall have the meanings assigned to them in Appendix A hereto.
                                            ----------

                             ARTICLE II - ORGANIZATION.
                             -------------------------

      2.1   CONTINUATION OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP.  The Partners agree to carry
            -----------------------------------
on a limited partnership (the "Partnership") subject to the terms of this
Agreement in accordance with the provisions of the Delaware Revised Uniform
Limited Partnership Act, as amended (the "Delaware Act").

      2.2   NAME.  The name of the Partnership is "Conning Investment
            ----
Partners Limited Partnership III"  The General Partner may change the name of
the Partnership to such other name as the General Partner may determine at
any time, upon written notice to all Partners indicating such new name.

                                     - 1 -
<PAGE> 7

      2.3   ADDRESS.  The initial address of the Partnership's registered
            -------
office in Delaware is 32 Loockerman Square, Suite L-130, Dover, County of
Kent, and its initial registered agent at such address for service of process
is The Prentice-Hall Corporation System, Inc.  The initial principal office
of the Partnership shall be located at CityPlace II, 185 Asylum Street,
Hartford, Connecticut 06103-4105.  The General Partner may change the
location of the principal office of the Partnership to such other location
within the United States as the General Partner may determine at any time,
upon written notice to all the Partners indicating the new location of such
principal office.  The General Partner may cause the Partnership to open such
additional offices at such other locations as the General Partner in its sole
discretion may determine.

      2.4   PURPOSE.  The principal purpose of the Partnership is to organize
            -------
and act as the general partner of Conning Insurance Capital Limited
Partnership III (the "Domestic Fund"), a Delaware limited partnership, and as
Investment General Partner of Conning Insurance Capital International
Partners III, a Cayman Islands limited partnership (the "Offshore Fund"); the
Domestic Fund and the Offshore Fund are each referred to as a "Fund" and
collectively referred to as the "Funds") and in furtherance thereof to engage
in any lawful act or activity for which limited partnerships may be organized
under the laws of the State of Delaware.

      2.5   POWERS.  Subject to all of the terms and provisions hereof, the
            ------
Partnership shall have all the powers available to it as a limited
partnership under the laws of the State of Delaware.

                           ARTICLE III - GENERAL PARTNER.
                           -----------------------------

      3.1   NAME, ADDRESS AND SUBSCRIPTION.  The name and address of the
            ------------------------------
General Partner, its Subscription and its percentage interest in certain
Partnership allocations to be made hereunder ("Percentage Interest") are set
forth in Schedule A.  Schedule A shall be amended from time to time, without
         ----------   ----------
the consent of any Partner, to reflect any changes in the Subscription of the
General Partner occurring pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement.

      3.2   MANAGEMENT AND CONTROL OF THE PARTNERSHIP.  Subject to the
            -----------------------------------------
provisions of this Agreement, the management, policies and control of the
Partnership shall be vested exclusively in the General Partner.  Limited
Partners may, to the extent expressly provided in this Agreement, possess or
exercise any of the powers, or have or act in any of the capacities,
permitted under Section 17-303(b) of the Delaware Act for limited partners
who are deemed thereby not to participate in the control of the affairs of a
limited partnership.

                                    - 2 -
<PAGE> 8

      3.3   POWERS.  Subject to the provisions of this Agreement, the General
            ------
Partner shall have the power on behalf and in the name of the Partnership to
carry out and implement any and all of the purposes of the Partnership set
forth in Section 2.4 and to exercise any of the powers of the Partnership set
forth in Section 2.5, including, without limitation, the power to:

            (a)   open, maintain and close accounts with brokers and give
instructions or directions in connection therewith;

            (b)   open, maintain and close bank accounts and draw checks or
other orders for the payment of money;

            (c)   receive, receipt for and dispose of and deal in all
securities, checks, money and other assets or liabilities of the Partnership;

            (d)   hire employees or retain investment bankers, attorneys,
accountants, consultants, custodians, contractors and other agents, and pay
them compensation;

            (e)   execute on behalf of the Partnership, as general partner of
the Fund, any agreement between the Partnership and the Fund or any amendment
or termination thereof;

            (f)   enter into, make and perform such contracts, agreements and
other undertakings, and do any and all such other acts required of the
Partnership or the Fund with respect to the Partnership's or the Fund's
interest in any corporation, partnership, limited partnership, trust,
association or other entity or activity, including but not limited to
entering into agreements with respect to such interests, which agreements may
contain such terms, conditions and provisions as the General Partner in its
sole discretion shall approve;

            (g)   make all elections for the Partnership that are permitted
under tax or other applicable laws, including, without limitation, an
election under Section 754 of the Code; and

            (h)   maintain one or more offices within or without the State of
Connecticut and in connection therewith rent or acquire office space and do
such other acts as may be advisable in connection with the maintenance of
such offices; provided, however, that maintaining such offices, renting or
acquiring office space and doing any such other acts shall not affect the
limited liability of the Limited Partners as set forth in Section 4.2 hereof.

      3.4   CERTIFICATE OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP.  The General Partner shall
            ----------------------------------
file for record with the appropriate public authorities and, if required,
publish the Certificate of Limited Partnership of the Partnership and any
amendments thereto, and

                                    - 3 -
<PAGE> 9
shall take all such other action as may be required to preserve the limited
liability of the Limited Partners in any jurisdiction in which the
Partnership shall conduct its activities.

      3.5   DUTY OF CARE.  The General Partner shall exercise its best
            ------------
judgment in conducting the Partnership's operations and in performing its
other duties hereunder.  The General Partner shall not incur any liability to
the Partnership, any Partner or any other Person for any loss suffered by the
Partnership or such other Partner or Person which arises out of any action or
omission of the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner
assisting the General Partner, at the General Partner's request, in
performing the General Partner's duties hereunder, provided that (a) the
General Partner or such Affiliate of the General Partner acted in good faith
and in a manner such Person reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed to,
the best interests of the Partnership and, with respect to any criminal
action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe such Person's
conduct was unlawful, and (b) such course of conduct did not constitute gross
negligence or willful misconduct of the General Partner or such Affiliate of
the General Partner.  No Affiliate of the General Partner shall incur any
liability to the Partnership, any Partner or any other Person for any loss
suffered by the Partnership or such other Partner or Person which arises out
of any action or omission of the General Partner, or out of any action or
omission of such Affiliate of the General Partner taken or suffered by such
Affiliate of the General Partner in the course of providing assistance to the
General Partner at the General Partner's request, provided that (1) such
Affiliate of the General Partner acted in good faith and in a manner such
Affiliate of the General Partner reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed
to, the best interests of the Partnership and, with respect to any criminal
action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe such Person's
conduct was unlawful, and (2) such course of conduct did not constitute gross
negligence or willful misconduct of such Affiliate of the General Partner.
No Affiliate of the General Partner shall be liable for any action taken or
omitted by any other Affiliate of the General Partner unless such action or
omission was taken or suffered by such other Affiliate of the General Partner
while acting as an agent of such Affiliate of the General Partner and, with
respect to such action or omission, such other Affiliate of the General
Partner did not satisfy the requirements of clauses (1) and (2) of the
preceding sentence.  Neither the General Partner nor any Affiliate of the
General Partner shall be liable for the negligence, whether of omission or
commission, dishonesty or bad faith of any employee, broker or other agent of
the Partnership selected by the General Partner with reasonable care.  The
General Partner and each Affiliate of the General Partner shall be fully
protected and justified with respect to any action or omission taken or
suffered by any of them in good faith if such action or omission is taken or
suffered in reliance upon and in accordance with the opinion or

                                    -4 -
<PAGE> 10
advice as to matters of law of legal counsel, or as to matters of accounting of
accountants, selected by any of them with reasonable care.  In addition, the
General Partner and each of its Affiliates shall be entitled to indemnification
by the Partnership to the extent provided in Article XVII hereof.

      3.6   NO SALARY.  The General Partner shall receive no salary or other
            ---------
compensation from the Partnership, but shall be entitled to its share of
allocations and distributions made by the Partnership determined in the
manner set forth herein.

      3.7   TAX MATTERS PARTNER.  The tax matters partner, as defined in
            -------------------
Section 6231 of the Code, of the Partnership shall be the General Partner
(the "Tax Matters Partner").  The Tax Matters Partner shall not resign as Tax
Matters Partner unless, on the effective date of such resignation, the
Partnership has designated another general partner as Tax Matters Partner and
that general partner has given its consent in writing to its appointment as
Tax Matters Partner.  The Tax Matters Partner shall receive no additional
compensation from the Partnership for its services in that capacity, but all
expenses incurred by the Tax Matters Partner in such capacity shall be borne
by the Partnership.  The Tax Matters Partner is authorized to employ such
accountants, attorneys and agents as it, in its sole discretion, determines
are necessary to or useful in the performance of its duties.  Any Person who
serves as Tax Matters Partner shall not be liable to the Partnership or to
any Partner for any action it takes or fails to take as Tax Matters Partner
with respect to any administrative or judicial proceeding involving
"partnership items" (as defined in Section 6231 of the Code) of the
Partnership, unless such action or failure to act constitutes a violation of
the General Partner's duty of care set forth in Section 3.5.

                           ARTICLE IV - LIMITED PARTNERS.
                           -----------------------------

      4.1   NAMES, ADDRESSES AND SUBSCRIPTIONS.  The names and addresses of
            ----------------------------------
the Limited Partners and their respective Subscriptions and Percentage
Interests are set forth in the supplements referred to on Schedule A.
                                                          ----------
Schedule A and the supplements shall be amended from time to time, without
- ----------
the consent of any Partner, to reflect any changes in the identity,
Subscriptions or Percentage Interests of the Limited Partners occurring
pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.  The General Partner may, without
the consent of any Partner, at any time or from time to time increase the
Percentage Interest of any Limited Partner by reduction of the General
Partner's Percentage Interest.  In addition, on one or more occasions on or
before January 25, 1998, in connection with the admission of any new Limited
Partner(s), the General Partner may reduce the Percentage Interest of any
Limited Partner or Retired Partner (which reductions shall be done on a pro
rata basis as to all Limited Partners and Retired Partners on each occasion,
subject to a

                                    - 5 -
<PAGE> 11
lesser reduction in the case of a particular Limited Partner due to the
limitation set forth below on the maximum amount by which any Limited Partner's
or Retired Partner's Percentage Interest may be reduced) and reallocate such
reduction amounts to such new Limited Partner(s), with the maximum reduction for
any Limited Partner or Retired Partner being ten percent (10%) of the total
maximum Percentage Interest held by such Limited Partner or Retired Partner at
such time, after reducing such ten percent (10%) amount by all previous
reductions pursuant to this provision.  It is the intent of the General Partner
to reduce its Percentage Interest (and to correspondingly increase the
Percentage Interest of the Limited Partners in the aggregate) to 40% by January
31, 1997, according to Schedule C.

      4.2   LIMITED LIABILITY.  The liability of each of the Limited Partners
            -----------------
to the Partnership shall be limited to the sum of (1) any unpaid capital
contributions which it agreed to make to the Partnership, to the extent
provided in Section 17-502(b) of the Delaware Act; and (2) any distribution
which such Limited Partner is required to return to the Partnership pursuant
to Section 17-607(b) of the Delaware Act.

      4.3   NO CONTROL OF PARTNERSHIP.  No Limited Partner, in his capacity
            -------------------------
as such, shall take any part in the control of the affairs of the
Partnership, or undertake any activities on behalf of the Partnership, or
have any power to sign for or to bind the Partnership.

      4.4   BANKRUPTCY, ETC.  The bankruptcy, liquidation, dissolution, death
            ----------------
or incompetency of a Limited Partner shall not result in the termination of
the Partnership, but the rights of such Limited Partner under this Agreement
shall accrue to such Limited Partner's successor or estate.

                ARTICLE V - ADMISSION OF ADDITIONAL LIMITED PARTNERS.
                ----------------------------------------------------

      5.1   ADMISSION OF ADDITIONAL LIMITED PARTNERS.
            ----------------------------------------

            (a)   The General Partner may admit to the Partnership one or
more additional Limited Partners.

            (b)   Upon the admission of an additional Limited Partner, the
General Partner shall (1) determine the Percentage Interest and Subscription
of such additional Limited Partner and (2) cause the General Partner's
Percentage Interest to be reduced to reflect the Percentage Interest
allocated to the additional Limited Partner or make such other adjustments to
the Percentage Interests of the Partners as the General Partner, with the
consent of each affected Limited Partner, shall determine.

      5.2   CAPITAL CONTRIBUTION.  Upon the admission of any new Limited
            --------------------
Partner, such new Limited Partner shall make a capital contribution to the
Partnership in the amount equal to its Subscription.

                                    - 6 -
<PAGE> 12

      5.3   ACCESSION TO AGREEMENT.  Each Person who is to be admitted as an
            ----------------------
additional Limited Partner shall accede to this Agreement by executing,
together with the General Partner, an amendment to this Agreement providing
for such admission.  In addition, the General Partner shall execute, file
and, where necessary, record any required amendments to the Partnership's
Certificate of Limited Partnership.  The admission of additional Limited
Partners to the Partnership shall be effective upon the execution of the
necessary amendment to this Agreement or such later effective date as is set
forth in such amendment.

                      ARTICLE VI - CAPITAL OF THE PARTNERSHIP.
                      ---------------------------------------

      6.1   CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS.  The General Partner shall make capital
            ---------------------
contributions to the Partnership as and when required to permit the
Partnership to satisfy its obligations as General Partner or Investment
General Partner of the Domestic Fund and Offshore Fund, respectively.  Each
Limited Partner shall make capital contributions equal in amount to its
Subscription upon his, her or its admission to the Partnership.

      6.2   NO INTEREST OR WITHDRAWALS.  No interest shall accrue on any
            --------------------------
capital contribution made by a Partner, and no Partner shall have the right
to withdraw or to be repaid any of his capital contributions so made, except
as specifically provided in this Agreement.

                               ARTICLE VII - ACCOUNTS.
                               ----------------------

      7.1   CAPITAL ACCOUNTS.  There shall be established on the books of the
            ----------------
Partnership a capital account ("Capital Account") for each Partner that shall
consist of such Partner's initial capital contribution to the Partnership,
(a) increased by (i) any additional capital contributions made by such
Partner to the Partnership and (ii) any amounts from time to time added to
the Capital Account of such Partner pursuant to Article VIII; and (b)
decreased by (i) any distributions made to such Partner and (ii) any amounts
from time to time subtracted from the Capital Account of such Partner
pursuant to Article VIII.

      7.2   ACCOUNTING FOR DISTRIBUTIONS IN KIND.  For purposes of
            ------------------------------------
maintaining Capital Accounts when Partnership property is distributed in
kind, (a) the Partnership shall treat such property as if it had been sold
for its fair market value on the date of distribution as determined in
accordance with Article X hereof; (b) any difference between the fair market
value of such property as so determined and the Cost of such property shall
constitute Net Gain or Loss and shall be allocated to the Capital Accounts of
the Partners pursuant to Section 8.3(a), and (c) all property distributed in
kind by the Partnership to a Partner shall be debited to that Partner's
Capital Account at the fair market value of such property on the date of
distribution (net of any liabilities secured by such distributed property
that such

                                    - 7 -
<PAGE> 13
Partner is considered to assume or take subject to under Section 752 of the
Code).

      7.3   COMPLIANCE WITH TREASURY REGULATIONS.  The foregoing provisions
            ------------------------------------
and the other provisions of this Agreement relating to the maintenance of
Capital Accounts are intended to comply with Section 704(b) of the Code and
Treasury Regulations Section 1.704-l(b), and shall be interpreted and applied
in a manner consistent with such regulations.  If the General Partner shall
determine that it is prudent to modify the manner in which the Capital
Accounts, or any debits or credits thereto, are computed in order to comply
with such regulations, the General Partner may make such modification,
provided the General Partner reasonably determines such modification is not
likely to have a material effect on the amounts distributable to any Partner
pursuant to Articles IX or XII hereof.

                             ARTICLE VIII - ALLOCATIONS.
                             --------------------------

      8.1   GENERAL.  Partnership income, gain, loss, deductions and expenses
            -------
shall be allocated to the Capital Accounts of the Partners in accordance with
this Article VIII.

      8.2   NET GAIN OR LOSS.  (a) As of the end of each year of the
            ----------------
Partnership, and after giving effect to the allocations set forth in Sections
8.3, 8.4 and 8.6(b), the Net Gain or Loss of the Partnership for such fiscal
period shall be allocated as follows:

            (a)   All Net Gain or Loss attributable to allocations made by
the Fund to the Partnership in its capacity as general partner of the Fund:

                  (i)   which are made with respect to the capital contribution
      of the Partnership to the Fund shall be allocated to the General Partner;
      and

                  (ii)  which are made other than with respect to the capital
      contribution of the Partnership to the Fund (e.g., the Partnership's
      "carried interest" in the profits or losses or net profits or losses of
      the Fund) shall be allocated among the Partners in proportion to their
      respective Percentage Interests.

            (b)   All Short-Term Income shall be allocated to the General
Partner.

            (c)   All other Net Gain or Loss of the Partnership shall be
allocated to all Partners in proportion to their respective Percentage
Interests.

      8.3   TIMING OF ALLOCATIONS ON DISTRIBUTIONS IN KIND.  Any Net Gain or
            ----------------------------------------------
Loss of the Partnership that is attributable to a

                                    - 8 -
<PAGE> 14
distribution of property in kind by the Partnership or the Fund shall be
allocated as follows (subject to the remainder of this Article VIII):

            (a)   Net Gain or Loss of the Partnership attributable to amounts
allocated by the Fund to the Partnership in its capacity as the general
partner of the Fund as a result of distributions in kind of Fund property
shall be allocated to all Partners, at the time such allocations are made by
the Fund, on the same basis that an equivalent amount of Net Gain or Loss
attributable to Fund allocations would be allocated by the Partnership for a
hypothetical fiscal year ending immediately prior to the distribution in kind
by the Fund that gave rise to such Net Gain or Loss.

            (b)   Net Gain or Loss resulting pursuant to Section 7.2 from the
distribution by the Partnership of its property in kind shall be allocated to
all Partners, immediately prior to the time such distribution is made, on the
same basis that an equivalent amount of Net Gain or Loss not attributable to
Fund allocations would be allocated for a hypothetical fiscal year ending
immediately prior to the distribution in kind that gave rise to such Net Gain
or Loss.

            (c)   For purposes of applying the loss allocation limitations of
Section 8.4 in the case of an allocation of Net Gain or Loss pursuant to
subsections (a) or (b) above for a hypothetical fiscal year, the actual
balances in the Partners' Capital Accounts shall be adjusted to reflect prior
distributions in kind made during such hypothetical fiscal year by the Fund
or the Partnership, but not any realized gains or losses of the Partnership
for such hypothetical fiscal year.

      8.4   REGULATORY ALLOCATIONS.  The following provisions are included in
            ----------------------
order to comply with tax rules set forth in the Code and to permit the
Partnership to obtain the benefits of a "safe harbor" provided by Treasury
Regulation Section 1.704--1(b)(2)(ii)(d).
                                      -

            (a)   If and to the extent that any allocation of Net Loss,
Issuance Items or other items of loss, expense (or portion thereof) to any
Partner would cause such Partner's Capital Account to be negative by an
amount which exceeds such Partner's Restoration Amount or would further
reduce a balance in such Partner's Capital Account that is already negative
by an amount which exceeds such Partner's Restoration Amount, then such loss,
expense or charge (or portion thereof) shall be allocated first to the
Capital Accounts of the other Partners in proportion to the positive balances
in their respective Capital Accounts until all such Capital Accounts are
reduced to zero, then to the Capital Accounts of Partners with Restoration
Amounts, in proportion to their respective Restoration Amounts, until each
such Partner's Capital Account is negative by an amount equal to

                                    - 9 -
<PAGE> 15
such Partner's Restoration Amount, and then to the Capital Account of the
General Partner; provided that an allocation pursuant to this Section 8.4(a)
shall be made only if and to the extent that such Partner would have an Capital
Account that is negative by an amount which exceeds such Partner's Restoration
Amount after all allocations provided for in this Article VIII have been made
tentatively as if this Section 8.4 were not included in this Agreement.

            (b)   If any Partner unexpectedly receives an adjustment,
allocation or distribution described in Treasury Regulation Section
1.704-l(b)(2)(ii)(d)(4), (5) or (6), and such adjustment, allocation or
                  -  -    -      -
distribution causes such Partner to have a deficit balance in such Partner's
Capital Account, there shall be allocated to such Partner items of income and
gain (consisting of a pro rata portion of each item of Partnership income,
                      --- ----
including gross income, and gain for such fiscal period) in an amount and
manner sufficient to eliminate such Partner's deficit Capital Account
balance, to the extent required by Treasury Regulation Section
1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d), as quickly as possible, provided that an allocation
                  -
pursuant to this Section 8.4(b) shall be made only if and to the extent that
such Partner would have a negative Capital Account after all allocations
provided for in this Section 8.4 have been made tentatively as if this Section
8.4(b) were not included in this Agreement.  The foregoing sentence is intended
to constitute a "qualified income offset" provision as described in Treasury
Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d), and shall be interpreted and applied in
                                     -
all respects in accordance with that Section.

            (c)   In the event that any Partner has a negative Capital
Account at the end of any Partnership fiscal year which is in excess of such
Partner's Restoration Amount, there shall be allocated to such Partner items
of Partnership income (including gross income) and gain in the amount of such
excess as quickly as possible, provided that an allocation pursuant to this
Section 8.4(c) shall be made only if and to the extent that the deficit in
such Partner's Capital Account would exceed such Partner's Restoration Amount
after all allocations provided for in this Article VIII have been made
tentatively as if Section 8.4(b) hereof and this Section 8.4(c) were not
included in this Agreement.

            (d)   To the extent that an adjustment to the adjusted tax basis
of any Partnership asset pursuant to Section 743(b) of the Code is required,
pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(m), to be taken
                                                          -
into account is determining Capital Accounts, the amount of such adjustment
to the Capital Accounts shall be treated as an item of gain (if the
adjustment increases the basis of the asset) or loss (if the adjustment
decreases such basis) and such gain or loss shall be specially allocated to
the Partners in a manner consistent with the manner in which their Capital
Accounts are required to be adjusted pursuant to such Section of the
Regulations.

                                    - 10 -
<PAGE> 16

            (e)   The allocations set forth in Sections 8.4(a), 8.4(b),
8.4(c) and 8.4(d) hereof (the "Regulatory Allocations") are intended to
comply with certain requirements of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-l(b).
Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Article VIII (other than the
Regulatory Allocations), the Regulatory Allocations shall be taken into
account in allocating subsequent Net Gain, Net Loss, Issuance Items and items
of income, gain, loss and deduction among the Partners so that, to the extent
possible, the net amount of such allocations of subsequent Net Gain, Net
Loss, Issuance Items and other items and the Regulatory Allocations to each
Partner shall be equal to the net amount that would have been allocated to
each such Partner pursuant to the provisions of this Article VIII if the
Regulatory Allocations had not occurred.

                  For purposes of applying the foregoing sentence,
allocations pursuant to this Section 8.4(e) shall be made with respect to
allocations pursuant to Section 8.4(d) only to the extent the General Partner
reasonably determines that such allocations will otherwise be inconsistent
with the economic agreement among the Partners.

            (f)   If the Partnership, in its capacity as general partner of
the Fund, receives any special allocations from the Fund pursuant to certain
provisions of the Fund Partnership Agreements dealing with certain
"extraordinary allocations", the General Partner, after consulting with the
Partnership's accountants and other advisors, shall allocate such amounts
among the Partners in a manner consistent with the economic arrangements
among the Partners and the purpose of such provisions.

      8.5   ADJUSTMENTS TO REFLECT CHANGE IN INTERESTS.  Notwithstanding the
            ------------------------------------------
foregoing, with respect to any fiscal period during which any Partner's
interest in the Partnership changes, whether by reason of the admission of a
Partner, the withdrawal of a Partner, a non-pro rata contribution of capital
                                            --- ----
to the Partnership or any other event described in Section 706(d)(1) of the
Code and regulations issued thereunder, allocations of Net Gain or Loss shall
be adjusted appropriately to take into account the varying interests of the
Partners during such period.  The General Partner shall consult with the
Partnership's accountants and other advisors and shall select the method of
making such adjustments, which method shall be used consistently thereafter.

      8.6   TAX ALLOCATIONS.
            ---------------

            (a)   For federal, state and local income tax purposes,
Partnership income, gain, loss, deduction or credit (or any item thereof) for
each fiscal year shall be allocated to and among the Partners in order to
reflect the allocations made pursuant to the provisions of this Article VIII
for such fiscal year (other than allocations of items which are not
deductible or

                                    - 11 -
<PAGE> 17
are excluded from taxable income), taking into account any variation between the
adjusted tax basis and book value of Partnership property in accordance with the
principles of Section 704(c) of the Code.

            (b)   Any income, gain, loss or deduction realized as a direct or
indirect result of the issuance of a Partnership interest by the Partnership
to a Partner, the issuance to the Partnership of an interest in the Fund or
changes during the term of the Partnership in any Partner's Percentage
Interest or Subscription ("Issuance Items") shall be allocated among the
Partners so that, to the extent possible, the net amount of such Issuance
Items, together with all other allocations under this Agreement to each
Partner, shall be equal to the net amount that would have been allocated to
each such Partner if the Issuance Items had not been realized.  Issuance
Items allocated to any Partner shall be added to such Partner's Capital
Account if such items constitute income or gain, and shall be subtracted from
that Capital Account if such items constitute losses or expenses.

      8.7   TIMING OF ALLOCATIONS.  The General Partner, in its sole
            ---------------------
discretion, may cause the Partnership to make the allocations described in
this Article VIII (other than allocations for tax purposes pursuant to
Section 8.6) as of a time other than the end of a fiscal quarter on the basis
of an interim closing of the Partnership's books at such time, but only if a
Fund makes such interim allocations.  In such event, each short fiscal period
attributable to any such interim closing shall constitute a fiscal quarter
for purposes of this Article VIII.

                             ARTICLE IX - DISTRIBUTIONS.
                             --------------------------

      9.1   TIMING OF DISTRIBUTIONS.  The Partnership intends to distribute
            -----------------------
promptly to the Partners all cash and other property it receives in
distributions from the Fund or any other source; provided, however, that the
                                                 --------  -------
General Partner may defer any such distribution to provide for liabilities or
obligations of the Partnership or to establish appropriate reserves.

      9.2   TAX DISTRIBUTIONS.
            -----------------

            (a)   The Partnership intends to distribute to the Partners, as
it is received, the amount ("Tax Distribution") of any distribution received
from the Funds as a tax distribution.  Such distribution shall be made to the
Partners in amounts which would enable the Partners to satisfy their
respective tax liabilities, assuming for this purpose that all Partners are
subject to the highest rate of tax that may be applicable to any Partner, as
determined by the General Partner in consultation with accountants to the
Partnership.

                                    - 12 -
<PAGE> 18

            (b)   Notwithstanding the foregoing, (i) amounts otherwise
distributable to any Partner as Tax Distributions with respect to any taxable
year shall be reduced (but not below zero) by any other distributions made by
the Partnership to such Partner during such fiscal year; and (ii) the
aggregate amount of distributions that otherwise would be made pursuant to
this Section 9.2 with respect to any taxable year shall be reduced or
eliminated to the extent determined by the General Partner pursuant to the
proviso to Section 9.1.
- -------

            (c)   To the extent the Partnership receives from the Funds any
amounts which are treated under the Fund Partnership Agreements as an advance
against tax distributions to permit the Partners of the Partnership to make
estimated tax payments, such amounts, when received by the Partners, shall
similarly be treated as advances against Tax Distributions, and shall be
subject to return by the Partners to the Partnership to the extent such
advances are determined by the General Partner to have been excessive upon
calculation at the end of the fiscal year of the correct amount of tax
distributions to be made by the Funds to the Partnership and Tax
Distributions to be made by the Partnership to its Partners.

      9.3   ADDITIONAL DISTRIBUTIONS.  All additional distributions, other
            ------------------------
than Liquidating Distributions, shall be made as follows:

            (a)   As long as any Partner has a positive balance in his
Capital Account, all cash or property received during the fiscal year by the
Partnership which is attributable to cumulative Net Gain (e.g., in excess of
prior Net Loss) or Short-Term Income that have been allocated in accordance
with Article VIII shall be distributed to the extent possible to the Partners
in proportion to the respective allocations of each such item under Article
VIII.  Cash or property received which is not attributable to Net Gain or
Short-Term Income shall be distributed to the Partners in proportion to their
respective Capital Accounts.

            (b)   If no Partner has a positive balance in his Capital
Account, distributions shall be made to all Partners in proportion to their
respective Percentage Interests.

      9.4   OPERATIONAL RULES.
            -----------------

            (a)   For purposes of Section 9.3, the Capital Account balances
of the Partners shall be adjusted, prior to determining the amount of any
distribution provided for therein, to reflect all prior Partnership
distributions and all distributions made contemporaneously with the
distributions provided for in Section 9.3, as well as all Partnership Net
Gain or Net Loss attributable to any distributions previously or
contemporaneously made in kind.

                                    - 13 -
<PAGE> 19

            (b)   The valuation of securities distributed in kind shall be
made in the manner provided in Article X.  Each class of securities to be
distributed in kind shall be distributed to the Partners in proportion to
their respective shares of the entire amount to be distributed (determined as
provided in Section 9.3 or, with respect to Liquidating Distributions,
Section 12.2), except to the extent that a disproportionate distribution of
such securities is necessary in order to avoid distributing fractional
shares.  For purposes of the preceding sentence, each lot of stock or other
securities having a separately identifiable tax basis or holding period shall
be treated as a separate class of securities.

      9.5   TAX WITHHOLDING.  If the Partnership incurs a tax withholding
            ---------------
obligation with respect to any Partner, any amount required to be withheld by
the Partnership with respect to such Partner shall be treated for all
purposes of this Agreement as if it had been transferred to such Partner by
the Partnership as an interest-free advance.  Amounts treated as advanced to
any Partner pursuant to this Section 9.5 shall be repaid by such Partner to
the Partnership within thirty (30) days after the Partnership delivers a
written request to such Partner for such repayment; provided, however, that
                                                    --------  -------
if any such repayment is not made, the Partnership shall collect such unpaid
amounts from any Partnership distributions that otherwise would be made to
such Partner.  Any part of such withheld amount not collected by the
Partnership from such distributions shall be charged to such Partner's
Capital Account at such time as the General Partner in its sole discretion
shall determine, but in no event later than the time immediately preceding
the Partnership's final Liquidating Distribution to such Partner.

      9.6   CERTAIN DISTRIBUTIONS PROHIBITED.  Anything in this Article IX to
            --------------------------------
the contrary notwithstanding, all Partnership distributions shall be subject
to the following limitations:

            (a)   No distribution shall be made to any Partner if, and to the
extent that, such distribution would not be permitted under Section 17-607(a)
of the Delaware Act.

            (b)   No distribution other than a Tax Distribution shall be made
to any Partner to the extent that such distribution, if made, would cause the
deficit balance, if any, in the Capital Account of such Partner (determined
without regard to any allocations made pursuant to Section 8.4(c)) to exceed
such Partner's Restoration Amount.

      9.7   CONSENT TO DISTRIBUTIONS.  Each Partner, by becoming a Partner,
            ------------------------
consents to any such distribution hereafter made or omitted to be made to the
Partners or any of them in accordance with this Article IX.

                                    - 14 -
<PAGE> 20

                    ARTICLE X - VALUATION OF PARTNERSHIP ASSETS.
                    -------------------------------------------

      10.1  VALUATION BY GENERAL PARTNER.  Whenever valuation of Partnership
            ----------------------------
assets or net assets is required by this Agreement, the fair market value of
such assets shall be determined by the General Partner in good faith.

      10.2  GOODWILL.  The Partnership's name and goodwill shall, as among
            --------
the Partners, be deemed to have no value and shall belong to the Partnership
or any successor thereof, and no Partner shall have any right or claim
individually to the use thereof.  Upon termination of the Partnership, all
rights to the name of the Partnership and any goodwill associated with that
name shall be assigned to the General Partner.

                        ARTICLE XI - DURATION OF PARTNERSHIP.
                        ------------------------------------

      11.1  TERM OF PARTNERSHIP.  The Partnership shall continue until
            -------------------
December 31, 2003, unless extended as provided in Section 11.4, or unless
sooner dissolved as provided in Sections 11.2 or 11.3 or by operation of law.

      11.2  DISSOLUTION UPON WITHDRAWAL OF GENERAL PARTNER.  The Partnership
            ----------------------------------------------
shall be dissolved upon the occurrence with respect to a General Partner of
any of the "events of withdrawal" described in Section 17-402 of the Delaware
Act, provided, that the Partnership shall not be dissolved and the business
of the Partnership shall continue to be carried on if there is at least one
remaining general partner, and, provided, further, that the Partnership shall
not be dissolved if all the Limited Partners agree in writing to continue the
business of the Partnership and appoint one or more Persons to be the general
partner in accordance with Section 17-801 of the Delaware Act.

      11.3  NO DISSOLUTION ON EVENTS AFFECTING LIMITED PARTNERS.  The
            ---------------------------------------------------
Partnership shall not be dissolved in the event of the dissolution, death,
bankruptcy, substitution or admission of any Limited Partner.

      11.4  EXTENSION OF TERM.  It is contemplated by the Partners that the
            -----------------
term of the Partnership shall terminate on December 31, 2003, unless sooner
terminated pursuant to Section 11.2 or by operation of law.  Notwithstanding
the foregoing, the term of the Partnership shall be extended for up to two
additional one-year periods if the term of either Fund is similarly extended
pursuant to its Fund Partnership Agreement.

                 ARTICLE XII - LIQUIDATION OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS.
                 --------------------------------------------------

      12.1  GENERAL PROVISIONS.  At dissolution, the Partnership shall be
            ------------------
liquidated in an orderly manner.  The General Partner shall be the liquidator
to wind up the affairs of the Partnership pursuant to this Agreement;
provided that, if

                                    - 15 -
<PAGE> 21
there shall be no remaining general partner at that time, 66-2/3% in interest of
the Limited Partners may designate one or more other persons to act as the
liquidator(s).  Any such liquidator, other than the General Partner, shall be a
"liquidating trustee" within the meaning of Section 17-101(8) of the Delaware
Act.

      12.2  LIQUIDATING DISTRIBUTIONS.  The liquidator(s) shall satisfy or
            -------------------------
provide for the satisfaction of the Partnership's liabilities and obligations
to creditors.  Any Net Gain or Loss realized in connection with the
liquidation of the Partnership shall be allocated among the Partners pursuant
to Article VIII, and the remaining assets of the Partnership shall then be
distributed to the Partners in proportion to the positive balances in their
respective Capital Accounts (and, if a distribution in kind is to be made,
after allocating any Net Gain or Loss attributable to such distribution).  In
performing their duties, the liquidator(s) are authorized to sell, exchange
or otherwise dispose of the assets of the Partnership in such reasonable
manner as the liquidator(s) shall determine to be in the best interest of the
Partners.  During the liquidation of the Partnership, the liquidators(s)
shall furnish to the Partners the financial statements and other information
specified in Article XVIII.

      12.3  EXPENSES OF LIQUIDATOR(S).  The expenses incurred by the
            -------------------------
liquidator(s) in connection with winding up the Partnership, all other losses
or liabilities of the Partnership incurred in accordance with the terms of
this Agreement, and reasonable compensation for the services of the
liquidator(s) shall be borne by the Partnership.

      12.4  DURATION OF LIQUIDATION.  A reasonable time shall be allowed for
            -----------------------
the winding up of the affairs of the Partnership in order to minimize any
losses otherwise attendant upon such a winding up, provided that the
liquidator(s) shall use their best efforts to carry out the liquidation in
conformity with the timing requirements of Treasury Regulation Section
1.704-l(b)(2)(ii)(g).
                  -

      12.5  DUTY OF CARE.  The liquidator(s) shall not be liable to any
            ------------
Partner for any loss attributable to any act or omission of the liquidator(s)
taken in good faith in connection with the liquidation of the Partnership and
distribution of its assets.  The liquidator(s) may consult with counsel and
accountants with respect to liquidating the Partnership and distributing its
assets and shall be justified in acting or omitting to act in accordance with
the advice or opinion of such counsel or accountants, provided they shall
have been selected with reasonable care.

                                    - 16 -
<PAGE> 22

      12.6  NO LIABILITY FOR RETURN OF CAPITAL.
            ----------------------------------

            (a)   The liquidator(s), the General Partner and their respective
officers, directors, agents, partners and Affiliates shall not be personally
liable for the return of the capital contributions of any Partner.

            (b)   If, after the Partnership has made its final Liquidating
Distribution, the General Partner's Capital Account is negative, then,
notwithstanding the foregoing, the General Partner shall return to the
Partnership part or all of of the distributions received by it pursuant to
Article IX or this Article XII in an aggregate amount equal to such deficit
but not in excess of such Partner's Restoration Amount.  Returns made by a
Partner pursuant to this Section 12.6 shall be made in cash.  The Partners
shall use best efforts to make any such returns promptly and in any event in
conformity with the timing requirements of Treasury Regulation Section
1.704-l(b)(2)(ii)(g).  Amounts repaid by the Partners pursuant to this
                  -
Section 12.6 shall be paid to a Fund in satisfaction of the Partnership's
obligation to restore a deficit in its capital account as maintained by such
Fund, paid to other creditors of the Partnership or distributed to Partners with
positive balances in their Capital Accounts in proportion to such balances.

                      ARTICLE XIII - LIMITATION ON TRANSFER OF
                      ----------------------------------------
                 INTERESTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS OR RETIRED PARTNERS.
                 -------------------------------------------------

      13.1  CONSENT OF GENERAL PARTNER TO TRANSFERS.  The prior written
            ---------------------------------------
consent of the General Partner, which consent may be granted or withheld in
the General Partner's absolute discretion, shall be required for any Transfer
of part or all of any Limited Partner's or Retired Partner's interest in the
Partnership.

      13.2  OPINION OF COUNSEL.  Any Transfer shall be made only upon receipt
            ------------------
by the Partnership of a written opinion of counsel for the Partnership or of
other counsel reasonably satisfactory to the Partnership (which opinion shall
be obtained at the expense of the transferor) that such Transfer will not
result in (a) the Partnership or the General Partner being subjected to any
additional regulatory requirements, (b) a violation of applicable law or this
Agreement, (c) the Partnership being classified as an association taxable as
a corporation, (d) the Partnership becoming subject to tax as a corporation
pursuant to Section 7704 of the Code, or (e) the Partnership being deemed
terminated pursuant to Section 708 of the Code.

      13.3  EXPENSES.  The transferor of any interest in the Partnership
            --------
hereby agrees to reimburse the Partnership, at the request of the General
Partner, for any expenses reasonably incurred by the Partnership in the
course of consummating such Transfer.

                                    - 17 -
<PAGE> 23

      13.4  SUBSTITUTION OF LIMITED PARTNERS OR RETIRED PARTNERS.  Without
            ----------------------------------------------------
the consent of the General Partner and the aforesaid written opinion of
counsel, no transferee of a Partnership interest shall be admitted as a
substituted Limited Partner or Retired Partner.  Any transferee of a
Partnership interest transferred in accordance with the provisions of this
Article XIII shall be admitted as a substituted Limited Partner or Retired
Partner upon the later of the execution of the required amendment to this
Agreement or the effective date set forth in such amendment, and such
transferee shall succeed to the rights and liabilities of the transferor
Limited Partner or Retired Partner, and the Capital Account and Percentage
Interest of the transferor shall become the Capital Account and Percentage
Interest, respectively, of the transferee, to the extent of the interest
transferred.

      13.5  COVENANTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS AND RETIRED PARTNERS.
            --------------------------------------------------

            (a)   Except in accordance with the provisions of this Article
XIII, each Limited Partner and Retired Partner agrees with all other Partners
that it shall not make any Transfer of all or any part of its interest in the
Partnership.

            (b)   Each Limited Partner and Retired Partner, by its execution
of this Agreement, thereby agrees and consents to the admission of any
substituted Limited Partner or Retired Partner pursuant to the terms of this
Article XIII.  Any transferee of a Partnership interest shall execute a
power-of-attorney as provided in Section 20.2 and such other documents as the
General Partner may reasonably request to effect such substitution, including
an assumption of all obligations of the transferor Limited Partner or Retired
Partner under this Agreement.

            (c)   Any attempted Transfer of a Limited Partner's or Retired
Partner's interest without compliance with this Agreement shall be void.  In
the event of any transfer which shall result in multiple ownership of any
Limited Partner's or Retired Partner's interest in the Partnership, the
General Partner may require one or more trustees or nominees to be designated
as representing a portion of or the entire interest transferred for the
purpose of receiving all notices which may be given, and all payments which
may be made, under this Agreement and for the purpose of exercising all
rights which the transferor as a Limited Partner or Retired Partner has
pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement.  Every Transfer shall be
subject to all of the terms, conditions, restrictions and obligations of this
Agreement.

                                    - 18 -
<PAGE> 24

                 ARTICLE XIV - WITHDRAWAL OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS.
                 -------------------------------------------------

      14.1  WITHDRAWALS GENERALLY PROHIBITED.  Except as otherwise
            --------------------------------
specifically provided for in this Agreement, no Partner shall have the right
to withdraw its capital and profits from the Partnership.

      14.2  WITHDRAWAL UPON DEATH, DISABILITY, BANKRUPTCY OR TERMINATION OF
            ---------------------------------------------------------------
EMPLOYMENT.  In the event of (i) the occurrence with respect to any Limited
- ----------
Partner of an event described in Section 17-402(4) or (6) of the Delaware Act
as in effect on the date hereof, (ii) if any Limited Partner shall become
disabled, or (iii) if such Limited Partner shall no longer be an employee,
consultant or member of the Board of Directors of the General Partner or any
Affiliate thereof, such Limited Partner shall thereupon for purposes of this
Agreement be deemed to have withdrawn as of the date thereof, and in such
event such Limited Partner's interest in the Partnership as a Limited Partner
shall automatically be converted into a Retired Partner's interest in
accordance with the provisions of Article XV.  For purposes of this
Agreement, a Limited Partner shall be deemed to be disabled if he is unable
to perform his or her business obligations for any 180 days out of any
365-day period.

                       ARTICLE XV - RETIRED LIMITED PARTNERS.
                       -------------------------------------

      15.1  GENERAL.  A Limited Partner who withdraws, or the personal
            -------
representative or estate of a Limited Partner who shall be deemed to have
withdrawn, shall retain an interest in the Partnership as a Retired Partner;
such former Limited Partner's interest in the Partnership as a Limited
Partner shall be automatically converted into a Retired Partner's Interest;
and such Person shall be considered a Retired Partner for all purposes under
the terms of this Agreement, provided, however, that a Retired Partner shall
                             --------  -------
retain only the portion of his or her Percentage Interest indicated on
Schedule B, depending on whether such withdrawal is due to (i) death or
- ----------
disability ("Category A"), or (ii) withdrawal for any other reason (Category
B").

      Notwithstanding the foregoing, the General Partner may accelerate the
vesting schedule described above for any Retired Partner who is deemed to
have withdrawn from the Partnership, but shall be under no obligation to do
so, and may in its discretion do so for one or more Retired Partners and not
for all Retired Partners.  The table set forth above may not be altered with
respect to any particular Limited Partner without such Partner's prior
written consent.

      15.2  ADJUSTMENTS TO REFLECT RETIREMENT.
            ---------------------------------

            (a)   The portion of the Percentage Interest of a Limited Partner
which is not retained under subsection 15.1 shall

                                    - 19 -
<PAGE> 25
be allocated to the General Partner, unless the General Partner in its sole
discretion decides to allocate such portion of Percentage Interest to one or
more Partners in some other manner.

            (b)   In connection with any such adjustment of Percentage
Interests, the General Partner in its discretion may cause subsequent
allocations to be made in the manner described in Section 8.5.

      15.3  RETIRED PARTNER PARTICIPATION.  A Retired Partner shall take no
            -----------------------------
part in the management, policy or control of the Partnership and shall have
no power or authority to undertake any activities on behalf of the
Partnership or to sign for or to bind the Partnership.  Any Retired Partner
shall be bound by the terms of this Agreement and by all action taken by the
General Partners or the Limited Partners.  No Retired Partner, or trust for
the benefit of a Retired Partner or the children of a Retired Partner, shall
participate in any consent of the Limited Partners for any purpose hereunder.

                       ARTICLE XVI - LIMITATION ON TRANSFER OF
                       ---------------------------------------
                          INTEREST OF THE GENERAL PARTNER.
                          -------------------------------

      The General Partner may transfer its entire interest to a successor
General Partner which is an Affiliate of the General Partner, provided,
                                                              --------
further, that any such transfer shall be made only if it results in no
- -------
material adverse tax consequences to the Partnership, its Partners or the
Funds or their partners.  The General Partner shall not otherwise assign,
pledge, mortgage, hypothecate, sell or otherwise dispose of or encumber all
or any part of its general partnership interest.  Any attempted transfer of
the General Partner's interest in violation of this Article XVI shall be
void.

                           ARTICLE XVII - INDEMNIFICATION.
                           ------------------------------

      17.1  GENERAL PROVISIONS.  The General Partner, each Limited Partner
            ------------------
and Retired Partner and each officer, director, employee and agent of the
General Partner (each an "Indemnified Party" and collectively, the
"Indemnified Parties") shall be indemnified by the Partnership (only out of
Partnership assets, including the proceeds of liability insurance) against
any claim, demand, controversy, dispute, cost, loss, damage, expense
(including reasonable attorneys' fees), judgment and/or liability incurred by
or imposed upon such Indemnified Party in connection with any action, suit or
proceeding (including any proceeding before any administrative or legislative
body or agency), to which such Indemnified Party may be made a party or
otherwise involved or with which such Indemnified Party shall be threatened,
by reason of such Indemnified Party's being at the time the cause of action
arose or thereafter, the General Partner (including without limitation the
General Partner acting as Tax Matters Partner) or a current or former
director, officer,

                                    - 20 -
<PAGE> 26
employee or agent of the General Partner (provided, with respect to any
Indemnified Party other than the General Partner, that in such capacity such
Indemnified Party was performing services on behalf of the Partnership or the
Fund), a Limited Partner performing services for the Partnership at the
request of the General Partner, or a director, officer, partner or employee
of any other organization in which the Partnership or the Fund owns an
interest (or has owned an interest at any time during the full calendar year
preceding the date on which the acts or omissions giving rise to such
Indemnified Party's claim for indemnity hereunder first occurred) or of which
the Partnership or the Fund is a creditor (to the extent such Indemnified
Party has not been indemnified by such other organization), which other
organization such Indemnified Party serves or has served as director,
officer, partner or employee at the request of the Partnership or the Fund
(whether or not such Indemnified Party continues to be a director, officer,
employee or agent of the General Partner or an officer, director, partner or
employee of such other organization at the time such action, suit or
proceeding is brought or threatened), except with respect to matters as to
which such Indemnified Party shall have been finally adjudicated in any such
action, suit or proceeding not to have acted in good faith or to have acted
with gross negligence or a willful disregard of such Indemnified Party's
duties, or in breach of such Indemnified Party's fiduciary obligations, or,
with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, to have had reasonable
cause to believe such Indemnified Party's conduct was unlawful.  In the event
of settlement of any action, suit or proceeding brought or threatened, such
indemnification shall apply to all matters covered by the settlement except
for matters as to which the Partnership is advised by independent counsel
(who may be counsel to the Partnership) that the Person seeking
indemnification, in the opinion of counsel, did not act in good faith or
acted with gross negligence or a willful disregard of such Person's duties,
or in breach of such Person's fiduciary obligations, or, with respect to any
criminal action or proceeding, that the Person seeking indemnification had
reasonable cause to believe such Person's conduct was unlawful.  The
foregoing right of indemnification shall be in addition to any rights to
which an Indemnified Party may otherwise be entitled and shall inure to the
benefit of the executors, administrators, personal representatives,
successors or assigns of each such Indemnified Party.  Notwithstanding the
foregoing, no payments shall be made with respect to a claim for
indemnification hereunder unless the Indemnified Party has made reasonable
efforts to reduce the amount of an indemnified loss by seeking contribution
from other sources.

      17.2  ADVANCE PAYMENT OF EXPENSES.  The Partnership shall pay the
            ---------------------------
expenses incurred by an Indemnified Party in defending a civil or criminal
action, suit or proceeding, or in opposing any claim arising in connection
with any potential or threatened civil or criminal action, suit or
proceeding, in

                                    - 21 -
<PAGE> 27
advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or proceeding, provided
that the Indemnified Party provides a legally enforceable undertaking to repay
such payment if such Indemnified Party shall be determined not to be entitled
thereto as provided herein.

      17.3  INSURANCE.  The General Partner, on behalf of the Partnership,
            ---------
may cause the Partnership to purchase and maintain insurance, at the expense
of the Partnership and to the extent available, for the protection of any
Indemnified Party against any liability incurred by such Person, whether or
not the Partnership has the power to indemnify such Person against such
liability.

      17.4  LIMITATION OR EXPANSION BY LAW.  If the General Partner or the
            ------------------------------
Partnership is subject to any federal or state law, rule or regulation which
restricts the extent to which any Person may be exonerated or indemnified by
the Partnership, then the indemnification provisions set forth in this
Article XVII and the exoneration provisions set forth in Section 3.5 shall be
deemed to be amended, automatically and without further action by the General
Partner or the Limited Partners, to conform to such restrictions on
exoneration or indemnification as set forth in such applicable federal or
state law, rule or regulation.  If any law, statute, rule or regulation of
any jurisdiction by which the Partnership may be governed is amended in the
future to enlarge the scope of indemnification or eliminate or reduce the
liability of any Indemnified Party, then this Article XVII and Section 3.5
may be amended and modified at the sole discretion of the General Partner
without any further action by the Limited Partners to broaden correspondingly
the exoneration or indemnification provided hereunder.  The rights to
indemnification and advance payment of expenses conferred by this Article
XVII shall not be exclusive of any other right which any Indemnified Party
may have or hereafter acquire under any law, statute, rule, regulation,
charter document, by-law, contract or agreement.

                  ARTICLE XVIII - ACCOUNTING, RECORDS AND REPORTS.
                  -----------------------------------------------

      18.1  FISCAL YEAR.  The fiscal year of the Partnership shall be the
            -----------
period ending on December 31.

      18.2  KEEPING OF ACCOUNTS AND RECORDS.  At all times the General
            -------------------------------
Partner shall cause to be kept proper and complete books of account, in which
shall be entered fully and accurately the transactions of the Partnership.
Such books of account (which shall be kept on the accrual method of
accounting), together with (a) an executed copy of this Agreement (and any
amendments hereto), (b) the Certificate of Limited Partnership of the
Partnership (and any amendments thereto); (c) executed copies of any powers
of attorney pursuant to which any certificate has been executed by the
Partnership; (d) a current list of the full name, taxpayer identification
number and last known address of each

                                    - 22 -
<PAGE> 28
Partner set forth in alphabetical order; (e) copies of all federal, state and
local tax returns, if any, filed by the Partnership for each of the prior
three years; and (f) all financial statements of the Partnership for each of
the prior three years, shall at all times be maintained at the principal
office of the Partnership and shall be open to inspection by the Partners or
their duly authorized representatives.

      18.3  INSPECTION RIGHTS.  At any time while the Partnership continues
            -----------------
and until its complete liquidation (but only during reasonable business
hours), each Limited Partner and Retired Partner (or the designee thereof)
may fully examine and audit the Partnership's books, records, accounts and
assets, including bank balances, and may make, or cause to be made, any
examination or audit at such Partner's expense.  Each Limited Partner and
Retired Partner (or the designee thereof) may, during normal business hours,
examine, or request that the General Partner furnish, such additional
information as is reasonably necessary to enable the requesting Partner (or
the designee thereof) to review the state of the affairs of the Partnership.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, the management of the affairs of the
Partnership shall be in the complete control of the General Partner and the
General Partner shall have the benefit of the confidential information
provisions of Section 17-305(b) of the Delaware Act, and provided, further,
                                                         --------  -------
that no Limited Partner shall be entitled to inspect any matter which the
General Partner considers confidential concerning another Limited Partner,
including but not limited to the supplements referred to on Schedule A.

      18.4  ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.  The General Partner shall transmit
            ---------------------------
to each Partner, as soon as practicable and in any event within one hundred
and twenty (120) days after the close of each fiscal year, the financial
statements of the Partnership for such fiscal year.  Such financial
statements shall include balance sheets of the Partnership as of the end of
such fiscal year and of the preceding fiscal year, statements of income and
loss of the Partnership for such fiscal year and for the preceding fiscal
year, all prepared in accordance with tax accounting principles consistently
applied in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.  A separate schedule
of changes in each particular Partner's Capital Account shall also be
provided to each such Partner.  The General Partner shall also transmit to
each Partner, as soon as practicable after the close of each fiscal year and
in any event by April 15, such Partner's Schedule K-1 (Form 1065) or an
equivalent report indicating such Partner's share of all items of income or
gain, expense, loss or other deduction and tax credit of the Partnership for
such year for federal income tax purposes, as well as the status of his
Capital Account as of the end of such year, and such additional information
as he reasonably may request to enable him to complete his tax returns or to
fulfill any other reporting requirements.

                                    - 23 -
<PAGE> 29

      18.5  ACCOUNTING METHOD.  The Partnership may use the the accrual
            -----------------
method of accounting (or, subject to Section 448 of the Code, the cash method
of accounting) for federal income tax purposes.

                         ARTICLE XIX - WAIVER AND AMENDMENT.
                         ----------------------------------

      Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the terms and
provisions of this Agreement may be waived, modified or amended only with the
written consent of the General Partner and of at Limited Partners holding at
least fifty-one percent (51%) of the Percentage Interests held by all Limited
Partners.  No amendment shall, however, (a) enlarge the obligations of any
Partner under this Agreement without the written consent of such Partner, (b)
dilute the relative interest of any Partner in the profits or capital of the
Partnership or in Partnership allocations and distributions attributable to
the interest owned by such Partner without the written consent of such
Partner (except such dilution as may result from additional Subscriptions
from the Partners or the admission of additional Limited Partners in
accordance with the terms hereof), or (c) alter or waive the terms of this
Article XIX without the consent of any Partner who would be adversely
affected thereby.  The General Partner shall promptly furnish copies of any
amendments to this Agreement to all Partners.

                          ARTICLE XX - GENERAL PROVISIONS.
                          -------------------------------

      20.1  NOTICES.  Except where otherwise specifically provided in this
            -------
Agreement, all notices, requests, consents, approvals and statements shall be
in writing and shall be deemed to have been properly given by personal
delivery or if mailed from within the United States by first class U.S. mail,
postage prepaid, or if sent by prepaid courier service, prepaid telegram,
telex or electronic facsimile transmission, addressed in each case, if to the
Partnership, at CityPlace II, 185 Asylum Street, Hartford, Connecticut
06103-4105, fax number (203) 520-1299, and if to any Partner, to the address
of such Partner as set forth in Schedule A or in the instrument pursuant to
                                ----------
which it became a Partner or, in each case, to such other address or
addresses as the addressee may have specified by written notice as aforesaid
to the other parties.

      20.2  POWER OF ATTORNEY.
            -----------------

            (a)   Each of the Partners hereby constitutes and appoints the
General Partner as its true and lawful attorney-in-fact, in its name, place
and stead to make, execute, sign, acknowledge and file (1) a Certificate of
Limited Partnership under the laws of the State of Delaware or any other
jurisdiction, any amendment or restatement to any such Certificate of Limited
Partnership and any other document,

                                    - 24 -
<PAGE> 30
instrument or certificate which may from time to time be required by law to
effectuate, implement and continue the valid and subsisting existence of the
Partnership, or any other instrument, certificate or document required from
time to time to admit a Partner, to effect its substitution as a Partner, to
effect the substitution of the Partner's assignee as a Partner, or to reflect
any action of the Partners provided for in this Agreement; and (2) any other
instrument, certificate or document as may be required or appropriate under
the laws, regulations or procedures of the United States, any state or any
governmental entity in any jurisdiction in which the Partnership is
conducting or intends to conduct its activities, provided all such
instruments, certificates and other documents referred to in clauses (1) and
(2) above are in accordance with the terms of this Agreement as then in
effect.  Copies of all such instruments, certificates and other documents
shall be sent to all Partners.

            (b)   Each of the Partners is aware that the terms of this
Agreement permit certain amendments to the Certificate of Limited Partnership
and this Agreement to be effected and certain other actions to be taken by or
with respect to the Partnership, in each case with the approval or by the
vote of less than all the Partners.  If, as and when (1) an amendment of the
Certificate of Limited Partnership or this Agreement is proposed or an action
is proposed to be taken by or with respect to the Partnership which does not
require, under the terms of this Agreement, the approval of all of the
Partners, (2) Partners holding the interest in the Partnership specified in
this Agreement as being required for such amendment or action have approved
such amendment or action in the manner contemplated by this Agreement and (3)
a Partner has failed or refused to approve such amendment or action
(hereinafter referred to as a non-consenting Partner), each non-consenting
Partner agrees that the special attorney specified above, with full power of
substitution, is hereby authorized and empowered to execute, acknowledge,
make, swear to, verify, deliver, record, file and/or publish, for and on
behalf of such non-consenting Partner, and in its name, place and stead, any
and all instruments and documents which may be necessary or appropriate to
permit such amendment to be lawfully made or action lawfully taken.  Each
Partner is fully aware that it and each other Partner has executed this
special power of attorney, and that each Partner will rely on the
effectiveness of such powers with a view to the orderly administration of the
Partnership's affairs.

            (c)   The foregoing grant of authority (1) is a special power of
attorney coupled with an interest in favor of the General Partner and as such
shall be irrevocable and shall survive the death or disability of a Partner
that is a natural person and the merger, dissolution or other termination of
the existence of a Partner that is a corporation, association, partnership or
trust, and (2) shall survive the assignment by the

                                    - 25 -
<PAGE> 31
Partner of the whole or any portion of its interest, except that where the
assignee of the whole thereof has furnished a power of attorney, this power
of attorney shall survive such assignment for the sole purpose of enabling
the General Partner to execute, acknowledge and file any instrument necessary
to effect any permitted substitution of the assignee for the assignor as a
Partner and shall thereafter terminate.

            (d)   The General Partner shall require a similar power of
attorney to be executed by a transferee of a Partner as a condition of its
admission as a substituted Partner.

      20.3  WAIVER OF PARTITION.  Each Partner hereby irrevocably waives any
            -------------------
and all rights that it may have to maintain an action for partition of any of
the Partnership's property.

      20.4  ADDITIONAL DOCUMENTS.  Each Partner hereby agrees to execute all
            --------------------
certificates, counterparts, amendments, instruments or documents that may be
required by laws of the various states or other jurisdictions in which the
Partnership conducts its activities, to conform with the laws of such states
or other jurisdictions governing limited partnerships.

      20.5  BINDING ON SUCCESSORS.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
            ---------------------
it shall inure to the benefit of the respective heirs, successors, assigns
and legal representatives of the parties hereto.

      20.6  COUNTERPARTS.  This Agreement or any amendment hereto may be
            ------------
signed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an original, but
all of which taken together shall constitute one agreement (or amendment, as
the case may be).

      20.7  VOTING.  Any vote or other action required or permitted to be
            ------
taken by this Agreement may be taken by written consent signed by not less
than the requisite number of parties required or permitted to take such vote
or other action.

      20.8  GOVERNING LAW.  This Agreement shall be governed by and construed
            -------------
in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware.

      20.9  SECURITIES ACT MATTERS.  Each Partner understands that in
            ----------------------
addition to the restrictions on transfer contained in this Agreement, it must
bear the economic risks of its investment for an indefinite period because
the Partnership interests have not been registered under the Securities Act
and, therefore, may not be sold or otherwise transferred unless they are
registered under the Securities Act or an exemption from such registration is
available.  Each Partner agrees with all other Partners that it will not sell
or otherwise transfer its interest in the Partnership unless such interest
has been so registered or in the

                                    - 26 -
<PAGE> 32
opinion of counsel for the Partnership, or of other counsel reasonably
satisfactory to the Partnership, such an exemption is available.

      20.10 AUTHORITY OF GENERAL PARTNER.  No Person dealing with the
            ----------------------------
General Partner shall be required to determine its authority to make any
commitment or undertaking on behalf of the Partnership or to determine any
fact or circumstance bearing upon the existence of its authority and,
notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, the acts of the
General Partner in carrying on the activities of the Partnership as
authorized herein shall bind the Partnership.

      20.11 CONTRACT CONSTRUCTION.  Whenever the content of this Agreement
            ---------------------
permits, the masculine gender shall include the feminine and neuter genders,
and reference to singular or plural shall be interchangeable with the other.
The invalidity or unenforceability of any one or more provisions of this
Agreement shall not affect the other provisions, and the Agreement shall be
construed in all respects as if any such invalid or unenforceable
provision(s) were omitted.  References in this Agreement to particular
sections of the Code or the Delaware Act shall be deemed to refer to such
sections as they may be amended after the date of this Agreement.

      20.12 SECTION HEADINGS.  Captions in this Agreement are for convenience
            ----------------
only and do not define or limit any term of this Agreement.

                 [Remainder of this page intentionally left blank.]

                                    - 27 -
<PAGE> 33

      IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Amended and
Restated Limited Partnership Agreement as of the day, month and year first
above written.
                                                GENERAL PARTNER:

                                                CONNING & COMPANY


                                                By: /s/ John B. Clinton
                                                   -----------------------------
                                                Title: Senior Vice President


                                                LIMITED PARTNERS:

                                                /s/ James T. Bagley
                                                --------------------------------
                                                James T. Bagley

                                                /s/ Thomas A. Byrne
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Thomas A. Byrne

                                                /s/ Stephan L. Christiansen
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Stephan L. Christiansen

                                                /s/ John B. Clinton
                                                --------------------------------
                                                John B. Clinton

                                                /s/ John A. Corroon, Jr.
                                                --------------------------------
                                                John A. Corroon, Jr.

                                                /s/ Walter M. Fiederowicz
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Walter M. Fiederowicz

                                                /s/ Mark E. Hansen
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Mark E. Hansen

                                                /s/ Donald L. McDonald
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Donald L. McDonald

                                    - 28 -
<PAGE> 34

                                                /s/ Gordon G. Pratt
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Gordon G. Pratt

                                                /s/ Gary K. Ransom
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Gary K. Ransom

                                                /s/ David N. Reid
                                                --------------------------------
                                                David N. Reid

                                                /s/ Harold Sandstrom
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Harold Sandstrom

                                                /s/ Joseph D. Sargent
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Joseph D. Sargent

                                                /s/ Thomas D. Sargent
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Thomas D. Sargent

                                                /s/ Fred M. Schpero
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Fred M. Schpero

                                                /s/ William C. Shenton
                                                --------------------------------
                                                William C. Shenton

                                                /s/ Maurice W. Slayton
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Maurice W. Slayton

                                                /s/ Gerard Vecchio
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Gerard Vecchio

                                 * * *

Schedule for the general partner and for each limited partner, listing the
name, address, total subscription amount and percentage interest of such
general or limited partner.


                                    - 29 -
<PAGE> 35



                                                                      Schedule B
                                                                      ----------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Period After Receipt
of Portion of
Percentage Interest                 Category A -                    Category B -
During Which                        If Withdrawal is Due to         If Withdrawal is
Retired Partner                     Death or Disability -           For Any Other Reason -
is Deemed to Have                   Portion of Percentage           Portion of Percentage
Withdrawn.<F*>                      Interest Retained               Interested Retained
- --------------------                -----------------------         ----------------------
<S>                                <C>                             <C>
Before three years                            0%                              0%

On or after three years
 and before four years                       30%                             15%

On or after four years             an additional                   an additional
 and before five years                       30%                             15%

On or after five years             an additional                   an additional
 and before six years                        30%                             15%

On or after six years                                              an additional
 and before seven years                     100%                             15%

On or after seven years                     100%                            100%

<FN>
<F*>  To the extent a Retired Partner received portions of his or her Percentage
      Interest on more than one date, such percentages retained above shall be
      separately applied to each portion based on its date of receipt, to
      produce a total retained Percentage Interest.  In any event, and
      notwithstanding the foregoing schedules, Percentage Interests shall be
      100% vested on December 28, 2003.
</TABLE>

                                    - 33 -
<PAGE> 36

                                                                      Schedule C
                                                                      ----------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           General Partner's Percentage
Allocation Period                    Allocation Date           Interest Reduced To:
- -----------------                    ---------------       ----------------------------
<S>                                  <C>                   <C>
Inception                            By April 30, 1994                 88%
First Year                           By January 31, 1995               76%
Second Year                          By January 31, 1996               64%
Third Year                           By January 31, 1997               52%
Fourth Year                          By January 31, 1998               40%
</TABLE>

                                    - 34 -
<PAGE> 37

                                     APPENDIX A
                                     ----------

                                TABLE OF DEFINITIONS
                                --------------------

      "AFFILIATE" shall mean, with respect to the Person to which it refers,
       ---------
a Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries,
controls or is controlled by, or is under common control with, such subject
Person; provided, however, that all partners of the Partnership and all
        --------  -------
officers, directors and employees of the General Partner shall be deemed to
be Affiliates of the Partnership.

      "CAPITAL ACCOUNT" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 7.1.
       ---------------

      "CODE" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and the rules and
       ----
regulations promulgated thereunder, as amended from time to time.

      "COST" shall mean, with respect to Partnership assets and unless the
       ----
context otherwise requires, the Partnership's adjusted tax basis of such
assets for federal income tax purposes, provided that (i) if the Partnership
has made an election under Section 754 of the Code, such tax basis shall be
determined after giving effect to adjustments made under Section 734 of the
Code but without regard to adjustments made under Section 743 of the Code;
and (ii) the Cost of any securities or other property received by the
Partnership in distributions made by the Fund shall be deemed to equal the
fair market value of such property, as determined pursuant to the Fund
Partnership Agreement, as of the date such property is distributed by the
Fund.

      "DELAWARE ACT" shall mean the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited
       ------------
Partnership Act, as amended from time to time.

      "DOMESTIC FUND" shall mean Conning Insurance Capital Limited
       -------------
Partnership III, a Delaware limited partnership.

      "FUND(S)" shall mean either or both of the Domestic Funds and the
       -------
Offshore Fund.

      "FUND PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT(S)" shall mean one or more of the limited
       -----------------------------
partnership agreements of the Domestic Fund and the Offshore Fund.

      "GENERAL PARTNER" shall mean Conning & Company, a Connecticut
       ---------------
corporation, that serves as the sole general partner of the Partnership, and
any successor or thereto pursuant to the provisions of Article XVI.

      "INDEMNIFIED PARTIES" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 17.1.
       -------------------

                                    -i-
<PAGE> 38

      "ISSUANCE ITEMS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 8.6(b).
       --------------

      "LIMITED PARTNERS" shall mean those Persons listed in Schedule A hereto
       ----------------                                     ----------
as limited partners, together with any additional or substituted limited
partners admitted to the Partnership after the date hereof.  Whether a
majority in interest (or any other specified percentage in interest) consents
to any action permitted or required of the Limited Partners under this
Agreement shall be determined as provided in Section 20.7.

      "LIQUIDATING DISTRIBUTION" shall mean any distribution made by the
       ------------------------
Partnership after the latest to occur of (a) the Partnership's dissolution,
determined pursuant to Article XIII, and (b) the date on which the
Partnership has received its final distribution from the Fund.

      "NET GAIN OR LOSS" shall mean, with respect to any fiscal period, the
       ----------------
sum of (a) all amounts allocated for such fiscal period to the Partnership
pursuant to the Fund Partnership Agreement to the Partnership in its capacity
as the general partner of the Fund, (b) net gain or loss from the sale or
exchange of the Partnership's capital assets during such fiscal period, (c)
gain or loss deemed to have been realized by the Partnership, pursuant to
Section 7.2, on a distribution in kind of its assets during such fiscal
period, and (d) other items of income, gain, loss, deduction and expense of
the Partnership for such fiscal period that are not included in (a), (b) or
(c), including any income which is exempt from federal income tax, all
Partnership losses and all expenses properly chargeable to the Partnership,
whether deductible or non-deductible and whether described in Section
705(a)(2)(B) of the Code, treated as so described pursuant to Treasury
Regulation Section 1.704-l(b)(2)(iv)(i), or otherwise except for Issuance
                                                      ------ ---
Items.  Net Gain or Loss shall be determined in accordance with tax
accounting principles rather than generally accepted accounting principles.

      "OFFSHORE FUND" shall mean Conning Insurance Capital International
       -------------
Partners III, a Cayman Islands limited partnership.

      "PARTNERS" shall mean the General Partner and the Limited Partners.
       --------

      "PARTNERSHIP" shall mean Conning Investment Partners Limited
       -----------
Partnership III.

      "PERSON" shall mean any individual, partnership, corporation, trust or
       ------
other entity.

      "PERCENTAGE INTEREST" shall mean, with respect to any Partner and at
       -------------------
any time, the amount set forth at such time opposite such Partner's name in
Schedule A under the heading "Percentage Interest."
- ----------

                                    -ii-
<PAGE> 39

      "RESTORATION AMOUNT" shall mean, with respect to any Partner and at any
       ------------------
time, (a) any amount of such Partner's Subscription that such Partner has not
contributed in cash to the Partnership as of such time; and (b) in the case
of the General Partner only, any amounts the General Partner is required to
restore to the Funds pursuant to Section 12.6.

      "RETIRED PARTNER" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 15.1.
       ---------------

      "SECURITIES ACT" shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended from
       --------------
time to time.

      "SHORT-TERM INCOME" shall mean interest and dividend income earned on
       -----------------
temporary investment of capital contributions or distributions received from
the Fund(s) which are held by the Partnership pending investment in the
Fund(s), disbursement for expenses or distribution to the Partners.

      "SUBSCRIPTION" shall mean, with respect to any Partner, the total
       ------------
amount which such Partner has agreed to contribute to the Partnership as
reflected on Schedule A hereto.
             ----------

      "TAX MATTERS PARTNER" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3.7.
       -------------------

      "TRANSFER" shall mean any transfer, sale, assignment, gift, pledge,
       --------
hypothecation or other disposition of an interest in the Partnership.


<PAGE> 40

                 CONNING INVESTMENT PARTNERS LIMITED PARTNERSHIP III
                               AMENDMENT NO. 1 TO THE
                 AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT

      AGREEMENT OF AMENDMENT, dated as of the 18th day of March, 1994, by and
among Conning & Company, the undersigned general partner (the "General
Partner"), and the undersigned limited partners, together with any other
persons or entities subsequently admitted as limited partners (the "Limited
Partners").  The General Partner and the Limited Partners are referred to
collectively as the "Partners."

      WHEREAS, by executing the limited partnership agreement of Conning
Investment Partners Limited Partnership III, a Delaware limited partnership
(the "Partnership") dated as of December 28, 1993, (the "Initial Partnership
Agreement"), the Partners formed the Partnership pursuant to the provisions
of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act;

      WHEREAS, the Partners caused the Initial Partnership Agreement to be
amended and restated in its entirety by adopting the Amended and Restated
Limited Partnership Agreement of the Partnership dated March 18, 1994 (the
"Restated Agreement"); and

      WHEREAS, the Partners desire to amend the Restated Agreement in the
manner set forth below;

      NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the agreements
contained herein, and intending to be legally bound hereby, the parties
hereto agree as follows:

      1.    Section 15.2(b) of the Restated Agreement is hereby deleted in
its entirety and replaced with the following new Sections 15.2(b), 15.2(c)
and 15.2(d).
            "(b)  If any Partner withdraws, or is deemed to have withdrawn,
      from the Partnership at any time before any part of such Partner's
      Percentage Interest has vested, the Partnership may, but shall not be
      obligated to, elect to purchase such Partner's interest in the Partnership
      for an amount equal to the balance in such Partner's Capital Account at
      the time of such withdrawal.  Any such election shall be made by delivery
      of written notice to that effect signed by the General Partner and
      delivered to the withdrawing Partner within 120 days after the date of
      such Partner's withdrawal.  If the Partnership elects to purchase the
      withdrawing Partner's interest in the Partnership, payment to the
      withdrawing Partner for such Partner's interest shall be made, in cash,
      within 180 days after the date of such withdrawal."


<PAGE> 41

                                    - 2 -

            "(c)  After the withdrawal or deemed withdrawal of any Partner
      before any part of such Partner's Percentage Interest has vested, if the
      Partnership does not elect to purchase such former Partner's interest in
      the Partnership as provided in Section 15.2(b):  (1) the balance in such
      former Partner's Capital Account shall be frozen at an amount equal to the
      balance in such account as of the date of such former Partner's withdrawal
      or deemed withdrawal; (2) such former Partner shall receive no allocations
      from the Partnership for any fiscal period after that withdrawal date; and
      (3) such former Partner shall receive no distributions from the
      Partnership other than such former Partner's proportionate share, based on
      the relative Capital Account balances of such former Partner, the General
      Partner, the Limited Partners and any Retired Partners (determined at the
      time of distribution), of each distribution made pursuant to Section 12.2
      to all Partners in proportion to the positive balances in their respective
      Capital Accounts."

            "(d)  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, no
      Partner who has withdrawn or is deemed to have withdrawn from the
      Partnership before any part of such Partner's Percentage Interest has
      vested shall be entitled, after the date of such withdrawal, to inspect
      the Partnership's books or records or to receive any reports or other
      information from the Partnership except such former Partner's Schedule K-1
      to the Partnership's Internal Revenue Service Form 1065 and any equivalent
      state tax schedules or forms required to enable such former Partner to
      complete his or her tax returns for any fiscal period during which such
      former Partner is treated as a partner of the Partnership for tax
      purposes.  Any such former Partner hereby agrees that he or she shall
      continue to be treated as a partner of the Partnership, solely for tax
      purposes, until either (1) such former Partner has received the payment
      for his or her interest in the Partnership provided for under Section
      15.2(b) (if the Partnership has elected to purchase such former Partner's
      interest in the Partnership pursuant to Section 15.2(b)) or (2) such
      former Partner has received liquidating distributions from the Partnership
      in aggregate amounts equal to the positive balance in such former
      Partner's Capital Account (if the Partnership has not so elected)."


      2.    Section 8.7 of the Restated Agreement is hereby amended by
deleting the word "quarter" in the two instances in which it appears, and
replacing that word with the word "year".

      3.    Section 14.2 of the Restated Agreement is hereby amended by
deleting the reference therein to "Section 17-402(4) or (6)" and replacing
that reference with "Section 17-402(a)(4) or (6)".


<PAGE> 42

                                    - 3 -


      4.    Section 15.1 of the Restated Agreement is hereby amended (a) by
adding, at the beginning of the first sentence thereof, the phrase "Subject
to Section 15.2"; and (b) by deleting, from the last sentence thereof, the
phrase "set forth above" and replacing that phrase with the phrase "set forth
in Schedule B".
   ----------

      5.    This Agreement of Amendment may be signed in counterparts, each
of which shall constitute an original, but all of which taken together shall
constitute one Agreement of Amendment.

      6.    The amendments set forth in the preceding sections of this
Agreement of Amendment shall be effective as of March 18, 1994.

                    [REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]


<PAGE> 43

                                    - 4 -


      IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Agreement of
Amendment as of the day and year first above written.

                                                GENERAL PARTNER:

                                                CONNING & COMPANY


                                                By: /s/ John B. Clinton
                                                   -----------------------------
                                                Title: Sr. Vice President


                                                LIMITED PARTNERS:

                                                /s/ James T. Bagley
                                                --------------------------------
                                                James T. Bagley

                                                /s/ Thomas A. Byrne
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Thomas A. Byrne

                                                /s/ Stephan L. Christiansen
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Stephan L. Christiansen

                                                /s/ John B. Clinton
                                                --------------------------------
                                                John B. Clinton

                                                /s/ John A. Corroon, Jr.
                                                --------------------------------
                                                John A. Corroon, Jr.

                                                /s/ Walter M. Fiederowicz
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Walter M. Fiederowicz

                                                /s/ Mark E. Hansen
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Mark E. Hansen

                                                /s/ Donald L. McDonald
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Donald L. McDonald

                                                /s/ Gordon G. Pratt
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Gordon G. Pratt


<PAGE> 44

                                    - 5 -


                                                LIMITED PARTNERS

                                                /s/ Gary K. Ransom
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Gary K. Ransom

                                                /s/ David N. Reid
                                                --------------------------------
                                                David N. Reid

                                                /s/ Harold Sandstrom
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Harold Sandstrom

                                                /s/ Joseph D. Sargent
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Joseph D. Sargent

                                                /s/ Thomas D. Sargent
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Thomas D. Sargent

                                                /s/ Fred M. Schpero
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Fred M. Schpero

                                                /s/ William C. Shenton
                                                --------------------------------
                                                William C. Shenton

                                                /s/ M. W. Slayton
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Maurice W. Slayton

                                                /s/ Gerard Vecchio
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Gerard Vecchio


<PAGE> 45


                 CONNING INVESTMENT PARTNERS LIMITED PARTNERSHIP III
                               AMENDMENT NO. 2 TO THE
                 AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED PARRTNERSHIP AGREEMENT



      WHEREAS, Paul S. Goulekas ("Goulekas") and Steven F. Piaker ("Piaker")
desire to be admitted as limited partners to the Conning Investment Partners
Limited Partnership III Amended and Restated as of March 18, 1994 and as
subsequently amended through but not including the date hereof (the
"Partnership");

      WHEREAS, Conning & Company, the undersigned general partner (the
"General Partner") desires to have Goulekas and Piaker be admitted as limited
partners to the Partnership;

      WHEREAS, the General Partner desires, in accordance with Section 4.1 of
the Amended and Restated Limited Partnership Agreement of the Partnership
dated March 18, 1994 and as subsequently amended through but not including
the date hereof (the "Restated Agreement"), to reduce the General Partner's
Percentage Interest and increase the Percentage Interests of certain of the
Limited Partners;

      NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the agreements
contained herein, and intending to be legally bound hereby, the parties
hereto agree as follows:

      1.    Goulekas and Piaker agree to be admitted as limited partners to the
            Partnership, subject to the terms and conditions of the Restated
            Agreement, and each of them agrees to contribute to the Partnership
            his subscription amount as set forth in Schedule A to the Restated
            Agreement.

      2.    Schedule A to the Restated Agreement is hereby amended by deleting
            it in its entirety and replacing it with the attached Schedule A.

                    [REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]


<PAGE> 46

      IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Amendment No. 2
to the Restated Agreement as of the 17th of April, 1995.


                                                GENERAL PARTNER:

                                                CONNING & COMPANY


                                                By: /s/ Fred M. Schpero
                                                   -----------------------------
                                                Title: Vice President,
                                                       Secretary and CFO

                                                LIMITED PARTNERS:

                                                /s/ Paul S. Goulekas
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Paul S. Goulekas

                                                /s/ Steven F. Piaker
                                                --------------------------------
                                                Steven F. Piaker

                                * * *

Schedule for the general partner and for each limited partner, listing the
name, address, total subscription amount and percentage interest of such
general or limited partner.


<PAGE> 47

                 CONNING INVESTMENT PARTNERS LIMITED PARTNERSHIP III
                               AMENDMENT NO. 3 TO THE
                 AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT

      WHEREAS, Frank D. Campbell ("Campbell"), Scott E. Daniels ("Daniels"),
Claude A. Fongemie ("Fongemie"), Seth C. Miller ("Miller"), Allen A. Mossein
("Mossein"), Stephen R. Pivacek ("Pivacek"), William E. Rotatori ("Rotatori")
and Paul J. Sellier ("Sellier") desire to be admitted as limited partners to
the Conning Investment Partners Limited Partnership III Amended and Restated
as of March 18, 1994 and as subsequently amended through but not including
the date hereof (the "Partnership");

      WHEREAS, Conning & Company, the undersigned general partner (the
"General Partner") desires to have Campbell, Daniels, Fongemie, Miller,
Mossein, Pivacek, Rotatori and Sellier be admitted as limited partners to the
Partnership;

      WHEREAS, the General Partner desires, in accordance with Section 4.1 of
the Amended and Restated Limited Partnership Agreement of the Partnership
dated March 18, 1994 and as subsequently amended through but not including
the date hereof (the "Restated Agreement"), to reduce the General Partner's
Percentage Interest and increase the Percentage Interests of certain of the
Limited Partners;

      NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the agreements
contained herein, and intending to be legally bound hereby, the parties
hereto agree as follows:

            1.    Campbell, Daniels, Fongemie, Miller, Mossein, Pivacek,
                  Rotatori and Sellier agree to be admitted as limited partners
                  to the Partnership, subject to the terms and conditions of the
                  Restated Agreement, and each of them agrees to contribute to
                  the Partnership his subscription amount as set forth in
                  Schedule A to the Restated Agreement.

            2.    Schedule A to the Restated Agreement is hereby amended by
                  deleting it in its entirety and replacing it with the
                  attached Schedule A.

                    [REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]


<PAGE> 48


       IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Amendment No. 3
to the Restated Agreement as of the 15th of December, 1995.


                                               GENERAL PARTNER:

                                               CONNING & COMPANY

                                               By: /s/ Fred M. Schpero
                                                  ------------------------------
                                               Title: Vice President, Secretary
                                                      & Chief Financial Officer


                                               LIMITED PARTNERS:

                                               /s/ Frank D. Campbell
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Frank D. Campbell

                                               /s/ Scott Daniels
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Scott E. Daniels

                                               /s/ Claude A. Fongemie
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Claude A. Fongemie

                                               /s/ Seth C. Miller
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Seth C. Miller

                                               /s/ Allen A. Mossein
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Allen A. Mossein

                                               /s/ Stephen R. Pivacek
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Stephen R. Pivacek

                                               /s/ William E. Rotatori
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               William E. Rotatori

                                               /s/ Paul J. Sellier
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Paul J. Sellier

                                * * *

Schedule for the general partner and for each limited partner, listing the
name, address, total subscription amount and percentage interest of such
general or limited partner.

<PAGE> 49

        CONNING INVESTMENT PARTNERS LIMITED PARTNERSHIP III
                      AMENDMENT NO. 4 TO THE
        AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED PARRTNERSHIP AGREEMENT


     WHEREAS, Sabra R. Brinkmann ("Brinkmann"), Douglas R. Koester
("Koester"), Daniel J. Mainolfi ("Mainolfi"), Michael D. McLellan
("McLellan"), Leonard M. Rubenstein ("Rubenstein") and J. Terri Tanaka
("Tankaka") desire to be admitted as limited parners to the Conning
Investment Partners Limited Partnership III Amended and Restated as of March
18, 1994 and as subsequently amended through but not including the date
hereof (the "Partnership");

     WHEREAS, Conning & Company, the undersigned general partner (the
"General Partner") desires to have Brinkmann, Koester, Mainolfi, McLellan,
Rubenstein and Tanaka be admitted as limited partners to the Partnership;

     WHEREAS, the General Partner desires, in accordance with Section 4.1
of the Amended and Restated Limited Patnership Agreement of the Partnership
dated March 18, 1994 and as subsequently amended through but not including
the date hereof (the "Restated Agreement"), to reduce the General Partner's
Percentage Interest and increase the Percentage Interests of certain of the
Limited Partners;

     NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the agreements
contained herein, and intending to be legally bound hereby, the parties
hereto agree as follows:

      1.    Brinkmann, Koester, Mainolfi, McLellan, Rubenstein and Tanaka
            agree to be admitted as limited partners to the Partnership,
            subject to the terms and conditions of the Restated Agreement,
            and each of them agrees to contribute to the Partnership his or
            her subscription amount as set forth in Schedule A to the
            Restated Agreement.

      2.    Schedule A to the Restated Agreement is hereby amended by deleting
            it in its entirety and replacing it with the attached Schedule A.

           [REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

<PAGE> 50

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Amendment No. 4
to the Restated Agreement as of the 18th of December, 1996.


                                          GENERAL PARTNER:

                                          CONNING & COMPANY


                                          By: /s/ M. W. Slayton
                                             ----------------------------------
                                          Title:  President


                                          LIMITED PARTNERS:


                                          /s/ Sabra R. Brinkmann
                                          -------------------------------------
                                          Sabra R. Brinkmann




                                          /s/ D. Koester
                                          -------------------------------------
                                          Douglas R. Koester




                                          /s/ Daniel J. Mainolfi
                                          -------------------------------------
                                          Daniel J. Mainolfi




                                          /s/ Michael D. McLellan
                                          -------------------------------------
                                          Michael D. McLellan




                                          /s/ Leonard M. Rubenstein
                                          -------------------------------------
                                          Leonard M. Rubenstein




                                          /s/ J. Terri Tanaka
                                          -------------------------------------
                                          J. Terri Tanaka



<PAGE> 1

              INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' CONSENT

The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Conning Corporation:


We consent to the use of our reports included herein and to the
references to our firm under the headings, "Selected Consolidated
Financial Data" and "Experts" in the prospectus.





                                    /s/ KPMG Peat Marwick LLP


St. Louis, Missouri
December 11, 1997

<PAGE> 1


                        CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS
                        ----------------------------------

We hereby consent to the use in the Prospectus constituting part of this
Registration Statement on Form S-1 of our report dated February 21, 1995,
except for Note 12, as to which the date is September 19, 1997, relating to the
financial statements of Conning, Inc. & Subsidiaries, which appears in such
Prospectus. We also consent to the reference to us under the heading "Experts"
in such Prospectus.





/s/ Price Waterhouse LLP

Hartford, Connecticut
December 11, 1997



© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission